UV WinLab Software Guide
UV WinLab Software Guide
UV WINLAB SOFTWARE
User’s Guide
2 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Any comments about the documentation for this product should be addressed to:
User Assistance
PerkinElmer, Inc.
710 Bridgeport Avenue
Shelton, CT 06484
Notices
Except as specifically set forth in its terms and conditions of sale, PerkinElmer
makes no warranty of any kind with regard to this document, including, but not
limited to, the implied warranties of merchantability and fitness for a particular
purpose.
PerkinElmer shall not be liable for errors contained herein for incidental consequential
damages in connection with furnishing, performance or use of this material.
Copyright Information
Trademarks
Registered names, trademarks, etc. used in this document, even when not specifically
marked as such, are protected by law.
Table of Contents
Introduction ...................................................................................................... 11
The UV WinLab HTML Help System ............................................................................ 12
Security ............................................................................................................. 13
Security Settings ....................................................................................................... 14
Users ........................................................................................................................ 15
Groups ..................................................................................................................... 18
Locking out users ...................................................................................................... 24
Passwords ................................................................................................................ 26
Summary .................................................................................................................. 29
Checksum Failures .................................................................................................... 30
Signatures ................................................................................................................ 32
Audit Trail ................................................................................................................. 36
Login History ............................................................................................................ 38
Explorer Window............................................................................................... 41
The Explorer ............................................................................................................. 42
Folders ..................................................................................................................... 49
Methods ................................................................................................................... 55
Viewing Methods in the Explorer .......................................................................... 55
Creating Methods ............................................................................................... 56
Using the New Method Wizard ............................................................................. 57
Using an existing method to create a new method ................................................ 58
Reviewing and approving Methods ....................................................................... 61
Viewing, editing and running methods ................................................................. 63
Example Methods for Medium Performance Instruments .............................................. 65
ASBC Color and Turbidity in Beer ............................................................................... 67
Bilirubin in CSF (UK Method) ...................................................................................... 68
Bradford Protein Assay .............................................................................................. 70
Chlorophyll a, b and c (Trichromatic) Determination .................................................... 72
Chlorophyll Determination (US10200H) ....................................................................... 74
Cytochrome P450 Determination ................................................................................ 76
G6PD Kinetics ........................................................................................................... 78
EU Olive Oil Determination ......................................................................................... 79
Lambda Max ............................................................................................................. 81
Lowry Protein Concentration ...................................................................................... 83
Naphthalene (ASTM D1840-03) .................................................................................. 85
Nitrate Determination (EPA 352.1/US Test Method 9200) ............................................ 87
Nucleic Acid Concentration and Purity ......................................................................... 89
Percentage Strength at 500 nm.................................................................................. 91
Phosphate in Water (EPA 365.2 & 365.3/DIN 38 405) ................................................ 92
Porphyrin Scan .......................................................................................................... 94
Sulfite in Food by Enzymatic Determination ................................................................ 95
Warburg–Christian Assay for Protein and Nucleic Acid Concentration ............................ 97
Wine Color Analysis ................................................................................................... 99
Scan and Second Derivative ..................................................................................... 101
Example Methods for High Performance Instruments ................................................ 103
Bandpass Filter Characterization ............................................................................... 104
Camouflage Using Integrating Sphere ...................................................................... 105
Color Difference (Delta E) ........................................................................................ 106
Measurement of Glass and Architectural Materials to EN410 ...................................... 108
Cut-Off Filter Characterization .................................................................................. 109
Film Thickness using Interference Fringes ................................................................. 110
Opacity Calculation for Paints and Coatings ............................................................... 111
Haze ASTM D-1003 ................................................................................................. 113
HP Reflectance Color User Selectable ....................................................................... 115
Simple Transmittance Color Method 5 nm ................................................................. 117
4 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Miscellaneous.......................................................................................................... 978
Templates............................................................................................................... 985
Reports .................................................................................................................. 993
Communiqué FAQ ................................................................................................... 997
Further Information ...................................................................................... 1003
Further Information ............................................................................................... 1004
Recommended Practices ........................................................................................ 1005
Handling Calibration Standards .............................................................................. 1006
Choice of Solvent .................................................................................................. 1007
IPV References ..................................................................................................... 1008
UV Spectroscopy ................................................................................................... 1010
Electronic Transitions ............................................................................................ 1011
Sources of Degradation of Spectrophotometric Performance .................................... 1013
Environment ................................................................................................... 1013
Line Power Supply .......................................................................................... 1013
Aging Lamp .................................................................................................... 1013
Alignment ...................................................................................................... 1013
Warm-up Time ............................................................................................... 1013
Sample Handling ............................................................................................ 1013
Aging of Instrument ........................................................................................ 1014
Proper Care of the Instrument ......................................................................... 1014
Frequently Asked Questions (FAQs) ........................................................................ 1015
Administration ................................................................................................ 1015
Databases and File Structure ........................................................................... 1015
Methods and Tasks ......................................................................................... 1017
IPV (Instrument Performance Verification) ....................................................... 1020
Printing .......................................................................................................... 1021
10 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Introduction
12 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Throughout the document we refer to two types of instrument supported by the software:
Medium performance instruments – Lambda 20, 40, 40P, 20Bio, 40Bio, 25, 35, 45, 365.
High performance instruments– Lambda 650, 650S, 750, 750S, 800, 850, 850+, 900,
950, 1050 NB, 1050 WB, and 1050+.
Security
14 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Security Settings
There are two versions of UV WinLab – Standard Security and Enhanced Security (ES). Some
of the settings described in these topics apply to both versions of the software, whereas
others vary depending on the type of security that you have. Where options vary, both are
explained.
The Security settings are only available to Administrators. From the Setup Users and Groups
dialog (accessed by selecting Setup Users and Groups from the Administration menu in the
Explorer), you are able to set up and edit users, groups, and password settings.
Within the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, Administrators are also able to define
the signature points within the software, and view the Audit Trail, Login History and
Summary.
Users
Groups
Passwords
Signatures
Audit Trail
Login History
Summary
Checksum Failures
UV WinLab Software Guide . 15
Users
What are the default users?
The Administrator is purely for setting up users, groups, passwords and signature points
(signature points are only available in the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab). They do
not have access to any functionality within the rest of the software. To use the software, a
person must be a member of one of the other default groups or a member of a new group
that the Administrator creates.
NOTE: By default, in the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, the default users are only
members of the default group with the same name. For example, the Analyst user is
a member of the Analysts groups, and the Developer is a member of the Developers
group.
1. If the Setup Users and Groups dialog is not displayed, select Setup Users and Groups
from the Administration menu.
The Setup Users and Groups dialog is displayed.
3. Enter the User name,Full name, Password, and repeat the Password in the Confirm
password entry field.
The password length is defined on the Password Control tab.
NOTE: The Password is case-sensitive. It can consist of letters, numbers and single spaces
only.
4. Select Enabled if you wish the user to be able to login or Disabled if you do not wish
them to be able to login at the current time.
5. If Enabled is selected, select User must change password at next login to force the
user to change their password when they log in.
16 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: In the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, User must change password at
next login is always selected, forcing the user to change their password when they
log in for the first time.
6. Click OK.
The User name drop-down list is updated with the new user.
1. Select the user from the Name drop-down list on the Users tab and then click Delete.
A message will be displayed asking you to confirm that you wish to delete the user.
2. Click Yes.
The user is deleted.
NOTE: It is not possible to reuse a User name that has been deleted.
NOTE: It is not possible to delete the Administrator from the Administrators group.
1. Select the user from the Name drop-down list on the Users tab.
2. Select the Group from the list of Available groups for user and then click Add.
The Group is added to the User is a member of list.
NOTE: When a group is added to the User is a member of list, it no longer appears in the
Available groups for user list.
To remove a user from a group, select the Name on the User tab, then, select the
group from the User is a member of list, and click Remove.
The user is removed from the group.
The group is removed from the User is a member of list, and is added to the Available
groups for user list.
If the Lockout is set to Permanent and the user has failed to login correctly within the
allowed number of attempts, the administrator must assign a new password before they are
able to login again.
When the administrator next logs in after a user has been locked out, a list of Locked Out
Users is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 17
1. Highlight the name of the user that you wish to reinstate and then click Edit.
The Edit User dialog is displayed.
3. Click OK.
The user is removed from the list of Locked Out Users.
NOTE: If you click OK rather than Edit when the list of Locked Out Users is displayed, the
list is closed and the Explorer starts. Any locked out users will remain locked out. The
list will be redisplayed each time you login until any locked out users have each been
assigned a new password.
NOTE: Users locked out for a specified duration can be unlocked by the administrator in the
same manner.
3. Select the user's Name from the drop-down list and click Edit.
An Edit User dialog is displayed.
5. Click OK.
The User is disabled. The Group membership section of the Setup Users and Groups
dialog is grayed when a disabled name is selected in the Name list.
NOTE: To enable the user, select Enabled on this dialog. You must also enter and confirm a
new password when enabling a user.
NOTE: All user updates are recorded in the audit log in the Enhanced Security version of UV
WinLab.
NOTE: In the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, the Administration Audit Trail
records all changes to security settings in compliance with 21 CFR Part 11. All
changes to users, groups, password settings and signature points are recorded.
18 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Groups
What are the default groups and what can members of these groups do?
The following table lists the default groups together with what members of the group are
able to do:
NOTE: The information in the table below refers to the Enhanced Security (ES) version of
the software.
Database Database Create and edit methods and IPV set-ups, Manage and delete
Manager Managers methods and IPV set-ups, Manage tasks, Manage the
database.
Analysts Analysts Continue tasks, Run calibrations, Run methods, Run queries.
Developers Developers Create and edit methods and IPV setups, Edit and save
calibrations, Edit queries, Edit report templates, Manage and
delete methods and IPV set-ups, Print reports, Re-process
results, Run calibrations, Run instrument performance
verifications, Run methods, Run queries, Run calibrations,
Continue tasks.
Reviewers Reviewers Edit and save calibrations, Edit queries, Edit report templates,
Manage and delete methods and IPV set-ups, Print reports,
Review methods and IPV setups, Review report templates,
Review reports, Review results, Run calibrations, Run
instrument performance verifications, Run methods, Run
queries.
Approvers Approvers Approve methods and IPV setups, Approve report templates,
Approve reports, Approve results, Edit and save calibrations,
Edit queries, Edit report templates, Manage and delete
methods and IPV set-ups, Print reports, Run calibrations,
Run instrument performance verifications, Run methods, Run
queries.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 19
NOTE: The Administrators group is not listed on the Groups tab because the group does not
have any permissions in the software apart from setting up Users' Groups and
Signature points. It is not possible to change any of the permissions associated with
the Administrator's group, or delete the Administrators group.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard Security version of the software, the system provides
three pre-configured groups, Administrator, User and Service. Users who are
members of the User group have all access rights or permissions in the system other
than Administrator and Service rights.
NOTE: It is not possible to create a new group within the Standard version of UV WinLab.
5. Click OK.
The new Group is created.
The table below lists the available permissions within UV WinLab and what the permission
allows the user to do.
Approve methods and IPV set- Approve locked methods and locked IPV set-ups.
ups
Approve own results Allows a user to approve their results within the
Workspace or Results Browser.
Approve report templates Approve report templates. (This sets the status of the
report template to Approved)
Approve reports Approve reports. (This sets the status of the report to
Approved)
20 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Approve results Approve a task. (This sets the status of the task to
Approved).
Create and edit methods and IPV Create, edit, copy, paste, lock and unlock methods;
set-ups import and export methods, create IPV set-up and
apply to an instrument, re-perform failed IPV, postpone
an IPV, perform an IPV on demand.
Edit queries Create, edit and run results queries; cut, paste, delete
and restore queries.
Edit report templates Opens Communique report creator to create, edit and
save report templates; Delete user created report
templates (default templates cannot be deleted).
Manage and delete methods and Delete, restore, cut and paste methods; move methods
IPV set-ups between folders.
Manage tasks Rename and delete folders, rename folder items, cut
and paste tasks between folders.
Manage the database Run database utilities, use legacy file converter,
determine the visibility of folders, empty the recycle bin.
Review methods and IPV set-ups Review a locked method or locked IPV set-up.
Review results Review a task. (This sets the status of the task to
Reviewed)
The permissions available to each group are selected on the Groups tab. The permissions are
listed as a tree structure. When a new group is created, none of the permissions are selected
by default.
1. To select all the permissions click Permissions at the top of the tree:
OR
To assign one or more (but not all) permissions, click in the box next to the permission
you wish to assign to the group.
A tick indicates that the permission is available for the group.
NOTE: When only some of the permissions are selected, the check box at the top of the tree
is grayed to indicate that not all of the options are selected:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 23
NOTE: The numbers at the end of each permission relate to the database. When you view
the audit trail, it is these numbers that are listed rather than the description of the
permission. You will need to refer back to the list of permissions on the Groups tab to
find the number that relates to a particular permission, or look at the summary where
the permission together with the number is given.
1. To delete a group, select the Group from the Name drop-down list and then click
Delete.
A message is displayed asking you to confirm that you wish to delete the selected
group.
2. Click Yes.
The group is deleted.
1. Select the user from the Name drop-down list on the User tab.
2. Select the Group from the list of Available groups for user and then click Add.
The Group is added to the User is a member of list.
If you wish to create more than one new user and assign each of them to a group/groups
you must click Apply after assigning the groups to the first user before creating the next
new user otherwise the group assignments for the currently selected user will be lost.
NOTE: When a group is added to the User is a member of list, it no longer appears in the
Available groups for user list.
To remove a user from a group, select the Name on the User tab, then, select the
group from the User is a member of list, and click Remove.
The user is removed from the group.
The group is removed from the User is a member of list, and is added to the Available
groups for user list.
NOTE: The Administration Audit Trail records all changes to security settings in compliance
with 21 CFR Part 11. All changes to users, groups, password settings and signature
points are recorded.
24 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: If Number of failed logins allowed before lockout is set to 1 the user will be
locked out when they have one incorrect login attempt. That is, they are not allowed
an incorrect login attempt, otherwise they will be immediately locked out.
Permanent until administrator unlocks means that the user will be unable to login again
until the administrator has unlocked their account and assigned a new password. Duration
prevents the user being able to login again until the time specified has elapsed. Duration is
grayed if Permanent is selected.
If Duration is selected, the default is 60 minutes. The minimum Duration is 1 minute and
the maximum Duration is 32767 minutes (22.75 days).
NOTE: In the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, details of failed login attempts are
recorded in the Login History.
If the Lockout is set to Permanent until administrator unlocks and the user has failed to
login correctly within the allowed number of attempts, the administrator must assign a new
password before they are able to login again.
When the administrator next logs in after a user has been locked out, a list of Locked Out
Users is displayed.
1. Highlight the name of the user that you wish to reinstate and then click Edit.
The Edit User dialog is displayed.
3. Click OK.
The user is removed from the list of Locked Out Users.
NOTE: If you click OK rather than Edit when the list of Locked Out Users is displayed, the
list is closed and the Explorer starts. Any locked out users will remain locked out. The
list will be redisplayed each time you login until any locked out users have each been
assigned a new password.
NOTE: Users locked out for a specified duration can be unlocked by the administrator in the
same manner.
26 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Passwords
NOTE: Passwords are case sensitive.
1. To change a user's password, select the user from the Name drop-down list on the
Users tab and then click Edit.
An Edit User dialog is displayed.
2. Enter the new Password and repeat it in the Confirm password entry field.
3. Click OK.
The new password is implemented. The next time the user logs in they will be forced to
change their password if you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab. In
the Standard version of UV WinLab, the user will only be forced to change their
password if User must change password at next login has been selected.
NOTE: If you have the Standard version of UV WinLab, you will be unable to change the
default passwords accessed via the Login dialog for the first day after installation. If
you attempt to change a password, the following message is displayed: 'You have
changed your password less than 1 days ago. You cannot change your password
again'. This is due to the default setting for Minimum password age, where Allow
changes after (days) is set to 1. If you wish to change the password within the first
day, the Administrator must select the Allow Changes Immediately option on the
Password Control tab of the Setup Users and Groups dialog.
NOTE: The settings on the Password Control tab apply to all users. It is not possible to
define individual Password controls for each user.
On the Password Control tab, Maximum password age defines the maximum number of
days that users can retain the same password before they must change it. By default the
password expires after 42 days. The minimum is 1 day and the maximum is 999 days.
The Maximum password age cannot be set less than the Minimum password age.
If it is not necessary for users to change their password, select Password never expires.
Within the ES version of the software users are forced to change their password the very first
time they login.
How do I define the minimum length of time that users must retain the
same password before they are able to change it?
On the Password Control tab, Minimum password age defines the number of days that users
must retain the same password before being allowed to change it. The default is to Allow
changes after 1 days. Allow changes after x days prevents users from changing their
password several times in a short space of time in order to return to a previous password.
To allow users to be able to change their password immediately, select Allow changes
immediately.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 27
The Minimum password age cannot be set greater than the Maximum password age.
The minimum is 1 day and the maximum is 999 days.
Within the ES version of the software, users will be forced to change their password the very
first time they login.
Within the Standard Security version of the software, select Change Password at First
Login to force users to change their password the very first time they login.
Minimum password length on the Password Control tab defines the minimum number of
characters that must be used in the password. By default, At least 6 characters is selected.
The minimum is 1 and the maximum is 16 characters.
Allow blank password is an alternative option. This means that users are not required to
enter a password on login, providing the user has previously opted to not enter a password
when they last changed their password, or if they have never logged in before.
NOTE: A second blank password cannot be used immediately when a blank password
expires if Number of passwords to remember has been selected in the Password
uniqueness section of the Password Control tab.
NOTE: Allow blank password is not available within the Enhanced Security (ES) version of
the software.
Users are able to reuse a previous password. By default, Number of passwords to remember
is set to 24.
Password uniqueness on the Password Control tab defines the number of new passwords
that must be used before a previous password can be reused. For example, if the first
password is 'security', and Number of passwords to remember is set to 3 entries, users
must use 3 other passwords in addition to their current password before they are able to
reuse 'security' as their password. The minimum is 1 and the maximum is 24.
If Do not keep password history is selected a user is able to reuse a password whenever
they wish.
NOTE: Do not keep password history is not available in the Enhanced Security version of
UV WinLab.
28 . UV WinLab Software Guide
If you are using the Enhanced Security (ES) software, a password is mandatory. However,
this is not the case within the Standard Security version of the software. Users can either be
asked for just their Username or their Username and password.
1. From the Administration menu in the Explorer, select Setup Users and Groups.
The Setup Users and Groups dialog is displayed.
3. In the Login and Type section, select either PerkinElmer Login or No Passwords
Login.
PerkinElmer Login requires the user to enter the Username and Login. No Passwords
Login requires just the Username.
NOTE: If No Passwords Login is selected, the user will be able to select their user name
from a drop-down list when the login dialog is displayed. If a password is required,
the user will have to enter their name manually as a drop-down list will not be
available (for security reasons).
Within the ES version of the software a record of previous passwords is automatically made
and there is no way of turning this off.
Changes to passwords are recorded in the Audit Trail. However the actual passwords are not
visible; the word Hidden is displayed instead.
Within the Standard Security version, select Do not keep password history if you do not
wish to retain a record of the number of previous passwords.
NOTE: The Administration Audit Trail records all changes to security settings in compliance
with 21 CFR Part 11. All changes to users, groups, password settings and signature
points are recorded.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 29
Summary
NOTE: The Summary is only available in the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab.
Password control – it records login type, maximum password age, minimum password
age, minimum password length, password uniqueness, lockout count and lockout
duration.
Permissions – it records the number of permissions and lists all the permissions with
their associated number.
Users – it records the number of users. For each user it records the username, full
name, status, last login, the group the user belongs to, and the permissions of that
group.
Groups – it records the number of groups. For each group it records the group name,
the users in the group, and the group permissions.
1. From the Administration menu in the Explorer select Setup Users and Groups.
The Setup Users and Groups dialog is displayed.
Checksum Failures
NOTE: Checksums (and hence Checksum failures) are only applicable in the Enhanced
Security version of UV WinLab.
NOTE: The only remedy to an error message stating there is a checksum failure, and
preventing you from accessing UV WinLab, is to restore from a backup database.
UV WinLab ES uses a variety of security techniques to ensure that files cannot be tampered
with either accidentally or deliberately. Checksums ensures that data has not been tampered
with. Under normal operation checksums are used in the application to validate the data
security, however, a checksum failure can occur after a number of situations:
Power failure
If they occur then the reasons for them should be investigated and the reasons understood,
before simply recovering from the problem.
If the UVWinLab database gets a checksum failure the software will continue operating but
the data in error will not be accessible. You will receive an error message if you try to open
an invalid method or task.
It is essential that backups are regularly made of the Repository in order to recover from a
checksum failure. The Windows Administrator can restore from this backup if the database
becomes corrupt as follows:
It should then be possible to view all the data again. Data collected after the last backup will
be lost when the backup is restored.
It is essential that backups are regularly made of the security database in order to recover
from a possible database failure. This should be done at the same time as the UVWinLab
database is backed up.
In addition, the security system automatically backs up the users.mdb database at the end of
a session, and on exit from the Administration dialog, in a subdirectory called \Backup as
C:\Documents and Settings\All Users\Application
Data\PerkinElmer\SecuritySystem\backup\users.bak
UV WinLab Software Guide . 31
The Windows Administrator can restore from this database if the active database becomes
corrupt and gives a checksum failure as follows:
It should then be possible to log on again. Some data may be lost if there were any changes
to the database that were not backed up.
It is essential that backups are made regularly of key files and databases in order to secure
the data in case of computer failure or accidental loss or damage, or even intentional
damage.
NOTE: Backups of users.mdb and UVWinLab.mdb should be made at the same time to
ensure that they are synchronized. If they are not synchronized and a problem occurs
that means a backed-up database needs to be restored, there may be issues when
attempting to use the UV WinLab Explorer.
32 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Signatures
NOTE: Signatures are only available in the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab.
A Signature Point is a point in the software that requires a signature. The Signature Points
are pre-defined. For example, one Signature Point is Save Method, so when a method is
saved it requires a Signature and a dialog automatically appears. The user has to enter their
User name, Password (if this option has been selected) and Reason for saving the method.
They may also be able to add additional comments if this option has previously been selected
by the Administrator.
The list of Signature Points within the software are already defined. The Administrator is able
to define the settings (that is, whether a signature and comments are required) for each
Signature Point individually or apply the same settings to all Signature Points. In addition, the
Administrator defines the list of reasons that may have caused each Signature Point to occur.
The user then selects a reason from this pre-defined list in the Signature Point dialog.
A Signature Point will only require a signature if Signature required is selected. Otherwise,
the software will ignore the Signature Point and the user will not be prompted for a
signature.
2. Select the Signature Point Name from the drop-down list of available names.
4. If you wish the user to be able to add comments if required, select Prompt for
comments.
When the Signature Point dialog is displayed in the software, the user will be prompted to
select a reason. For example, if they are rejecting data because they used the wrong
method, they would select wrong method implemented from the drop-down list of
available reasons. The list of reasons is also defined on this tab.
34 . UV WinLab Software Guide
1. To add a new reason, click New and enter the new Reason.
OR
To delete a reason, select the Reason from the Reasons list and click Delete.
OR
To edit a reason, select the Reason from the Reasons list, click Edit and modify the
text.
2. Repeat steps 5 and 6 as many times as necessary to add reasons for the Signature
Point.
2. To define the same settings for all Signature Points, click Update All.
The Update All Signature Points dialog is displayed.
3. In the Require Signature section, select either All Points require a signature, No Points
require a signature, or Do not change the current settings.
If Do not change the current settings is selected, no change will be made to the
Prompt for Comments settings.
4. In the Prompt for comments, select either All Points require a prompt, No Points require
a prompt, or Do not change the current settings.
If Do not change the current settings is selected, no change will be made to the
Prompt for Comments settings.
5. Click OK.
The Update All Signatures dialog closes and the Signature Points dialog is re-displayed.
NOTE: If Signature required and Prompt for comments are not selected, when a signature
point occurs in the software a reason drop-down list will still appear and the user will
be required to select a reason. To prevent the dialog appearing, all reasons for the
particular Signature point must be deleted.
1. Select the Name of the Signature Point to which you wish to add a new reason.
2. Click New.
The New Reason dialog is displayed.
2. Select the Reason to edit from the list in the Text field.
3. Click Edit.
The Edit Reason dialog is displayed.
2. Select the Reason to delete from the list in the Text field.
3. Click Delete.
A message is displayed asking to confirm the deletion.
4. Click OK to confirm.
The Reason is deleted from the Text field. The changes are recorded in the Audit trail.
The order of the reasons in the Text field is the order in which the reasons will appear in the
drop-down list that the user will see.
2. Select the Reason that you wish to move the position of.
3. Use the arrow keys on the right hand side of the list to move the Reason up or down
as required.
36 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Audit Trail
NOTE: The Audit Trail is only available in the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab.
NOTE: The Administration Audit Trail can only be viewed by the Administrator.
The Administration Audit Trail records all changes to security settings in compliance with 21
CFR Part 11. All changes to users, groups, password settings and signature points are
recorded. It also records when the Login History or Audit Trail have been exported and
cleared.
1. From the Administration menu in the Explorer select View Audit Trail.
The View Audit trail dialog is displayed.
Function– the item that was changed, for example, Add New User
Full Name – the full name of the user who made the change
User Name– the login user name of the user who made the change
NOTE: When permissions are added or deleted for a particular group, the Audit trail entry is
a number rather than the full permission name. To relate the number to a
permission, select Setup Users and Groups from the Administration menu and then
select the Groups tab. Each of the permissions listed has the related number against
it. The permission and associated number are also displayed in the summary.
NOTE: Exporting the Audit Trail does not clear the Audit Trail details from the dialog.
NOTE: It is only possible to clear Audit Trail entries that have previously been exported. If
the Audit Trail contains additional entries from after it was last exported, only those
entries that have been exported will be deleted. If none of the entries have been
exported, a warning message will be displayed when you attempt to clear the Audit
Trail.
38 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Login History
NOTE: The Login History is only available in the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab.
The Login History can only be viewed by users who are members of a group that has
permission to perform administration tasks.
1. From within the Explorer select View Audit trail from the Administration menu.
The View Audit trail dialog is displayed.
Full Name
User Name
Status – OK indicates that the user logged in with the correct password, Failed
indicates that a login was attempted with an incorrect password.
NOTE: If a non-existent User Name is entered during login a failed login attempt is
recorded. Not Found is entered in the Full Name field of the Login History, and the
incorrectly entered User Name is also recorded.
NOTE: Exporting the Login History does not clear the Login History details from the dialog.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 39
NOTE: It is only possible to clear Login History entries that have previously been exported. If
the Login History contains additional entries since it was last exported, only those
entries that have been exported will be deleted. If none of the entries have been
exported, a warning message will be displayed when you attempt to clear the Login
History.
40 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Explorer Window
42 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The Explorer
The Explorer window is shown below. It enables access to all major parts of the software.
From the Explorer you can configure instruments, organize and launch tasks, setup report
templates and view results.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 43
Method Starts the New Method Wizard. This helps you configure a new
method.
Instrument Displays the New Instrument Wizard that helps configure a new instrument.
Query Displays a further submenu with the options Samples, Verifications, and
Calibrations. This enables you to create queries to view sample information,
IPV results and calibrations created as part of Quant methods.
Report Starts Communiqué (the reporting package) with a blank report template.
Template
Edit/ Opens the selected Method for editing. If a Task is selected, the command
Re- becomes Re-process. The processing commands in the task can be changed
process and the raw data re-processed and saved.
Run/Conti Runs the selected Method to create a Task. If a Task has been selected, the
nue Run command becomes Continue.
Empty Empties the Recycle Bin. This is only available when Recycle Bin is selected
Recycle on the Folder List.
Bin
NOTE: In the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, only UV WinLab
Administrators are able to empty the Recycle Bin.
Restore Restores the selected files in the Recycle Bin back to their original locations.
This is only available when Recycle Bin is selected on the Folder List.
Delete Deletes the currently selected item and places it in the Recycle Bin.
Rename Highlights the name of the item that is currently selected, allowing it to be
edited.
NOTE: Only folders can be renamed.
Paste Pastes the items from the clipboard. Only available when there is something on the
clipboard.
Folder List Switches the Folder List on and off. A check mark is displayed when the
Folder List is switched on.
Shortcut Switches the Shortcut Bar on and off. A check mark is displayed when the
Bar Shortcut Bar is switched on.
Toolbars Displays a submenu listing the available toolbars from where you can switch
the Toolbars on and off. A check mark is displayed when a Toolbar is
switched on.
Status Bar Switches the Status Bar on and off. A check mark is displayed when the
Status Bar is switched on.
Large icons Displays the items in the top of the Main pane as 32 x 32 icons. A bullet is
displayed if this is the option selected.
Small icons Displays the items in the top of the Main pane as 16 x 16 icons. A bullet is
displayed if this is the option selected.
List Displays the items in the top of the Main pane as a list. Only the Names are
displayed. A bullet is displayed if this is the option selected.
Details Displays the items in the top of the Main pane as a list. The Name, Type,
Modified on, Modified by and Status are listed. A bullet is displayed if this is
the option selected.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 45
Perform now Displays a drop-down list of all available IPV setups. Runs the
selected setup on the default instrument.
Manual Control Opens the Manual Control task and applies it to the selected
or default instrument.
Instrument The Instrument Event Log records all calibration details, and
Event Log all instrument property changes (for example, changing a
lamp or detector).
Calibrate Opens the Calibration dialog that allows you to calibrate the
Instrument attached default instrument.
View Audit Trail Displays the Login History and Audit Trail tabs of the View Audit Trail
dialog.
NOTE: Only Setup Users and Groups and Options are available within the Standard
version of UV WinLab. The tabs Groups and Summary are not available in the
Standard version of UV WinLab.
NOTE: The Options dialog, which enables you to set up the software to always save tasks
on closing, is only available in the Standard version of UV WinLab. It is not available
in the ES version of UV WinLab.
Delete
Cut
Paste
Manual Control
Folder View
Click the right mouse button anywhere on the menu bar and select or deselect the
toolbar.
What menu items are available when I right-click in the white space in the
Explorer window?
The following menu commands are available when you click the right mouse button in the
white space. Not all commands are always shown; it depends on the item highlighted in the
Folder List. For example, New-Method is only available when Methods is highlighted in the
Folder List.
View
Large icons Displays the items in the top of the Main pane as 32 x 32 icons. A bullet
is displayed if this is the option selected.
Small icons Displays the items in the top of the Main pane as 16 x 16 icons. A bullet
is displayed if this is the option selected.
List Displays the items in the top of the Main pane as a list. Only the Names
are displayed. A bullet is displayed if this is the option selected.
Details Displays the items in the top of the Main pane as a list. The Name,
Type, Modified on, Modified by and Status are listed. A bullet is
displayed if this is the option selected.
Arrange
by
Modified on Arranges the Main pane by the date the Method / Folder was modified
on. This is the default.
Modified by Arranges the Main pane by the user who modified the Method / Folder.
Paste
New Method Starts the New Method Wizard. This helps you configure a new method.
Folder Creates a new folder and highlights the name so that it can be
amended.
NOTE: If you are unable to see any of the menus or menu items listed here it is because you
do not have the required permission. Permissions are defined by the UV WinLab
Administrator. Please contact your UV WinLab Administrator for further details about
your permissions.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 49
Folders
Folders can be added to create a hierarchy of information. The information here is mostly
concerned with the folders shown for methods and tasks.
In the Standard version of UV WinLab, all folders are public and can be seen be everyone.
The groups of which you are a member determine the folders you will see within the
Explorer. The groups and the members of the groups are assigned by the Database
Manager. You are able to view folders that are assigned to the groups of which you are a
member, and any folders that are assigned 'Public'.
For example, the Database Manager creates 2 groups – Group A and Group B. For each
group, the Database Manager creates two folders which have restricted access (that is, they
can only be seen by the group to which they have been assigned) – folder 1 and folder 2 for
group A, and folders 3 and 4 for group B.
If you are a member of group A, you will only see folder 1 and folder 2. However, if you are
a member of group A and group B, you will see all four folders.
NOTE: If you are a Database Manager you will see all the available folders listed within the
Explorer, including any private folders created by other users. Any private folders will
have the name of the user to which they are assigned appended to the name of the
folder.
The Database Manager is able to see all folders. If the folders assigned to a particular group
are Restricted, only the members of that group are able to see the folders. If folders have
been assigned as Public, everyone is able to see them. Only you and the Database Manager
are able to see any private folders that you create.
How can I tell if a folder is Public, Private or Restricted if I do not have the
necessary permission?
Select the required folder, click the right mouse button on the folder and then select
Properties.
The folder's Properties dialog is displayed. The Type of folder, together with its
Location, what the folder Contains (number of folders and folder items), the date it
was Created, and the Owner are displayed.
50 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Select the required folder, click the right mouse button on the folder and then select
Properties.
The folder's Properties dialog is displayed.
1. Select the required folder, click the right mouse button on the folder and then select
Properties.
The folder's Properties dialog is displayed.
NOTE: Only a person with Manage the Database permission is able to see the Permissions
tab.
To add a folder, select New from the File menu and then select Folder from the
submenu.
OR
Click on the toolbar and select Folder from the drop-down list.
OR
Click the right mouse button (right-click) on the white space in the Main pane of the
Explorer window and select New and then select Folder from the submenu.
A new folder is added to the Explorer, and you can name the folder.
NOTE: You can also add subfolders. Select the folder you wish to add a subfolder to, then
add a new folder as described above.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 51
To delete a folder, select the folder and then select Delete from the File menu.
OR
OR
Right-click on the white space in the Main pane of the Explorer window and select
Delete.
You will be asked to confirm that you wish to delete the folder.
NOTE: You can only delete one folder at a time. You can only delete an empty folder. If a
folder contains subfolders that are empty, it cannot be deleted.
Anyone can add private folders to their Explorer. Only you and the Database Manager will be
able to see your private folders.
To add a folder, select New from the File menu and then select Folder from the
submenu.
A new private folder is added to your Explorer, and you can name the folder.
To delete a folder, select the folder and then select Delete from the File menu.
You will be asked to confirm that you wish to delete the folder.
If you are a Database Manager you can add folders and configure them (that is, determine
who will be able to see them in their Explorer). A Database Manager is also able to re-assign
a private folder.
NOTE: Folders cannot be created within the following Folder List items – Instruments,
Report templates, Reports, and Recycle Bin.
NOTE: Within the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, only the Database Manager is
able to add a description to public folders and restricted folders. Users are able to
add descriptions to any private folders that they create.
1. Select the required folder, right-click on the folder and then select Properties.
The Folder Properties dialog is displayed.
2. Enter the required information in the Description field of the General tab and click OK.
The description is saved in the Properties dialog.
NOTE: It is possible to edit a description by selecting the folder, right-clicking on the folder
and then selecting Properties.
When a folder is selected within the Explorer, any description that has been entered appears
in the Display pane along with other information about the folder.
52 . UV WinLab Software Guide
1. Select the required folder and then select Rename from the File menu.
The name of the folder is highlighted.
2. Enter the new name of the folder and then press Enter on the keyboard.
1. To move a method or task between folders, select the method (or task) and then select
Cut from the Edit menu.
2. Select the folder to contain the method and then select Paste from the Edit menu.
The method is moved to the selected folder.
NOTE: Within the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, you are only able to move
methods (using cut and paste) if you are a member of any group that has permission
to Manage the database. Only the Administrator is able to assign this option to
particular groups.
NOTE: Methods and tasks can be cut and pasted between folders but they cannot be copied.
NOTE: Within the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, only the Database Manager is
able to configure folders – that is, determine the visibility of the folder to users –
using the Permission tab within the Folder properties.
1. Select the folder, right-click on the folder and then select Properties.
The Folder Properties dialog is displayed.
Private A Private folder can only be seen by the person who created the folder, and a
Database Manager. A Database Manager can re-assign a private folder to
another user.
1. Select the folder, right-click on the folder and then select Properties.
The Folder Properties dialog is displayed.
3. Select Private.
5. Click OK.
The private folder is assigned to the new owner. Only the Database
Manager and the new owner are now able to see the folder.
Restricted A Restricted folder can only be seen by members of the group(s) that are given
access to the folder by a Database Manager.
1. Select the folder, right-click on the folder and then select Properties.
The Folder Properties dialog is displayed.
3. Select Restricted.
A list of Available Groups is displayed.
4. Select a group from the Available groups list and click Add.
The group is added to theGroups with access to this folder list.
5. Repeat step 3 to add further groups to the Groups with access to this
folder list, as required.
6. Click OK.
7. All groups in the Groups with access to this folder list will have access to
the Restricted folder.
To remove a group from the Groups with access to this folderlist, select
the group and click Remove.
The group is removed from the Groups with access to this folder list and
added to the Available Groups list.
NOTE: If you are a Database Manager and wish to alter a folder description AND the
visibility of a folder, enter any necessary changes on the General tab of the folder's
Properties dialog and click Apply before selecting the Permissions tab and making
the necessary changes. This ensures that the changes made on the General tab are
saved when the Permissions tab is selected.
54 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The following menu items are available when you click the right mouse button on a folder:
Methods
A method is a template that is used to create a task. A method can be reused any number of
times. When data is collected and it is saved, a task is generated. The Methods level within
the Explorer contains some default Methods folders and subfolders including Development,
For Approval, Released, Archived, and Example Methods. When you Add A New Instrument,
a number of base methods specific to your instrument are installed You also have the option
to install a number of Example Methods, arranged into folders by application.
Yes, you always have to start from a Method. A Task is a method that contains data that has
been collected.
When a Method type is selected, the top section of the Main pane shows the folders and
items on the relevant section of the Folder List.
The Full details view (obtained by selecting Details from the View menu) displays the
columns: Name, Description, Type, Created by, Created on, Modified by, Modified on,
Revision, Method ID, Instrument type, and Status.
NOTE: Polarization is only available for High performance instruments (Lambda 650, 650R,
650S, 750, 750S, 800, 850, 850R, 850+, 900, 950, 1050 WB, 1050 NB, and 1050+).
The available status types are: locked, unlocked, approved, reviewed, draft, superceded, one
off, and predefined.
Hovering the mouse over a Method name displays a tooltip that displays the Name, Type and
Description of the Method.
When a Method is selected in the Main pane, the Display pane contains the details of the
method: Name, Description, Type, Created by, Created on, Modified by, Modified on,
Revision, Method ID, Instrument type and Status.
This information can be copied to the clipboard using CTRL+C, but it cannot be edited.
56 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Delete Deletes the method to the recycle bin. If you are using
the ES version of UV WinLab, the Delete Method
security dialog will be displayed and must be completed
before the method can be deleted.
NOTE: You must have the correct permission to access these menu items. For further
information about your permissions, please contact your UV WinLab Administrator.
Yes.
From the File menu select New and then select Folder.
A folder is added and can be renamed.
Creating Methods
What types of methods are available?
NOTE: You cannot change the base methods installed with your instrument. You can only
save it as a new method.
Some example methods are provided. There are two example method folders: Medium
Performance Instruments and High Performance Instruments. The example methods are
divided into subfolders by application. You can choose which methods groups are imported
when you add your instrument. The methods are specific to the type of instrument (Medium
or High) and they cannot be interchanged (it is not possible to run a method created for a
Medium performance instrument on a High performance instrument). For further information
about example methods, see:
These methods can also be used as a starting point to create your own methods. Or, you can
use the Method Wizard to define a new method. See "How do I create and save a new
method?" below.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 57
You can create a new method using the New Method Wizard, or you can change one of the
example methods supplied and save it with a new name.
1. From the File menu select New, and then from the submenu select Method.
OR
Select Methods from the Folder List, and then right-click within the white space in the
right-hand pane. Select New and then select Method from the submenu.
OR
2. Select the type of Instrument from the drop-down list and then click Next.
The description field below the drop-down lists displays the instruments available for the
selected type.
The Select Instrument page of the Wizard is then displayed.
3. Select the type of instrument from the drop-down list, and then click Next.
This associates a particular instrument with a method.
NOTE: Only instruments that have previously been installed are listed. See Adding an
instrument for further information.
5. If you wish to copy the instrument settings from an existing method into this new
method, select Copy settings from an existing method.
6. Click Browse Methods, locate the required method and then click OK.
7. Click Next.
8. Select the accessories that will be used and then click Next.
It is possible to select more than one accessory. Where accessories cannot be used
together, it will not be possible to make the selection.
The Finish page of the wizard is displayed.
9. Edit upon completion is selected by default. The method opens in the workspace once
it has been saved. If you wish to just create the method but not edit it at this time,
deselect Edit upon completion.
58 . UV WinLab Software Guide
11. Select the location for the new method from the list of folders.
12. The method has a default name. Click OK to save the method with the default name, or
enter a new name and then click OK.
13. If you are using the Enhanced Security (ES) version of UV WinLab a security dialog will
be displayed prompting you for your User name, Password, Reason and Comment.
Enter the required details and then click OK.
The wizard closes and the method is created. If you selected Edit upon completion, the
method will open within the Workspace. Otherwise, the Explorer is re-displayed.
1. In the Explorer, select the example method to be used as the template for the new
method.
2. Double-click on the method to open it in the Task Workspace and select View.
3. From the File menu select Save Settings, and then from the submenu select As
NewMethod.
The Save As Method dialog is displayed.
4. Select the location for the new method from the list of folders.
NOTE: The folders available in the Folder List will depend on the permissions you have.
6. If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, enter your User name,
Password, Reason and Comment.
The fields that appear on this dialog depend on the settings previously defined by your
UV WinLab Administrator.
7. Click OK.
The dialog closes and the method is saved. The status of the method in the Explorer is
draft.
NOTE: The new method (which is now open) is in View mode. If you wish to edit the
settings you must close the method and then right-click on the method in the
Explorer and select Edit.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 59
Select the required Method, and then from the File menu select Edit.
The Method opens in the Workspace and can be edited.
OR
Right-click on the Method and select Edit from the pop-up menu.
NOTE: You must have the correct permission to edit a Method. For further information about
your permissions, please contact your UV WinLab Administrator.
1. In the Explorer, select the folder that you want to import the method into.
NOTE: The method to be imported must not have the same name as a method that already
exists in the folder. If the method has the same name, you can rename the method
you are importing or import the method into a different folder.
3. Select the folder to export the method to, and then click Save.
The method is exported to the selected folder.
Pre-defined: This is the status of the default methods that ship with UV WinLab 6.0. Pre-
defined methods are read-only and cannot be overwritten. You have to open the method and
then select Save Settings As New Method from the File menu to create an editable copy.
In UV WinLab 6.0 the example method status is set to draft and the above procedure is not
necessary.
60 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Draft: This is the status assigned to a newly created method. The method can be changed
and saved as many times as required. When the method has been finalised the method can
be locked and the status changes to Locked. In UV WinLab 6.0 the example method status is
draft.
Locked: A Draft or Unlocked method can be Locked. In the Locked state, the method can be
Viewed and Run, but the settings cannot be Edited. Once Locked, a method can be (1)
Unlocked – enabling further changes to be made. The status then becomes Unlocked. In the
Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, a new (editable) revision of the method is created.
The previous revision remains unchanged and is not editable. (2) Reviewed (This is only
applicable to the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab).
Unlocked: This is the status after a Locked, Reviewed (Enhanced Security version only), or
Approved (Enhanced Security version only) method is Unlocked. In the Enhanced Security
version of UV WinLab, the revision number of the method is incremented. In the Standard
version of UV WinLab, the original method simply becomes unlocked. In the Enhanced
Security version, the Audit trail is initiated on unlocking a method.
Reviewed: This is only available in the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab. It is the
method status after it has been reviewed.
Approved: This is only available in the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab. It is the
method status after it has been approved. IPV methods (for Medium Performance Methods)
have a status of Approved.
NOTE: If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, you must have the
correct permission to lock a method. Permissions are defined by the UV WinLab
Administrator. Please contact them for further information.
NOTE: The report template associated with a Method should be approved before the Method
is locked. If not, the Print to Database reporting option will not be available.
3. If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, enter your User name,
Password, Reason and Comment.
The fields that appear on this dialog depend on the settings previously defined by the
UV WinLab Administrator.
4. Click OK.
The dialog closes and the method is locked. The fields on the Data Collection page are
grayed as they can no longer be edited. The Status bar in the Workspace shows that
the method is locked. The Lock command on the Tools menu toggles to Unlock. The
status of the method in Explorer is now displayed as locked and the Revision number
is 1. The Audit Trail is started.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 61
NOTE: If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, you must have the
correct permission to unlock a method. Permissions are defined by the UV WinLab
Administrator. Please contact them for further information.
3. Click OK.
The message is removed and the method is opened in the Workspace.
6. Click OK.
The dialog closes. The fields on the Data Collection and Accessory pages can now be
edited. The status bar in the Workspace shows that the method is unlocked. The
Unlock command on the Tools menu toggles to Lock. The status of the original
method is still locked (and retains any reviewed and/or approved status) and the name
is appended with -Revision 1. A new unlocked copy of the method is created with the
same name but appended with -Revision 2.
NOTE: Once Revision 1 has been unlocked once it is not possible to unlock it again. The
following message is displayed if you try to unlock it again: 'This method has already
been unlocked and a later revision created. Use Save Settings As New Method to
create a new editable method'.
No, once a method has been locked it must use the instrument and accessory for which it
has been set-up. If you try to use a different configuration, you will get an error message
and the method will not run. However, if the method is not locked, the software will detect a
change to the instrument and/or accessory and update the settings accordingly.
The ability to formally review and approve methods, tasks, IPV setups and sample results is a
function of the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab.
It is up to the UV WinLab Administrator to set the correct privileges to ensure that only the
appropriate people can ‘sign off’ data.
62 . UV WinLab Software Guide
We use the term ‘Review’ to mean that the person has looked at the data and has agreed
that it is correct. This is along the lines of a peer review and any number of people can
review data as determined by your internal procedures.
We use the term ‘Approve’ to mean that a person with ‘authority’ has signed off the data as
fit-for-purpose and again details of who is allowed to do this should be documented in your
internal procedures. A Method can only be approved once.
A method is reviewed from within the Workspace. A method must be locked before it can be
reviewed.
NOTE: If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, you must have the
correct permission to review a method. Permissions are defined by the UV WinLab
Administrator. Please contact them for further information. If you are using the
Standard version of UV WinLab, reviewing methods is not available.
2. From the Tools menu select Review and from the submenu select Method.
The Review Method dialog is displayed.
4. Click OK.
The dialog closes and the method status updates to Reviewed.
The method event log is updated. To view the method event log, select Event Log and
then Method from the Tools menu in the Workspace.
A method is approved from within the Workspace. A method must be locked before it can be
approved. A method does not have to be reviewed before it is approved.
NOTE: If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, you must have the
correct permission to approve a method. Permissions are defined by the UV WinLab
Administrator. Please contact them for further information. If you are using the
Standard version of UV WinLab, approving methods is not available.
2. From the Tools menu select Approve and from the submenu select Method.
The Approve Method dialog is displayed.
4. Click OK.
The dialog closes. The status of the method updates to Approved.
The method event log is updated.
Select the required Method, and then from the File menu select Run.
The Method opens in the Workspace and can be edited.
OR
Right-click on the Method and select Run from the pop-up menu.
OR
OR
Viewing
If you select to view a method, all the method settings are grayed and cannot be altered.
You can select Save Settings As New Method from the File menu and save the method
with a new name, thereby creating a new method. To use this new method, you will need to
close the current method (with the grayed settings) and then open the new method from the
Explorer.
If you close the Workspace when you are viewing a method, you are not prompted to save
the method as it is not possible to make any changes.
NOTE: It is not possible to select Run (to collect data) when you are viewing a method.
Editing
If you select to edit a method, you can make changes to the method and save these
changes. When you close the Workspace, a prompt will ask whether you wish to save the
method. This prompt will appear regardless of whether you have made any changes. If you
have not run the method (that is, not collected any data), the Save Results To Task and Save
Results As New Task commands on the File menu will remain grayed as they are not
applicable.
It is possible to run the method (to collect data and so create a task) when you are editing a
method. When you close the Workspace, a prompt will appear asking if you wish to save the
method and the task respectively. If you choose not to save the method, any changes you
made since it was last saved are lost. If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab
and you choose not to save the task, all the data will be lost. If you are using the Enhanced
Security version of UV WinLab, you must save the task before exiting the Workspace. The
Save Settings To Method, Save Settings As New Method, Save Results To Task, and Save
Results As New Task commands on the File menu are all available.
64 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Running
If you have run the method and collected data (and so created a task), when you close the
Workspace, a prompt will appear asking if you wish to save the task. If you do not save the
method, any changes you made since it was last saved are lost. If you are using the
Standard version of UV WinLab and you choose not to save the task, all the data will be lost.
If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, you must save the task before
exiting the Workspace. The Save Settings As New Method, Save Results To Task, and Save
Results As New Task commands on the File menu are all available.
If you select to run a method,you can make changes to the method and save these changes
using the Save Settings command. When you close the Workspace, a prompt will ask
whether you wish to save the task. If you have not run the method (that is, not collected any
data), the Save Results To Task and Save Results As New Task commands on the File menu
will remain grayed as they are not applicable.
How do I save baselines with a method and how does this affect the
corrections collected when I run a task?
2. Click .
Clicking Autozero will perform the selected corrections.
NOTE: You should not save corrections with the method if you select Always at task start
or Always before next measurement, as by definition, previous corrections are
discarded.
If As required at task start is selected, the corrections that were saved with the method are
used and only any additional corrections that are required are collected at the start of the
task provided the expiry time has not elapsed.
If As required before next measurement is selected, the corrections that were saved with
the method are used and only any additional corrections that are required are collected
before each measurement.
NOTE: If you press when you are in a task that contains corrections that were saved as
part of the method, these previously saved corrections are discarded.
Can I setup the sample table and save this as part of my method?
Yes, you can specify the sample table including number of samples,
replicates/measurements, and columns and will be saved when the method is saved. This will
be saved when the method is saved.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 65
Protein Scan
Environmental
General QC
1. Open the Example Methods folder and then open the Medium Performance
Instruments methods folder.
2. Open the appropriate method subfolder and highlight the required method.
2. Highlight the ASBC Color and Turbidity in Beer method and then select Run from the
File menu.
The method opens in Workspace.
Ordinate Mode %T
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the tree and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
68 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Oxyhaemoglobin has an absorbance maximum between 410 and 418 nm. Bilirubin has a
broad peak in the range 450 to 460 nm, or a shoulder adjacent to an oxyhaemoglobin peak,
if this is present.
This method is based on a Scan method. A scan is collected for the wavelength range of
interest. A baseline is determined, and the absorbance above this baseline at 476 nm (the
net bilirubin absorbance, NBA) is calculated. In addition, the absorbance of any
oxyhaemoglobin peak above this baseline (the net oxyhaemoglobin absorbance, NOA) at nm
is also determined.
2. Highlight the Bilirubin in CSF (UK Method) method and then select Run from the File
menu.
The method opens in Workspace.
Ordinate Mode A
Slit Width 1 nm
Number of cycles 1
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
70 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The determination is based on the fact that the dye Coomassie Brilliant Blue G-250 exists in
two different color forms, red and blue. It is converted from the red form to the blue form on
binding with a protein, with a corresponding shift in the absorption maximum from 465 nm
to 590 nm. In this method the absorption at 590 nm is measured. Four calibration standards
are run.
2. Highlight the Bradford Protein Assay method and then select Run from the File menu.
The method opens in the Workspace.
Ordinate Mode A
Number of cycles 1
Units g mL–1
Proceed on error
9. Select the Parameters page and ensure that the Baseline Correction is set to None.
The default report template is Simple Quant Report and this is set to print On
demand.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
72 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Ca [mg m–3] = (11.85 D663–665 – 1.54 D647 – 0.08 D630) v l–1 V–1
Cb [mg m–3] = (–5.43 D663–665 + 21.03 D647 – 2.66 D630) v l–1 V–1
Cc [mg m–3] = (–1.67 D663–665 – 7.6 D647 + 24.52 D630) v l–1 V–1
Data is collected as a scan for speed and diagnostic purposes but it is reported as an
expanding table.
2. Highlight the Chlorophyll (Trichromatic) method and then select Run from the File
menu.
The method opens in the Workspace.
Ordinate Mode A
Data interval 1 nm
7. Enter the Extract Volume (ml), Filtered Water Vol (litres) and Pathlength (cm) values
for each sample.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 73
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
74 . UV WinLab Software Guide
2. Highlight the Chlorophyll determination (US 10200H) method and then select Run
from the File menu.
The method opens in the Workspace.
Ordinate Mode A
Number of cycles 1 nm
7. Enter the Volume Extracted and Volume Filtered for each sample.
10. Ensure that the Results Table is defined to display the following values for each sample:
Volume Extracted and Volume Filtered.
11. On the Output page, ensure that the report template is Chlorophyll US Method
10200H and that this is set to print On demand.
14. When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
76 . UV WinLab Software Guide
This method can be used for determining cytochrome p450 in tissue samples. The
measurement is based on the difference between the absorption maxima (at 450 nm) of the
reduced and native forms of cytochrome p450.
Scatter correction at 490 nm is carried out to correct for stray light. Tissue preparations are
often quite turbid, so the scatter correction will eliminate the high background values
produced by turbid samples.
The reference wavelength used is 490 nm, since this is an isobestic point (common to both
forms), effectively eliminating the effect of turbidity scattering.
The reference for the method is Omura, T. and Sato, R., (1964) J. Biol. Chem., 239, pp.
2370–2378
2. Highlight the Cytochrome P450 Determination method and then select Run from the
File menu.
The method opens in the Workspace.
Ordinate Mode A
7. Enter the Resuspension factor and Dilution factor for each sample.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 77
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
78 . UV WinLab Software Guide
G6PD Kinetics
This method determines the activity of the enzyme Glucose-6-phosphate Dehydrogenase
(G6PD). The rate is measured at 340 nm (NAD/NADH+ type of kinetics). This is a Timedrive
method with a duration of 5 minutes. The default interval is 30 s.
This method can be automated to use with a cell changers (6, 8 or 9 positions).
2. Highlight the G6PD Kinetics method and then select Run from the File menu.
The method opens in the Workspace.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 79
Reference: Codex standard for olive oil, virgin and refined, and for refined olive-pomace oil.
Codex Stan 33-1981 (Rev 1-1989)
The ordinate values at 232 nm (Equation 1), 270 nm (Equation 2) are calculated individually.
These individual values are then multiplied by concentration to give Equations 3 and 4. A
peak is then searched for over specified range 268–272 nm.
2. Highlight the EU Olive Oil Determination method and then select Run from the File
menu.
The method opens in Workspace.
Ordinate Mode A
Number of cycles 1
7. Enter the Conc (g/100 mL) and Cell information for each sample.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 81
Lambda Max
This method can be used to find the maximum absorbance and wavelength over a scan
range 700–350 nm.
2. Highlight the Lambda Max method and then select Run from the File menu.
The method opens in Workspace.
Ordinate Mode A
Slit width 1 nm
Data interval 1 nm
Number of cycles 1
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 83
2. Highlight the Lowry Protein Concentration method and then select Run from the File
menu.
The method opens in Workspace.
Ordinate Mode A
Slit width 1 nm
Data interval 1 nm
Number of cycles 1
Component Protein
Units mg/ml
9. Select the Parameters page and ensure the Ordinate Mode is set to Height.
84 . UV WinLab Software Guide
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 85
2. Highlight the Naphthalene (ASTM D1840-03) method and then select Run from the
File menu.
The method opens in Workspace.
Wavelength 285 nm
Ordinate Mode A
Slit Width 1 nm
Data Interval 1 nm
Number of cycles 1
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 87
2. Highlight the Nitrate (EPA 352.1/US Test Method 9200) method and then select Run
from the File menu.
The method opens in Workspace.
Wavelength 410 nm
Ordinate Mode A
Data Interval 1 nm
Number of cycles 1
Component Nitrate
Units mg L–1
Proceed on error
88 . UV WinLab Software Guide
9. Select the Parameters page and ensure that the Baseline Correction is set to None
and the Wavelength is set to 410.00 nm.
10. Select the Calibration page and ensure that the table is defined to display the following
values for each Standard: Concentration, Ordinate (A) and Residual.
11. Make sure there are 5 Standards, with concentration values of 0.000, 0.1250, 1.0000,
1.5000 and 2.0000.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated
and inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 89
2. Highlight the Nucleic Acid Concentration and Purity method and then select Run
from the File menu.
The method opens in Workspace.
Ordinate Mode A
Slit Width 1 nm
In this method, three sample tags have been defined – dsDNA, ssDNA, and RNA.
7. For each sample, select the required sample tag – dsDNA, ssDNA or RNA.
Click in the Sample Tag field to display a drop-down arrow . Click on the arrow to
display a drop-down list of dsDNA, ssDNA and RNA.
The Results Table is defined to display the following values for each sample – Abs 260, Abs
280, Abs 320, Ratio, Corr 260, dsDNA Conc, ssDNA Conc, and RNA Conc.
The default report template is Nucleic Acid Quantification and Purity and this is set to
print on demand.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 91
2. Highlight the Percentage Strength at 500 nm method and then select Run from the
File menu.
The method opens in the Workspace.
Wavelength 500 nm
Ordinate Mode A
Response 2s
Slit width 1
Number of cycles 1
The Results Table is defined to display the following values for each sample – Absorbance
and Percent Strength.
The default report template is Percentage Strength at 500nm and this is set to print On
demand.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
92 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Phosphate in Water
(EPA 365.2 & 365.3/DIN 38 405)
This example method is for determining the concentration of phosphate compound in water.
It measures phosphate in the form of orthophosphate and total phosphate after digestion
using a Wavelength Quant method. This analysis is suitable for determining orthophosphate
concentrations at 0101 mg/ml to 5 mg/ml PO4-3.
Orthophosphate ions in acid solution combine with molybdate ions in the presence of
antimony ions to produce a complex that is reduced by ascorbic acid to phosphor
molybdenum blue.
2. Highlight the Phosphate in Water method and then select Run from the File menu.
The method opens in Workspace.
Wavelength 710 nm
Ordinate Mode A
Slit Width 1 nm
Data Interval 1 nm
Number of cycles 1
Component Phosphate
Units mg L–1
Proceed on error
9. Select the Parameters page and ensure that the Baseline Correction is set to None
and the Wavelength is set to 710 nm.
10. Select the Calibration page and ensure that the table is defined to display the following
values for each Standard: Concentration, Ordinate (A) and Residual.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
94 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Porphyrin Scan
It uses a Scan method.
2. Highlight the Porphyrin Scan method and then select Run from the File menu.
The method opens in Workspace.
Ordinate Mode A
Slit width 1 nm
The Results Table is defined to display the following values for each sample: Patient ID,
Porphyrin (nmol /L), Lo Baseline Point, Hi Baseline Point, Peak Height, Abs 405 nm,
Abs RH Base, Abs LH Base, and Conc Factor.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 95
Sulfite is oxidized to sulfate by sulfite oxidase in the presence of oxygen. The hydrogen
peroxide (H2O2) formed in this reaction is reduced by NADH-peroxidase (NADH-POD) in the
presence of reduced nicotinamide-adenine dinucleotide (NADH). The NADH is oxidized. The
amount of NADH oxidized is equivalent to the amount of sulfite. NADH absorbs at 334, 340
and 365 nm.
2. Highlight the Sulfite Determination method and then select Run from the File menu.
The method opens in Workspace.
Wavelength 340 nm
Ordinate Mode A
Slit Width 1 nm
Time Interval 1s
7. Enter the values for Time Point A1 and Time Point A2 for each sample.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 97
This method is used to eliminate the interference, by calculation, of nucleic acid absorbance
in the determination of protein concentration. Proteins exhibit a distinct UV absorption band
with a maximum at around 280 nm. Nucleic acids also have a strong UV absorbance at 280
nm, but absorb more strongly at 260 nm. The reverse is true of proteins. Therefore a
two-component mixture can be quantified using two linear equations:
This is based, however, on the application of generic molar absorption coefficients for
proteins and for nucleic acids, where in practice, the individual coefficient is often unknown.
2. Highlight the Warburg–Christian Assay for Protein and Nucleic Acid Concentration
method and then select Run from the File menu.
The method opens in Workspace.
Ordinate Mode A
Slit width 1 nm
Data interval 1 nm
Number of cycles 1
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 99
Color reference: Glories Y. (1984), "La couleur des vins. 2e partie," Connaissance Vigne et
Vins, 18, pp. 253–271.
Hue reference: Sudraud P. (1958), "Interpretation des curbes d'absorption des vins rouges,"
An. Technol. Agric., 7, pp. 203–208.
Samples of undiluted wine should be run in a 1 mm pathlength glass or quartz cell. The
method will adjust the absorbance to 10 mm.
2. Highlight the Wine Analysis and then select Run from the File menu.
The method opens in Workspace.
Ordinate Mode A
Slit width 1 nm
Data interval 1 nm
Number of Cycles 1
The Results Table is defined to display the following values for each sample – A420 nm,
A520 nm, A620 nm, Color Intensity, Wine Hue, Tristim X, Tristim Y, Tristim Z, xvalue,
yvalue, L* a* b*, Cab*, S, Q, hab*, hab*1 and hab*2.
The default report template is Wine Analysis Report and this is set to print On demand.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 101
The associated template (scan with processing and conditions) will show the raw and
processed spectrum superimposed on one page. The template also displays the processing
functions and the instrument settings.
2. Highlight the Scan and Second Derivative method and then select Run from the File
menu.
The method opens in Workspace.
Ordinate Mode A
Slit width 1 nm
Data interval 1 nm
Number of cycles 1
The default report template is Scan with Second Derivative, and this is set to print On
demand.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 103
Color
Materials
Opacity
Optics
Solar Reflectance
1. Open the Example Methods folder and then open the High Performance Instruments
methods folder.
2. Open the appropriate method subfolder and highlight the required method.
2. Highlight the Bandpass Filter method and then select Run from the File menu.
The method opens in the Workspace.
Ordinate Mode %T
7. Select Corrections in the Folder List and select the appropriate options.
For more accurate results, it is recommended that you select 0%T/ Blocked Beam
Baseline and Use internal attenuator.
8. Enter the Nominal Wavelength and Out of Band wavelength for each sample.
The Results Table is defined to display the following values for each sample: Nominal
Wavelength (nm), Peak Wavelength (nm), Peak Transmittance (%), Center
Wavelength (nm), Out of Band LH Point (nm), Out of Band LH Point (nm), Mean
Out of Band Transmittance (%) and Wavelength Pass/Fail.
The default report template is Bandpass Filter and this is set to print on demand.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 105
2. Select the Camouflage Using Integrating Sphere method and then select Run from
the File menu.
The method opens in the Workspace.
Ordinate Mode %R
Slit width 1 nm
Data interval 5 nm
The default report template is Camouflage Report and this is set to print On demand.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
106 . UV WinLab Software Guide
2. Highlight the Color Difference (Delta E) method and then select Run from the File
menu.
The method opens in the Workspace.
8. Ensure that the Results Table is defined to display the following values for each sample
– X D65/10, Y D65/10, Z D65/10, Chrom x D65/10, Chrom y D65/10, L* D65/10, a*
D65/10, b* D65/10, Cab* D65/10, hab*, X Ref, Y Ref, Z Ref, Chrom x ref, Chrom y Ref,
L* Ref, a* Ref, b* Ref, Cab* Ref, hab* Ref, Delta L*, Delta a*, Delta b*, Delta Cab*,
Delta hab*, Delta H, and Delta E CIE 1976 and DCIE 1994.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 107
The default report template is Delta E and this is set to print On demand.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
108 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Ordinate Mode %T
Data interval 5 nm
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 109
2. Highlight the Cut-Off Filter Characterization method and then select Run from the File
menu.
The method opens in the Workspace.
Wavelengths 420–300 nm
Ordinate Mode %T
Slit Width 1 nm
The Results Table is defined to display the following values for each sample: Nominal
Wavelength (nm), Maximum Transmission (%), Minimum Transmission (%) and Cutoff
Wavelength.
The default report template is Cutoff Filter Report and this is set to print on demand.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
110 . UV WinLab Software Guide
2. Highlight the HP Film Thickness Using Interference Fringes method and then select
Run from the File menu.
The method opens in the Workspace.
Ordinate Mode %T
The Results Table is defined to display the Thickness (Microns) of each sample.
The default report template is Film Thickness and this is set to print when the task is
completed.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 111
2. Select the Opacity method and then select Run from the File menu.
The method opens in the Workspace.
Ordinate Mode %R
Data interval 10 nm
The Results Table is defined to display the following for each sample: Color Analysis,
Description, Yblack, Ywhite.
The default report template is Opacity and this is set to print On demand.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 113
The transmittance spectra are converted to luminous transmission and the haze calculated.
The data used in the method is obtained between 780 and 300 nm, with a 5 nm data
interval.
2. Highlight the Haze ASTM D-1003 method and then select Run from the File menu.
The method opens in the Workspace.
Ordinate Mode %R
Data interval 5 nm
6. Enter the number of Samples and, for each sample, the appropriate Illuminant and
Std Obs values.
7. Select Corrections in the Folder List and select the appropriate options.
For more accurate results, it is recommended that you select 100%T/0A Baseline
(Autozero), and Use internal attenuator.
The Results Table is defined to display the following values for each sample: Haze (%),
Diffuse Luminous Transmittance (%), Y Sample (Light Transmittance), Y Sample
and Instrument Scatter, Y Instrument Scatter, Illuminant (A=1,C=2), Std Obs (2
or 10 degrees).
114 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The default report template is Haze Report and this is set to print on demand.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 115
The method calculates L*, a* and b* coordinates and the chroma (Cab*) and hue (Hab*).
Data is collected as a scan for speed and diagnostic purposes but it is reported as an
expanding table.
It can be adapted for use with a transmittance accessory, but a thickness correction may be
needed for samples of a non-standard thickness. See Simple Transmittance Color Method.
12. Highlight the HP Reflectance Color User Selectable method and then select Run from
the File menu.
The method opens in the Workspace.
Data Interval 10 nm
Ordinate Mode %R
16. Enter the number of Samples and, for each sample, the appropriate Illuminant and
Std Obs values.
116 . UV WinLab Software Guide
18. Ensure that the Results Table is defined to display the following values for each sample
– Tristim X, Tristim Y, Tristim Z, xvalue, yvalue, L*, a*, b*, Cab* and Hab*,
Illuminant (A=1,C=2,D65=3), Std Obs (2 or 10 degrees).
The default report template is User Defined Color Report and this is set to print On
demand.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 117
The first part of the method calculates the tristimulus values X, Y and Z (corresponding to
the primary using the illuminate and observer tables issued by CIE. X, Y and Z represent the
primary colors – red, green and blue.
The method calculates L*, a* and b* coordinates and the chroma (Cab*) and hue (Hab*).
Data is collected as a scan for speed and diagnostic purposes but it is reported as an
expanding table.
2. Highlight the Simple Color Method 5nm method and then select Run from the File
menu.
The method opens in the Workspace.
8. Ensure that the Results Table is defined to display the following values for each sample
– Tristim X, Tristim Y, Tristim Z, xvalue, yvalue, L*, a*, b*, Cab* and Hab*.
The default report template is Color Analysis Report and this is set to print On demand.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 119
2. Highlight the ASTM E 892-87 Terrestrial Solar Irradiance method and then select Run
from the File menu.
The method opens in the Workspace.
Ordinate Mode %R
Data interval 5 nm
The Results Table is defined to display the following value for each sample: Solar
Response.
The default report template is ASTM E892 Solar Response and this is set to print on
demand.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
120 . UV WinLab Software Guide
2. Highlight the Whiteness & Yellowness Index method and then select Run from the
File menu.
The method opens in the Workspace.
Ordinate Mode %R
8. Ensure that the Results Table is defined to display the following values for each sample
– Tristim X, Tristim Y, Tristim Z, xvalue, yvalue, L*, a*, b*, Cab*, Hab*, YI, WI and
Tint.
The default report template is Whiteness Yellowness Index and this is set to print on
demand.
When the Method is run and the task has been generated, the results are calculated and
inserted into the Results Table.
To preview the report that will be generated, select Output on the Folder List and click
Preview.
The report is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 121
Tasks
Tasks are created using methods. A method (for example, a quant method) is used as a
template to create a task (for example, a quant task). When data, such as sample
information, is added and the samples are run, all the information (the template and the
results) are saved together as a task.
When a task folder is selected, the top section of the Main pane shows the folders and tasks
on the relevant section of the Folder List.
The Full details view displays the columns: Name, Type, Modified by, Modified on, and
Status.
The available task types are: Scan, Wavelength Program, Scanning Quant,
NOTE: Polarization Scan Task is only available for High performance instruments.
A task may have any of the following status types: In progress, Complete, Aborted,
Reviewed, Approved.
When a task is selected in the Main pane, the Display pane contains the details of the task:
Name, Description, Type, Created by, Created on, Modified by, Modified on, Instrument serial
no, Instrument type and Status (of the task).
122 . UV WinLab Software Guide
What menu items are available when I right-click on a task from within
the Explorer?
NOTE: If any menu item is disabled it means that you do not have the necessary permission
to perform the operation.
When the mouse is hovered over the task in the Main pane, a tooltip displays the name of
the task, the type of task and any description that was entered.
Yes.
2. From the File menu select New and then select Folder.
A folder is added and can be renamed.
1. Select the required Task and then from the Edit menu select Cut.
2. Select the new destination within the Explorer Tasks (for example, a different folder)
and then click Paste.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 123
Yes, you always have to start from an existing method. A task is a method that has been run
and the data saved. A method can be used to create many tasks.
1. Select the method upon which the task will be based and from the File menu (or by
clicking the right mouse button on the method) select Run.
The method will open in the Workspace.
OR
Create a new method using the New Method Wizard, and select Edit on opening.
The method will open in the Workspace.
2. If necessary, complete the Sample Table, and any other nodes of the Folder List that
were not completed (or need editing) when the method was created.
NOTE: You must have permission to edit methods to be able to alter the method settings.
For further information about your permissions, please contact your UV WinLab
Administrator.
3. Click .
The task is run.
4. From the File menu select Save Results and then select ToTask.
The Save Task dialog is displayed. A default name for the task is provided.
6. Click Save.
7. If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab you are then prompted for
your User name, Password, Reason and Comment.
8. Click OK.
The task is saved to the tasks folder in the Explorer.
A locked, earlier version of a method can be used to create a task. However, none of the
method parameters can be modified. When you attempt to open a locked, superceded
method, the following message is displayed:
Method is locked, samples may be run but modification of method parameters will not be
possible unless it is first unlocked.
124 . UV WinLab Software Guide
No, a method does not have to be locked and approved before it is used to create a task.
However, for good practice we recommend that you do lock and approve methods before
using them to create tasks.
By running a method. A method can be run from the Explorer or from a shortcut on the
Desktop or the Start menu.
OR
If you have created a shortcut to the method on the Desktop, double-click on the
method icon.
The method opens in the Workspace.
2. Complete the Sample Table on the Sample tab on the Sample Info page.
3. Click .
The samples are run in the order listed in the Sample Table. The Graphs tab displays
automatically at the start of the run and the spectrum appears in the graph display. A
green tick appears next to the sample name in the Sample Table when it has been run.
For information on reporting and data export see Output.
NOTE: If the method being used is locked, and the incorrect accessory is fitted, an error
message will be displayed informing the user that the method cannot be performed
with the current configuration. The accessory configuration must be correct.
1. From the File menu select Save Results, and then from the submenu select ToTask.
The Save Task dialog is displayed.
2. Enter a Name if you wish to change the default Name, and a Description of the Task.
The default name is based on the method used to create the task, the date and the
time.
3. Click Save.
The Save Results dialog is displayed.
5. Click OK.
The Task is saved under Task in the Explorer.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 125
NOTE: If you try to exit a task without saving a message will be displayed asking if you wish
to save the task before exiting. If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV
WinLab you must save the task before you exit.
NOTE: In the Enhanced Security version of the software, samples are automatically saved to
the database between collections. You cannot save over an existing Task and so
Save As Task will be inactive. You must select Save Results from the File menu
and then select As New Task from the submenu.
NOTE: You can set up the Standard version of the software to always save a Task on
closing, without displaying a message.
In the Standard version of the software, on closing a task a message is displayed asking if
you wish to save the task before closing the program. If you wish UV WinLab to always save
a task on closing, without displaying a message, you can select the Always save task on
close option.
3. Click OK.
The Save Results dialog is displayed.
NOTE: This option is only available with the Standard version of UV WinLab. If you are using
the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab you must save the task before you exit
the method. A message will be displayed prompting you to save the task before
exiting.
NOTE: If you are unable to see the Administration menu it is because you do not have the
required permission. Permissions are defined by the UV WinLab Administrator. Please
contact your UV WinLab Administrator for further details about your permissions.
In the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, each task must be saved with a unique
name and it cannot be overwritten.
Yes, you can save the raw sample spectra in *.sp format for analysis in software such as UV
WinLab Data Processor and Viewer (DPV).
OR
Click Select All to select all the samples in the Sample Table.
3. Click Save.
The Save Results dialog is displayed.
4. Click Browse.
The Browse for Folder dialog is displayed.
OR
6. Click OK.
7. To overwrite spectra already exported from the task, select Overwrite Samples.
NOTE: If you select any samples that have already been saved, without selecting Overwrite
Samples, only the new spectra will be saved. The existing spectra will NOT be
overwritten. A dialog will ask if you wish to continue.
8. Click Save.
NOTE: You can also send your raw and processed spectra, as well as the spectral results of
any equations, directly to UV WinLab DPV selecting Send To UV WinLab DPV on the
File menu. The application will start with your data open in the Viewing Area (see the
UV WinLab DPV Help file for information on UV WinLab DPV).
Yes, you can continue any task that has not been locked, reviewed or approved. You can run
samples that were not completed previously, or add new samples to a task that was
completed.
To continue a task, select the task and then from the File menu select Continue.
The task is opened in the Workspace.
Yes. When you close the Workspace, you will be asked if you wish to save the task. If you
are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, and you choose not to save the task, the data
that has just been collected will be lost. If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV
WinLab, you must save the task before exiting the Workspace. The Save Settings As New
Method, and Save As Task commands on the File menu are all available.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 127
If you know the name of the task, double-clicking on it in the Explorer will open the task in
the Workspace where you can view the settings and the results. The Data Collection and
Instrument pages are grayed as they cannot be edited.
If you do not know the name of the task, you can search for it using a Query. The results of
the query are displayed in the Query window and double-clicking on a result opens the task
that generated the result in the Workspace.
It is possible to view all the information relating to a task that has previously been run.
Select the task and from the File menu (or by right-clicking on the task) select View.
The task opens in the Workspace as read-only. All fields are grayed and cannot be
edited.
The Save Task and Save As Task commands on the File menu are not available.
The task can be reviewed and approved (if you have the correct permissions) when it is
opened as read-only.
NOTE: It is also possible to save all the settings (excluding the data) as a new method. From
the File menu select Save As and then select Method. This applies to the Standard
and Enhanced Security versions of UV WinLab.
Yes, it is possible to select different processing options and apply them to the collected data.
NOTE: If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, you must have
permission to re-process results.
1. From the Explorer Window, open the previously saved task by right-clicking on it and
selecting Re-process or by selecting Re-process from the File menu.
4. From the File menu select Save As and then select Task.
The re-processed task must be saved with a new name.
7. Click OK.
The re-processed task is saved under Tasks in the Explorer Window.
NOTE: It is also possible to save all the settings (excluding the data) as a new method.
From the File menu select Save As and then select Method. This applies to both the
Standard and Enhanced Security versions of UV WinLab.
NOTE: To re-process a task, you must have the necessary permission. Please contact your
UV WinLab Administrator for further information about your permissions.
Re-process allows you to apply different processing commands to the data saved.
NOTE: It is not possible to add comments to the sample or standards table when re-
processing a task.
If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab you can overwrite the previous data or
save the task with a new name.
4. From the File menu select Save and then select Task to overwrite the original data.
OR
To save the task with a new name, select Save As and then select Task.
You will be prompted for a new name.
If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, you cannot overwrite the
original data. The re-processed task must be saved with a new name.
5. From the File menu select Save As and then select Task.
7. Click Save.
8. If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab you are then prompted for
your User name, Password, Reason and Comment.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 129
9. Click OK.
The reprocessed task is saved to the tasks folder in the Explorer.
NOTE: It is also possible to save all the settings (excluding the data) as a new method.
From the File menu select Save As and then select Method. This applies to the
Standard and Enhanced Security versions of UV WinLab.
For further information on printing the summary, see the Communiqué Report Creator
section of the Help.
Yes, you can continue any task that has not been locked, reviewed or approved. You can run
samples that were not completed previously, or add new samples to a task that was
completed.
To continue a task, select the task and then from the File menu select Continue.
The task is opened in the Workspace.
Yes. When you close the Workspace, you will be asked if you wish to save the task. If you
are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, and you choose not to save the task, the data
that has just been collected will be lost. If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV
WinLab, you must save the task before exiting the Workspace. The Save Method, Save As
Method, Save Task, and Save As Task commands on the File menu are all available.
The ability to formally review and approve methods, tasks, IPV setups and sample results is a
function of the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab.
It is up to the UV WinLab Administrator to set the correct privileges to ensure that only the
appropriate people can ‘sign off’ data.
We use the term ‘Review’ to mean that the person has looked at the data and has agreed
that it is correct. This is along the lines of a peer review and any number of people can
review data as determined by your internal procedures.
130 . UV WinLab Software Guide
We use the term ‘Approve’ to mean that a person with ‘authority’ has signed off the data as
fit-for-purpose and again details of who is allowed to do this should be documented in your
internal procedures.
When a task has been run, it is 'locked' by definition – that is, all fields are disabled and
cannot be edited unless you have permission to Reprocess results.
2. From the Tools menu select Review and from the submenu select Task.
The Review dialog is displayed.
4. Click OK.
The task event log is updated accordingly.
When a task has been run, it is 'locked' by definition – that is, all fields are disabled and
cannot be edited unless you have permission to Reprocess results.
2. From the Tools menu select Approve and from the submenu select Task.
The Approve dialog is displayed.
4. Click OK.
The status of the task is Approved.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 131
Instruments
When you select Instruments from the Folder List, the Main
pane displays the instruments available.
The Main pane also allows you add a new instrument. The
instrument can be a real instrument that you are attached to or
a simulated instrument if you are not attached to an instrument.
A simulated instrument will allow you to run tasks and "collect"
simulated data.
NOTE: If you are unable to perform any of the procedures described below it is likely that
you do not have the necessary permission. Permissions are assigned by the
Administrator; contact them for further information on your permissions within UV
WinLab.
NOTE: It is not possible to add folders to the Instrument node of the Folder List.
The following menu items are available when you right-click on an instrument:
Edit Displays the Edit Instrument dialog.
Instrument
Verification NOTE: This menu item and all its submenu items are
only available for Medium performance
instruments.
Manual Control Opens the Manual Control task and applies it to the
selected instrument.
Type of instrument
Status
Port
Installed on.
This information can be selected and copied to the clipboard using CTRL+C.
The available Medium performance instruments are Lambda 25, 35, 45, 20, 40, 40P, 20Bio,
40Bio, and 365.
The available High performance instruments are Lambda 650, 750, 800, 850, 850+, 900,
950, 1050, and 1050+.
Simulated versions of each instrument are also available. When a simulated instrument is
added, the Serial Number is set to Simulation (and cannot be changed).
134 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: You must have the configure instruments permission to be able to add an instrument.
NOTE: You must switch the instrument on and allow it to initialize before adding it to the
software.
3. Click Next.
4. Select the instrument type from the drop-down list, and if required, select Make this
the default instrument.
5. Click Next.
NOTE: If you wish to use a Simulated Medium performance instrument, you must also setup
the Simulator. See the on-screen Help for further information
7. From the drop-down list, select the Port the instrument is connected to.
This is grayed if Simulation is selected.
8. Click Next.
NOTE: Clicking Next will automatically perform a check to see if the correct instrument is
attached to the selected port and switched on, and will display a Warning message if
not.
11. Select your shortcut options. If you wish to add shortcuts to the base methods for your
instrument to the Start Menu or the Desktop, select the appropriate options.
All the options are selected as default.
13. Select the group(s) of Example Methods that you would like to install.
The groups include: Biochemistry & Molecular Biology, Clinical & Healthcare,
Environmental, Food & Drink, and General QC.
15. If all the settings are correct click Finish to close the wizard and add the instrument.
The Wizard closes, a confirmation message that the instrument has been successfully
installed is displayed, and the instrument is displayed in the Explorer. If you have
selected to make this the default instrument, a tick mark is displayed next to the
instrument icon.
3. Click Next.
4. Select the instrument type from the drop-down list, and if required, select Make this
the default instrument.
5. Click Next.
6. From the drop-down list, select the Port to which the instrument is connected.
OR
7. Click Next.
The software will try and detect the serial number of the attached instrument. The next
wizard screen you see depends on whether the serial number is successfully detected.
8. You must enter the Serial Number and then click Update.
NOTE: You will not be able to proceed with the instrument installation until you have
updated the Serial Number.
9. When the Serial Number has been updated, click Next to continue.
OR
The Serial Number previously detected or entered is displayed but cannot be edited.
14. Select your shortcut options. If you wish to add shortcuts to the base methods for your
instrument to the Start Menu or the Desktop, select the appropriate options.
All the options are selected as default.
16. Select the group(s) of Example Methods that you would like to install.
The groups include: Color, Optics, Materials and Solar Reflectance.
18. If all the settings are correct click Finish to close the wizard and add the instrument.
The Wizard closes, a confirmation message that the instrument has been successfully
installed is displayed, and the instrument is displayed in the Explorer. If you have selected to
make this the default instrument, a tick mark is displayed next to the instrument icon.
Select the instrument to be deleted and then from the File menu select Delete.
OR
OR
1. To select an instrument, click on the required instrument in the Main pane of the
Explorer.
The instrument is highlighted.
OR
Right-click on the selected instrument and select Set As Default Instrument from the
menu.
NOTE: Simulated instruments are only available for Medium performance instruments. For
High performance instruments you can select to install an offline instrument. This will
allow you to create methods for a particular method type with being attached to the
instrument. However, you cannot simulate data collection.
Follow the instructions above for adding a new instrument, but make sure that Simulation is
selected on the second screen of the New Instrument Wizard. When a simulated instrument
is added, the name of the instrument in Explorer is Sim X (where X is the type of
instrument), and the Serial number is Simulation.
Before the Simulated instrument can be used, the Simulator must be set up.
1. From the Start menu select Programs – PerkinElmer Applications – UV WinLab – Setup
Simulator.
The UV WinLab Simulator Control dialog is displayed.
3. In the Folder for Data field, enter the full path for the folder containing the data to be
used for the simulation.
The data to be used in the simulation must have a *.asc extension.
4. Click Close.
The simulator is setup.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 139
NOTE: IPV is not available for High performance instruments (Lambda 650, 650R, 650S,
750, 750S, 800, 850, 850+, 900, 950, 1050 NB, 1050 WB, and 1050+). The status
will be set to None.
Instrument Details
How do I open or edit instrument details?
Name Enter a Name for the instrument. The instrument will be listed in
the Explorer using this Name.
Port Select the Port the instrument will communicate through from the
drop-down list of available ports. The software will perform an
automatic check to ensure that the correct type of instrument is
connected to that port.
Instrument Properties
How do I view the properties of an instrument?
NOTE: This is only available for High performance instruments (Lambda 650, 650R, 650S,
750, 750S, 800, 850, 850R, 850+, 900, 950, 1050 NB, 1050 WB, and 1050+). In
addition, you must have permission to configure instruments in order to view this
dialog. For further information about your permission please contact your UV WinLab
software Administrator.
OR
Lamps tab
3. Select the lamp type from the list of available internal lamps for the selected instrument.
The Current Usage field displays the usage of the selected lamp. This field is for
information only and cannot be edited.
4. To reset the lamp usage after a lamp has been replaced, select Reset Usage.
NOTE: If the lamp has expired, it is not possible to just reset the Current Usage. The lamp
must be replaced.
The Current Usage time is reset to zero when you click OK and exit the dialog.
NOTE: You must have the necessary permission to be able to reset the usage time. In
addition, this action is a signature point and the information (user name, password,
reason, comment) will be recorded in the audit trail.
We recommend 2000 hours for a PerkinElmer-supplied deuterium lamp, and 1000 hours
for a PerkinElmer-supplied tungsten lamp.
A reminder message to change the lamp will be displayed when the Current Usage
approaches the Lamp Life.
7. Click in the Name field and enter the name of the lamp.
9. Select whether the lamp is Enabled or Disabled from the drop-down list in the Enabled
column of the table.
To remove a lamp from the table, click anywhere in the required row and then click
Remove.
The lamp is removed.
NOTE: An external lamp will not appear on the Data Collection page within the Workspace
unless it has been enabled from this Properties page.
Instrument tab
The instrument tab displays the current filter table settings which can be modified, and also
which items of firmware are enabled. This tab is mainly for use by PerkinElmer Service
Engineers. You should not alter anything unless you fully understand the implications of
doing so.
NOTE: The Add and Remove buttons are only available if you have Service Permission. For
further information about your permissions, please contact your UV WinLab
Administrator.
Filters are held on a disc within the instrument, which moves to the correct position when the
appropriate wavelength is reached. The disc can only rotate in one direction.
The table below shows how the filter is related to the position (defaults). Positions 8, 9, and
10 are NIR filters and are only available on the Lambda 900, 950 and 1050.
2 319.2 T=100%
3 379.2 UG11
4 562.4 BG38
5 690.4 OG550
6 810.4 RG665
7 1190.4 RG780
8 1670.4 T-LPG-1.0
9 2680.8 T-LPG-1.5
10 3350 T-LPG-2.5
11 T=0%
3. Click in the Position field and select the position from the drop-down list. The Filter
Type is automatically updated.
OR
Click in the Filter Type field and select the filter from the drop-down list. The Position
field is automatically updated.
The same filter position and filter type can be specified in the table more than once.
NOTE: The wavelengths can be added in any order. If you wish to reorder the wavelengths,
you can click on the wavelength column header. When the dialog is closed the
software will automatically reorder the table into wavelength order if they are not
already.
1. For the firmware to recognize that a common beam depolarizer is installed, select
Enable common beam depolarizer.
2. For the firmware to recognize that sample and reference beam attenuators are installed,
select Enable internal attenuators.
This option is not available on the Lambda 650, 650R, 650S, 750 and 750S.
1. To reset the lamp usage after a lamp has been replaced, select Reset Usage.
2. Click OK.
The usage is reset to 0:0.
We recommend 2000 hours for a PerkinElmer-supplied deuterium lamp, and 1000 hours for a
PerkinElmer-supplied tungsten lamp.
2. Click in the Name field and enter the name of the lamp.
4. Select whether the lamp is Enabled or Disabled from the drop-down list in the Enabled
column of the table.
To remove a lamp from the table, click anywhere in the required row and then click
Remove.
Note that the lamp may still appear in the External Lamp drop-down list on the
Instrument page.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 143
NOTE: An external lamp will not appear on the Data Collection page within the Workspace
unless it has been enabled from this Properties page.
The Instrument Event Log records all calibration details, and all instrument property
changes (for example, changing a lamp or detector):
2. Click Print.
All the Instrument Event Log information is printed to the default printer.
Calibrate Instrument
How do I calibrate my instrument?
NOTE: You must check that the beam path is clear before performing a calibration.
the routine, and whether the test is enabled. The Zero Percent T calibration must be
performed when you change the detector, but is not usually required at other times.
2. To view (and change) the settings for a particular routine, highlight the routine in the
table and then click Settings.
The settings dialog for the selected routine is displayed.
NOTE: Settings is not available for the Slits or Zero Percent T calibrations.
UV/Vis Wavelength
Select Manual set, Manual set 1 peak, Manual Set 2 peaks, Auto search 1 peak, or
Auto search 2 peaks.
Manual set – allows you to enter the offset and factor (without the need to determine the
values in advance).
Manual set 1 peak – allows you to change the offset. A well known peak can be shifted to
an exact wavelength.
Manual set 2 peaks – allows you to change the offset and factor by specifying the old and
new values of 2 well known peaks.
Auto search 1 peak – allows you to change the offset. The software performs an automatic
search for the D2 peak at 656.1 nm. The measured peak is then shifted to the exact
wavelength.
Auto search 2 peaks – allows you to change the offset and factor. The software performs
an automatic search for the D2 peak at 656.1 nm and the peak at 0.0 nm. The measured
peaks are then shifted to the exact wavelengths.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 145
NIR Wavelength
Select Manual set, Manual set 1 peak, Manual Set 2 peaks, Auto search 1 peak, or
Auto search 2 peaks.
Manual set – allows you to enter the offset and factor (without the need to determine the
values in advance).
Manual set 1 peak – allows you to change the offset. A well known peak can be shifted to
an exact wavelength.
Manual set 2 peaks – allows you to change the offset and factor by specifying the old and
new values of 2 well known peaks.
Auto search 1 peak – allows you to change the offset. The software performs an automatic
search for the D2 peak at 1312.2 nm. The measured peak is then shifted to the exact
wavelength.
Auto search 2 peaks – allows you to change the offset and factor. The software performs
an automatic search for the D2 peak at 1312.2 nm and the peak at 0.0 nm. The measured
peaks are then shifted to the exact wavelengths.
There are no user-defined settings for the Slits or Zero Percent T calibrations.
2. Click Calibrate.
The calibrations are performed in the order listed in the table. Messages below the table
show the progress of the calibration. If you are performing the Zero Percent T
calibration on a Lambda 650/750, you will be prompted to place the magnetic beam
blocks supplied over the ports in the sample compartment wall.
When a calibration has passed, a green tick is displayed in the first column of the table. If
the test fails, a red cross is displayed. In such an event please contact a PerkinElmer Service
Engineer.
3. When the calibration has finished, click Close to close the dialog.
It is not possible to print the calibration results. The date and time of the calibration is
recorded in the instrument event log.
NOTE: If you deselect calibration routines and then exit the dialog (either after performing
the calibration or without performing the calibration), the next time you open the
dialog all the options are selected by default.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 147
Manual Control
Manual control is a special method that allows manual control of the default instrument and
enables you to look at the ordinate result at a particular wavelength, or switch to alignment
mode, without anything being saved to the database. It consists of only Instrument and
Accessory settings and cannot be used to collect data. A typical use of Manual Control would
be for aligning an accessory.
Ensure Instruments is selected on the Folder List in the Explorer, and then from the
Tools menu select Manual Control.
The Manual Control workspace is displayed.
The top page, displayed by default or by selecting Manual Control from the Folder List,
displays the Name and Description. These cannot be edited.
Optimize Gains Optimizes the gain based on the current settings. Allows you
to choose whether to apply this to the open method.
NOTE: This is only available for the Lambda 900, 950 and
1050. It is only available from the Actions menu
when in the Workspace.
Autozero
How do I perform an Autozero?
1. Enter the Wavelength at which you want to perform the Autozero and then click Apply.
The instrument goes to the selected wavelength.
Calibrate Instrument
How do I calibrate my instrument?
NOTE: Calibration is only available for high-performance instruments – Lambda 650, 650R,
650S, 750, 750S, 800, 850, 850R, 850+, 900, 950, 1050 WB, 1050 NB, and 1050+.
NOTE: You must check that the beam path is clear before performing a calibration.
2. To view (and change) the settings for a particular routine, highlight the routine in the
table and then click Settings.
The settings dialog for the selected routine is displayed.
NOTE: Settings is not available for the Slits or Zero Percent T calibrations.
UV/Vis Wavelength
Select Manual set, Manual set 1 peak, Manual Set 2 peaks, Auto search 1 peak, or
Auto search 2 peaks.
Manual set – allows you to enter the offset and factor (without the need to determine the
values in advance).
Manual set 1 peak – allows you to change the offset. A well-known peak can be shifted to
an exact wavelength.
Manual set 2 peaks – allows you to change the offset and factor by specifying the old and
new values of 2 well known peaks.
Auto search 1 peak – allows you to change the offset. The software performs an automatic
search for the D2 peak at 656.1 nm. The measured peak is then shifted to the exact
wavelength.
Auto search 2 peaks – allows you to change the offset and factor. The software performs
an automatic search for the D2 peak at 656.1 nm and the peak at 0.0 nm. The measured
peaks are then shifted to the exact wavelengths.
150 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NIR Wavelength
Select Manual set, Manual set 1 peak, Manual Set 2 peaks, Auto search 1 peak, or
Auto search 2 peaks.
Manual set – allows you to enter the offset and factor (without the need to determine the
values in advance).
Manual set 1 peak – allows you to change the offset. A well known peak can be shifted to
an exact wavelength.
Manual set 2 peaks – allows you to change the offset and factor by specifying the old and
new values of 2 well known peaks.
Auto search 1 peak – allows you to change the offset. The software performs an automatic
search for the D2 peak at 1312.2 nm. The measured peak is then shifted to the exact
wavelength.
Auto search 2 peaks – allows you to change the offset and factor. The software performs
an automatic search for the D2 peak at 1312.2 nm and the peak at 0.0 nm. The measured
peaks are then shifted to the exact wavelengths.
There are no user-defined settings for the Slits and Zero Percent T calibrations.
2. Click Calibrate.
The calibrations are performed in the order listed in the table. Messages below the table
show the progress of the calibration. If you are performing the Zero Percent T
calibration on a Lambda 650/750, you will be prompted to place the magnetic beam
blocks supplied over the ports in the sample compartment wall.
When a calibration has passed, a green tick is displayed in the first column of the table.
If the test fails, a red cross is displayed. In such an event please contact a PerkinElmer
Service Engineer.
3. When the calibration has finished, click Close to close the dialog.
It is not possible to print the calibration results. The date and time of the calibration is
recorded in the instrument event log.
NOTE: If you deselect calibration routines and then exit the dialog (either after performing
the calibration or without performing the calibration), the next time you open the
dialog all the options are selected by default.
To modify the settings of a routine, select the required row in the table and click
Settings.
The appropriate calibration dialog is displayed.
NOTE: Settings is not available for the Slits or Zero Percent T calibrations.
Select Manual set, Manual set 1 peak, Manual Set 2 peaks, Auto search 1 peak, or
Auto search 2 peaks.
Manual set – allows you to enter the offset and factor (without the need to determine the
values in advance).
Manual set 1 peak – allows you to change the offset. A well known peak can be shifted to
an exact wavelength.
Manual set 2 peaks – allows you to change the offset and factor by specifying the old and
new values of 2 well known peaks.
Auto search 1 peak – allows you to change the offset. The software performs an automatic
search for the D2 peak at 656.1 nm. The measured peak is then shifted to the exact
wavelength.
Auto search 2 peaks – allows you to change the offset and factor. The software performs
an automatic search for the D2 peak at 656.1 nm and the peak at 0.0 nm. The measured
peaks are then shifted to the exact wavelengths.
Select Manual set, Manual set 1 peak, Manual Set 2 peaks, Auto search 1 peak, or
Auto search 2 peaks.
Manual set – allows you to enter the offset and factor (without the need to determine the
values in advance).
Manual set 1 peak – allows you to change the offset. A well known peak can be shifted to
an exact wavelength.
Manual set 2 peaks – allows you to change the offset and factor by specifying the old and
new values of 2 well known peaks.
Auto search 1 peak – allows you to change the offset. The software performs an automatic
search for the D2 peak at 1312.2 nm. The measured peak is then shifted to the exact
wavelength.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 153
Auto search 2 peaks – allows you to change the offset and factor. The software performs
an automatic search for the D2 peak at 1312.2 nm and the peak at 0.0 nm. The measured
peaks are then shifted to the exact wavelengths.
Instrument Properties
How do I view the properties of an instrument?
NOTE: This is only available for high performance instruments (Lambda 650, 650R, 650S,
750, 750S, 800, 850, 850+, 900, 950, WB 1050, NB 1050, and 1050+). In addition,
you must have permission to configure instruments in order to view this dialog. For
further information about your permission please contact your UV WinLab software
Administrator.
Lamps tab
1. Select the lamp type from the list of available internal lamps for the selected instrument.
The Current Usage field displays the usage of the selected lamp. This field is for
information only and cannot be edited.
2. To reset the lamp usage after a lamp has been replaced, select Reset Usage.
NOTE: If the lamp has expired, it is not possible to just reset the Current Usage. The lamp
must be replaced.
The Current Usage time is reset to zero when you click OK and exit the dialog.
NOTE: You must have the necessary permission to be able to reset the usage time. In
addition, this action is a signature point and the information (user name, password,
reason, comment) will be recorded in the audit trail.
We recommend 2000 hours for a PerkinElmer-supplied deuterium lamp, and 1000 hours
for a PerkinElmer-supplied tungsten lamp.
A reminder message to change the lamp will be displayed when the Current Usage
approaches the Lamp Life.
154 . UV WinLab Software Guide
5. Click in the Name field and enter the name of the lamp.
To remove a lamp from the table, click anywhere in the required row and then click
Remove.
The lamp is removed.
NOTE: An external lamp will not appear on the Data Collection page within the Workspace
unless it has been enabled from this Properties page.
Instrument tab
The instrument tab displays the current filter table settings and also which items of firmware
are enabled.
NOTE: It is not possible to edit the Filter Table when the Instrument Properties have been
accessed via the Actions menu from within Manual Control. You must right-click on
the Instrument from within the Explorer and select Instrument Properties.
You should not alter the firmware options unless you fully understand the implications of
doing so.
1. For the firmware to recognize that a common beam depolarizer is installed, select
Enable common beam depolarizer.
2. For the firmware to recognize that sample and reference beam attenuators are installed,
select Enable internal attenuators.
This option is not available on the Lambda 650, 650R, 650S, 750 and 750S.
1. To reset the lamp usage after a lamp has been replaced, select Reset Usage.
2. Click OK.
The usage is reset to 0:0.
We recommend 2000 hours for a PerkinElmer-supplied deuterium lamp, and 1000 hours for a
PerkinElmer-supplied tungsten lamp.
2. Click in the Name field and enter the name of the lamp.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 155
To remove a lamp from the table, click anywhere in the required row and then click
Remove.
The lamp is removed.
NOTE: An external lamp will not appear on the Data Collection page within the Workspace
unless it has been enabled from this Properties page.
Optimize Gains
What is Optimize Gains?
NOTE: Optimize Gains is only available for the Lambda 900, 950 and 1050. It is only
available from the Actions menu when you are within the Workspace.
Optimize gain adjusts settings to avoid any discontinuity at the detector change point caused
by differences in detector linearity. The primary method is to adjust the gain to ensure that
the Servo slit width control will stay within its operating range (0.2–20 nm).
The energy (and thus the slit position) is affected by the accessory fitted. Therefore, balance
should be done with the accessory installed.
4. The Monochromator is set at a point just to the NIR side of the detector change.
6. The UV slit width is set to one-quarter of the size of the NIR slit width, due to
differences in the monochromator grating.
NOTE: When you select Optimize Gains, the Instrument Status Bar will update with the
Instrument status. When the procedure is complete, a dialog will be displayed
showing the result and asking whether you wish to apply the result to the current
method:
156 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Click Apply to method to apply the results to the current method, or click Cancel to reject
the results and keep the current instrument settings.
See also
IPV Setup
NOTE: IPV is only available for Medium performance instruments – Lambda 25, 35, 45, 20,
40, 40P, 20Bio and 40Bio. The IPV commands on the Tools menu within the Explorer
are only available when Instruments is highlighted in the Folder List.
There is a growing awareness among analytical chemists of the need to produce accurate
and precise results. Quality control has become increasingly important in all areas of
analytical chemistry. The quality of an analytical result depends on various factors among
which instrumentation is one of the most important, and a number of regulations for single
applications fields already exist.
To comply with national and international regulations and standards, such as Good
Laboratory Practice (GLP), EN45000, or Pharmacopoeia, the performance of spectrometers
must be checked at regular intervals.
An IPV is used to determine the fitness for purpose of an instrument. A large number of tests
are available covering most appropriate regulatory bodies.
If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab you must have the correct
permission to allow you to create IPV Setups. Permissions are defined by the Administrator –
please contact your UV WinLab Administrator if necessary.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, many of the security features
described below are not present as they are only necessary for Enhanced Security.
The following IPV tests are available from the Tests page of the IPV Setup. For further
information about a particular test, see:
K2Cr2O7 solution
Photometric repeatability
glass
Resolution with benzene
Standard security – any user can setup, lock and unlock an IPV setup.
Enhanced security – a user must have permission to create IPV setups. The default group
'Developer' has permission to create IPV setups. In addition, if a user has permission to
create IPV setups they can run an IPV on demand. Only users with permission to create IPV
setups can run IPVs on demand.
1. From the Folder List, select Instruments and then click on (to select) the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
2. From Tools menu select Instrument Performance Verification and then select Create
IPVSetup from the submenu.
The IPV Setup is displayed. There are three pages in the Folder List for the IPV Setup –
IPV Setup, Reporting and Tests. Each of these is described in turn below.
Setup
The Setup page defines the name of the IPV setup and the timing of the tests. It allows you
to import and export an IPV setup. It also allows a Standard Operating Procedure (SOP) to
be attached to the IPV setup.
Name Select the Name of a Setup from the drop-down list of available IPV
Setups.
OR
To create a new IPV Setup, click New.
The New IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
Enter a Name and click OK.
The Name is displayed on the Setup page.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 159
Description If a previous IPV has been selected, the Description is displayed. You can
edit this Description if required.
If a new setup has just been created, you can enter a description for this
new setup.
Save Enables you to save the setup with the selected name.
Import Enables you to import an IPV setup created and exported from another
PC.
Export Enables you to export an IPV setup so that it can be used on another PC.
On demand Selecting On demand only disables all timing controls. The IPV tests can
only then only be run by selecting the Perform now menu command. See
Timing.
NOTE: This setup will only be used by someone with IPV authorization
specifically choosing to do so.
Automatic tests Selecting Automatic tests occur at means that this setup will be triggered
occur at as specified for each test and the tests will be required the first time a
task using this instrument is opened, after the time set here. See Timing.
Attach SOP Enables you to attach a Standard Operating Procedure document that will
be available to users when the tests are run.
Summary Displays a summary of the tests selected and the settings chosen using a
standard template.
Approve Enables someone with the correct permission to approve the setup.
Review Enables someone with the correct permission to review the setup.
Audit Trail Displays the audit trail for the setup using a standard template.
Reporting
The IPV report can be printed as a hardcopy, or printed to the database. Either or both of
these options can be selected.
Save report to Puts a copy of the report into the Communiqué database.
database
NOTE: Save report to database is not available as on option within
the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab as the report is
always saved.
160 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Report timing Select to output a report After each test or At end of tests.
Report When selected, only a summary report is printed rather than the full
summary only report. The full report is available via a Query.
NOTE: If Report summary only is not selected, both the Full report and report summary
are printed by default.
Tests
The Tests page displays all the available IPV tests and enables you to select the tests you
wish to perform.
Available tests A list of all the available tests.
Add Moves a test from the available list to the selected list.
Remove Moves a test from the selected list to the available list.
The setup for each test is displayed by selecting the Test from the Folder List within the IPV
Setup dialog. For further information on setting up tests see the help for the individual test.
1. From the Tools menu in Explorer select Instrument Performance Verification and then
select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
2. Select the Name of the IPV setup that you wish to edit.
The parameters of the setup are displayed.
4. Click Save.
The setup is saved with the new parameters.
NOTE: If you are editing a locked IPV setup you will be forced to save the setup with a new
name. The Save button is grayed; only the Save As button is available.
If you unlock a setup and edit it, the audit trail records the changes and
the revision number of the setup, which is shown in the Audit Trail, is
incremented.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 161
Once you have created the IPV Setup and have entered a Name on the Setup page,
click Save or Save As on the Setup page.
If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab you may be asked to
select a reason and enter a comment. The dialog that appears depends on the settings
previously defined by the UV WinLab Administrator.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab and you enter a name that has
already been used you can overwrite the existing setup with the same name
providing the setup has not been locked. If the original setup with the same name
has been locked you will be prompted for a new name.
NOTE: If you attempt to save an IPV setup without entering all the necessary parameters a
message is displayed. You can continue with the save or return to the test and
complete the parameters.
Yes, it is possible to save the setup and return to it later to complete the test parameters. On
re-opening the IPV setup you will be informed which tests are incomplete.
NOTE: If you try to import an IPV setup file with the same name as a setup file that already
exists, you will be asked to rename the setup that is being imported.
NOTE: If a file has been changed outside of the UV WinLab software it cannot be imported.
What happens if I try to import an IPV Setup with the same name as a
Setup that already exists?
If you try to import an IPV setup with the same name as a setup that already exists, you will
be asked to rename the setup that you are importing. An Import IPV Setup dialog is
displayed.
2. Enter your User name and Password. Select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if
required enter a Comment.
3. Click OK.
The User authentication dialog closes.
NOTE: If you Cancel the User authentication dialog, the Setup file is not imported.
1. From the IPV Setup page, select the Name of the Setup that you want to Export.
2. Click Export.
A Save As dialog is displayed.
4. Click Save.
The dialog closes and a copy of the file is exported.
NOTE: If a file of the same name already exists in the place you are exporting to, you can
overwrite the existing file or save the file with a different name.
2. Click .
The Print dialog is displayed.
NOTE: For further information on the Print settings dialog within Communiqué Print Preview
see the Communiqué section of this Help.
4. Click OK.
The summary is printed as requested.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 163
6. Click .
The Print dialog is displayed.
NOTE: For further information on the Print settings dialog within Communiqué Print Preview
see the Communiqué section of this Help.
8. Click OK.
The summary is printed as requested.
NOTE: If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab you will be prompted to
confirm the Audit Trail printing. If electronic signatures have been turned on, you
may be prompted for your user name, password, a reason and comment, depend on
the settings previously defined by the UV WinLab Administrator.
The type of output and the frequency of the report is defined on the Reporting page of the
IPV Setup, and is saved as part of the IPV setup.
The IPV report can be printed as a hardcopy using the default printer or saved to the
Communiqué database. Either or both of these options can be selected.
You can also select whether to output a report after each test or at the end of all the tests
(where the number of tests run is defined by the timings settings of each test).
You can select to have only a summary report rather than the whole report. This summary
report can be produced as a hard copy or saved to the database.
NOTE: If electronic signatures are switched on within the Enhanced Security version of UV
WinLab, a report cannot be printed if it has not been successfully e-signed.
164 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, only users who have
permission to setup IPVs are able to perform IPVs on demand.
If you select Automatic tests are due at, enter the hour and select am or pm from the
drop-down list.
This setup will be triggered as specified for each test and the tests will be required the first
time a task using this instrument is opened, after the time specified.
Automatic Tests Example – Setup1 has been configured with 2 tests: Test1 and Test2.
Setup 1 has been configured to run at 7:00 am. Test 1 has been set to run every 2 days and
Test 2 has been set to run every 5 days. The first time the setup is run, both the tests are
run.
The next time the user logs into the application the system checks to see whether any of the
tests are due. Since both tests were run, Test1 will now be due on the third day from the day
it was run and Test2 will be due on the sixth day.
If the next time the user logs in it is the third day (2 days after the test was first run), Test1
will be due and the user will be prompted as such. Test2 is not due.
If the user next logs in on the sixth day, Test 1 and Test2 are due and the user will be
prompted as such.
2. Select the IPV setup to associate with the instrument from the drop-down list of
available IPV setups.
3. Click OK.
The IPV setup is associated with the instrument.
NOTE: If an IPV setup that has not been fully setup is selected, a warning is displayed and
the IPV setup dialog is then displayed with this setup loaded so that it can be
completed.
NOTE: It is possible to run an IPV not associated with the instrument. Right-click on the
instrument and select Perform Now. A dialog is displayed allowing you to select the
IPV to run. This IPV will be run without the IPV setup being associated with the
instrument.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 165
How will I be reminded when tests are due if I have set them up to run
automatically?
Selecting Automatic tests occur at on the setup page of the IPV setup means that this
setup will be triggered as specified for each test and the tests will be required the first time a
task using this instrument is opened, after the time specified. A message will be displayed
telling you that IPV tests are now due on the instrument.
OR
Click Postpone to close the dialog. The next time a task is opened that uses this
instrument the IPV reminder dialog is redisplayed.
NOTE: if you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab it is only possible to
postpone the tests if you have the correct permission. You will be asked to provide a
reason for postponing the tests. If the tests are postponed, the IPV status of the
instrument is set to NONE.
Only one IPV setup can be associated with the connected instrument at any time.
It is possible to attach an SOP so that it is available when the IPV is run. If an SOP is
attached, an SOP button is available when the IPV is run, allowing the user to click on it if
they wish and display the SOP document.
2. Click Browse.
The Open dialog is displayed.
The tests to be run are selected on the Tests page of the IPV Setup. The lists of tests in the
Available tests column are tests that are available but are not currently part of the IPV Setup.
The list of tests in the Selected tests column are the tests that are to be run as part of the
IPV.
Select the test from the list of Available tests and click Add.
The test is removed from the Available tests list and added to the Selected tests list.
Select the test from the list of Selected tests and click Remove.
The test is removed from the Selected tests list and added to the Available tests list.
166 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The setup for each test is displayed by selecting the Test from the Folder List within the IPV
Setup dialog. For further information on setting up tests see the help for the individual test.
NOTE: Each IPV test is configured independently of all the other tests.
If the IPV setup is locked and then reviewed, the Event log within the Audit Trail is updated.
The IPV setup can be reviewed as many times as you like before it is approved.
NOTE: If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab,you must have the
necessary permission to Review an IPV setup. If you do not have the correct
permission, the Review button remains grayed.
3. Click OK.
The information is recorded in the Event log section of the Audit trail.
3. Click OK.
The information is recorded in the Event history section of the Audit trail.
NOTE: You must have the necessary permission to Approve an IPV setup. If you do not
have the correct permission, the Approve button remains grayed.
Each time the IPV setup is approved, the information is recorded in the Event log section of
the Audit trail. This only applies to the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab.
3. Click OK.
The audit trail is activated.
NOTE: Once the IPV setup has been locked it cannot be unlocked (and the Save button is
grayed). However, you use the Save As command to create another version of the
IPV Setup with a new name. This will be unlocked.
Yes.
On the IPV setup page, select the Name of the IPV setup that you want to view.
Does an IPV Setup have to be locked, reviewed and approved before it can
be run?
NOTE: Reviewing and Approving is only applicable to the Enhanced Security version of UV
WinLab.
168 . UV WinLab Software Guide
No. However, you can use the Save As command to create another version of the IPV setup.
This will automatically be unlocked.
Wavelength accuracy with deuterium lamp or Wavelength accuracy with glass filters or
Wavelength accuracy with third-party lamp.
What are the tests for the TGA Test (Australian code of good
manufacturing practice for therapeutic goods test)?
Baseline flatness;
Stray Light with potassium dichromate or Stray light with sodium nitrite;
Photometric accuracy with glass filters (NIST 930/1930 or related), or Photometric accuracy
with solutions (potassium dichromate), or Photometric accuracy with potassium nitrate;
Wavelength accuracy with deuterium lamp or Wavelength accuracy with glass filters or
Wavelength accuracy with solutions or Wavelength accuracy with third-party lamp.
See also
This test tests the absorbance stability using a Timedrive method over 60 minutes by
calculating the trend at a specified wavelength and absorbance. The result must be less than
or equal to the limit specified for the test to pass.
Double beam spectrometers are usually very stable and have drift specifications of about
0.0002 A/h. Typical drift specifications for single beam instruments are about 10 times higher
(0.02 A/h). A high stability (low drift) is of importance in all routine applications where the
instrument is in continuous use. In kinetic analysis, the drift can be observed directly when
enzymatic reactions are overlaid and the final result shows inaccuracy. A high drift may also
affect quantitative analysis when a calibration has been performed and the baseline is
shifting during the analysis of unknown samples.
In the absorbance stability test, a Timedrive method is used to measure the change of the
absorbance reading during one hour. It is measured without samples and at the reference
position (zero absorbance). For drift measurements it is especially important to let the
instrument warm up. A double beam instrument needs a warm-up time of approximately 30
minutes, a single-beam instrument needs a warm-up time of about 1 hour.
The spectrum below shows a baseline measurement during a one hour period. Note the very
high ordinate expansion with 0.002 A full scale.
170 . UV WinLab Software Guide
1. Select Absorbance Zero Stability from the list of tests in the Folder List on the IPV
Setup page:
The Absorbance Zero Stability test page is displayed. The page contains all the default
settings.
NOTE: The only entries that are required (if you wish to use the default values) are the
prompts.
3. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 for the Sample, Pass and Fail prompts.
6. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
7. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
8. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, click Save (if you have previously
named and saved the setup), or Save As if you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
9. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 171
1. Select Instruments from the Folder List, and then click (to select) on the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
OR
Using the right mouse button, click on the instrument whose performance you wish to
verify, and select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
4. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If
Absorbance Zero Stability is not currently selected, it will appear in the Available
tests list.
How do I remove Absorbance Zero Stability from the list of tests I want to
perform?
1. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Select Absorbance stability in the Selected tests list and then click Remove.
Absorbance Zero Stability moves from the Selected tests list to the Available tests
list. It is also removed from the Tests folder in the Folder List.
What are the variable parameters and the default, maximum and
minimum values?
Default Minimum Maximum
Ordinate Mode A
Response (s) 2
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
174 . UV WinLab Software Guide
When a spectrum is recorded over the entire wavelength range without sample or reference,
the baseline stability specification can be defined. In practice, this line always has some noise
from optical and electronic elements in the instrument, especially at the wavelength ends. In
a high-quality, double-beam spectrometer, the baseline stability should be lower than 0.0001
A between 200 nm and 1100 nm at zero absorbance and a scan speed of 240 nm/min. Single
beam instruments have about three times higher values for the corrected baseline. If the
baseline stability is poorer, it may result in distorted spectra, especially when measuring at
low concentrations.
1. Select Baseline Stability from the list of tests in the Folder List on the IPV Setup page:
The Baseline stability test page is displayed. The page contains all the default settings.
2. If you do not wish to use the default Baseline flatness limit, enter a new value.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 175
3. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
6. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
7. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear the check box beside Stop
tests on failure.
8. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, select the IPV Setup page from the
Folder List and click Save (if you have previously named and saved the setup), or Save
As if you are saving the setup with a new name
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
9. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
How do I add Baseline Stability test to the list of tests I want to perform?
1. Select Instruments from the tree, and then click (to select) on the instrument whose
performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
4. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
176 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The IPV setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If
Baseline Stability is not currently selected, it will appear in the Available tests list.
1. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Select Baseline stability in the Selected tests list and then click Remove.
Baseline stability moves from the Selected tests list to the Available tests list. It is
also removed from the Tests folder in the Folder List.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 177
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
Baseline Flatness limits (A) +/–0.001 0.0000 1.0000
Perform every (days) 7 1 365
Stop tests on failure On – –
Ordinate Mode A
Number of cycles 1
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop-down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
178 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Noise
Noise means changes of the detector signal caused by optical and electronic effects and this
interference causes uncertainty in the photometric information. The magnitude of the noise
may vary across the spectrum and is most significant at low energy levels. The noise is
defined at one wavelength compared to baseline stability. Low noise levels means high
sensitivity measurements.
Noise level is measured at a single wavelength for a short time period (3 minutes). No
standard material or solutions are required. The noise level at the specified wavelength is
determined from the resulting Timedrive spectrum by calculating the Root Mean Square
(RMS) at a specified wavelength and absorbance.
The timedrive spectrum below shows the noise level measured at 500 nm over a 3 minute
period. Note the high ordinate expansion. The maximum is 0.001 A and the minimum is –
0.001 A.
Noise at Wavelength 1
Noise at Wavelength 2
Noise at Wavelength 3
UV WinLab Software Guide . 179
When the test is performed, if the result in RMS is below or equals the upper limit, the test is
passed.
1. Select Noise at wavelength 1 from the list of tests in the Folder List on the IPV Setup
page:
The Noise at wavelength 1 test page is displayed. The page contains all the default
settings.
2. If you do not wish to use the default limit, enter a new value.
3. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 for the Sample, Pass and Fail prompts.
6. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
7. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
8. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, click Save (if you have previously
named and saved the setup), or Save As if you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
9. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
180 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
1. Select Instruments from the Folder List, and then click (to select) on the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
4. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup
The IPV setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If Noise
at wavelength 1 is not currently selected, it will appear in the Available tests list.
1. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Highlight Noise at wavelength 1 in the Selected tests list and then click Remove.
Noise at wavelength 1 moves from the Selected tests list to the Available tests list.
It is also removed from the Tests folder in the Folder List.
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
Ordinate Mode A
Response (s) 1
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
UV WinLab Software Guide . 183
When the test is performed, if the result in RMS is below or equals the upper limit, the test is
passed.
1. Select Noise 2 from the list of tests in the Folder List on the IPV Setup page:
The Noise at wavelength 2 test page is displayed. The page contains all the default
settings.
2. If you do not wish to use the default Wavelength, enter a new value.
3. If you do not wish to use the default Absorbance, enter a new value.
4. If you do not wish to use the default Noise RMS limit, enter a new value.
5. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
7. Repeat steps 5 and 6 for the Sample, Pass and Fail prompts.
8. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop-down list.
9. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
10. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, select the IPV setup page and click
Save (if you have previously named and saved the setup), or Save As if you are saving
the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
11. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
184 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
1. Select Instruments from the Folder List, and then click (to select) on the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
4. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If Noise
at wavelength 2 is not currently selected, it will appear in the Available tests list.
1. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Highlight Noise at wavelength 2 in the Selected tests list and then click Remove.
Noise at wavelength 2 moves from the Selected tests list to the Available tests list.
It is also removed from the Tests folder in the Folder List.
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
Ordinate Mode A
Response (secs) 1
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
UV WinLab Software Guide . 187
When the test is performed, if the result in RMS is below or equals the upper limit, the test is
passed.
1. Select Noise at wavelength 3 from the list of tests in the Folder List on the IPV Setup
page:
The Noise at wavelength 3 test page is displayed. The page contains all the default
settings.
2. If you do not wish to use the default limit, enter a new value.
3. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 for the Sample, Pass and Fail prompts.
6. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
7. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
8. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, click Save (if you have previously
named and saved the setup), or Save As if you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
9. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
188 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
1. Select Instruments from the Folder List, and then click (to select) on the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
4. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If Noise
at wavelength 3 is not currently selected, it will appear in the Available tests list.
1. Select the Tests folder on the Tree within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Select Noise at wavelength 3 in the Selected tests list and then click Remove.
Noise at wavelength 3 moves from the Selected tests list to the Available tests list.
It is also removed from the Tests folder in the Tree.
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
Ordinate Mode A
Response (secs) 1
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
UV WinLab Software Guide . 191
Photometric Accuracy
Photometric Accuracy is defined as the closeness of the measured values of transmittance
(%T) or absorbance (A) to the actual value, determined by measuring standards of known A
and %T.
The solution from PerkinElmer's DAB reference material can be used to check photometric
accuracy. The solutions are individually calibrated. They absorb over the entire wavelength
range and so they are insensitive to stray radiation.
The spectrum below illustrates the spectral characteristics of potassium dichromate solution.
1. Select Photometric Accuracy K2Cr2O7Solution from the list of tests in the Folder List
on the IPV Setup page:
The Photometric Accuracy K2Cr2O7 Solution test page is displayed. The page contains
all the default settings.
2. Select the Reference material from the drop-down list or enter the name of the
reference material.
3. Enter the Calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 193
4. Enter the Re-calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Re-calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
8. Enter the Calibrated absorbances for each of the solutions at each of the
wavelengths.
The values can be found on the certificate provided with the reference material. The
number of values to be entered depends on the number of wavelengths and number of
solutions. For example, if the are 4 wavelengths and 2 solutions, 8 values must be
entered – as each solution has a value at each wavelength.
9. If you wish, enter the Photometric accuracy limit for each of the solutions.
The minimum is 0.00 and the maximum is 10.00 A.
10. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
12. Repeat steps 10 and 11 for the Sample, Fail and Pass prompts.
13. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
14. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
15. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, select the IPV Setup page from the
tree and click Save (if you have previously named and saved the setup), or Save As if
you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
194 . UV WinLab Software Guide
16. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
1. Select Instruments from the Folder List, and then click (to select) on the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
4. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If
Photometric Accuracy K2Cr2O7Solution is not currently selected, it will appear in
the Available tests list.
1. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Select Photometric Accuracy K2Cr2O7Solution in the Selected tests list and then click
Remove.
Photometric Accuracy K2Cr2O7Solution is added to the Available tests list. It is
also removed from the Tests folder in the Folder List.
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
Number of solutions 2 1 4
Number of wavelengths 5 1 10
Photometric Accuracy limits solution 1 (same for This field is 0.0000 10.0000
solutions 1 to 4) (± A) left blank in
the software
for you to
enter your
value. You
must add the
limit of the
instrument
(0.01 A) to
the tolerance
of the
reference
material (this
value can be
found on the
certificate
provided with
the reference
material).
Enter the sum
of these two
values in this
field.
Ordinate Mode A
Response (secs) 5
Number of cycles 1
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
198 . UV WinLab Software Guide
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 199
The spectrum below illustrates the spectral characteristics of potassium dichromate solution
near 430 nm.
1. Select Photometric Accuracy K2Cr2O7Solution 430 nm from the list of tests in the
Folder List on the IPV Setup page.
The Photometric Accuracy K2Cr2O7 Solution 430 nm test page is displayed. The page
contains all the default settings.
2. Select the Reference material from the drop-down list or enter the name of the
reference material.
3. Enter the Calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
4. Enter the Re-calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed
by clicking .
The Re-calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
8. Enter the Calibrated absorbances for each of the solutions at each of the
wavelengths.
The values can be found on the certificate provided with the reference material. The
number of values to be entered depends on the number of wavelengths and number of
solutions. For example, if the are 4 wavelengths and 2 solutions, 8 values must be
entered – as each solution has a value at each wavelength.
9. If you wish, enter the Photometric accuracy limit for each of the solutions.
The minimum is 0.00 and the maximum is 10.00 A.
10. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
12. Repeat steps 10 and 11 for the Sample, Fail and Pass prompts.
13. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
14. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
15. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, select the IPV Setup page from the
tree and click Save (if you have previously named and saved the setup), or Save As
if you are saving the setup for the first time.
16. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 201
1. Select Photometric Accuracy K2Cr2O7Solution 430 nm from the list of tests in the
Folder List on the IPV Setup page – Example.
The Photometric Accuracy K2Cr2O7 Solution 430 nm test page is displayed. The page
contains all the default settings.
2. Select the Reference material from the drop-down list or enter the name of the
reference material.
The only reference material available for Photometric Accuracy K2Cr2O7Solution 430 nm
is EP Potassium Dichromate in Sulphuric Acid.
3. Enter the Calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
4. Enter the Re-calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed
by clicking .
The Re-calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
9. If you wish, enter the Photometric accuracy limit for each of the solutions.
The minimum is 0.00 and the maximum is 10.00 A.
10. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
12. Repeat steps 10 and 11 for the Sample, Fail and Pass prompts.
202 . UV WinLab Software Guide
13. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
14. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
15. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, select the IPV Setup page from the
tree and click Save (if you have previously named and saved the setup), or Save As if
you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
16. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
1. Select Instruments from the Folder List, and then click (to select) on the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the
Explorer, and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
4. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog.
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If
Photometric Accuracy K2Cr2O7Solution430 nm is not currently selected, it will
appear in the Available tests list.
1. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog.
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Select Photometric Accuracy K2Cr2O7Solution 430 nm in the Selected tests list and then
click Remove.
Photometric Accuracy K2Cr2O7Solution 430 nm is added to the Available tests
list. It is also removed from the Tests folder in the Folder List.
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
Number of solutions 1 1 4
Number of wavelengths 1 1 10
Photometric Accuracy limits solution 1 This field is left blank in 0.0000 10.0000
(same for solutions 1 to 4) (+A) the software for you to
enter your value. You
must add the limit of the
instrument (0.01 A) to
the tolerance of the
reference material (this
value can be found on the
certificate provided with
the reference material).
Enter the sum of these
two values in this field.
Ordinate Mode A
Response (secs) 5
Number of cycles 1
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup.
The software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the
necessary tests to be run.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 205
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
206 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The test requires you to prepare a solution of potassium nitrate A.R. in distilled water and
dilute this to give solutions with concentrations of 1.0650 %, 0.7100 % and 0.3550 % w/v.
When the test is performed, if the result is below or equal the upper limit, or higher than or
equal to the lower limit, the test is passed.
1. Select Photometric Accuracy with KNO3 Solution from the list of tests in the Folder
List on the IPV Setup page:
The Photometric Accuracy with KNO3 Solution test page is displayed. The page contains
all the default settings.
4. If you wish to change the default Photometric accuracy limit, enter a new value in the
field.
5. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
7. Repeat steps 5 and 6 for the Sample, Pass and Fail prompts.
8. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
9. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
10. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, click Save (if you have previously
named and saved the setup), or Save As if you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 207
11. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
1. Select Instruments from the Folder List, and then click (to select) on the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
4. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If
Photometric Accuracy with KNO3 Solution is not currently selected, it will appear in
the Available tests list.
5. Select Photometric Accuracy with KNO3 Solution and then click Add.
Photometric Accuracy with KNO3 Solution moves from the Available tests list to
the Selected tests list. It is also added to the Tests folder in the Folder List:
208 . UV WinLab Software Guide
1. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Select Photometric Accuracy with KNO3 Solution in the Selected tests list and then click
Remove.
Photometric Accuracy with KNO3 Solution moves from the Selected tests list to the
Available tests list. It is also removed from the Tests folder in the Folder List.
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
1.0650 0.7510
0.7100 0.5000
0.3550 0.2500
Ordinate Mode A
Response (secs) 5
Number of cycles 1
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
UV WinLab Software Guide . 211
The glass filters from PerkinElmer's set of NTRM spectrometric calibration reference material
can be used to check photometric accuracy. The glass filters are individually calibrated. They
absorb over the entire wavelength rage and so they are insensitive to stray radiation. The
influence of temperature on the transmission characteristics is small (–0.0003 Absorbance
units per Kelvin). The influence of the spectral bandpass is ± 0.0005 A in the range 0.5 nm to
4 nm slit.
When the test is performed, if the result is below or equal the upper limit, or higher than or
equal to the lower limit, the test is passed.
1. Select Photometric Accuracy Glass from the list of tests in the Folder List on the IPV
Setup page–Example.
The Photometric accuracy with glass test page is displayed. The page contains all the
default settings.
2. Select the Reference material from the drop-down list of available reference materials.
3. Enter the Calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
4. Enter the Re-calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Re-calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
8. If more than 5 wavelengths are specified, enter the additional wavelengths at which the
test is performed.
212 . UV WinLab Software Guide
11. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
13. Repeat steps 11 and 12 for the Sample, Fail and Pass prompts.
14. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
15. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
16. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, select the IPV Setup page from the
Folder List and click Save (if you have previously named and saved the setup), or Save
As if you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
17. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
How do I add Photometric accuracy with glass test to the list of tests I
want to perform?
1. Select Instruments from the Folder List, and then click (to select) on the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 213
4. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If
Photometric accuracy with glass is not currently selected, it will appear in the
Available tests list.
How do I remove Photometric accuracy with glass from the list of tests I
want to perform?
1. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
214 . UV WinLab Software Guide
2. Select Photometric accuracy with glass in the Selected tests list and then click
Remove.
Photometric accuracy with glass moves from the Selected tests list to the Available
tests list. It is also removed from the Tests folder in the Folder List.
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
Number of wavelengths 5 1 10
Number of filters 1 1 4
Photometric accuracy limits (repeated for This field is left 0.0000 10.0000
filters 1 to 4) (± A) blank in the
software for you
to enter your
value. You must
add the limit of
the instrument
(0.003 nm) to
the tolerance of
the reference
material (this
value can be
found on the
certificate
provided with the
reference
material). Enter
the sum of these
two values in this
field.
NOTE: The number of calibrated absorbances depends on number of filters and number of
wavelengths. The maximum is 40 (10 wavelengths x 4 filters).
What are the available wavelengths for the different types of filters?
Filter Wavelengths (nm)
Ordinate Mode A
Response (secs) 5
Number of cycles 1
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
UV WinLab Software Guide . 217
This test tests the photometric linearity using the certified absorbance values at specified
wavelengths of a glass filter, against the limit specified. When the test is performed, if the
result is below or equal the upper limit, or higher than or equal to the lower limit, the test is
passed.
You can validate the instrument's linearity using solutions of different concentrations or
reference materials. During a PerkinElmer Validation Process check, glass reference materials
( 1 A + 2 A) are used. Measurements are taken for each glass reference material individually,
then both reference materials are loaded into the sample holder at the same time. If the
measurement for both reference materials together is the sum of the measurements for the
reference materials individually, the instrument's response is linear.
If the response is not linear, additional checks should be performed on the instrument,
particularly checking the instrument control setting (0%T / 100%T) and testing for stray
radiation. It is not only the instrument performance which may limit linear measurements
over a wide absorbance range. There are also some limits with certain samples. The sample
itself must obey the Beer–Lambert law. Generally, the Beer–Lambert law is only valid for real
and ideal solutions with no interactions between the dissolved sample molecules. The bigger
the interaction between the dissolved molecules, the bigger is the deviation from the Beer–
Lambert law. For example, association or dissociation in the sample may cause severe
deviations.
1. Select Photometric Linearity Grey Glass from the list of tests in the Folder List on the
IPV Setup page:
The Photometric linearity test page is displayed. The page contains all the default
settings.
4. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
7. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
218 . UV WinLab Software Guide
8. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
9. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, select IPV setup from the Folder List,
and click Save (if you have previously named and saved the setup), or Save As if you
are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
10. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
How do I add Photometric linearity with Grey Glass test to the list of tests
I want to perform?
1. Select Instruments from the Folder List, and then click (to select) on the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
4. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If
Photometric linearity with Grey Glass is not currently selected, it will appear in the
Available tests list.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 219
How do I remove Photometric linearity with Grey Glass test from the list
of tests I want to perform?
1. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Select Photometric linearity with Grey Glass in the Selected tests list and then click
Remove.
Photometric linearity with Grey Glass is added to the Available tests list. It is also
removed from the Tests folder in the Folder List.
220 . UV WinLab Software Guide
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
Reference material – – –
Ordinate Mode A
Response (sec) 5
Number of cycles 1
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
Stray radiation is not the only factor which influences linearity; linearity also depends on the
characteristics of the detector. Photomultipliers as detectors have a much wider linear
dynamic range than photodiodes. Spectrometers with a photmultiplier detector allow
measurement over a wider absorbance range than spectrometers with diode detectors. In
addition to this, you can use a reference beam attenuator in instruments with a
photomultiplier; this is not possible in instruments with diode detectors. Nevertheless it is
easily possible to measure up to about 4 Absorbance units with an instrument which has
photodiodes as detector and respective low stray radiation. The linearity is somewhat
dependent on the measurement wavelength, because stray light may be slightly different at
different wavelengths.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 221
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
222 . UV WinLab Software Guide
This test tests the photometric repeatability using certified absorbance values at specified
wavelengths of a glass filter. The calculated standard deviation of the 10 measurements
must be less than or equal to the limit specified for the test to pass.
1. Select Photometric repeatability glass from the list of tests in the Folder List on the
IPV Setup page:
The Photometric repeatability test page is displayed. The page contains all the default
settings.
2. Select the Reference material from the drop-down list or enter the name.
4. Enter the Calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
5. Enter the Re-calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Re-calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 223
8. If you wish, alter the default Photometric standard deviation limit (A)
The default is 0.001 A
9. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
11. Repeat steps 10 and 11 for the Sample, Pass and Fail prompts.
12. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
13. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
14. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, select the IPV Setup from the Folder
List and click Save (if you have previously named and saved the setup), or Save As if
you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
15. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
224 . UV WinLab Software Guide
1. Select Instruments from the Folder List, and then click (to select) on the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
4. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup
The IPV setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If
Photometric Repeatability is not currently selected, it will appear in the Available
tests list.
1. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Select Photometric repeatability in the Selected tests list and then click Remove.
Photometric repeatability is added to the Available tests list. It is also removed from
the Tests folder in the Folder List.
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
Number of wavelengths 5 1 5
What are the available wavelengths for the different types of filters?
Filter Wavelengths (nm)
NTRM PKI 930 Glass Filters 440.00, 465.00, 546.10, 590.00, 635.00
NTRM PKI 1930 Glass Filters 440.00, 465.00, 546.10, 590.00, 635.00
NIST SRM 930 Glass Filters 440.00, 465.00, 546.10, 590.00, 635.00
NIST SRM 1930 Glass Filters 440.00, 465.00, 546.10, 590.00, 635.00
NIST SRM 2031 metal film on Quartz filters 250.00, 280.00, 340.00, 360.00, 400.00
UV WinLab Software Guide . 227
Ordinate Mode A
Response (sec) 5
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
228 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Resolution
The resolution in a spectral analysis depends upon the bandpass (spectral bandwidth) of the
spectrometer, which in turn depends primarily on the physical slit width. The smaller the slit
width, the higher the resolution of bands in a spectrum that can be achieved.
What is bandpass?
The bandpass is defined as the full width at half maximum of the radiation beam emerging
from the monochromator. It is proportional to the mechanical slit width at high values. It
decreases less rapidly than the mechanical slit at low values.
The instrument's bandpass should be 1/5 to 1/10 of the full width at half peak height of the
band to be measured. Higher values can cause loss of both photometric accuracy and
resolution of detail.
The energy decreases as the mechanical slit width squared. This causes increased noise at
high resolution (that is, low bandpass).
To test the resolution, add one drop of benzene to a quartz cell and close the cell with a
stopper.
As can be seen from the benzene spectra below, too high a slit width decreases both
photometric accuracy and the resolution of spectral detail. Too low a slit width may increase
noise. Under conditions of high energy, decreasing the slit causes only a small increase in
noise. At low energy, the noise is inversely proportional to the slit width at large and medium
slit widths. At very small slits, the noise increases faster than 1/slit width. A good
compromise is usually made with a slit between 1/5 and 1/10 of the widths of the spectral
features of interest.
1. Select Resolution Benzene from the list of tests in the Folder List on the IPV Setup
page:
The Resolution with Benzene Vapor test page is displayed. The page contains all the
default settings.
230 . UV WinLab Software Guide
2. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 for the Sample, Pass and Fail prompts.
5. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
6. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
7. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, click Save (if you have previously
named and saved the setup), or Save As if you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
8. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
How do I add Resolution with Benzene Vapor test to the list of tests I
want to perform?
1. Select Instruments from the Folder List, and then click (to select) on the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
4. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 231
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If
Resolution Benzene is not currently selected, it will appear in the Available tests list.
How do I remove Resolution with Benzene Vapor from the list of tests I
want to perform?
1. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Highlight Resolution Benzene in the Selected tests list and then click Remove.
Resolution Benzene moves from the Selected tests list to the Available tests list. It
is also removed from the Tests folder in the Folder List.
232 . UV WinLab Software Guide
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
Ordinate Mode A
Number of cycles 1
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
NOTE: Only a 1nm slit is used when performing the tests on a Lambda 25.
NOTE: An Autozero is performed between scans. This test uses a scan method.
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 233
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
This test is a visual assessment of the quality of the spectra and requires you to state
whether the results are within specification. When the test is complete, the spectrum is
displayed in a dialog together with a Pass button and a Fail button. Make a visual inspection
of the graph and then click Pass or Fail as required.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
234 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Pharmacopoeia regulations state that only spectrometers which give good enough resolution
of a toluene spectrum can be used for pharmaceutical applications. It is recommended in the
literature that the absorbance ratio at 269 nm/266 nm is greater than 1.5.
The test solution is a 0.02% solution of toluene in hexane (v/v), in a 1 cm quartz cell.
Alternatively, the PerkinElmer UV/Vis standard for EP/DAB may be used, which contains a
ready-to-use toluene solution according to EP/DAB.
The spectrum below is of a 0.02% toluene solution in hexane recorded with slit width 1 nm.
There is a maximum at 268.7 nm and a minimum at 266.9 nm. The respective absorbance
readings are 0.4476 and 0.2371. The absorbance ratio of maximum and minimum is
0.4476/0.2371 = 1.89
1. Select Resolution Toluene from the list of tests in the Folder List on the IPV Setup
page:
The Resolution with Toluene test page is displayed. The page contains all the default
settings.
2. Select the Reference material from the drop-down list or enter the name of the
Reference material.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 235
4. Enter the Calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
5. Enter the Re-calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Re-calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
8. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
10. Repeat steps 8 and 9 for the Pass and Fail and Sample prompts.
11. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
12. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
13. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the tree and enter the information
as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, select the IPV Setup page from the
tree and click Save (if you have previously named and saved the setup), or Save As if
you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
14. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
236 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
How do I add Resolution with Toluene Solution test to the list of tests I
want to perform?
1. Select Instruments from the tree, and then click (to select) on the instrument whose
performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
4. Select the Tests folder on the Tree within the IPV setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup
The IPV setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If
Resolution Toluene is not currently selected, it will appear in the Available tests list.
How do I remove Resolution with Toluene Solution from the list of tests I
want to perform?
1. Select the Tests folder on the Tree within the IPV setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Highlight Resolution Toluene test in the Selected tests list and then click Remove.
Resolution Toluene to the Available tests list. It is also removed from the Tests
folder in the Tree.
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
NOTE: If a slit width is specified that is not compatible with those available for a particular
spectrometer, an error message will be displayed when you try to run the test.
Ordinate Mode A
Number of cycles 1
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
NOTE: Only a 1nm slit is used when performing the tests on a Lambda 25.
NOTE: If a slit width is specified that is not compatible with those available for a particular
spectrometer, an error message will be displayed when you try to run the test.
NOTE: An Autozero is performed between scans. This test uses a scan method.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 239
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
240 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Pharmacopoeia regulations state that only spectrometers which give good enough resolution
of a toluene in methanol spectrum can be used for pharmaceutical applications. The test
solution is a 0.02 % solution of toluene in methanol (v/v), in a 1 cm quartz cell. The
spectrum shows a small negative peak at 265 nm located between two large negative peaks
at 261 nm and 268 nm. It is recommended in the literature that the absorbance ratio at 265
nm / 261 nm is not less than 0.2.
1. Select Resolution Toluene in Methanol from the list of tests in the Folder List on the
IPV Setup page:
The Resolution with Toluene in Methanol test page is displayed. The page contains all
the default settings.
2. Select the Reference material from the drop-down list or enter the name of the
Reference material.
4. Enter the Calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
5. Enter the Re-calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Re-calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
8. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 241
10. Repeat steps 8 and 9 for the Sample, Fail and Pass prompts.
11. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
12. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
13. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, select the IPV Setup page from the
Folder List and click Save (if you have previously named and saved the setup), or Save
As if you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
14. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
How do I add Resolution with Toluene in Methanol test to the list of tests
I want to perform?
1. Select Instruments from the Folder List, and then click (to select) on the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
4. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If
Resolution Toluene in Methanol is not currently selected, it will appear in the
Available tests list.
242 . UV WinLab Software Guide
1. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Select Resolution Toluene in Methanol in the Selected tests list and then click Remove.
Resolution Toluene in Methanol moves to the Available tests list. It is also removed
from the Tests folder in the Folder List.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 243
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
NOTE: If a slit width is specified that is not compatible with those available for a particular
spectrometer, an error message will be displayed when you try to run the test.
Ordinate Mode A
Number of cycles 1
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
NOTE: Only a 1 nm slit is used when performing the tests on a Lambda 25.
NOTE: If a slit width is specified that is not compatible with those available for a particular
spectrometer, an error message will be displayed when you try to run the test.
NOTE: An Autozero is performed between scans. This test uses a scan method.
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
UV WinLab Software Guide . 245
Stray Light
Stray radiation is any unwanted radiant energy measured by the detector that is outside the
spectral region isolated by the bandpass of the instrument. Stray radiation is that portion of
the light reaching the detector that is not of the desired wavelength, given the position of the
monochromator.
A high amount of stray radiation can lead to severe limitations in linearity. In cases where
stray radiation is present and not absorbed by the sample, the absorbance reading may be
too low. This effect is much smaller at low absorbance values. With increasing absorbance,
the stray radiation becomes more dominant and the readings become too low. In
quantitative analysis at higher absorbance values, the result is strongly dependent on the
influence of stray radiation.
The stray radiation specifications consequently have a direct influence on the calibration
curve in quantitative analysis and on the precision of the results.
For example, assume that the instrument's wavelength is set to the peak of an absorption
band, but that 0.1% of the radiation in the beam is another wavelength which is not
absorbed by the sample. Consider 4 samples whose actual peak absorbances are 1, 2, 3, and
4. The observed %T will be 0.001 greater than the actual in each case due to the 0.1% stray
radiation.
The table below illustrates the effect of 0.1% stray radiation on the transmission and
absorbance readings of a sample with a real absorbance of 1, 2, 3, 4 A.
Actual peak Actual %T at Observed %T at Observed peak
absorbance peak peak absorbance
The following table illustrates the effect of different amounts of stray radiation.
Actual Absorbance readings from instruments with different % stray radiation
absorbance specifications
The amount of stray radiation energy varies throughout the spectral range and between
instruments, depending on the age of the spectrometer and on environmental conditions. If
is therefore important that the stray radiant energy check is done at several points of the
spectrum, particularly in regions where the best performance is required.
Stray radiation is measured with cutoff filters at a wavelength where they do not transmit
light. To allow proper stray radiation measurement these filters should have a wide region
where they transmit (stray) light. Filters with continuous high absorbance are not suited
because they also block most of the stray radiation and give unrealistic low stray radiation
values.
A general method to make sure an instrument is within the stray radiation tolerance for a
specific application is the stray radiation test according to DAB 10/EP and other
pharmacopoeias.
See also
The spectrum below is of a KCl solution (12 g/l). It shows the cut-off at 200 nm.
1. Select Stray Light KCl 200 nm from the list of tests in the Folder List on the IPV Setup
page:
The Stray Light with Potassium Chloride test page is displayed. The page contains all
the default settings.
2. Select the Reference material from the drop-down list or enter the name of the
Reference material.
4. Enter the Calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
5. Enter the Re-calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Re-calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
7. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
10. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
11. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
12. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, select the IPV Setup page from the
Folder List and click Save (if you have previously named and saved the setup), or Save
As if you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
13. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 249
How do I add Stray light with Potassium Chloride Solution at 200 nm test
to the list of tests I want to perform?
1. Select Instruments from the tree, and then click (to select) on the instrument whose
performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
4. Select the Tests folder on the Tree within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If Stray
Light KCl 200 nm is not currently selected, it will appear in the Available tests list.
1. Select the Tests folder on the Tree within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Select Stray Light KCl 200 nm in the Selected tests list and then click Remove.
Stray Light KCl 200 nm to the Available tests list. It is also removed from the Tests
folder in the Tree.
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
Ordinate Mode A
Number of cycles 1
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
252 . UV WinLab Software Guide
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
UV WinLab Software Guide . 253
The spectrum below is of a KCl solution (12 g/l). It shows the absorbance is greater than 2.0
at 198 nm.
1. Select Stray Light KCl from the list of tests in the Folder List on the IPV Setup page:
The Stray Light with Potassium Chloride test page is displayed. The page contains all
the default settings.
2. Select the Reference material from the drop-down list or enter the name of the
Reference material.
4. Enter the Calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
254 . UV WinLab Software Guide
5. Enter the Re-calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Re-calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
6. In the Measurement (nm) field, enter the wavelength that you wish to perform the
test.
8. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
10. Repeat steps 8 and 9 for the Sample, Fail and Pass prompts.
11. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
12. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
13. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, select the IPV Setup page from the
Folder List and click Save (if you have previously named and saved the setup), or Save
As if you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
14. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 255
How do I add Stray light with Potassium Chloride Solution test to the list
of tests I want to perform?
1. Select Instruments from the Folder List, and then click (to select) on the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
4. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If Stray
Light KCl is not currently selected, it will appear in the Available tests list.
How do I remove Stray light with Potassium Chloride solution from the list
of tests I want to perform?
1. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Select Stray Light KCl in the Selected tests list and then click Remove.
Stray Light KCl moves to the Available tests list. It is also removed from the Tests
folder in the Folder List.
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
Measurement (nm) -
UV WinLab Software Guide . 257
Ordinate Mode A
Number of cycles 1
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
258 . UV WinLab Software Guide
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
UV WinLab Software Guide . 259
This test tests the stray light at 220 nm using sodium iodide solution. The measured
transmission difference between the blocked beam and the sodium iodide solution must be
greater than or equal to the specified limit.
The spectrum below is of an aqueous solution of NaI 10 g/l. It illustrates the cut-off point at
260 nm.
1. Select Stray Light NaI 220 nm from the list of tests in the Folder List on the IPV Setup
page:
The Stray light with Sodium Iodide test page is displayed. The page contains all the
default settings.
2. Select the Reference material from the drop-down list or enter the name of the
Reference material.
4. Enter the Calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
260 . UV WinLab Software Guide
5. Enter the Re-calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Re-calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
7. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
9. Repeat steps 7 and 8 for the Sample, Block, Pass and Fail prompts.
10. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
11. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
12. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, select the IPV setup page from the
Folder List and click Save (if you have previously named and saved the setup), or Save
As if you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
13. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 261
How do I add Stray light with Sodium Iodide Solution test to the list of
tests I want to perform?
1. Select Instruments from the Folder List, and then click (to select) on the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
4. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If Stray
Light NaI 220 nm is not currently selected, it will appear in the Available tests list.
How do I remove Stray light with Sodium Iodide solution from the list of
tests I want to perform?
1. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Select Stray Light NaI 220 nm in the Selected tests list and then click Remove.
Stray Light NaI 220 nm to the Available tests list. It is also removed from the Tests
folder in the Folder List.
262 . UV WinLab Software Guide
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
Ordinate Mode %T
Response (sec) 1
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
264 . UV WinLab Software Guide
This test uses a Timedrive method to test the stray light of the instrument at both 340 nm
and 370 nm using sodium nitrite solution. The measured transmission difference between the
blocked beam and the solution must be greater than or equal to the specified limit. When the
test is performed, if the result is equal to, or below the upper limit, the test passes.
The spectrum below is of a 50 g/l NaNO2 solution. It illustrates the cut-off point at 385 nm.
1. Select Stray Light NaNO2 340 nm, 370 nm from the list of tests in the Folder List on
the IPV Setup page:
The Stray light with Sodium Nitrite test page is displayed. The page contains all the
default settings.
2. Select the Reference material from the drop-down list or enter the name of the
Reference material.
4. Enter the Calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 265
5. Enter the Re-calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Re-calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
7. If you wish to change the default Stray light limit, enter a new value in the field.
8. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
10. Repeat steps 8 and 9 for the Sample, Block, Pass and Fail prompts.
11. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
12. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
13. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, click Save (if you have previously
named and saved the setup), or Save As if you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
14. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
266 . UV WinLab Software Guide
How do I add Stray light with Sodium Nitrite Solution test to the list of
tests I want to perform?
1. Select Instruments from the Folder List, and then click (to select) on the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
4. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If Stray
Light NaNO2 340 nm, 370 nm is not currently selected, it will appear in the Available
tests list.
5. Select Stray Light NaNO2 340 nm, 370 nm and then click Add.
Stray Light NaNO2 340 nm, 370 nm moves from the Available tests list to the
Selected tests list. It is also added to the Tests folder in the Folder List:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 267
How do I remove Stray light with Sodium Nitrite solution from the list of
tests I want to perform?
1. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Select Stray Light NaNO2 340 nm, 370 nm in the Selected tests list and then click
Remove.
Stray Light NaNO2 340 nm, 370 nm to the Available tests list. It is also removed
from the Tests folder in the Folder List.
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
Ordinate Mode A
Response (sec) 1
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 269
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
270 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Wavelength Accuracy
Wavelength accuracy is the closeness of the wavelength value reported by the instrument to
the actual value, determined by comparing measured and known values of sharp lines. It
defines how precisely a selected wavelength can be set by a spectrometer. If a wavelength
calibration is specified as ± 0.5 nm at 656.1 nm, its wavelength accuracy is not as good as an
instrument specified at ± 0.1 nm. If a spectrometer had a wavelength accuracy of ± 0.1 nm,
the maximum transmittance might be found anywhere between 656.0 nm and 656.2 nm.
Wavelength accuracy is not as critical for spectrometers functioning in the region 400 nm to
800 nm, where wide-band chromophores are encountered. However, when working in the
UV region where sharp absorption bands are often encountered, wavelength accuracy
becomes much more critical.
The deuterium lamp wavelength calibration check tests the wavelength accuracy using the
Deuterium (D2) lamp emission line at 656.1 nm and/or 486 nm, against the limit specified.
When the test is performed, if the result is below or equal to the upper limit, or higher than
or equal to the lower limit, the test is passed.
The spectrum below is obtained from a Lambda 35 (2 nm slit setting). The D 2 peak is at
656.1 nm.
1. Select Wavelength accuracy D2 from the list of tests in the Folder List on the IPV
Setup page:
The Wavelength accuracy with Deuterium lamp test page is displayed. The page
contains all the default settings.
3. If you wish to change the default Wavelength accuracy limit, enter a new value in the
field.
4. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
272 . UV WinLab Software Guide
7. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
8. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
9. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, select the IPV Setup page from the
Folder List and click Save (if you have previously named and saved the setup), or Save
As if you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
10. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
How do I add Wavelength accuracy with Deuterium lamp test to the list of
tests I want to perform?
11. Select Instruments from the Folder List, and then click (to select) on the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
12. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
13. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
14. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If
Wavelength accuracy D2 is not currently selected, it will appear in the Available tests
list.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 273
How do I remove Wavelength accuracy with Deuterium lamp from the list
of tests I want to perform?
1. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Select Wavelength accuracy D2 in the Selected tests list and then click Remove.
Wavelength accuracy D2 moves from the Selected tests list to the Available tests
list. It is also removed from the Tests folder in the Folder List.
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
Number of wavelengths 2 1 2
Ordinate Mode E2
Number of cycles 1
UV Lamp On
NOTE: There is no Autozero energy scan. There is no reference material for this test.
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 275
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
276 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The influence of temperature on the peak positions is negligible in the range 20–30 °C. The
influence of the spectral bandpass (slit) on the peak positions is also negligible in the range
1–2 nm for the peaks selected for calibration.
This test tests the wavelength repeatability using the emission line of the Deuterium (D 2)
lamp at 656.1 nm. The standard deviation of the 10 measurements must be less than or
equal to the limit specified. When the test is performed, if the result is below or equal the
upper limit, or higher than or equal the lower limit, the test is passed.
1. Select Wavelength accuracy solution from the list of tests in the Folder List on the
IPV Setup page:
The Wavelength accuracy with glass filters test page is displayed. The page contains all
the default settings.
2. Select the Reference material from the drop-down list or enter the name of the
reference material.
4. Enter the Calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
5. Enter the Re-calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Re-calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 277
8. Enter the default Wavelength accuracy limit for each of the solutions.
The minimum is 0.00 and the maximum is 10.00 A.
9. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the Sample, Pass and Fail prompts.
12. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
13. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
14. To define the next test, select the test from the list in the Folder List and enter the
information as required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, click Save (if you have previously
named and saved the setup), or Save As if you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
15. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
278 . UV WinLab Software Guide
How do I add Wavelength accuracy with solutions test to the list of tests I
want to perform?
1. Select Instruments from the Folder List, and then click (to select) on the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
4. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If
Wavelength accuracy solution is not currently selected, it will appear in the Available
tests list.
How do I remove Wavelength accuracy with solutions test from the list of
tests I want to perform?
1. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Select Wavelength accuracy solution in the Selected tests list and then click Remove.
Wavelength accuracy solution to the Available tests list. It is also removed from the
Tests folder in the Folder List.
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
Wavelength accuracy limit (nm) +/- This field is left 0.0 10.0
blank in the
software for you to
enter your value.
You must add the
limit of the
instrument (0.25
nm) to the tolerance
of the reference
material (this value
can be found on the
certificate provided
with the reference
material). Enter the
sum of these two
values in this field.
Ordinate Mode A
Number of cycles 1
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
282 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The influence of temperature on the peak positions is negligible in the range 20–30 °C. The
influence of the spectral bandpass (slit) on the peak positions is also negligible in the range
1–2 nm for the peaks selected for calibration.
This test tests the wavelength accuracy using peaks of a selected glass filter (for example,
Holmium Oxide Glass at 287.3, 360.9, 459.0 and 540.1 nm), against the limit specified.
When the test is performed, if the result is below or equal the upper limit, or higher than or
equal the lower limit, the test is passed.
1. Select Wavelength Accuracy Glass from the list of tests in the Folder List on the IPV
Setup page:
The Wavelength accuracy with glass filters test page is displayed. The page contains all
the default settings.
2. Select the Reference material from the drop-down list or enter the name of the
reference material.
4. Enter the Calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
5. Enter the Re-calibration date of the reference material using the calendar displayed by
clicking .
The Re-calibration date can be found on the certificate provided with the reference
material.
Use the left and right arrow buttons on the calendar to navigate through the months
and then click on the correct day. The calendar closes and the Calibration date is
updated.
8. If you wish, alter the default Wavelength accuracy limit for each of the solutions.
The minimum is 0.00 and the maximum is 10.00 A.
9. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the Sample, Pass and Fail prompts.
12. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
13. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
14. To define the next test, select the test from the Folder List and enter the information as
required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, select the IPV setup page from the
Folder List and click Save (if you have previously named and saved the setup), or Save
As if you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
15. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
How do I add Wavelength accuracy with glass filters test to the list of
tests I want to perform?
1. Select Instruments from the Folder List, and then click (to select) on the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
284 . UV WinLab Software Guide
4. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If
Wavelength Accuracy Glass is not currently selected, it will appear in the Available
tests list.
How do I remove Wavelength accuracy with glass filters from the list of
tests I want to perform?
1. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Select Wavelength Accuracy Glass in the Selected tests list and then click Remove.
Wavelength Accuracy Glass moves to the Available tests list. It is also removed
from the Tests folder in the Folder List.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 285
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
Number of wavelengths 4 1 10
Wavelength accuracy limit (nm) +/- This field is left blank 0.0 nm 10.0 nm
in the software for you
to enter your value.
You must add the limit
of the instrument (0.25
nm) to the tolerance of
the reference material
(this value can be
found on the
certificate provided
with the reference
material). Enter the
sum of these two
values in this field.
Ordinate Mode A
Number of cycles 1
286 . UV WinLab Software Guide
UV Lamp On
Visible Lamp On
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
UV WinLab Software Guide . 287
This test tests the wavelength accuracy using specified emission lines of a third party lamp
(for example, a Mercury lamp at 253.70, 302.25, 313.16, 334.15, 365.48, 404.66, 435.83,
546.07, 576.96 and 579.07 nm), against the limit specified. When the test is performed, if
the result is below or equal the upper limit, or higher than or equal the lower limit, the test is
passed.
NOTE: This test is not available if a cell changer is installed. The test must always be run
manually.
1. Select Wavelength Accuracy Third Party Lamp from the list of tests in the Folder List
on the IPV Setup page:
The Wavelength accuracy with third-party lamp test page is displayed. The page
contains all the default settings.
2. Select the Reference lamp from the drop-down list orenter the name of the reference
lamp.
7. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
9. Repeat steps 7 and 8 for the Pass, Fail and Post test prompts.
10. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
11. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
288 . UV WinLab Software Guide
12. To define the next test, select the test from the Folder List and enter the information as
required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, click Save (if you have previously
named and saved the setup), or Save As if you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
13. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
How do I add Wavelength accuracy with third-party lamp test to the list of
tests I want to perform?
1. Select Instruments from the Folder List, and then click (to select) on the instrument
whose performance you wish to verify.
2. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
3. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
4. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If
Wavelength Accuracy Third Party Lamp is not currently selected, it will appear in the
Available tests list.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 289
5. Select Wavelength Accuracy Third Party Lamp and then click Add.
Wavelength Accuracy Third Party Lamp moves from the Available tests list to the
Selected tests list. It is also added to the Tests folder in the Folder List:
1. Select the Tests folder on the Folder List within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Select Wavelength Accuracy Third Party Lamp in the Selected tests list and then click
Remove.
Wavelength Accuracy Third Party Lamp is added to the Available tests list. It is also
removed from the Tests folder in the Folder List.
290 . UV WinLab Software Guide
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
Serial number – – –
Number of wavelengths 10 1 10
Ordinate Mode E2
Number of cycles 1
UV Lamp Off
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
292 . UV WinLab Software Guide
When you wish to make measurements at a given wavelength it is important that each time
the instrument reproduces the same wavelength setting (± a small tolerance). Failure to do
so could decrease the sensitivity of the test and possibly include an error, yielding false
results.
This test tests the wavelength repeatability using the emission line of the deuterium lamp at
656.1 nm. The standard deviation of the 10 measurements must be less than or equal to the
limit specified.
1. Select Wavelength Repeatability D2 from the list of tests in the Folder List on the IPV
Setup page:
The Wavelength Repeatability test page is displayed. The page contains all the default
settings.
NOTE: The calibrated wavelength is displayed for reference only and cannot be edited.
3. If you wish to alter the default message, click in the Prompt field for the Pre-Test
prompt.
6. Select how often you wish the test to be performed. Enter a value (the default is 7), and
then select days, weeks or months from the drop-down list.
7. If you do not want the tests to stop when a test fails, clear Stop tests on failure.
8. To define the next test, select the test from the Folder List and enter the information as
required.
OR
If you have defined all the tests for the IPV setup, select the IPV Setup page from the
Folder List and click Save (if you have previously named and saved the setup), or Save
As if you are saving the setup for the first time.
The Save or Save As dialog is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 293
9. If you selected Save, select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a
Comment.
OR
If you selected Save As, enter a name for the setup and click OK. On the next dialog,
select a Reason from the drop-down list, and if required enter a Comment.
NOTE: If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, clicking Save will save the test
without asking for a reason or comment. Selecting Save As will only display the Save
As dialog. The additional dialog described above is for the Enhanced Security version
only.
NOTE: If you Cancel the Save or Save As dialog, the Setup changes are not saved.
1. Select Instrument Performance Verification from the Tools menu within the Explorer,
and from the submenu select Create IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog shows all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If
Wavelength Repeatability D2 is not currently selected, it will appear in the Available
tests list.
2. Select the Name of a previously saved IPV setup that includes this test or create a new
IPV setup to include this test.
3. Select the Tests folder on the Tree within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup.
The IPV Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests. If
Wavelength Repeatability D2 is not currently selected, it will appear in the Available
tests list.
1. Select the Tests folder on the Tree within the IPV Setup dialog:
The folder expands to show all the tests currently included in the IPV Setup. The IPV
Setup dialog displays the list of Available tests and Selected tests.
2. Select Wavelength Repeatability in the Selected tests list and then click Remove.
Wavelength Repeatability moves from the Selected tests list to the Available tests
list. It is also removed from the Tests folder in the Tree.
What are the variable parameters and the default, minimum and
maximum values?
Parameter Default Min Max
Ordinate Mode E2
Number of cycles 1
UV Lamp On
NOTE: There is no Autozero energy scan. There is no reference material for this test.
Perform every allows you to select how often you want to perform the test.
Select Days, Weeks or Months from the drop down list and then enter the appropriate
value in the field to the left.
This test will then only be performed at the set interval.
It is possible to define different time intervals for each of the tests within an IPV setup. The
software will check when each of the tests are due and will only prompt for the necessary
tests to be run.
If Stop tests on failure is selected, as soon as one of the tests fails the IPV is stopped. The
Event log section of the Audit trail records that the IPV failed. You can run the entire IPV
again.
If Stop tests on failure is not selected, a failure of the test is recorded but the software
proceeds with any remaining tests.
See also
IPV Setup
Running an IPV
296 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Running an IPV
An IPV can be setup to run at a particular time or on demand only. See IPV Setup.
How do I run an IPV that has been setup to run at a particular time?
If the IPV has been setup to run at a particular time, the first time you enter the software
after the selected time, a message will be displayed informing you that the IPV is due if at
least one of the IPV tests in the setup is due to be run.
1. Click Run.
The tests are performed in the order listed.
NOTE: If Stop tests on failure was selected and a test fails, the IPV stops and no further
tests are run. If Stop tests on failure was not selected, all the tests are performed
regardless of whether other tests in the IPV have passed or failed, and the results
were recorded.
If print report at end of tests was selected in the setup, when the tests are complete the
reports are printed/saved as previously defined. If Print hardcopy of report was selected,
the Print/Reprint dialog is displayed.
3. Select a Reason and if required, enter a Comment to confirm printing of the report.
The report is printed using the default IPV report template for the test.
4. Select the test whose report you wish to view and then click Display Report.
The report is displayed in the Communiqué Print Preview window. If Summary was
previously selected in the IPV Setup, only a summary of the report is displayed. For
further information on printing the report from the Communiqué Print Preview window,
see the CommuniquéReport Creator section of this Help .
If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab you do not have to save the results of
the IPV tests. However, if you are using the Enhanced Security version, you must save the
results before exiting.
5. Click Save.
The Save dialog is displayed.
7. Click OK.
The IPV results are saved.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 297
NOTE: If the setup contains a series of tests that need to be run at different time intervals,
the software will determine which of the tests need to be run at the time and only
perform those tests.
The IPV setup will be run on the default instrument. All tests in the setup will be run
regardless of the frequency defined. The IPV setup assigned to the instrument remains
unchanged.
NOTE: If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, you must have
permission to create IPV setups in order to be able to run an IPV on demand.
2. In the Main pane, select the Medium performance instrument whose performance you
want to verify.
3. From the Tools menu select Instrument Performance Verification, and then from the
sub-menu select Perform now.
The Select IPV Setup dialog is displayed.
4. Select the IPV setup that you wish to perform from the drop-down list of available
setups.
5. Click Perform.
The Instrument Performance Verification dialog is displayed with the list of tests to be
performed.
NOTE: If an SOP was defined in the IPV setup, the Display SOP button is available. Click
Display SOP to display the SOP for running the IPV.
6. Click Run.
The tests are performed in the order they are listed.
NOTE: If Stop tests on failure was selected and a test fails, the IPV stops and no further
tests are run. If Stop tests on failure was not selected, all the tests are performed
regardless of whether other tests in the IPV have passed or failed, and the results are
recorded.
If print report at end of tests was selected in the setup, when the tests are complete the
reports are printed/saved as previously defined. If Print hardcopy of report was selected,
the Print/Reprint dialog is displayed.
8. Select a Reason and if required, enter a Comment to confirm printing of the report.
The report is printed using the default IPV report template for the test.
298 . UV WinLab Software Guide
9. Click on the test whose report you wish to view (to select it) and then click Display
Report.
The report is displayed in the Communiqué Print Preview window. If Summary was
previously selected in the IPV Setup, only a summary of the report is displayed. For
further information on printing the report from the Communiqué Print Preview window,
see the Communiqué Report Creator section of this Help .
If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab you do not have to save the results of
the IPV tests. However, if you are using the Enhanced Security version, you must save the
results before exiting.
What will happen if I try to run IPV tests with an accessory fitted?
If any accessory is fitted, a message will be displayed asking you to remove the accessory
before the IPV is run.
If Stop tests on failure was selected, the IPV stops and no further tests are run. If Stop tests
on failure was not selected, all the tests are performed regardless of whether other tests in
the IPV have passed or failed, and the results are recorded.
If an IPV test fails the entire IPV setup is deemed to have failed and the instrument IPV
status is FAILED. The IPV status will remain FAILED until all tests in the IPV Setup
subsequently pass.
To re-run you must exit the IPV and then select to perform the setup again.
Can I stop the tests once they have been started and then rerun them?
Yes.
You must exit the IPV and then select to perform the setup again.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 299
What are the test priorities if all of the tests are selected to run at same
time?
1. Wavelength accuracy D2
2. Wavelength repeatability D2
6. Baseline Stability
7. Noise at wavelength 1
8. Noise at wavelength 2
9. Noise at wavelength 3
19. Stray light with Sodium Nitrite solution at 340 and 370 nm
All IPV results can be accessed using Queries. A search can be performed on all the results in
the database and only the results that match your search criteria are returned. For further
information see Queries.
300 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Queries
Query Setup allows you to select the criteria to be used to search the results database. For
example, you may wish to view only the results obtained using a particular method, or all the
results generated by a particular Analyst over the previous month.
By selecting an option on each of the Sample Query Setup tabs it is possible to generate a
very specific search of the results database.
There are three types of query – sample query , IPV query , and Calibration query
A Sample query is used to view results. Opening a query lists sample results that fit the
criteria specified in the setup. Selecting a result shows the details of that results, such as
method details and instrument settings. You can also view the task that the sample came
from. Multiple samples can be trended.
An IPV query is used to view the results of an instrument performance verification. Opening
a query lists IPVs that fit the criteria specified in the setup. Selecting a verification gives the
details for the individual tests while opening one of those tests displays the task that created
it.
A Calibration query is used to view results of calibrations in Quant type methods. Opening a
query lists calibrations that fit the criteria specified in the setup. Selecting a calibration gives
details of the individual calibration.
When Queries is selected in the Folder List, the Main pane shows the list of queries that have
already been created. Clicking on one of the queries displays information (Name, Description,
Type, Created by, Created on, Modified by, Modified on, and Status) for the selected query in
the Display pane.
2. If folders have been created, select the folder to which the query should be saved.
All queries are saved in the Queries folder within the Explorer.
2. Select the required directory and enter a name for the results.
The file extension must be .csv.
3. Click Save.
The dialog closes and the file is saved.
1. From the list of results, select the sample whose spectrum you wish to export.
4. Enter the name of the spectrum and select the format for the file – either *.asc or *.sp.
5. Click Save.
The spectrum is exported to the selected directory.
To add a folder, select New from the File menu in the Explorer Window and then select
Folder from the submenu.
OR
Right-click within the Query Main pane and from the menu select New and then select
Folder from the submenu.
A new folder is added, and you can name the folder.
For further information about folders, including settings permissions on the folder, see
Folders.
To delete a folder, select the folder in the Explorer Window and then select Delete from
the File menu.
You will be asked to confirm that you wish to delete the folder.
See also
Printing
Approving results
Adding comments
UV WinLab Software Guide . 303
Sample Queries
How do I set up a Samples query?
1. In Explorer, from the File menu select New and then Query, and then from the
submenu select Samples.
The Sample Query Setup dialog is displayed.
NOTE: If you perform a Sample Query you will get the results for samples and IPVs. This is
because a spectrum generated during an IPV test can only be viewed by selecting the
IPV test from the Results Table of a Sample Query. To avoid displaying the IPV
results, specify a Selected Method or Method of type on the Method tab or the
Sample Query Setup.
The Method tab is displayed by default. However, once a query has been performed, the
dialog will then default to the last used tab on the dialog.
Method tab
Selected Select Selected method to search for samples from the selected method
method only. Select the method from the drop-down list of available methods.
Method of type Select Method of type to search for samples from only tasks of the
correct type. Select the type of task from the drop-down list. Choose
from Scan, Wavelength Program, Timedrive and WavelengthQuant, Scan
Quant and Polarization.
Methods Select Methods containing to search for samples in methods with the
containing selected text. Enter the required text to search on.
In the Name Select In the Name to search for the text in the method names. This
option is only available when Methods containing is selected.
In the Select In the Description to search for the text in the method
Description descriptions. This option is only available when Methods containing is
selected.
Sample tab
Samples of Select Samples of type to search for samples of a particular type. Select
type the type from the drop-down list of available sample types: Sample,
Control, Blank, Replicate Mean, Replicate and Measurement.
Samples Select Samples containing to search for samples which contain the
containing selected text. Enter the required text to search on.
In the Name Select In the Name to search for the text in the names of the samples.
This option is only available when Samples containing is selected.
In the Select In the Description to search for the text in the descriptions of the
Description samples. This option is only available when Samples containing is
selected.
In a custom Select In a custom column to search for the text in any custom
column columns. This option is only available when Samples containing is
selected.
Person tab
All Analysts When All Analysts is selected, the query searches all analysts.
Current Login Select Current Login to search for samples based on the name currently
logged in.
Analyst Select Analyst to search for samples run by a selected person. Select the
name from the drop-down list of all users.
Date tab
Select All Dates, Today, Over the past X days, or Over selected period.
All Dates When All Dates is selected, the query searches all dates.
Over the past Select Over the past (days) to search for samples run over the past X
(days) days. Select the number of days from the drop-down list.
Over selected Select Over selected period to search for samples run between (and
period including) selected dates. Select the From (start of search period) and
To (end of search period) dates. Click to display a calendar. Select
the month using the left and right arrow buttons next to the month and
then click on a date to select it.
Result tab
Select All Results, Results with Status, or Results where a custom column reports.
All Results When All Results is selected, the query searches all results.
Results with Select Results with Status to search for samples where the result has the
Status selected status. Select the status -Pending, Complete, Approved,
Reviewed, Imported, Halted, Excluded, from the drop-down list.
Results where Select Results where a custom column reports to search for samples
a custom where the entered text or number exists in a custom column.
column reports
Instrument tab
Instrument type Select Instrument type to search for samples run on a selected
instrument type. Select the instrument type from the drop-down list.
Sorting tab
Sort by Select Sort by to sort the query results by a selected column. Select the
column from the drop-down list.
Then sort Select Then sort by to do a second level sort. Select the column from the
by drop-down list.
1. Click OK.
The database is searched based on the criteria specified and the results are displayed in
a Query window.
306 . UV WinLab Software Guide
IPV Queries
How do I set up an IPV query?
1. From the File menu select New and then Query, and then from the submenu select
Verifications.
The IPV Query Setup dialog is displayed.
The Instrument tab is displayed by default. However, once a query has been performed, the
dialog will then default to the last used tab on the dialog.
Instrument tab
Selected Select Selected Instrument to search for IPV results run on a specific
Instrument instrument. Select the instrument from the drop-down list.
Setup tab
This setup only Select This setup only to search for IPV results from a particular setup.
Select the setup from the drop-down list.
Test tab
IPVs that include this Select IPVs that include this test to search for IPV results from the
test selected test.
Person tab
Current Select Current Login to search forIPV resultsbased on the name currently
Login logged in.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 307
Analyst Select Analyst to search for IPV resultsrun by a selected person.Select the user
from the drop-down list of all users.
Approver Select Approver to search for IPV results approved by a selected person.
Select the name from the drop-down list of Approvers (users with approval
permission).
Date tab
Select All Dates, Today, Over the past X days, Over selected period.
All Dates When All Dates is selected, the query does not search based on dates.
Today Select Today to search only for IPV results run today.
Over the past Select Over the past(days) to search for IPV results run over the past X
(days) days. Select the number of days from the drop-down list.
Over selected Select Over selected period to search for IPV results run between (and
period including) selected dates. Select the From (start of search period) and
To (end of search period) dates from the drop-down lists. Click to
display a calendar. Select the month using the left and right arrow
buttons next to the month name and then click on a date to select it.
Result tab
All Select All failures to search only for IPV tests that failed.
failures
All passes Select All passes to search only for IPV tests that passed.
Sorting tab
Sort by Select Sort by to sort the query results by a selected column. Select the
column from the drop-down list.
Then sort Select Then sort by to do a second level sort. Select the column from the drop-
by down list.
1. Click OK.
The database is searched based on the criteria specified, and the results are displayed
in a UV WinLab Sample Query window.
308 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Calibration Queries
How do I set up a Calibration query?
1. In the Explorer, from the File menu select New and then Query, and then from the
submenu select Calibrations.
The Calibrations Query Setup dialog is displayed.
NOTE: The Method tab is displayed by default. However, once a query has been performed,
the dialog will then default to the last tab used on the dialog.
Method tab
Selected Choose Selected to search for calibrations from the selected quant method
only. Select the method from the drop-down list of available methods.
Methods Select Methods containing to search for calibrations in quant methods with
containing the selected text. Enter the required text to search on.
In the Name Select In the Name to search for the text in the method names. This
option is only available when Methods containing is selected.
In the Select In the Description to search for the text in the method descriptions.
Description This option is only available when Methods containing is selected.
Person tab
Current login Select Current login to search for calibrations based on the name
currently logged in.
Analyst Select Analyst to search for calibrations run by a selected person. Select
the name from the drop-down list of all users.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 309
Date tab
Select All Dates, Today, Over the past X days,or Over selected period.
All Dates When All Dates is selected, the query does not search based on dates.
(All dates are included in the search.)
Over the past Select Over the past (days) to search for calibrations run over the past X
(days) days. Select the number of days from the drop-down list.
Over selected Select Over selected period to search for calibrations run between (and
period including) selected dates. Select the From (start of search period) and
To (end of search period) dates. Click to display a calendar. Select
the month using the left and right arrow buttons next to the month and
then click on a date to select it.
Result tab
All Calibrations Select All Calibrations with to search for calibrations with specific
with parameters. Select Correlation (R-squared Values) and/or Intercept
Between.
Correlation (R- Select Correlation (R-squared) Values to search for calibrations with a
squared) Values correlation value within a specified range. Select Less Than (equal to) or
Greater Than (equal to), and then a value between 0.00001 and
1.00000.
This option is only available when All Calibrations with is selected.
Sorting tab
Sort by Select Sort by to sort the query results by a selected column. Select the
column from the drop-down list.
Then sort Select Then sort by to do a second level sort. Select the column from the drop-
by down list.
Click OK.
The database is searched based on the criteria specified and the results are displayed in
a Query window.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 311
The Menus and Toolbar enable you to interact with the results.
The Results Table displays the results and by selecting a row or rows, it enables you view the
information related to particular results.
The Results Tree enables you to navigate around the results shown in the Results Table.
The Results Display displays the information about the sample or samples selected in the
Results Table, such as sample details, instrument settings, spectra and charts.
NOTE: Raw spectra (not processed spectra) are displayed in the Results Display.
312 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Save As Enables you to edit a previously saved query and then save it with a new
name.
Print Displays a preview of the report in the Communiqué Print Preview window.
Preview
NOTE: This is only possible if a report is associated with the method/task.
Exit Exits the Query window. If it is a new query or an edited query you are asked
if you wish to save the query.
Tree View Toggles the Results Tree View on and off. A check mark is displayed when
the Tree View is switched on.
Display pane Toggles the Display pane on and off. A check mark is displayed when the
Display pane is switched on.
Toolbar Toggles the Toolbar on and off. A check mark is displayed when the Toolbar
is switched on.
Options Displays an options dialog where you can set the number of decimal places
to be used when displaying data, and long or short date format.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 313
NOTE: This is only available for a sample query and only when a single
sample is selected.
Query Setup Displays the relevant Query Setup dialog with details of the currently
loaded query. Also use Query Setup to edit queries.
Select Columns Displays a dialog for selecting the columns displayed on the query table.
Add Spectra Displays a dialog enabling spectra to be added to the spectral graph.
Format chart Opens the Shewhart Chart dialog, Quartile Chart dialog or Histogram
dialog as appropriate, enabling the current chart to be re-formatted. See
Shewhart Chart, Quartile Chart, Histogram.
Return to chart Returns the view to the Quartile or Shewhart chart from the Sample
Results Tree. See Shewart Chart and Quartile Chart for more
information.
Review Displays the Review dialog enabling an authorized user to review a sample.
Save
Save As
Print Preview
View task
Query setup
Format Histogram
Return to chart
Approve Results
Results Table
To view the results associated with a particular sample, IPV or calibration result, click on
the required row of the Results Table.
The Results Tree is displayed. It is the means of navigation around all the data
associated with the results displayed in the Results Table for a query. Information
related to the selected branch of the Results Tree is displayed in the Display Pane.
How do I view the results associated with more than one sample?
To view the results associated with more than one sample in the Results Table,
highlight the required rows using the mouse.
NOTE: When selecting more than one sample it is only possible to select all samples or a
block of samples. It is not possible to select non-contiguous samples from the Results
Table. If the samples you require are not in a block, edit the query using the Sort By
tab to sort your data.
When more than one sample is selected it is possible to display the results using any of the
following plots: Shewhart Chart, Quartile Chart, or Histogram.
NOTE: The Results Tree for multiple samples is not shown until a chart has been generated.
NOTE: Shewhart Charts and Quartile Charts are not available for IPV results.
A query may return standards and baselines as well as samples as they are all treated as
'samples' in a sample query. If you wish to sort these into separate groups, click on the
Sample ID column title. The query results will then sort by Sample ID and you will be able to
easily distinguish samples, standards and baselines.
If you wish to reorganize the results, you can click on a column title. This will then sort the
results according to this column. This is the same as using the Sort By tab when setting up
the query.
316 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Display Pane
The Display Pane is used to display spectra, plots, or information, depending on the Results
Tree item selected.
NOTE: Spectra are only available for Timedrive and Scan samples.
1. Click in the required row of the Results Table to select the sample.
The row is highlighted blue to show that the sample is selected and the Results Tree is
updated.
2. On the Results Tree click Sample Spectrum (for sample queries) or Spectrum (for IPV
queries).
The spectrum of the selected sample/ IPV result is displayed in the Results Display. The
spectrum is the raw spectrum.
It does not show any of the processing that may have been applied as part of the Task
(for sample queries).
NOTE: If another sample is selected from the Results Table the Display Pane is updated
accordingly.
NOTE: Calibration query results display graphs and not individual spectra. See Results Tree
for further information on the available data.
To view the processed spectrum (of a Sample Query Result only), double-click on the
sample row in the Results Table.
The Task opens and the processed spectrum can be viewed.
For information on manipulating the spectrum using the toolbar buttons, see Graphs.
Shewhart Charts, Quartile Charts and Histograms can be displayed within the Results Display
when multiple samples are selected in the Results Table.
NOTE: When selecting more than one sample it is only possible to select all samples or a
block of samples. It is not possible to select non-contiguous samples from the Results
Table. If the samples you require are not in a block, edit the query using the Sort By
tab to sort your data.
1. Select the samples in the Results Table to be used to generate the plot.
2. From the Actions menu select Add Chart and from the submenu select Shewhart
Chart, Quartile Chart or Histogram.
The appropriate dialog is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 317
NOTE: Shewhart Charts and Quartile Charts are not available for IPV Query results.
See also
Adding Comments
You can add your own comment to a sample in the Results Table.
Select the result in the Results Table and then select Signatures and Comments from
the Results Tree.
Any comments added to the sample are listed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 319
Shewhart Chart
A Shewhart chart is a control chart that can be used to determine when variation may no
longer be due to random variation, but to an assignable cause. Shewhart charts involve
plotting the actual observation on a chart with warning and action limits depicted.
NOTE: Shewhart Chart is only available if at least two rows of the Results Table are
selected. It is only possible to select consecutive rows within the Results Table. If the
rows that you require are not consecutive, use the Sorting tab within the Sample
Query Setup dialogto rearrange the order in which the results are displayed.
NOTE: Shewhart Charts are not available for IPV Query results.
1. Select the samples from the Results Table that are to be included in the Shewhart Chart.
2. From the Actions menu select Add Chart, and from the submenu select Shewhart
Chart or click .
The Shewhart Chart dialog is displayed.
4. Click OK.
The Shewhart Chart is displayed in the Results Display.
NOTE: It is the type of chart and the specified parameters that are saved rather than a chart
that relates to currently selected samples in the Results Table. For example, you may
select all the samples in the Results Table and then display a Shewhart Chart. If you
then select a subset of the samples in the Results Table the Shewhart Chart will
update to reflect the samples now selected. The next time you highlight more than
one sample in the Results Table, the Multiple Sample Results Results Tree will be
displayed. The Results Tree will list the branch Shewhart Charts and the Name of
the chart under this branch, and the chart will reflect the currently highlighted
samples in the Results Table.
It is possible to generate more than one plot for each type of chart. Each plot is listed under
the appropriate sub-branch of the Multiple Sample Results Results Tree.
The following parameters are set within the Shewhart Chart dialog:
A default Name is provided for the chart. The default name changes
depending upon the Y-Axis selected. To edit the Name, select the Name
Name
field and enter the required text. The Name of the chart is displayed in the
Results Tree.
A default Y-Axis label is provided. To edit the label, select the field and
enter the required text. The Y-Axis label is displayed on the chart.
Y-Axis label
320 . UV WinLab Software Guide
A default Plot Title is provided. To edit the label, select the field and enter
Title
the required text. The Plot Title is displayed on the chart.
Show
statistical
Select this if you wish to display limit lines at 2 and 3 standard deviations
limits 2 and 3
on the chart.
standard
deviations
NOTE: It is also possible to modify the Shewhart chart via the Results Tree. Right-click on
the selected chart name and from the menu select Format Chart. The Shewhart
Chart dialog is displayed.
NOTE: Changing the Axes changes the default details in the label boxes, so the Axes should
be selected first.
It is possible to delete a Shewhart chart if you do not wish it to be saved as part of the
query.
1. Select the name of the Shewhart chart from the Results Tree.
The name is highlighted blue and the chart is displayed in the Display Pane.
2. Right-click on the name of the Shewhart chart in the Results Tree, and from the menu
select Delete.
The selected chart is deleted.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 321
Each of the points on the Shewhart Chart corresponds to one of the selected samples from
the Results Table.
To view the spectrum associated with a particular point, position the mouse over the
point and then click.
When the mouse is over a point it changes to a cross to show that the point can be
clicked.
When the point is clicked, the Results Tree for that sample is displayed, allowing you to
view the analysis spectrum in the Display pane, and the result to which the spectrum
belongs is highlighted in the Results Table.
To return to the Shewhart Chart after viewing the spectrum, select Return To Chart
from the Actions menu.
The Shewhart Chart is redisplayed.
NOTE:Return to Chart will be grayed out until a point on the chart has been selected and
the individual sample is shown in the Display pane.
322 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Quartile Chart
A quartile chart shows results as a function of time using polar coordinates and therefore
giving a circular plot. The chart can include limits.
NOTE: Quartile Chart is only available if at least two rows of the Results Table are
selected. It is only possible to select consecutive rows within the Results Table. If the
rows that you require are not consecutive, use the Sorting tab within the Sample
Query Setup dialog to rearrange the order in which the results are displayed.
NOTE: Quartile Charts are not available for IPV Query results.
1. Select the results to be displayed in the chart from the Results Table.
2. From the Actions menu select Add Chart, and from the submenu select Quartile Chart
or click .
The Quartile Chart dialog is displayed.
4. Click OK.
The Quartile Chart is displayed in the Results Display.
NOTE: It is the type of chart and the specified parameters that are saved rather than a chart
that relates to currently selected samples in the Results Table. For example, you may
select all the samples in the Results Table and then display a Quartile Chart. If you
then select a subset of the samples in the Results Table the Quartile Chart will update
to reflect the samples now selected. The next time you highlight more than one
sample in the Results Table, the Multiple Sample Results Results Tree will be
displayed. The Results Tree will list the branch Quartile Chart and the Name of the
plot under this branch, and the plot will reflect the currently highlighted samples in
the Results Table.
Is it possible to generate more than one plot for each type of chart?
It is possible to generate more than one plot for each type of chart. Each plot is listed under
the appropriate sub-branch of the Multiple Sample ResultsResults Tree.
For each Chart Name, the Results Display lists the Y Axis, X Axis, and Chart Title.
The following parameters are set within the Quartile Chart dialog:
Enter the required Name of the Quartile Chart. The Name appears in
Name
the Results Tree.
A default Y-Axis label is provided. To edit the label, select the field and
Y-Axis label enter the required text. The Y-Axis label is displayed on the Quartile
Chart
UV WinLab Software Guide . 323
Title Enter the required Title. The Title is displayed on the Quartile Chart.
Show statistical
limits 2 and 3 Select this if you wish to display limit lines at 2 and 3 standard
standard deviations on the chart.
deviations
NOTE: Changing the Axes changes the default details in the label boxes, so the Axes should
be selected first.
NOTE: It is also possible to modify the Quartile chart via the Results Tree. Right-click on the
selected chart name and from the menu select FormatChart. The Quartile dialog is
displayed.
It is possible to delete a Quartile chart if you do not wish it to be saved as part of the query.
1. Select the name of the Quartile chart from the Results Tree.
The name is highlighted blue and the chart is displayed in the Display Pane.
2. Right-click on the name of the Quartile chart in the Results Tree, and from the menu
select Delete.
The selected chart is deleted.
Each of the points on the Quartile Chart corresponds to one of the selected samples from the
Results Table.
To view the spectrum associated with a particular point, position the mouse over the
point and then click.
When the mouse is over a point it changes to a cross to show that the point can be
clicked.
When the point is clicked, the Results Tree for that sample is displayed, allowing you to
view the analysis spectrum in the Display pane, and the result to which the spectrum
belongs is highlighted in the Results Table.
324 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To return to the Quartile Chart after viewing the spectrum, select Return To Chart
from the Actions menu
The Quartile Chart is redisplayed.
NOTE:Return to Chart will be grayed out until a point on the chart has been selected and
the individual sample is shown in the Display pane.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 325
Histogram
A histogram is a graphical representation of class frequencies as rectangles against class
interval, the value of frequency being proportional to the area of the corresponding
rectangle.
NOTE: Histogram is only available if at least two rows of the Results Table are selected. It
is only possible to select consecutive rows within the Results Table. If the rows that
you require are not consecutive, use the Sorting tab within the Sample Query Setup
dialog to rearrange the order in which the results are displayed.
1. Select the results to be displayed in the chart from the Results Table.
2. From the Actions menu select Add Chart, and from the submenu select Histogram or
click .
The Histogram dialog is displayed.
4. Click OK.
The Histogram Chart is displayed in the Results Display.
NOTE: It is the type of chart and the specified parameters that are saved rather than a chart
that relates to currently selected samples in the Results Table. For example, you may
select all the samples in the Results Table and then display a Histogram. If you then
select a subset of the samples in the Results Table the Histogram will update to
reflect the samples now selected. The next time you highlight more than one sample
in the Results Table, the Multiple Sample Results Results Tree will be displayed.
The Results Tree will list the branch Histograms and the Name of the plot under
this branch, and the plot will reflect the currently highlighted samples in the Results
Table.
Is it possible to generate more than one plot for each type of chart?
It is possible to generate more than one plot for each type of chart. Each plot is listed under
the appropriate subbranch of the Multiple Sample ResultsResults Tree.
For each Chart Name, the Results Display lists the Y Axis, X Axis, and Chart Title.
Enter the required Name of the Histogram. The Name appears in the
Name
Results Tree.
Select the required Y-Axis from the drop-down list. The options are
Y-Axis
determined from the columns displayed in the Results Table.
Select the required X-Axis from the drop-down list. The options are
X-Axis
determined from the columns displayed in the Results Table.
A default Y-Axis label is provided. To edit the label, select the field and
Y-Axis label
enter the required text. The Y-Axis label is displayed on the histogram.
326 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Title Enter the required Title. The Title is displayed on the Histogram.
NOTE: Changing the Axes changes the default details in the label boxes, so the Axes should
be selected first.
NOTE: It is also possible to modify the histogram via the Results Tree. Right-click on the
selected chart name and from the menu select Format Chart. The Histogram dialog
is displayed.
It is possible to delete a histogram if you do not wish it to be saved as part of the query.
2. Right-click on the name of the histogram in the Results Tree, and from the menu select
Delete.
The selected histogram is deleted.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 327
The detail of the plot displayed in the Results Display is dependent upon the samples
selected within the Results Table. For example, a different Histogram will be displayed
depending upon whether all or only some of the results are selected. The plot updates to
reflect the currently selected samples. It is therefore important to ensure the required
samples are selected in the Results Table before generating and subsequently copying the
plot to the clipboard.
2. From the Results Tree select the previously saved plot type.
The Display Pane displays the selected plot.
NOTE: Overlay is available only if at least two rows of the Results Table are selected. It is
only possible to select consecutive rows within the Results Table. If the rows that you
require are not consecutive, use the Sorting tab within the Sample Query Setup
dialogto rearrange the order in which the results are displayed.
1. Select the samples from the Results Table whose spectra you want to overlay.
An Overlay branch is added to the Results Tree:
The information displayed in the Results Display depends on the first result that is
highlighted in your selection. For example, if you select some rows that are scan results and
some that are wavelength program results and the first result is from a scan task, then the
spectra are displayed and the wavelength program data not included. If the first result is
from a wavelength program task, all the wavelength program data in the selected results are
displayed but the spectra from the scan tasks are not displayed.
1. Click the right mouse button on the name of the spectrum you wish to remove in the
legend below the graph.
Printing a Query
A variety of reports can be printed from the Query results. These can be for a single result
or for selected multiple results in the Query Table.
NOTE: If a report template has been specified as part of the method it is this template that
is used to display the result. If a template has not been specified, a default template
is used.
The report can also be viewed in the Display Pane by selecting Report from the Results
Tree.
3. Select Single Report using template, Single Report or Multiple reports using template.
If you select Single Report, select to print one or more from Query Summary, Table,
and Chart. Single report prints a single report for the multiple rows if selected. Query
Summary prints a summary of the options selected in the Query Setup window. Table
prints the selected results in the Summary page, and Chart prints the currently
displayed chart. Chart is only available if a chart is currently displayed.
If you select Single Report using template, or Multiple reports using template,
select the template from the appropriate drop-down list of available templates.
The report can also be viewed in the Display Pane by selecting Report from the Results
Tree.
For further information on report templates and printing reports, see the Communiqué
Report Creator section of this Help.
330 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The number of Decimal places to be used when displaying numerical values within the
Results Browser is defined within the Options dialog.
2. Use the up and down arrows (under the decimal places heading) to select the required
number of Decimal places.
Can I change the date format used within the Query window?
The dates displayed within the Results Browser can be displayed in Short Date or Long Date
format. The Short Date is displayed as 05/06/2002, while the Long Date is displayed as 05
June 2002.
Columns
How do I select the columns to appear in the Results Table?
The Columns dialog enables you to select the columns that will appear in the Query Results
Table, and also the order in which these columns will appear. In addition, any custom fields
are also listed in the columns dialog. These are selected (and so appear in the Results Table)
by default.
NOTE: When a Results Table is displayed, the Columns dialog can also be displayed by
clicking the right mouse button on any of the column headings.
2. To select a column to appear in the table, click the mouse in the box next to the
required column name.
A check mark appears in the box to show that the column is selected.
3. To select a column to be removed from the table, click the mouse in the box next to the
required column name.
A check mark is removed from the box to show that the column is no longer selected.
4. To move a column, select the name of the column you wish to move by clicking on the
name and then click Move Up or Move Down to move the column up or down the list
as required.
5. Click OK.
The columns dialog closes and the table is updated.
NOTE: If the content of a column is not applicable to a particular sample, then the field is
left blank. If the first sample in the table does not have an entry for that column, the
column is not displayed.
332 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Results Tree
The Results Tree is the means of navigation around all the data associated with the results
displayed in the Results Table for a query. There are basically four types of Results Tree –
one for Sample Details (when only one row of the Results Table is selected in a Sample
Analysis view), one for IPV (when only one row of the Results Table is selected in an IPV
view), one for calibrations (when only one row of the Results Table is selected in a
Calibration view), and one for Multiple Sample Results (when more than one row of the
Results Table is selected within a Sample Query or Calibration Query).
NOTE: The Results Tree for multiple samples is not shown until a chart has been generated.
To view the results associated with a particular sample, click on the required row of the
Results Table.
The following 'branches' of the Sample Details Results Tree are available when the
sample is from a scan task, a scan Quant task, or a Timedrive task:
Sample Details – lists the Sample ID, Sample Description, Sample Type, Analyst ID, Analyst
Name, Analysis Date, and any custom fields that have been defined.
Task / Method Details – lists the Task Name, Task Description,Method Name, Method
Description, Method Revision, Method Last Modified, and Method Status.
Sample Spectrum has the sub-branches: Instrument Details, Instrument Settings and
History.
Instrument Details – lists details of the instrument such as the model and Serial Number
and any accessories.
Instrument Settings – lists details of the instrument settings such as Resolution and Scan
Number.
History – displays the history of the sample, that is the Analyst who recorded the result, the
date of the analysis and any comments entered.
Signatures and Comments – lists any comments added to the file and shows any reviews
and approvals. Signatures Points must be enabled in the software for Signatures to be
displayed.
For a result from a Wavelength Program task or a Wavelength Quant task, Sample
Spectrum is replaced by Data. Data has the sub-branches Instrument Details, Instrument
Settings, and History.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 333
To view the information associated with a particular validation, click on the required row
of the Results Table.
The following 'branches' of the Verifications (IPV)Results Tree are available:
IPV Setup – lists the Setup Name, Description, Revision and Status.
IPV Results – lists the User Name, User ID, Date, Result.
Spectrum – Displays the spectrum obtained from the selected IPV test. This branch also has
the sub-branches Instrument Details, Instrument Settings and History. These sub-
branches display the instrument information associated with the IPV test.
Signatures and Comments – lists any comments added to the file and shows any reviews
and approvals.
To view the results associated with a particular sample, click on the required row of the
Results Table.
The following 'branches' of the Sample Details Results Tree are available:
Residuals graph:
Standards Table:
Instrument Details – lists details of the instrument such as the type and Serial Number and
any accessories.
Instrument Settings – lists details of the instrument settings such as Slit Width, Lamp and
Lamp change point.
History – displays the history of the sample, that is the Analyst who recorded the result, the
date of the analysis and any comments entered.
Signatures and Comments – lists any comments added to the file and shows any reviews
and approvals. Signatures Points must be enabled in the software for Signatures to be
displayed.
How do I view the results associated with more than one sample?
To view the results associated with more than one sample in the Results Table,
highlight the required rows using the mouse.
NOTE: When selecting more than one sample it is only possible to select all samples or a
block of samples. It is not possible to select non-contiguous samples from the Results
Table. If the samples you require are non-contiguous, edit the query and use the Sort
by tab to filter your data.
When more than one sample is selected it is possible to display the results using any of the
following plots: Shewhart Chart, Quartile Chart, or Histogram.
NOTE: The Results Tree for multiple samples is not shown until a chart has been generated.
NOTE: Shewhart Charts and Quartile Charts are not available for IPV results.
1. From the Actions menu select Add Chart, and then from the submenu select the
required chart.
The dialog for the selected chart is displayed. For example, if you select Shewhart
Chart, the Shewhart Chart dialog is displayed.
3. From the File menu select Save to save the chart as part of the Multiple Sample Results
within the saved view.
NOTE: It is the type of chart and the specified parameters that are saved rather than a chart
that relates to currently selected samples in the Results Table. For example, you may
select all the samples in the Results Table and then display and save a Shewhart
Chart as part of a particular view. If you then select a subset of the samples in the
Results Table the Shewhart Chart will update to reflect the samples now selected.
The next time you select more than one sample in the Results Table, the Multiple
Sample Results Results Tree will be displayed. The Results Tree will list the branch
Shewhart Charts and the Name of the plot under this branch, and the plot will
reflect the currently highlighted samples in the Results Table.
336 . UV WinLab Software Guide
It is possible to generate more than one plot for each type of chart. Each plot is listed under
the appropriate sub-branch of the Multiple Sample ResultsResults Tree.
When you click on the sub-branch name, Shewhart Chart, Quartile Chart, or Histogram,
all the Chart Names saved for the selected type of plot are listed under the selected sub-
branch within the Results Tree. For each Chart Name, the Results Display lists the Y Axis, X
Axis, and Chart Title.
1. To delete a chart from the Multiple Sample ResultsResults Tree, select the name of
the chart and then right-click.
The ability to formally review and approve methods, tasks, IPV setups and sample results is a
function of the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab.
It is up to the UV WinLab Administrator to set the correct privileges to ensure that only the
appropriate people can ‘sign off’ data.
We use the term ‘Review’ to mean that the person has looked at the data and has agreed
that it is correct. This is along the lines of a peer review and any number of people can
review data as determined by your internal procedures.
We use the term ‘Approve’ to mean that a person with the ‘authority’ has signed off the data
as fit-for-purpose and again details of who is allowed to do this should be documented in
your internal procedures.
Reviewing and Approving results is a function of the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab
and can only be performed by someone with the appropriate permission.
Review and Approve Signature Points must be enabled for these actions to be recorded in
the Signatures and Comments dialog.
1. Select one or more result from the Results Table that you wish to review or approve.
6. Click OK.
Review and Approve Signature Points must be enabled for these actions to be recorded in
the Signatures and Comments dialog.
To view the list of reviews/approval, select the required sample and then select
Signatures and Comments from the Results Tree view.
Each Review or Approval is listed.
338 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Adding Comments can be done in the Enhanced Security and Standard versions of UV
WinLab.
Add Spectra
Spectra can be added to the graph in the Results Display. The spectra are for comparison
only and are not saved as part of the task.
3. Click Open.
The spectrum is displayed on the graph.
NOTE: The spectrum is for comparison only and is not saved as part of the task.
340 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Report Templates
A default report template is provided with each example method. Also, when a new method
is created using the New Method Wizard, a report template is automatically attached. These
templates can be edited as required or new templates can be created. For further
information on creating report templates see Communiqué Report Creator section within this
Help.
NOTE: If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, a report template must
be approved before a report can be saved to the database. For further information
see Communiqué Report Creator section within this Help.
All the available report templates are listed under Report Templates within the Explorer.
The Explorer lists the Report Template Name, Type, Created on, Created by, and
Status.
When you highlight a Report Template, the Display Pane lists Name, Description, Type,
Created by, Created on, Revision and Status.
A list of all Report Templates is also available from the Output page within the Workspace, by
selecting the Report Template drop-down list.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 341
OR
Right-click on a report template in Explorer and select Open from the context menu.
OR
In the Explorer, highlight the name of the template and from the File menu select
Delete.
OR
Right-click on the template and select Delete from the context menu.
You are asked to confirm the deletion.
Reviewing and approving can only be performed from the Print Preview dialog within
Communiqué.
3. Click .
The Approve dialog is displayed.
4. Select the type of approval (Approve Template or Review Template) from the drop-
down list and click OK.
The Approve Template or Review Template dialog is displayed.
5. Enter your User name and Password, select a Reason from the drop-down list and
enter a Comment (if required).
The fields displayed on this dialog depend on whether you are using the Standard or
Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab.
6. Click OK.
The dialog closes and the Review or Approval is recorded.
342 . UV WinLab Software Guide
3. Click .
The Approve dialog lists all the reviews and approval of the template. For each, the
following information is recorded – Name, Time Stamp, Type (Review/Approve),
Reason, E-Sig (Yes/No), Comments.
Unapproved is the initial status of a report template, Approve locks it, Hold (reports only)
rejects it.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 343
Reports
Reports lists all the reports that have been saved to the database. The Main pane shows the
reports available, while the Display pane displays a preview of the currently selected report.
NOTE: In the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, reports can only be saved to the
database if they use a report template that has been approved. For further
information on approving report templates see the Communiqué Report Creator
section of the Help.
NOTE: It is not possible to edit a report. For information on printing a saved report see the
Communiqué Report Creator section of this Help.
344 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Recycle Bin
Selecting Recycle Bin on the Folder List displays a list of everything in the Recycle Bin.
OR
NOTE: You must have permission to Manage the database in order to be able to empty the
recycle bin. Emptying the Recycle Bin empties all the contents.
Select the file and then from the File menu select Restore.
OR
Right-click on the item in the Main pane and select Restore from the menu.
The file is restored to its original location.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 345
Database Tools
Database Tools are used by the Database Manager to:
2. Select the required type of database by clicking on the icon in the left-hand panel.
The list of available databases of that type is displayed with a tick in a green circle
showing the current database.
The database tools available depend on the type of database selected.
NOTE: You will need to close down UV WinLab and start it again to activate the database.
Compact Database – Compacts the files to free up disk space.
Create Database – Creates a new database.
Register Database – Enables you to connect the PC to a database already in place on
a network.
Check Database – Performs an integrity check on the database to ensure it has not
been tampered with or corrupted. A log file will be generated.
Partial Archive – Allows you to archive the database but leave the methods available
for future use.
Archive Utilities – Loads the Communiqué archiving utility.
The following table lists the tools that are available for each type of database. X indicates
that the option is available.
UV WinLab X X X X X X
Security X X
Communiqué X X X X X
346 . UV WinLab Software Guide
We recommend that you do not create a new Communiqué database, but instead archive
this database at regular intervals. If you create a new database it will not contain the default
templates. If, for example, you create a new Communiqué database, then perform an IPV
and set reporting to database, you will get a report template error message because the
report templates are not available. If you really do need to create a new Communiqué
database, the required templates can be imported from C:\Program
Files\PerkinElmer\UVWinLab\6.0\Comumnique Templates.
1. From the Database Tools dialog, select the required type of database by clicking on the
icon in the left-hand panel and then click CreateDatabase.
The Create Database dialog is displayed.
NOTE:The database tools available depend on the type of database selected. Certain types
of database may not allow you to create new ones.
3. In Path, enter the full path for the new database including the file name required.
OR
Click Browse, use the file selector displayed to select where the database will be
stored, enter the File name required, and click Save.
4. Click OK.
The new database is created and is added to the list in the Database Tools dialog.
You can now make this the default database by selecting it and then clicking Set Active
Database.
NOTE: You will need to close down UV WinLab and start it again to activate the new
database. You do not need to register the database.
Partial archiving allows you to archive your database but leave your methods for future use.
2. In Path, enter the full path for the archive database, including the file name required.
OR
Click Browse and then select the path and enter a file name.
3. Click OK.
The archive is performed. The archived database appears in the database list.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 347
Databases created using a different copy of UV WinLab software and either copied for your
use or held on a network, must be registered with your copy of UV WinLab:
1. From the Database Tools dialog, select the required type of database by clicking on the
icon in the left-hand panel and then click RegisterDatabase.
The Register Database dialog is displayed.
NOTE: The database tools available depend on the type of database selected. Certain types
of database may not allow you to register new ones.
3. In Path, enter the full path of the database including the file name.
OR
Click Browse, use the file selector displayed to select the required database and click
Open.
4. Click OK.
The database is now registered by the software and is added to the list in the Database
Tools dialog.
You can now make this the default database by selecting it and then clicking Set Active
Database, but you will then need to close down UV WinLab and start it again to
activate the database.
It is essential that backups are made regularly of key files and databases in order to secure
the data in case of computer failure or accidental loss or damage, or even intentional
damage.
...\PerkinElmer\Security System\Users.mdb
This is the database of users.
...\PerkinElmer\Security System\Backup\Users.bak
This is a backup of users.mdb)
...\PerkinElmer\UVWinLab\Communique.mdb
This is the database of reports and report templates.
...\PerkinElmer\UVWinLab\UVWinLab.mdb
This is the database of methods and tasks.
348 . UV WinLab Software Guide
UVWinLab uses a variety of security techniques to ensure that files cannot be tampered with
either accidentally or deliberately – one of these is to use checksums to ensure the data has
not been tampered with. Under normal operation, checksums are used in the application to
validate the data security. However, a checksum failure can occur after a number situations:
• Power failure
The only remedy to an error message stating there is a checksum failure is to restore from a
backup database.
UVWinLab database
If the UVWinLab Local Repository gets a checksum failure, the software will continue
operating but the data in error will not be visible. You will receive an error message if you try
to open an invalid task or method.
It is essential that backups are regularly made of the Repository in order to recover from a
checksum failure. The Windows Administrator can restore from this backup if the Repository
becomes corrupt as follows:
It should then be possible to view all the data again. Some data may be lost if there were
any changes to the database that were not backed up.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 349
Security database
The security system automatically backs up the users.mdb database at the end of a session,
and on exit from the administration dialog, in a subdirectory called \Backup:
...\PerkinElmer\Security System\backup\Users.bak
The Windows Administrator can restore from this database if the active database becomes
corrupt and gives a checksum failure as follows:
It should then be possible to log on again. Some data may be lost if there were any changes
to the database that were not backed up.
NOTE: Backups of Users.mdb and UV WinLab.mdb must be made at the same time to
ensure they are synchronized. If this does not happen, and a problem occurs that
requires an older version of one of the databases to be restored, the methods folder
in the UV WinLab Explorer may not be visible.
350 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Spectra without this 21 CFR Part 11 checksum will not be read into the system and cannot be
processed. This feature stops data from older data systems from being automatically used in
new compliant systems.
To allow users access to their legacy data a Conversion Utility has been included as part of
the Administration tools. The Legacy File Converter allows a person with the Manage the
database permission to add a data security checksum to a legacy spectrum.
NOTE: Use of the utility should be highly controlled and spectra that are processed should
have full supporting GxP provenance as part of their audit trail.
NOTE: You must have permission to Manage the database to be able to access the Legacy
File Converter.
The legacy file converter will convert spectral (.sp) and timedrive (.td) files.
1. Select Legacy File Converter from the Administration menu within the Explorer.
The Legacy File Converter is displayed.
2. For the Source Path, click Browse and on the file selector displayed, select the Source
Path for the directory containing the legacy data.
3. For the Destination Path, click Browse and on the file selector displayed, select the
Destination Path for the directory containing the converted data.
4. Click Next.
The data is copied and a checksum is added to each file, then the new files are written
to the destination directory leaving the original data untouched. The default text _cs is
appended to each filename.
0.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 351
The Workspace
352 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The Workspace
The Workspace is shown below. The Workspace is where the analysis of samples takes place. A
task is triggered from the Explorer – double-clicking on a Method or a Task opens the
Workspace.
NOTE: If you cannot see any of the menu items listed below it is because you do not have the
necessary permission. Permissions are assigned by the UV WinLab Administrator. Please
contact your UV WinLab Administrator for further details about your permissions.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 353
Import Table Enables you to import a sample table. Import Table is only available when
Sample Info is selected in the Folder List.
Save Results Submenu of To Task and As New Task. Saves changes to the existing Task
or to a new Task.
Save Settings Submenu of To Method and As New Method. Saves changes to the existing
Method or to a new Method.
Save Spectra Displays the Save Spectra dialog, which enables you to save selected samples
in *.sp/*.td format.
Export Displays the Export Data dialog. Allows you to export the data from a Task at
any time, rather than at the end of run. For more information on the Export
Data dialog and the file formats available, see Data Export.
Export Table Enables you to export a sample table. Export Table is only available when
Sample Info is selected in the Folder List.
Send To Submenu of UV WinLab DPV. Sends the raw data, processed data and the
results of any equation to UV WinLab Data Processor and Viewer (DPV) and
opens the application.
Report Generates a report with the selected Communiqué template and prints or
saves the report depending on how defined in the setup.
Copy Copies the selected item(s). Only available when one or more items are selected.
Paste Pastes the items from the clipboard. Only available when there is something on the
clipboard.
354 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Folder List Switches the Folder List on and off. A check mark is displayed when the
Folder List is switched on.
Instrument Switches the Instrument Status Bar on and off. A check mark is displayed
Status Bar when the Instrument Status Bar is switched on.
Status Bar Switches the Status Bar on and off. A check mark is displayed when the
Status Bar is switched on.
Overlay Samples Switches the Graph mode from one sample per graph to showing all
samples and vice versa.
Insert Event Inserts an event marker into the scan time to allow you to record an event as
Marker it happens. This is only available when a Timedrive Method is open.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 355
Lock Locks the method. Menu items toggles between Lock and Unlock.
Cut
Copy
Paste
Report
Send to DPV
Start
Stop
Set Wavelength
Autozero
Event Marker
UV WinLab Software Guide . 357
What commands are available when I run a method, edit a method, view a
method, view a task, reprocess a task, or continue a task?
Below is a table summarizing the commands available depending on whether you run a method,
edit a method, view a method, view a task, reprocess a task, or continue a task.
Action Run Edit View View Task Reprocess Continue
Method Method Method a Task a Task
Lock no yes if no no no no
permission
NOTE: It is not possible to reprocess a task if the method used to create the task has been
locked, reviewed or approved.
360 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Method
This is the top level page of the Method in the Workspace when a method is opened in Edit or
View mode. The Name, Description and Details of the Method are displayed, along with details of
any Standard Operating Procedure that may be associated with the method.
No, you cannot rename Methods. To change the name of a Method, you must save the results as
a new Method.
Select Save Settings from the File menu and then As New Method from the submenu.
Enter the required text in the Description field. When the Method is selected in the Explorer, the
Description is displayed (along with other information) in the lower pane.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 361
1. Click Browse.
The Open dialog is displayed.
NOTE: The Attach SOP check box is not available unless the document pah has been specified.
NOTE: The Display SOP button is grayed unless an SOP document has been attached.
362 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Task
This is the top level page of the task when it is opened in the Workspace. The Name, Description
and Details of the task are displayed.
No, you cannot rename Tasks. To change the name of a Task, you must save the results as a
new Task.
Select Save Results from the File menu and then As New Task from the submenu.
Enter the required text in the Description field. When the Task is selected in the Explorer, the
Description is displayed (along with other information) in the lower pane.
NOTE: The Display SOP button is grayed unless a SOP document has been attached.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 363
The Task Workspace has a special status bar that provides the status of the system and the
instrument readings.
Move the mouse over an area of the picture below to find out about each region of the
Instrument Status Bar.
NOTE: If the detector is overloaded during a scan, an exclamation mark appears next to the
ordinate value, together with a 'Invalid data: overflow reference' tooltip.
The following messages may be displayed depending upon the current operation:
When the Universal Reflectance Accessory (URA) is installed, the slit width and angle are
displayed.
During Initializing or Setting Up operations, a bar is displayed that indicates the operation is in
progress:
NOTE: When Lambda 365 is connected for the first time, the software will perform an
instrument self-check. During instrument self-check, the check items (including Main
Board Check, Tungsten Intensity Check, D2 Intensity Check, Slit Calibration, Filter
Calibration, D2 Peaks Check, Dark Intensity Check) are sequentially displayed in Status
bar.
364 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Data Collection
The information on the Data Collection page depends on the type of task you are creating. Basic
method settings such as wavelength, data interval (depending on the method type) can be set
on the Data Collection page as well as more advanced settings.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 365
NOTE: Scanning Quant and Wavelength Quant are derivatives of Scan and Wavelength Program,
respectively, and so are not covered separately here.
See the following for information on the Data Collection page relating to your chosen task:
Ordinate mode Select the Ordinate mode from the drop-down list.
Slit width Select the Slit width from the drop-down list.
Scan speed Enter the Scan speed for the scan (nm/min).
Data interval Enter the Data interval for the scan (nm).
Cycle as fast as possible Enables you to select the fastest cycle time. The time is displayed.
Cycle time Enables you to set your own cycle time. Select Cycle time and
enter a value in the field below. Select the units from the drop-down
list. The time must be longer than the minimum cycle time.
Lamp change at (nm) Enter the wavelength at which the lamps are to be switched.
Enter the values for the Start and End of the range in the Start and End fields respectively.
The Start value must be greater than the End value.
NOTE: The slit width is fixedon a Lambda 20 and Lambda 25. The drop-down list is grayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 367
Set a slit width that is between one-fifth and one-tenth of the bandwidth of the spectral
feature of interest.
Set a wide slit to increase the energy throughput and the signal-to-noise ratio.
This decreases the resolution and the photometric accuracy and can cause band
broadening.
Set a narrower slit to increase the resolution and the photometric accuracy.
This decreases the signal-to-noise ratio.
Select the required Scan speed from the drop-down list of available scan speeds.
Use slow scan speeds for narrow bands and to improve the signal-to-noise ratio. Use faster
scan speeds for broad bands.
It is possible to enter the Number of cycles, and then select either Cycle as fast as possible, or
enter a Cycle Time.
Number of cycles – Enter the number of cycles to be used. As the results are generated,
each result includes .cycleX at the end of the name, where X is the number of the cycle.
Cycle as fast as possible – As soon as a cycle finishes the next one begins.
368 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Cycle Time – Select the time unit, in seconds, minutes or hours, and enter the number
in the field to the left of the unit. The time you enter must be more than the minimum, and
in effect you are introducing a delay before the next cycle begins.
2. If you want to change the lamps at another wavelength edit the default value.
Edit the default value to shift the wavelength if a feature of special spectral interest is
located at the default change wavelength.
NOTE: After switching the UV lamp off, always allow it to cool for at least 5 minutes before
switching it on again. This prolongs the life of the UV lamp. In addition, where possible,
only switch the lamp off at the end of the working day.
NOTE: The default Lamp change for Lambda 365 is 400 nm. For other instruments, the default
value is 326 nm.
Only the UV lamp is used for the scan. Noise will be observed in the region where the Visible
lamp is required.
See also
Graphs
UV WinLab Software Guide . 369
Ordinate mode Select the Ordinate mode from the drop-down list.
Slit width (nm) Select the Slit width from the drop-down list.
Cycle as fast as possible Enables you to select the fastest cycle time. The time is displayed.
Cycle time Enables you to set your own cycle time. Select Cycle time and
enter a value in the field below. Select the units from the drop-down
list. The time must be longer than the minimum cycle time.
Lamp change at (nm) Enter the wavelength at which the lamps are to be switched.
1. Enter the wavelength in the field adjacent to the Add and Remove buttons:
2. Click Add.
The wavelength is added to the bottom of the list.
NOTE: The order in which the wavelengths are listed will be the order in which they are
scanned.
NOTE: The default wavelengths listed in the table when the method is opened are dependent on
the method being used to create the task.
370 . UV WinLab Software Guide
1. From the list of wavelengths, click on the wavelength that you wish to delete.
The wavelength is highlighted to show that it is selected.
2. Click Remove.
The wavelength is removed from the list.
The order of the wavelengths in the table will determine the order in which they are scanned.
To re-order to wavelengths:
1. From the list of wavelengths, click on the wavelength that you wish to move.
The wavelength is highlighted to show that it is selected.
2. Click Move Up to move the selected wavelength up one position in the list of wavelengths.
OR
Click Move Down to move the selected wavelength down one position in the list of
wavelengths.
NOTE: Move Up and Move Down are only available when a wavelength is selected from the
list.
NOTE: The slit width is fixed on a Lambda 20 and Lambda 25. The drop-down list is grayed.
NOTE: For the Lambda 365 the user can select 0.5, 1, 2, 5, and 20 nm slit widths.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 371
Set a slit width that is between one fifth and one tenth of the bandwidth of the spectral
feature of interest.
Set a wide slit to increase the energy throughput and the signal-to -noise ratio.
This decreases the resolution and the photometric accuracy and can cause band
broadening.
Set a narrower slit to increase the resolution and the photometric accuracy.
This decreases the signal-to-noise ratio.
The Response time (in seconds) is the time that is spent scanning at the selected wavelength.
For example, if the Response is set to 10 seconds, the spectrometer will scan for 10 seconds at a
selected wavelength before moving onto the next wavelength.
It is possible to enter the Number of cycles, and then select Cycle as fast as possible, or enter
a Cycle Time.
Number of cycles – Enter the number of cycles to be used. As the results are generated,
each result includes .cycleX at the end of the name, where X is the number of the cycle.
Cycle as fast as possible – as soon as a cycle finishes the next one begins.
Cycle Time – select the time unit in seconds, minutes or hours and enter the number in
the field to the left of the unit. The time you enter must be more than the minimum, and in
effect you are introducing a delay before the next cycle begins.
How do I export the information displayed in the table at the bottom of the
Sample Info page when I am working with a Wavelength Task?
Ordinate mode Select the Ordinate mode from the drop-down list
Slit width (nm) Select the Slit width from the drop-down list
Time interval (s) Enter the Time interval between readings (s).
Total time Enter the duration of the experiment. Choose the units from the
drop-down list – seconds, minutes or hours.
Response (s) Enter the Response time (s), over which data will be collected and
averaged.
Lamp change at (nm) Enter the wavelength at which the lamps are to be switched.
NOTE: The Slit width is fixed for a Lambda 25, Lambda 20, and Lambda 20 Bio.
374 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Set a slit width that is between one fifth and one tenth of the bandwidth of the spectral
feature of interest.
Set a wide slit to increase the energy throughput and the signal-to -noise ratio.
This decreases the resolution and the photometric accuracy and can cause band
broadening.
Set a narrower slit to increase the resolution and the photometric accuracy.
This decreases the signal-to-noise ratio.
The Time interval is the interval (in seconds) between readings (data points) during the data
collection.
The Total time is the duration of the experiment. The Total time must be a multiple of the Time
interval.
Enter a value in the Total time field and select the time units from the drop-down list
(seconds, minutes or hours).
Can I extend the Total time when I am in the middle of collecting data?
Yes, the Total time can be extended while data is still being collected for a particular sample.
This new time will also be applied to samples that have not yet been run.
The Response time in a Timedrive task is the amount of smoothing. (It is the length of time
over which the data is collected and averaged.)
A response time of zero means that there is no smoothing. The data is true raw data. It is
collected as fast as possible.
NOTE: When a Cell Changer is installed, the Response time is the time for which the data is
collected. For example, there are two samples in the Cell Changer; the Time interval is
set to 60 seconds and the Response time is set to 10 seconds. The instrument will take
reading of a cell for 10 seconds. It will then move to the second cell and take the reading
for 10 seconds. It will then wait the remainder of the time specified in the Time interval
(40 of the 60 seconds in this example), before returning to the first cell to begin the
process again.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 375
See also
Graphs
376 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Lamp change at (nm) Enter the wavelength at which the lamps are to be switched.
Ordinate mode Select the Ordinate mode from the drop-down list.
Slit width (nm) Select the Slit width from the drop-down list.
Lamp change at (nm) Enter the wavelength at which the lamps are to be switched.
Ordinate mode Select the Ordinate mode from the drop-down list.
Slit width Select the Slit width from the drop-down list.
Lamp change at (nm) Enter the wavelength at which the lamps are to be switched.
NOTE: The slit width is fixedon a Lambda 20 and Lambda 25. The drop-down list is grayed.
Set a slit width that is between one fifth and one tenth of the bandwidth of the spectral
feature of interest.
Set a wide slit to increase the energy throughput and the signal-to-noise ratio.
This decreases the resolution and the photometric accuracy and can cause band
broadening.
Set a narrower slit to increase the resolution and the photometric accuracy.
This decreases the signal-to-noise ratio.
1. Enter the Wavelength at which you want to perform the Autozero and then click Apply.
The instrument goes to the selected wavelength.
See also
Manual Control
NOTE: Scanning Quant and Wavelength Quant are derivatives of Scan and Wavelength Program,
respectively, and so are not covered separately here.
NOTE: If you enter a value outside the defined limits in a field, the field turns red until an
acceptable value is entered. You are still able to access other nodes of the Folder List
leaving invalid values on this page.
NOTE: The settings on the Data Collection page MUST NOT be altered when the Sample Table is
being run.
D2 Lamp
The D2 Lamp selection is available for all High performance instruments.
The check box allows the lamp to be selected or deselected for methods,
allowing methods to be run without the lamp being switched on.
NOTE: If you wish the lamps to be turned off when the instrument is not in use, this can be set
within Manual Control.
If the D2Lamp is turned off (deselected), the Lamp Change is automatically grayed.
External Lamps
NOTE: If you wish the lamps to be turned off when the instrument is not in use, this can be set
within Manual Control by deselecting the checkbox.
NOTE: The drop-down list is empty unless a lamp has been added in the Instrument properties
dialog.
Tungsten Lamp
The check box allows the lamp to be selected or deselected for methods,
allowing methods to be run without the lamp switched on.
NOTE: If you wish the lamp to be turned off when the instrument is not in use, this can be set
within Manual Control.
If the Tungsten lamp is turned off (deselected), the Lamp Change is automatically grayed.
Filter
This Filter setting only appears if you have Service permission. Selecting
Filter and clicking settings displays the Filter Change Settings dialog.
The Filter Change Settings dialog displays the current filter table settings
that can be modified, and is mainly for use by PerkinElmer Service
Engineers. You should not alter anything unless you fully understand the
implications of doing so.
Filters are held on a disc within the instrument, which moves to the correct position when the
appropriate wavelength is reached. The disc can rotate in one direction only. The table below
shows how the filter is related to the position (defaults). Positions 8, 9, and 10 are NIR filters,
and are only available on the Lambda 750, 900, 950 and 1050 spectrometers.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 381
2 319.2 T=100%
3 379.2 UG11
4 562.4 BG38
5 690.4 OG550
6 810.4 RG665
7 1190.4 RG780
8 1670.4 T-LPG-1.0
9 2620.8 T-LPG-1.5
10 3350 T-LPG-2.5
3. Click in the Position field and select the position from the drop-down list. The Filter Type
is automatically updated.
OR
Click in the Filter Type field and select the filter from the drop-down list. The Position field
is automatically updated.
The same filter position and filter type can be specified in the table more than once.
NOTE: The wavelengths can be added in any order. If you wish to re-order the wavelengths,
you can click on the wavelength column header. When the dialog is closed the software
will automatically re-order the table into wavelength order if they are not already.
Lamp Change
This is used to set the point at which beams are switched
between deuterium and tungsten lamps.
NOTE: We recommend that you do not set the value outside 300–350 nm as this may damage
the instrument.
Monochromator
NOTE: This is only applicable for Lambda 750, 900, 950 and 1050.
NOTE: If you press or the value increases or decreases by 0.1, respectively. If you keep
the button depressed, the value increases or decreases by 10, respectively.
NOTE: When the monochromator change point is modified, the detector change point is updated
to the same value automatically.
Cycles
Cycles are available for Wavelength Program, Polarization
and Scan methods.
Cycles enable you to perform multiple scans per sample. It is
possible to select the Number of cycles, and then select
either As fast as possible, or enter a cycle time.
NOTE: If you press or the number increases or decreases by 1, respectively. If you keep
the button depressed, the number increases or decreases by 10, respectively.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 383
3. If a cycle time is selected, enter the time and select the time units (seconds, minutes or
hours) from the drop-down list. The time you enter must be more than the minimum, and,
in effect, you are introducing a delay before the next cycle begins.
The limits are 1–999 seconds, 0.01–999.00 minutes and hours.
NOTE: If you press or the percentage increases or decreases by 1%, respectively. If you
keep the button depressed, the percentage increases or decreases by 10%, respectively.
Slits
Lambda 650, 800 and 850 Lambda 750, 900 and 950
spectrometers spectrometers
NOTE: The PbS slit is only available for the Lambda 750, 900, 950 and 1050 spectrometers. The
InGaAs slit is only available for the Lambda 1050 or a High performance instrument with
the Three Detector Module installed.
NOTE: Slits are not available on the Data Collection page when a Universal Reflectance
Accessory (URA) is installed as the slit width is defined on the Universal Reflectance
Accessory (URA) page.
If Programmed is selected, the slit width field is grayed, and values must be defined on the
Program page.
If Servo is selected,the slit width field is grayed, and the system will monitor the reference
beam energy and adjust the slits to avoid over saturation of the detectors. Servo is only
available for the PbS and InGaAs slits.
If you select Sample Table, the value will be defined in theSample Table. Selecting Sample
Table means that different NIR nodes and slit widths can be specified for each sample if
required.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 385
Detector Settings
Lambda 650, 650R, 650S, 800 and 850 Lambda 750, 900 and 950 spectrometers
spectrometers
Defines the photomultiplier tube (PMT) gain factor for the UV/Vis range. It is used for energy
measurement in single beam mode. A gain must be set on the PMT to produce a useable
spectrum. If the gain is too low, no spectrum will be observed. If the gain is too high, the
detector will saturate and the spectrum will be truncated. Setting the gain is a matter of 'trial and
error' as the correct gain will depend on other factors such as slit width.
Defines the signal average time. One chopper cycle is 0.04 sec. This is the minimal time for the
measurement of one transmission value.
If Programmed is selected for the slits, the PMT Response Setting is grayed. The value must
instead be entered on the Program page.
Defines the gain factor for the InGaAs detector. It is used for energy measurement in single
beam mode (E1 or E2 Ordinate Mode). A gain must be set on the InGaAs detector to produce a
useable spectrum. If the gain is too low, no spectrum will be observed. If the gain is too high,
the detector will saturate and the spectrum will be truncated. Setting the gain is a matter of 'trial
and error' as the correct gain will depend on other factors such as slit width.
If Programmed is selected for the slits, the InGaAs Gain Setting is grayed. The value must
instead be entered on the Program page.
Defines the InGaAs response. One chopper cycle is 0.04 sec. This is the minimal time for the
measurement of one transmission value.
If Programmed is selected for the slits, the InGaAs Response Setting is grayed. The value must
instead be entered on the Program page.
Defines the gain factor for the lead sulfide detector. It is used for energy measurement in single
beam mode (E1 or E2 Ordinate Mode). A gain must be set on the PbS detector to produce a
useable spectrum. If the gain is too low, no spectrum will be observed. If the gain is too high,
the detector will saturate and the spectrum will be truncated. Setting the gain is a matter of 'trial
and error' as the correct gain will depend on other factors such as slit width.
If Programmed is selected for the slits, the PbS Gain Setting is grayed. The value must instead
be entered on the Program page.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 387
Defines the PbS response. One chopper cycle is 0.04 sec. This is the minimal time for the
measurement of one transmission value.
If Programmed is selected for the slits, the PbS Response Setting is grayed. The value must
instead be entered on the Program page.
Beam Selection
The sample beam is purple. The reference beam is red.
NOTE: When using the Universal Reflectance Accessory (URA), the front beam
must be the sample beam.
If you wish to perform Polarization scans, we recommend that you have the
Common Beam Depolarizer and Depolarizer/Polarizer installed. If using a
Universal Reflectance Accessory, we recommend that you have the Common
Beam Depolarizer installed. If it is not installed, you may observe polarization
effects.
Select 0%, 0.1% (Lambda 1050 only), 1%, 10%, 100%, Automatic or Sample Table from the
drop-down lists for the front and rear beam attenuators.
0%, 0.1% (Lambda 1050 only), 1%, 10%, 100% correspond to the amount of energy passing
through the attenuator. 100% means that the beam is open. 0% means that the beam is closed.
If you select Sample Table, the values (0%, 0.1%, 1%, 10%, 100%, Automatic) can be defined
on a per sample basis in the Sample Table. Also, if Programmed is chosen as the slit mode, the
attenuator drop-down lists will be grayed out and the attenuator can be defined on the Program
page.
For samples that have an absorbance >3 A, you should consider using the attenuators. For
samples that have an absorbance >4 A, we recommend that you use the attenuators.
When the sample beam attenuator is set to automatic and you click , the software will
collect three spectra:
3. Attenuator spectrum – Sample beam set to the value defined for the reference beam
attenuator on the Data Collection page (for example 1% or 10%) and reference beam set
to 100%.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 389
Depolarizer/Polarizer
Along with frequency and amplitude, polarization is a key parameter that is
used to describe the character of radiation. Radiation is said to be polarized
when there is a preference direction of oscillation of the electromagnetic
waves. Natural radiation (for example, the sun) consists of electromagnetic
waves, with the oscillation of the electric and magnetic vectors being
distributed in all planes perpendicular to the direction of propagation. When
natural radiation interacts with optical elements, it becomes polarized to a
certain extent. Therefore, the radiation within a spectrometer will inevitably
be polarized.
The optional depolarizer/polarizer mounts within the sample compartment. It
is used to polarize or depolarize the beam of light entering the sample. A
switch on the accessory sets it to depolarizer or polarizer.
It can be configured with separate depolarizers or polarizers for the sample
and reference beams. The accessory is fully automated and is recognised by
the UV WinLab software.
For certain types of samples, the spectroscopic results are dependent on the orientation of the
sample to the existing plane of polarization of the sample beam. Placing depolarizer optics into
the beam can eliminate this influence. The depolarizer unit comprises two quartz wedges: one of
natural quartz and the other of Suprasil quartz. A depolarizer is recommended for all samples
exhibiting anisotropic behavior of absorbance, and for all types of transmission and reflectance
measurements involving a non near angle of incidence for the sample. The applicable wavelength
range is 190 to 2600 nm. Since the radiation is depolarized directly in front of the sample, the
depolarizing efficiency is better than 98%.
NOTE: The picture above shows the sample beam at the front. The actual position (front or
rear) depends on the beam selection (see beam selection bove). The
Depolarizer/Polarizer is not shown on the Data Collection page if it is not installed in the
instrument.
2. If Fixed is selected, enter the angle in the field below the drop-down list.
The minimum is 0° and the maximum is 340°.
NOTE: The Depolarizer/Polarizer is grayed for a Polarization method. The settings are defined in
the Method Settings area at the top of the Data Collection page.
When a Universal Reflectance Accessory (URA) is installed, an extra drop-down list is available:
390 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The Type drop-down list is used to alter the effective pathlength to allow for the
polarizer/depolarizer installed.
Select the type from the drop-down list – None, 1 mm, 2mm, 5 mm, 10 mm, 15 mm, 20
mm, or 30 mm.
A Polarizer type column is added to the sample table. The value selected on the instrument
page is used in the sample table by default but it can be altered for each sample or
measurement.
Sample Compartment
No settings are required here.
Detector Change
Lambda 650, 650R, 650S, 800 and 850 Lambda 750, 900 and 950 spectrometers
spectrometers
For a Lambda 750, 900, 950 or 1050, enter or select the detector change point(s).
For the PMT/PbS change point the default is 860.80 nm.
For the PMT/InGaAs change point (Lambda 1050 and Three Detector Module only) the
default is 860.80 nm.
For the InGaAs/PbS change point (Lambda 1050 and Three Detector Module only) the
default is 1800.80 nm.
If you press or the value increases or decreases by 0.1 respectively. If you keep the
button depressed, the value increases or decreases by 10 respectively.
NOTE: When the monochromator change point is modified, the detector change point is updated
to the same value automatically. However, the detector change point can then be
modified independently.
What elements of the user interface are available for the different method
types?
Below is a quick look-up table that shows the different parts of the user interface that are
available for the different methods (for example, Start polarization angle is only available for
Polarization methods).
NOTE: Scanning Quant and Wavelength Quant are derivatives of Scan and Wavelength Program
respectively and so are not listed separately in the tables below.
The area number refers to the area as numbered below on a map of the Data Collection page.
392 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Lambda 650/650S/650R
D2 Lamp
Tungsten Lamp
Wavelength
Start
Wavelength
End
Wavelength
Wavelength
Program
Add
Remove
Move Up
Move Down
Data Interval
Total Time
Ordinate Mode
Number of
cycles
As fast as
possible
Defined
interval
Lamp Change
UV WinLab Software Guide . 393
Common Beam
Mask
Monochromator
Photomultiplier
Gain
Photomultiplier
Response
NIR Gain
NIR Response
Front Beam
Rear Beam
Front Beam
Attenuator
Rear Beam
Attenuator
Slit mode
Slit width
Slit mode
Slit width
Ordinate mode
Scan speed
(read only)
394 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Lambda 800/850/850+
D2 Lamp
Tungsten Lamp
Wavelength
Start
Wavelength
End
Wavelength
Wavelength
Program
Add
Remove
Up
Down
Data Interval
Total Time
Ordinate Mode
Number of
cycles
As fast as
possible
Defined
interval
Lamp Change
UV WinLab Software Guide . 395
Common Beam
Mask
Monochromator
Photomultiplier
Gain
Photomultiplier
Response
NIR Gain
NIR Response
Front Beam
Rear Beam
Front Beam
Attenuator
Rear Beam
Attenuator
Slit mode
Slit width
Slit mode
Slit width
Detector
change point
Scan speed
(read only)
396 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Lambda 750/900/950
D2 Lamp
Tungsten Lamp
Wavelength
Start
Wavelength
End
Wavelength
Wavelength
Program
Add
Remove
Up
Down
Data Interval
Total Time
Ordinate Mode
Number of
cycles
As fast as
possible
Defined
interval
Lamp Change
UV WinLab Software Guide . 397
Common Beam
Mask
Monochromator
Photomultiplier
Gain
Photomultiplier
Response
NIR Gain
NIR Response
Front Beam
Rear Beam
Front Beam
Attenuator
Rear Beam
Attenuator
Slit mode
Slit width
Slit mode
Slit width
Detector
change point
Scan speed
(read only)
398 . UV WinLab Software Guide
D2 Lamp
Tungsten Lamp
Wavelength
Start
Wavelength
End Wavelength
Wavelength
Program
Add
Remove
Up
Down
Data Interval
Total Time
Ordinate Mode
Number of
cycles
As fast as
possible
Defined interval
Lamp Change
Common Beam
Mask
UV WinLab Software Guide . 399
Monochromator
Photomultiplier
Gain
Photomultiplier
Response
InGaAs Gain
InGaAs
Response
PbS Gain
PbS Response
Front Beam
Rear Beam
Front Beam
Attenuator
Rear Beam
Attenuator
Slit mode
Slit width
Slit mode
Slit width
Detector change
point(s)
Scan speed
(read only)
400 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Accessories
The detector settings available for the URA depend upon the ordinate mode selected in the
Method Settings Section of the Data Collection page.
Defines the Silicon (Si) detector gain factor for the UV/Vis range. It is used for energy
measurement in single beam mode (E1 or E2 Ordinate Mode). A gain must be set on the Si
detector to produce a useable spectrum. If the gain is too low, no spectrum will be observed. If
the gain is too high, the detector will saturate and the spectrum will be truncated. Setting the
gain is a matter of 'trial and error' as the correct gain will depend on other factors such as slit
width.
Defines the signal average time. One chopper cycle is 0.04 sec. This is the minimal time for the
measurement of one transmission value.
If Programmed is selected for the slits, the Si Response Setting is grayed. The value must
instead be entered on the Program page.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 401
Defines the gain factor for the lead sulfide detector. It is used for energy measurement in single
beam mode (E1 or E2 Ordinate Mode). A gain must be set on the PbS detector to produce a
useable spectrum. If the gain is too low, no spectrum will be observed. If the gain is too high,
the detector will saturate and the spectrum will be truncated. Setting the gain is a matter of 'trial
and error' as the correct gain will depend on other factors such as slit width.
If Programmed is selected for the slits, the PbS Gain Setting is grayed. The value must instead
be entered on the Program page.
Defines the PbS response. One chopper cycle is 0.04 sec. This is the minimal time for the
measurement of one transmission value.
If Programmed is selected for the slits, the PbS Response Setting is grayed. The value must
instead be entered on the Program page.
1. For Lambda 750, 900, 950 or 1050 spectrometers, enter or select the Detector Change
point.
You should only alter this value if you are fully aware of the implications of doing so.
NOTE: If you press or the value increases or decreases by 0.1 respectively. If you keep
the button depressed, the value increases or decreases by 10 respectively.
402 . UV WinLab Software Guide
If a Three Detector Module is installed in the High performance spectrometer and selected on the
Accessory page, the Detector Settings section will look like this:
If a Three Detector Module is installed in the High performance spectrometer and selected on the
accessory page, the Detector Change settings will look like this:
For a Lambda 750, 900, 950 or 1050 spectrometer, enter or select the Detector Change
point(s).
For the PMT/PbS change point the default is 860.8 nm.
For the PMT/InGaAs change point the default is 860.8 nm.
For the InGaAs/PbS change point the default is 1800.8 nm.
NOTE: If you press or the value increases or decreases by 0.1 respectively. If you keep
the button depressed, the value increases or decreases by 10 respectively.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 403
The detector settings displayed will depend on the type of sphere (InGaAs or PbS) installed and
the type of instrument (UV/Vis or UV/Vis/NIR).
The spheres have two detectors. A PMT for the UV/Vis region and, depending on the variant of
sphere accessory, an InGaAs or a PbS detector for the NIR region.
However, if a sphere is installed in a Lambda 650, 800 or 850 spectrometer, only the UV/Vis
(PMT) detector will be available.
See Detector Settings for more information on the settings available for the different types of
detector.
The detector settings displayed will depend on the type of sphere installed (InGaAs or PbS) and
the type of instrument (UV/Vis or UV/Vis/NIR).
The spheres have two detectors. A PMT for the UV/Vis region and, depending on the variant of
sphere accessory, an InGaAs or a PbS detector for the NIR region.
However, if a sphere is installed in a Lambda 650, 800 or 850 spectrometer, only the UV/Vis
(PMT) detector will be available.
404 . UV WinLab Software Guide
See also
NOTE: The scan speed is for reference only and cannot be edited.
NOTE: If a value outside the allowed range is entered, the field turns red until an acceptable
value is entered. The From value must be higher than the To value.
NOTE: It is possible to input a wavelength value down to -20 nm. These are to allow calibration
only, rather than being real, experimental wavelengths.
Lambda 750, 900, 950, 1050, 1050+ 0.01–10 nm (UV/Vis) , 0.04–10 nm (NIR)
NOTE: Selecting E1 or E2 does not automatically set the slits to Fixed. However, the Slit mode
and Ordinate Mode fields will turn red if E1 or E2 is selected with the slits not set to fixed.
See also
Sample Info
UV WinLab Software Guide . 407
NOTE: If a value outside the allowed range is entered, the field turns red until an acceptable
value is entered.
Enter the required time and then select the units from the drop-down list.
The maximum allowed time is 360 000 seconds (equivalent to 6000 minutes, or100 hours).
NOTE: If the timedrive cannot be achieved due to sampling time constraints (such as constraints
due to a cell changer being installed), the software will increase the data interval. The
final data interval will not be reported until the timedrive is complete.
Yes, the Total time can be extended while data is still being collected for a particular sample.
This new time will also be applied to samples that have not yet been run.
NOTE: Selecting E1 or E2 does not automatically set the slits to Fixed. However, the Slit mode
and Ordinate Mode fields will turn red if E1 or E2 is selected with the slits not set to fixed.
See also
Sample Info
UV WinLab Software Guide . 409
2. Click Add.
The wavelength is added to the bottom of the list.
NOTE: The order in which the wavelengths are listed will be the order in which they are
scanned.
3. From the list of wavelengths, click on the wavelength that you wish to delete.
The wavelength is highlighted to show that it is selected.
410 . UV WinLab Software Guide
4. Click Remove.
The wavelength is removed from the list.
The order of the wavelengths in the table will determine the order in which they are scanned.
To re-order to wavelengths:
1. From the list of wavelengths, click on the wavelength that you wish to move.
The wavelength is highlighted to show that it is selected.
2. Click Move Up to move the selected wavelength up one position in the list of wavelengths.
OR
Click Move Down to move the selected wavelength down one position in the list of
wavelengths.
NOTE:Move Up and Move Down are only available when a wavelength is selected from the list.
NOTE: Selecting E1 or E2 does not automatically set the slits to Fixed. However, the Slit mode
and Ordinate Mode fields will turn red if E1 or E2 is selected with the slits not set to fixed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 411
See also
Sample Info
412 . UV WinLab Software Guide
1. If you wish all your samples to be scanned at the same wavelength, select Fixed. If you
wish to scan different samples at different wavelengths, select Sample Table.
OR
If Sample Table is selected, a wavelength columnis added to the Sample Table. The
wavelength specified on the Data Collection page is entered by default, but it can be altered
on a per sample basis.
NOTE: When a Polarization scan is performed, the Instrument Status Bar shows the wavelength
and the angle.
NOTE: Selecting E1 or E2 does not automatically set the slits to Fixed. However, the Slit mode
and Ordinate Mode fields will turn red if E1 or E2 is selected with the slits not set to fixed.
See also
Sample Info
414 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: If any of the settings on the Data Collection page are changed, you must click Apply (in
the top right of the dialog) for them to take effect.
When you select Alignment mode and then click Apply, the instrument will enable the white
light. The Instrument Status Bar will show the status of the Instrument during the this procedure
and will read Idle and 0.0 nm when it is complete.
NOTE: Optimize Gains is only available for the Lambda 900, 950 and 1050.
Optimize gain adjusts settings to avoid any discontinuity at the detector change point caused by
differences in detector linearity. The primary method is to adjust the gain to ensure that the
Servo slit width control will stay within its operating range (0.2–20 nm).
The energy (and thus the slit position) is affected by the accessory fitted. Therefore, balance
should be done with the accessory installed.
3. The Monochromator is set at a point just to the NIR side of the detector change.
5. The UV slit width is set to one-quarter of the size of the NIR slit width, due to differences in
the monochromator grating.
When you select Optimize Gains, the Instrument Status Bar will update with the Instrument
status. When the procedure is complete, a dialog will be displayed showing the result and asking
whether you wish to apply the result to the current method:
416 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Click Apply to method to apply the results to the current method, or click Cancel to reject the
results and keep the current instrument settings.
NOTE: Selecting E1 or E2 does not automatically set the slits to Fixed. However, the Slit mode
and Ordinate Mode fields will turn red if E1 or E2 is selected with the slits not set to fixed.
NOTE: E1 & E2 mode allows you to monitor the energy from the sample and reference beams
simultaneously.
See also
Program
The Program page is an "expert mode" that is only available for the High performance
instruments (Lambda 650, 650R, 650S, 750, 750S, 800, 850, 850+, 900, 950, 1050+, 1050 WB
and 1050 NB). The Program page allows you to create a custom setup of the instrument to
reduce the detector jump on the Lambda 750, 900, 950 and 1050 spectrometers. It also enables
you to create a custom slit-width profile across the scan.
For items defined on the Program page, the respective items must first be set to Programmed
on the Data Collection page.
NOTE: The Program page is not available for Timedrive methods. In addition, the Program page
is not available for E1 and E2 Ordinate Modes in Wavelength Program, Scan and
Polarization methods.
NOTE: The InGaAs detector settings are only available if a Three Detector Module is installed
and selected on the Accessory page.
Lambda 750/750S – UV/Vis Detector Response, UV Slit Width, NIR Detector Response, NIR Slit
Width, NIR Detector Gain.
Lambda 900/950/1050 WB/1050 NB/1050+ – UV/Vis Detector Response, UV Slit Width, NIR
Detector Response, NIR Slit Width, NIR Detector Gain, Sample Beam Attenuator, Reference
Beam Attenuator.
NOTE: The respective items must be set to Programmed on the Data Collection page to define
settings on the Program page.
418 . UV WinLab Software Guide
1. Click Add.
A row is added to the bottom of the table. The first column is the wavelength. The second
column is the type of instrument setting, and the third column is the settings for the
instrument setting.
NOTE: A cross appears in the first column of the table until all the information for the row
has been entered. It is then replaced by a tick .
Click anywhere in the row you wish to remove and then click Remove.
The row is removed from the table.
Click in the Settings field you wish to modify and then click Settings.
The appropriate settings dialog is displayed.
The rows of the programming page are run in wavelength order starting with the lowest
wavelength. This is regardless of the order in which the rows have been added to the table.
Yes, the rows can be sorted by Wavelength or Type. The rows cannot be sorted using the
Settings column.
2. Click again on the column title to order the column in the reverse direction.
NOTE: This will not affect the order in which the program is run. It is just to aid viewing of the
information in the table.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 419
If you are using a Lambda 650, 650R, 650S, 800, 850R, 850+ or 850, a maximum of 40 rows
can be added to the table. If you are using a Lambda 750, 750S, 900, 950, 1050+, 1050 WB or
1050 NB a maximum of 60 rows can be added to the table.
It is only possible to have a maximum of 20 combined response settings (UV/Vis and NIR). For
example, if you have 5 UV/Vis response values, you can only have 15 NIR (PbS, InGaAs, or PbS
and InGaAs) detector response values.
It is only possible to have a maximum of 20 combined slit settings (UV and NIR). For example, if
you have 12 UV slit values, you can only have 8 NIR slit values. If Servo is selected for the NIR
slit, only one row of this type can be added to the table (giving a maximum of 19 UV/Vis rows).
It is possible to have 20 rows of NIR Gain settings. If you have a Three Detector Module
installed, then this means that if you have 15 NIR PbS Gain settings you can only have 5 NIR
InGaAs Gain settings.
A tick indicates the row will be run. A cross indicates that the row will not be run.
Instrument Settings
What settings are available for UV/Vis Slit Width?
NOTE: It is only possible to have a maximum of 20 combined slit settings (UV/Vis and NIR). For
example, if you have 12 UV/Vis slit values, you can only have 8 NIR slit values.
NOTE: If the Detector Change point is altered so that, a wavelength that fell in the NIR detector
range now falls in the UV/Vis detector range, the Type will automatically update.
420 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: It is only possible to have a maximum of 20 combined response settings (UV/Vis and
NIR). For example, if you have 5 UV/Vis response values you can have only 15 NIR PbS
response values.
NOTE: If the Detector Change point is altered so that, a wavelength that fell in the NIR detector
range now falls in the UV detector range, the Type will automatically update.
NOTE: The InGaAs detector settings are only available if a Three Detector Module is installed
and selected on the Accessory page.
The NIR InGaAs Slit will operate in the wavelength range above the PMT to InGaAs detector
change point specified on the Data Collection page and up to the InGaAs to PbS detector change
point specified on the Data Collection page.
If Servo is selected,the slit width field is grayed, and the system will monitor the reference beam
energy and adjust the slits to avoid over saturation of the detectors.
If Servo is selected, only one row of this type can be added to the table.
NOTE: It is only possible to have a maximum of 20 combined slit settings (UV and NIR). For
example, if you have 12 UV slit values, you can have only 8 NIR slit values. If you have 6
UV slit values and 8 NIR PbS slit values, this means that you can have only 6 NIR InGaAs
slit values.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 421
NOTE: If the Detector Change point is altered so that, a wavelength that fell in the NIR detector
range now falls in the UV detector range, the Type will automatically update.
NOTE: The InGaAs detector settings are only available if a Three Detector Module is installed
and selected on the Accessory page.
NOTE: It is only possible to have a maximum of 20 combined response settings (UV/Vis and
NIR). For example, if you have 5 UV/Vis response values and 10 NIR PbS response
values, you can have only 5 NIR InGaAs response values.
NOTE: If the Detector Change point is altered so that, a wavelength that fell in the NIR detector
range now falls in the UV detector range, the Type will automatically update.
NOTE: The InGaAs detector settings are only available if a Three Detector Module is installed
and selected on the Accessory page.
It is possible to have 20 rows of NIR Gain settings. This means that if you have 15 NIR PbS Gain
settings, you can only have 5 NIR InGaAs Gain settings.
It is possible to enter 10 unique values only for the Gain of the InGaAs detector. Once 10 unique
values have been used, the gain factor field becomes a drop-down list. For further gain settings
you can then select a value from the drop-down list.
NOTE: If the Detector Change point is altered so that, a wavelength that fell in the NIR detector
range now falls in the UV detector range, the Type will automatically update.
422 . UV WinLab Software Guide
If you are using a Lambda 750, 900 or 950, the NIR PbS slit will operate in the wavelength range
above the PMT to PbS detector change point specified on the Data Collection page and up to the
maximum wavelength of 3300 nm.
If you have a Three Detector Module installed and selected on the accessory page, the NIR PbS
Slit will operate in the wavelength range above the InGaAs to PbS detector change point
specified on the Data Collection page and up to the maximum wavelength of 3300 nm.
If Servo is selected,the slit width field is grayed, and the system will monitor the reference beam
energy and adjust the slits to avoid over saturation of the detectors.
If Servo is selected, only one row of this type can be added to the table.
NOTE: It is only possible to have a maximum of 20 combined slit settings (UV and NIR). For
example, if you have 12 UV slit values, you can have only 8 NIR slit values in total. If you
have 6 UV slit values and 6 NIR InGaAs slit values, this means that you can have only 8
NIR PbS slit values.
NOTE: If the Detector Change point is altered so that a wavelength that fell in the NIR detector
range now falls in the UV detector range, the Type will automatically update.
NOTE: It is only possible to have a maximum of 20 combined response settings (UV/Vis and
NIR). For example, if you have 5 UV/Vis response values, you can only have 15 NIR
response values. If you have 5 UV/Vis response values and 10 NIR InGaAs response
values, you can have only 5 NIR PbS response values.
NOTE: If the Detector Change point is altered so that a wavelength that fell in the NIR detector
range now falls in the UV detector range, the Type will automatically update.
Defines the gain factor for the lead sulfide (PbS) detector.
It is possible to have 20 rows of NIR Gain settings. This means that if you have 15 NIR InGaAs
Gain settings, you can only have 5 NIR PbS Gain settings.
It is possible to enter 10 unique values only for the Gain of the PbS detector. Once 10 unique
values have been used, the gain factor field becomes a drop-down list. For further gain settings
you can then select a value from the drop-down list.
NOTE: If the Detector Change point is altered so that, a wavelength that fell in the NIR detector
range now falls in the UV detector range, the Type will automatically update.
NOTE: If the Detector Change point is altered so that a wavelength that fell in the NIR detector
range now falls in the UV detector range, the Type will automatically update.
What settings are available for the Sample and Reference Beam Attenuators?
Select 0%, 0.1% (Lambda 1050 only), 1%, 10% or 100% from the drop-down lists for the front
and rear beam attenuators.
The percentage values correspond to the amount of energy passing through the attenuator.
100% means that the beam is open. 0% means that the beam is closed.
For samples that have an absorbance >3 A, you should consider using the attenuators. For
samples that have an absorbance >4 A, we recommend that you use the attenuators.
What happens if I specify wavelengths in the Program page that are outside
the range specified for the method?
Any wavelengths that are outside the specified range for the method will not be run.
424 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The monochromator values specifies where the UV and NIR ranges change over (grating change
point). Changing this value may affect the Type settings in the Program table.
For example, if a wavelength at 900 nm is specified as a UV Slit and then the monochromator
value is changed to 890 nm, the UV Slit is changed automatically to NIR PbS Slit.
If a NIR gain has been specified at a wavelength that falls in the UV range due to the new
monochromator value, the Type field will be updated.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 425
Accessory
This page lists the available accessories that have been detected by the software. If an accessory
is installed, it is detected and automatically selected here. Select the types of accessory that can
be made available with the method. There is also support for Lambda 365 Accessories.
If you wish to only allow the accessories you have selected to be available for the method, select
Only allow selected accessories. This means that if an analyst tries to run the method without
the correct accessory, an error message will be displayed informing them which accessory needs
to be removed and which needs to be installed.
NOTE: Only allow selected accessories is only available when at least one accessory has been
selected.
Sipper
Cell Changer
Peltier
Autosampler
NOTE: When you are within Manual Control, the Accessory page listing the available accessories
is for reference only and cannot be edited.
If a new accessory is installed and it invalidates data in the sample table, these will automatically
be replaced by intelligent defaults.
426 . UV WinLab Software Guide
S10 Autosampler, X65 8+1 Cell Changer , X65 8+1 Water Jacketed Cell Changer, X65 6+1 Cell
Changer with Peltier, X65 Sipper, and X65 50mm Transmission-Reflectance Sphere.
NOTE: The setting of Pump Speed is also available for X65 Sipper. The valid range is from 0.1 to
100 rpm.
1. Select the type of Auto or 6+1 Position Peltier from the drop-down list.
Auto Type allows you to set up a method with a cell changer without knowing the type of
cell changer that will be used when the method is run. Auto is displayed in the Cell and
Carousel columns in the sample table. When the task is run, the type of cell changer is
automatically detected and the Sample Table is updated and the user can then specify cell
position.
4. If Autozero at position is selected, then select the specific position from the drop-down
list.
8. Select the Temperature that will be monitor during a measurement. Options include: Block,
Probe1, and Probe2.
9. Select which Temperature will be displayed on the status bar, Block, Probe1, and
Probe2. The selected temperature can be updated when Peltier is ON.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 427
When you check the Temperature display for Peltier setting, you see three options: Block,
Probe1, Probe2. A user can select all of them at same time.
Select the cell position and click the Goto button, the Cell changer will move the selected cell
into the sample beam.
To warm the cell changer before the start of the method, Click Peltier On.
This will heat the cell changer to the required temperature.
When the Peltier is On, a user can click Peltier Off to turn the Peltier off.
Actual Peltier Temp. °C – displays the Peltier monitor temperature for each measurement.
Example: Set monitor as Probe1, this column will record Probe1 temperature; Set monitor as
Block, this column will record Block temperature.
Average Peltier Cycles Temp. °C – display the average Peltier temperature for the sample
over the sample measurement cycles. This column is present only when using more than one
measurement cycles.
The Manual Controls are the same as normally seen on the Peltier Accessory page, with the only
exception being the absence of the Description field. It also includes additional setting for Offset
(used by manufacturer to adjust temperature, not to modify it by the user).
3. Enter suitable Step Interval (10~100 for X65 cell changer; 1~10 for 6 position cell
changer Peltier).
4. Select MultiCell Calibration button, confirm the warning after removing all samples from
multi-cell holder.
The calibration will be started after you press OK, and the energy curve is updated in graph
view section. Meanwhile the value of current position shown in the dialog should also be
updated.
5. When a peak label is added, the “calibration successful” message will pop up. Additionally,
the multicell position will be updated to show the position after calibration.
NOTE: For ES version, the user will need “Calibrate Multi Cell” permission to perform calibration.
There is a signature point for save results.
428 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Sipper Accessory
Details for the Sipper, when installed, are shown on the Accessory page under Data Collection.
From here you can set the sample and delay times for sipping and the direction of pumping for
the flush.
The Sipper can be started from either the buttons on this page or the controls on the Sipper
itself.
Description Enter a description of the sipper. This will be saved with the method/task.
Sample time Enter the amount of time (0.01–99.99 in seconds) that the pump pulls sample
through for.
Delay time Enter the delay time (0.01–99.99 in seconds) between the end of filling and
the start of data collection. This is to allow for bubbles, turbulence, etc.
Flush Select Flush for a forward flush. Enter the time (0.01–99.99 in seconds). Flush
occurs after data collection.
Sample return Select Sample return for a backwards flush. Enter the time (0.01–99.99 in
seconds). The sample is returned to the original reservoir.
Time (seconds) Allows you to set the time for flushing or returning the sample using the
sipper.
Prompt before flushing Select for a prompt to be called before flushing the sample at the end of data
the sample during data collection.
collection
Fill Allows you to control the sipper directly. Starts to fill the flowcell as set by the
Sample time.
Flush/Return Allows you to control the sipper directly. Starts to flush the flowcell as set by
the selection of Flush or Return and the Time.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 429
What messages are displayed in the Instrument Status Bar when I am using a
Sipper?
When the sipper is in use, the Instrument Status Bar shows the current status of the sipper as
either SIPPING or FLUSHING depending on the button clicked.
What columns are added to the sample table when a sipper is installed?
Three columns are added to the sample table – Fill Time, Flush/Return Time, and Delay Time.
For further information about completing the sample table, see Sample info.
Description The Description field cannot be edited when you are in Manual Control.
Sample time Enter the amount of time (0.01–99.99 in seconds) that the pump pulls
sample through for.
Delay time Enter the delay time (0.01–99.99 in seconds) between the end of sampling
and the start of data collection. This is to allow for bubbles, turbulence, etc.
Flush Select Flush for a forward flush. Enter the time (0.01–99.99 in seconds).
Sample return Select Sample return for a backwards flush. Enter the time (0.01–99.99 in
seconds).
Fill Allows you to control the sipper directly. Starts to fill the flowcell as set by
the Sample time and Delay time.
Flush Allows you to control the sipper directly. Starts to flush the flowcell as set by
the selection of Flush or Return and the Time.
430 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Peltier Accessory
Sampling accessories such as cell changers can be used with temperature control. Peltier control
cell changers heat the blocks on the cell changers to the specified value. An external probe can
also be used to monitor the temperature on an individual cuvette. The temperature probe can be
used on its own or with a Peltier cell changer.
8. Enter a Description.
The description is saved with the Method.
10. If you wish to use the Temperature probe, select Temperature Probe.
12. If you wish to use a temperature probe, click in the Temperature probe check box.
Yes, an external probe can also be used to monitor the temperature on an individual cuvette.
The temperature probe can be used on its own or with a Peltier cell changer.
NOTE: When the temperature probe is used with the Peltier, data collection will not start until
the temperature probe reads the temperature specified for the Peltier. For example, if the
Peltier has been set to 37 °C , data collection will not start until the temperature probe
reads 37 °C.
If you wish to warm the cell changer before you start the method, click Peltier on. This will heat
the cell changer to the required temperature.
When the Peltier is on, the button becomes Peltier Off. Click Peltier Off to turn the Peltier off.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 431
What columns are added to the Sample Table when a Peltier and/or
temperature probe are installed?
A new column – Target Peltier Temp °C is added to the sample table when a Peltier is installed.
The Manual Controls are the same as normally seen on the Peltier Accessory page, except that
the Description field is not available.
Autosampler Accessory
Yes, if you enter text in the Description field, this is saved as part of the Method.
A tray layout is contained in a tray definition file (*.try). The tray definition file provides the
system with information about the sample racks installed on the autosampler. This allows the
sampling probe to be moved to the correct location for each container in the rack.
(200 sample positions Rack B3140621 (rinsing-port rack) with rinsing port
and a rinsing port location (location 0) and 20 locations [30 mm diameter] for
location) 50 ml solution containers (calibration and/or test sample
solutions)
and
(157 sample positions Rack B3001647 (rinsing-port rack) with rinsing port
and a rinsing port location (location 0), 8 locations [30 mm diameter] for 50
location) ml solution containers (calibration and/or test sample
solutions) , and 29 locations [16 mm diameter] for 15 ml
solution containers (test sample solutions)
and
(62 sample positions and Rack B3140621 (3x) with 21 locations [30 mm diameter], each
a rinsing port location) for 50 ml solution containers (calibration and/or test sample
solutions). Location 0 in the first rack is for the rinsing port.
434 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Custom Tray In addition to trays E, F and G, you can also use racks offered
by Gilson. These are 'Custom Trays' within UV WinLab. When
you select Custom Tray, a standard browse dialog appears
allowing you to select the required tray file. Tray files are .csv
files containing the tray layout, and must have the extension
*.try. When the file has been selected, it will then appear in the
drop-down list of tray types.
NOTE: If Enable Autosampler Sipper is de-selected, an external sipper must be installed. This
external sipper is controlled (Fill / Flush) from the Sipper Accessory page which will be
added to the Workspace Folder List when the accessory is installed. The sample time,
delay time, and flush/return settings are all disabled on the Autosampler page.
The Sample time is the time for which a sample is sipped from the sample container.
The Delay time is the time between the end of sampling and the start of measurement. The
Delay time allows the sample to settle before the measurement is taken.
NOTE: Flush and Sample return are only available if Enable Autosampler sipper is selected.
If Enable Autosampler sipper is de-selected, an external Sipper Accessory must be
installed, and the Flush and Sample return times have to be set on the sipper accessory
page.
The Flush and Sample return radio buttons allow you to specify what should happen to the
sample after it has been measured.
Flush – flushes the sample to the waste bottle for the specified period of time.
Sample return – returns the sample to the original sample container for the specified period of
time.
Select the position for the Autozero from the Fill cell from position drop-down list.
This cell position is then not available as a sample position within the Position [Autosampler]
column in the Sample Table (in the drop-down list). The Autozero will be performed before
the samples are analyzed regardless of the position specified.
Fill initiates an immediate fill action. The duration of the Fill is the Sample time.
NOTE: The Fill button is only available if Enable Autosampler Sipper is selected. If it is de-
selected, Fill must be initiated from the Sipper Accessory page.
Initiates an immediate Flush or Return. What happens to the sample after it has been measured
(flushed or returned) depends on the radio button selected above in the dialog. The duration of
the Flush/Return is the value entered in the Time field adjacent to the Flush/Return radio
buttons.
NOTE: The Flush/Return button is only available if Enable Autosampler Sipper is selected. If it is
de-selected, Flush/Return must be initiated from the Sipper Accessory page.
Clicking Goto Position displays the Goto position dialog that allows you to send the Autosampler
probe to a specific cell, XYZ position or have direct control of the Autosampler.
Clicking Reset moves the Autosampler probe to the rinse port position.
Clicking Initialize initializes the Autosampler and moves the probe to the rinse port position.
436 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Clicking Depth displays the Depth dialog allowing you to set the depth of the probe in the
sample tubes.
Scan
Wavelength Program
Timedrive
Scanning Quant
Polarization.
NOTE: The Polarization method is only available for High Performance Instruments (Lambda
650, 650R, 650S, 750, 750S, 800, 850, 850+, 900, 950, 1050+, 1050 WB and 1050 NB).
What columns are added to the Sample Table when the Autosampler is
installed?
Six columns are added to the Sample Table – Position, Probe Depth, Return Cell, Fill Time,
Flush/Return Time and Delay Time. The values in each of these columns are specified on a per
sample basis. This means that you can use different settings for every sample if you require.
If Default is specified in the sample table, the Autosampler Accessory page settings are used.
For further information about completing the Sample Table, see Sample info.
All the settings described above are available. However, a description cannot be entered and
information is not saved. Manual Control allows you to control the Autosampler without
performing a task.
See also
The dialog allows you to move the Autosampler probe to a specified position by either entering a
cell position, XYZ position or using direct control.
3. Click Apply to move the probe to the specified position and keep the dialog open, or click
OK, to move the probe to the specified position and close the dialog.
This allows the user to move the autosampler probe using XYZ coordinates.
It can be used with Trays E, F and G, where slim sample tubes may be being used, and this will
enable the probe to be successfully directed into the tube. It can also be used to determine a
custom tray layout where cell positions are not defined. For example, your sample may contain
solution and sediment and you wish to sample from the solution and prevent the probe entering
the sediment. By using XYZ you can determine the required height of the probe for the
measurement.
438 . UV WinLab Software Guide
2. Enter the required values or use and to scroll to the values in the X, Y and Z fields.
The limits are:
X 0– 310 mm
Y 0–255 mm
Z 0–146 mm
A single click of or increases / decreases the value by 1.0 mm.
3. Click Apply to move the probe to the specified position and keep the dialog open, or click
OK, to move the probe to the specified position and close the dialog.
NOTE: If the probe is in a cell and you click Apply or OK, the probe will move up out of the cell
before moving to the new location.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 439
Click the required arrow to move the probe one unit (1 mm).
The probe moves instantly and the XYZ coordinates are also updated.
NOTE: The longer the button is held down, the faster the probe will move (until the limits are
met or the button is released).
This allows you to fine tune a custom analysis or produce a custom tray layout. You can only
move +/– 10 units past the minimum height values for the cells or centered positions for the
cells.
NOTE: You must ensure that the value on the Goto depth dialog does not exceed the value set
on the Autosampler Depth dialog. No warning message will be displayed.
440 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The depth dialog allows you to specify the depth of the probe in the solution containers. This can
be used to prevent the probe from stirring up sediment that may be in the samples.
Drag the slider control to the required position between the maximum and minimum
heights.
The maximum height (0 mm) is the fully withdrawn probe. 146 mm is the maximum
distance that the probe can descend into the tube.
The value in the field below the slider control automatically updates.
OR
Enter the required value, or use and to update the value in the field.
The slider control updates automatically to reflect the new value.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 441
The Accessory page for the Cell Changer allows you to select the cell positions for the samples
and to define when an auto zero will be performed.
The selections on this page will determine what cell positions are available in the Sample Table.
By default the table will be populated in order, but this can be changed unless the method is
locked.
NOTE: When installing a cell changer, first switch off the Lambda spectrometer. Install the
accessory and then reboot the spectrometer so that the Cell Changer is initialized.
5+1
6+1
8+1
9+1
13 + 1.
X + 1 is the number of positions in the cellchanger. There is 1 reference position and X sample
positions.
Autozero every sample – Select this option to perform an autozero before every sample.
Autozero at position – Select this option to perform an autozero before specified sample
positions.
4. If Autozero at position is selected, select the position from the drop-down list.
If you wish to perform an auto zero at every selected position, select Autozero every
sample.
Before the samples are run, an autozero will be run at each selected position.
How do I perform one autozero per task with a cell changer installed?
When you are using a cell changer, a column called Cell is added to the Sample Table.
3. Select a sample in the Sample Table and click in the Cell field.
An drop-down arrow appears.
4. Click on the arrow and select the cell position for the sample from the drop-down list.
The list of available cell positions is dependent on the check boxes selected on the
Accessory page.
NOTE: If you have more samples than available positions in the cellchanger, you can select a
position more than once. The software will prompt you to insert the correct sample.
In the Enabled Positions section of the dialog, click in the check box.
indicates that the position is selected and it will appear in the Sample Table.
8+8
5+5
6+6
9+9.
3. Select Single reference in position, Single reference in front beam And single reference in
rear beam, or Matched pairing of samples to reference.
Select this option to specify a single reference cell position. This can be in the front or rear
carousel.
4. Select the front beam reference position from the drop-down list.
5. Select the rear beam reference position from the drop-down list.
444 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Select this option to use matched pair sample and references. This means that the reference for
sample 1 will be at position 1, the reference for sample 2 will be at position 2 and so on.
Select this option to perform an autozero before every sample in the selected (enabled) cell
positions.
Autozero at position –
The software will prompt you to remove all samples before the autozero(s) are performed.
Sample positions
NOTE: Autozero options are ignored if baseline Corrections are turned off
Enable front positions and Enable rear positions are available for Single reference in front beam
and single reference in rear beam.
Either Enable front positions or Enable rear positions will be available for Single reference in
position depending on the position of the reference beam. For example, if the reference beam is
specified as the rear beam, the Single reference in position option will be for the rear beam, and
Enabled front positions will be available.
By definition, only Enable front positions is available for Matched pairing of samples to reference.
How do I define the positions in the Cell Changer that will contain samples?
The number of available cells (represented by check boxes) depend on the type of cell changer
installed and the type of reference specified.
If Single reference in position is selected, and the reference beam is the rear beam, there will
be 5 cell positions in the front carousel available for samples. The Cell Changer is acting as a X +
1 cell changer (X samples and 1 reference). The reference in the back carousel is used for all
samples.
If Single reference in front beam and single reference in rear beam is selected, all positions
except those specified as reference positions will be available. Therefore, there will be 4 sample
positions in the front carousel and 4 sample positions in the rear carousel. The Cell Changer is
acting as a (2X–2)+2 Cell Changer [(2X–2) sample positions and 2 reference positions]. The
reference in the back carousel is used for all the samples in the front carousel, and then the
reference in the front carousel is used for all the samples in the back carousel.
If Matched pairing of samples to reference is selected, and the reference beam is the rear
beam, all 5 samples positions will be available in the front carousel. The Cell Changer is acting as
a 5 + 5 Cell Changer (5 samples and 5 references). Each sample in the front carousel uses the
reference in the corresponding position in the rear carousel cell. For example, the sample in cell
1 will used the reference in cell 1 in the rear carousel.
446 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To select the cells that will contain samples, select the check box adjacent to the cell
number.
A tick mark indicates that the cell will contain a sample.
On the Sample Table, only these positions will be available from the drop down list in the
Cell column.
If you wish to perform an autozero at every selected position, select Autozero every
sample.
Before the samples are run, an autozero will be run at each selected position. The software
will prompt you to remove the samples before the autozeros are performed.
In the Enabled Positions section of the dialog, click in the check box.
indicates that the position is selected and it will appear in the Sample Table. Only the
positions selected appear in the sample table. If there are more samples specified than the
number of available cell positions, the cell changer will re-index (back to the first specified
sample position) and the software will prompt you for the new samples.
NOTE: This is not available when Auto Type is selected. The sample table is populated with the
number of samples specified on the sample info page and the table is completed at run
time.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 447
What columns are added to the Sample Table when the Cell Changer is
installed?
When you are using a cell changer, columns called Cell and Carousel are added to the Sample
Table.
Two columns are added to the table – Cell and Carousel. Both are populated as Auto for every
sample and this cannot be edited. At run time, the software will detect the type of cell changer
and populate the sample table after data collection.
The Cell Changer Manual Control allows direct control of the Cell Changer. It enables you to go
to a specific position on the Cell Changer.
When you are within Manual Control select the Cell Changer node of the Folder List.
NOTE: The Type of Cell Changer installed is automatically detected by the software and cannot
be changed within Manual Control.
3. Click Goto.
The Cell Changer moves the selected cell into the beam.
448 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The Universal Reflectance Accessory (URA) is a variable angle reflectance accessory that loads
directly into the detector compartment of the Lambda 650/850/750/950/1050 spectrometers. It
can also be used with the Lambda 800 and 900.
The URA can be used to collect absolute or relative reflectance measurements of samples
measuring from 5 mm to greater than 150 mm. Samples less than 5 mm in size can be used with
a sample holder.
Data Collection
What types of data collection are available?
There are three types of data collection – Absolute Reflectance Mode, Relative Reflectance Mode,
and Transmission (Sample Compartment) Mode.
Absolute Reflectance Mode – The baseline is collected from the baseline position. The sample
spectra are collected from the sample position.
NOTE: When Absolute Reflectance Mode is selected, you are not prompted for the baseline
correction as it will be collected automatically by the software.
Relative Reflectance Mode – The baseline and the sample spectra are collected from the
sample position. In Relative Reflectance Mode, you are prompted to place a reference material at
the sample position when the baseline (autozero) is collected.
Transmission (Sample Compartment) Mode – This allows you to use the spectrometer sample
compartment with the URA still installed. The cover must be placed over the URA sample position
to prevent stray light, although it is not used for data collection.
Angle
What range of incident angles can be used?
The URA can be used to collect absolute or relative reflective measurements with an angle of
incidence in the range 8°–65°in 0.5° increments.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 449
It is possible to measure many angles of the same sample without user intervention using
Measurements within the Sample Table.
See Sample Info for further information on how to set up the Sample Table.
The Angle setting on the URA is the default value that will appear in the sample table for all
samples. This value can be altered for each sample from within the sample table.
You can set the angle on this page and select Sample or Baseline. If you then click Apply the
URA will move to the selected angle in the Sample or Baseline position (depending on the radio
button selected) and set the spot size.
Enter values for the Angle or click / to increase / decrease the value by 0.5 degrees.
Spot size
How do I specify the spot size?
Physical setting – Enter values for the Width and Length or click / to increase /
decrease the value by 0.1 mm.
The width does not have to be the same value as the length.
If the width and/or length value is altered on the Sample Info page, this supercedes the value
set on the Accessory page.
Altering the Physical setting (Width and Length) automatically alters the Instrument settings (Slit
width and CBM).
Instrument setting – Enter values for the Slit width and CBM (common beam mask) or click /
to increase / decrease the values (by 0.1 for the Slit width, and 1 for the CBM(%)).
Altering the Instrument setting (Slit width and CBM) automatically alters the Physical setting
(Width and Length).
Reducing the spot size increases noise in the data collected. Reducing the spot width (slit width)
increases spectral resolution.
How does the spot size remain constant as the angle is increased?
To maintain a constant spot size as the angle is increased, the Common Beam Mask (CBM) is
reduced.
450 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Actions
What does the Transit button do?
This button is only for use when you wish to ship the URA. Clicking Transit moves the internal
hardware into a safe position to avoid damage during shipment.
NOTE: Clicking Transit is not necessary if you are only removing the URA and placing it on the
bench.
This button is only available if you have Service permission. Clicking Alignment displays the
Alignment dialog. DO NOT ALTER ANY OF THE SETTINGS ON THIS DIALOG AS THIS WILL
RESULT IN YOUR URA BECOMING MISALIGNED. THIS DIALOG IS FOR USE BY
PERKINELMER SERVICE ENGINEERS ONLY.
Clicking Apply applies the current settings on the URA page to the URA. For example, if the
angle is set to 50° and Sample selected, the URA will move to an angle of 50° in the sample
position, and set the spot size.
If you are using a URA, it is likely that you will be making many measurements – for example,
measuring many angles of one sample. Correction spectra ( 100 %T / 0A Baseline (Autozero)
and/or 0 %T / Blocked Beam Baseline) will be measured for each angle and this could take
some time depending on the number of samples/measurements specified in the sample table.
We therefore recommend that you do not select Always at task start,as all correction spectra
will be recorded before any sample spectra are recorded. If you select Always before next
measurement, the same number of correction spectra will be recorded but the correction
spectra will be recorded for a particular sample (or measurement) and then the sample run. This
means that you will not have to wait as long before seeing your results.
You can save correction spectra as part of a method so that they do not have to be run each
time you run the method.
2. Click .
Clicking Autozero will perform the selected corrections.
NOTE: You should not save corrections with the method if you select Always at task start or
Always before next measurement, as by definition, previous corrections are discarded.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 451
If As required at task start is selected, the corrections that were saved with the method are
used and only any additional corrections that are required are collected at the start of the task
provided the expiry time has not elapsed.
If As required before next measurement is selected, the corrections that were saved with the
method are used and only any additional corrections that are required are collected before each
measurement.
NOTE: If you press when you are in a task that contains corrections that were saved as
part of the method, these previously saved corrections are discarded.
We recommend that you do not perform this action unless you fully understand how the URA
operates.
Clicking in Manual Control with a URA installed will collect a baseline using the URA in its
current position.
If the URA is currently in the sample position the baseline will be collected in the sample position.
You must place a reference mirror at the sample position to collect the baseline with the URA in
the sample position. Unlike when you are running a method, you will not be prompted to do this.
If you wish to autozero in the baseline position you must first drive the URA to the baseline
position by selecting Baseline and then clicking Apply. After performing the autozero you must
then drive the URA to the sample position (by selecting Sample and then clicking Apply) before
scanning a sample within Manual Control. If you fail to do this the data will be meaningless.
Small Samples
How do I align a small sample?
1. Click
URA Optics
What are the positions of the optics when an angle of incidence of 8° is
specified?
The schematic diagram below shows the optics in the URA positioned to collect a baseline
measurement when the angle of incidence is 8°. The available movements of the pathlength
compensator, input mirror and detector arc assembly are displayed using dashed arrows.
452 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To collect the sample measurement, the Input mirror rotates to direct the beam onto the sample.
The detector is raised up to the correct position to capture the light.
What are the positions of the optics when an angle of incidence of 65° is
specified?
The schematic diagram below shows the optics in the URA positioned to collect a baseline
measurement when the angle of incidence is 65°. The available movements of the pathlength
compensator, input mirror and detector arc assembly are displayed using dashed arrows.
To collect the sample measurement, the Input mirror rotates to direct the beam onto the sample.
The detector is raised up to the correct position to capture the light.
454 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Corrections
Corrections is used to specify how often a baseline must be collected, the type of baseline,
reflections settings and absorptance.
NOTE: Reflection Corrections is only available when the Ordinate mode is %R.
Baseline Corrections
What types of baseline can be collected?
2. If 0 %T / Blocked Beam Baseline is selected, select whether to use the internal attenuator.
Attenuators are used to improve noise levels at high absorbance / low transmittance. The
internal attenuator option will only be available if it is installed. If you use the internal
attenuator, the sample beam will automatically be blocked for the correction. If not
selected, you will be prompted to block the beam.
NOTE: Do not invalidate baselines with respect to instrument settings and Do not invalidate
attenuator corrections are not available when Always before next measurement is
selected as they are not applicable.
If Always at task start or As required at task start is selected, when a change is made
to the instrument settings, the corrections are collected for all pending samples before the
sample measurements and you must define when the corrections will expire.
456 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Select the number (1–999) and time period (hours, days, weeks) from the drop-down
lists.
NOTE: For Always at task start the expiry time only applies while the task remains open.
Always at task start –When data collection is first started for the task, corrections will
always be collected for all samples before the sample measurements are made. If the
task remains open and more samples are added, the task will re-use the corrections it
had collected previously. If any new corrections are required, these will be collected
before the sample measurements are made. However, if a task is closed and then re-
opened and continued at a later date, new corrections will be collected before the new
sample measurements.
As required at task start – When data collection is first started for the task, corrections
will be collected for all samples only where there are no existing, valid corrections. Any
existing, suitable corrections will be re-used. Corrections need to be saved with the
method for them to be available to tasks that are run from the method. Corrections can
be collected for a method using the Autozero command and then saved by selecting
Save Corrections on the Save Method or Save As Method dialog.
If As required before next measurement is selected, the necessary corrections will be
collected before each sample measurement only if there are no existing, suitable
corrections.
If Always before next measurement is selected, corrections for the sample will always be
collected before each sample measurement. Even if previously collected corrections are still
valid, these are discarded and new corrections collected.
If Import is selected a Browse dialog is displayed. Select the task or method you would like
to import the baseline(s) from and click Open. Corrections can be imported for use with all
samples. Select Import from the drop-down list. A Browse dialog is displayed enabling you
to explore and select a spectrum (or spectra). Each spectrum must cover the spectral range
of the spectrum to be corrected.
The pathname of the chosen task is displayed on the corrections page.
NOTE: You can view imported corrections that have been saved to your task or method using
Show Corrections. The Description will state Imported Correction.
NOTE: This option is only available for Scan or Scan Quant mode method.
IWR: White standard intensity of Reference port (IWR (Measured) is not the same with IWR (Baseline))
IDS: Dark intensity of Sample port
For more information, please refer to the Lambda 365 50mm Transmission-Reflectance
Sphere Installation Instructions.pdf (P/N 09931255) located in the Lambda 365 Document
Pack.
How do I save baselines with a method, and how does this affect the
corrections collected when I run a task?
2. Click .
Clicking Autozero will perform the selected corrections.
3. From the File menu select Save Settings, and then from the submenu select To Method.
NOTE: You should not save corrections with the method if you select Always at task start or
Always before next measurement, as by definition, previous corrections are discarded.
If As required at task start is selected, the corrections that were saved with the method are
used and only any additional corrections that are required are collected at the start of the task
provided the expiry time has not elapsed.
If As required before next measurement is selected, the corrections that were saved with the
method are used and only any additional corrections that are required are collected before each
measurement.
NOTE: If you press when you are in a task that contains corrections that were saved as
part of the method, these previously saved corrections are discarded.
2. Click .
458 . UV WinLab Software Guide
3. From the File menu select Save Settings, and then from the submenu select As New
Method.
5. Select the location for the new method from the list of folders.
NOTE: The folders available in the Folder List will depend on the permissions you have.
7. If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, enter your User name,
Password, Reason, and Comment.
The fields that appear on this dialog depend on the settings previously defined by your UV
WinLab Administrator.
8. Click OK.
The dialog closes and the settings and corrections are saved as a new method. The status
of the method in the Explorer is draft.
If Do not invalidate baselines with respect to instrument settings is selected and you change
any instrument settings after collecting corrections, the corrections will not be invalidated. The
only exception to this is if you increase the data range or reduce the data interval. In these
cases, there is insufficient data within the corrections and so they must be recollected. If this
occurs, the software will automatically collect the corrections required.
If Do not invalidate baselines with respect to instrument settings is not selected, and you
change any of the instrument settings, new baselines will be collected. If Always at task start or
As required at task start is selected, when a change is made to the instrument settings, the
corrections are collected for all future samples before the sample measurements. If As required
before next measurement is selected, the necessary corrections will be collected before each
sample measurement.
For Medium performance instruments you will be prompted to remove any samples prior to the
scan. The instrument will scan at 100%T.
For High performance instruments, if attenuators have been defined on the Data Collection page
the sample beam attenuator is set to the value of the reference beam attenuator and then the
instrument will scan at 100%T.
100%T – The sample beam attenuator is set to the value of the reference beam defined on the
Data Collection page and the 100% correction is collected.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 459
0% T – The sample beam attenuator is then set to 0% and the 0%T correction spectrum
collected.
0% T – You will then be prompted to block the sample beam. The 0%T spectrum is then
collected.
where
100%T – The sample beam attenuator is set to the value of the reference beam defined on the
Data Collection page and the 100% correction is collected.
0% T – The sample beam attenuator is then set to 0% and the 0%T correction spectrum
collected.
Reflection Corrections
When are the Reflection Corrections settings available?
The Reflection settings are only available when %R is specified as the Ordinate mode in the
Method settings section of the Data Collection page. You must specify one of the three Reflection
settings options – Reflectance corrected for reference (%RC), Reflectance corrected for IV
and VW accessories (%RA), or None.
Reflectance corrected for IV and VW accessories (%RA) allows you to collect absolute
reflectance data. This is the square root of reflectance data. %RA should be used for internally
reflective samples.
IV- and VW-type absolute specular reflectance accessories work by measuring two reflections
from the sample, and so the detector measures the square of the true reflectance. This mode
uses the square root of the measured spectrum so that the user collects the true reflectivity of
the sample.
NOTE: This option should not be selected for the URA, PELA 1030, or VN-type reflectance
accessories.
Reflectance corrected for reference (%RC) corrects a reflectance spectrum for dark and white
values.
2. If you select Select - Import, a Browse dialog is displayed and you can select the spectrum
to import.
The spectrum must cover the spectral range of the spectrum to be corrected.
NOTE: When a spectrum is imported, the file name and path is displayed in the Spectral
Reference drop-down list.
5. If you select Select-Import, a Browse dialog is displayed and you can select the spectrum
to import.
The spectrum must cover the spectral range of the spectrum to be corrected.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 461
NOTE: When a spectrum is imported, the file name and path is displayed in the spectral
Reference drop-down list.
Reflectance corrected for IV and VW accessories (%RA) allows you to collect absolute
reflectance data. This is the square root of reflectance data. %RA should be used for internally
reflective samples.
IV- and VW-type absolute specular reflectance accessories work by measuring two reflections
from the sample, and so the detector measures the square of the true reflectance. This mode
uses the square root of the measured spectrum so that the user collects the true reflectivity of
the sample.
NOTE: This option should not be selected for the URA, PELA 1030, or VN-type reflectance
accessories.
where R100 is the Light Spectral Reference, and R0 is the Dark Spectral Reference.
Attenuator Corrections
What do attenuators do?
The Front and Rear beam attenuators are used to select the attenuation in the sample and
reference beam. Reference beam attenuation is used to improve noise levels at high
absorbance/low transmittance. The instrument uses a single detector (photomultiplier for UV/Vis,
and InGaAs or PbS for NIR). A ratio is measured between the sample and reference beam. With
highly absorbing samples this means there is a ratio between a very small signal (highly
absorbing sample) and a big signal (the unblocked reference beam). The instrument cycles
between the two readings every 40 milliseconds and the rapidly changing light levels can cause
the detector to become noisy. In addition, there is the mathematical problem of performing a
ratio with a large difference between the numerator and the denominator.
Attenuator corrections are only collected if the Sample Beam attenuator is set to Automatic. The
option always remains visible if attenuators are installed, but is only activated in the software
when the Sample Beam attenuator is set to Automatic.
If Do not invalidate attenuator corrections is selected and you change any instrument settings
after collecting corrections, the corrections will not be invalidated. The only exception to this is if
you increase the data range or reduce the data interval. In these cases, there is insufficient data
within the corrections and so they must be recollected. If this occurs, the software will
automatically collect the corrections required.
If Do not invalidate attenuator corrections is not selected, and you change any of the
instrument settings, new baselines will be collected. If Always at task start or As required at
task start is selected, when a change is made to the instrument settings, the corrections are
collected for all future samples before the sample measurements. If As required before next
measurement is selected, the necessary corrections will be collected before each sample
measurement.
Expire Corrections
Can I set when a correction will expire?
Enter the time period after which you would like the corrections to expire in Hours, Weeks
or Days.
If you do not wish the corrections to expire, select Never.
Viewing Corrections
How do I view the correction spectrum/spectra/data for a sample/standard?
The correction spectra can be viewed within the Sample Table, Standards Table or Results Table.
Using the right mouse button, click on the sample/standard whose correction spectrum you
wish to view, and select Show Corrections.
A second window is displayed showing the sample and correction spectra:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 463
If the corrections are for a wavelength program or a wavelength quant task, a corrections table
is displayed when you select Show Corrections:
To determine the length of time remaining before a correction expires, you need to view the
status of the correction spectrum and the Correction settings within the method used to create
the task.
1. Open a task that has been run using the method whose correction expiry you wish to
determine.
2. From the sample table, click the right mouse button on a sample and select Show
Corrections.
The Corrections window is displayed with the sample and correction spectra.
3. Using the right mouse button, click on the name of the correction spectrum in the legend
below the graph and select Status:
464 . UV WinLab Software Guide
This shows the date and time that the correction was collected.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 465
5. Close the Status dialog and then close the Correction window.
7. From the date of the task and the expiry length, you can then calculate how much longer
the correction is valid for.
Accessories
What type of corrections should I use when I have a Universal Reflectance
Accessory (URA) installed?
If you are using a URA, it is likely that you will be making many measurements – for example,
measuring many angles of one sample. Correction spectra (100 %T / 0A Baseline (Autozero)
and / or 0 %T / Blocked Beam Baseline) will be measured for each angle and this could take
some time depending on the number of samples / measurements specified in the sample table.
We therefore recommend that you do not select Always at task start as all correction spectra
will be recorded before any sample spectra are recorded. If you select Always before next
measurement, the same number of correction spectra will be recorded but the correction
spectra will be recorded for a particular sample (or measurement) and then the sample run so
you will not have to wait as long before seeing your results.
You can save correction spectra as part of a method so that they do not have to be run each
time you run the method. See "How do I save baselines with a method, and how does this affect
the corrections collected when I run a task?" above.
466 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Sample Info
The Samples tab on the Sample Info page enables you to format the Sample Table with all the
information needed prior to collecting the samples, such as the type of sample preparation, the
Sample ID, the number and frequency of control samples, any Standards (quant methods) and
the columns that will appear in the Table. The spectra are displayed on the Graphs tab.
Should I enter the number of samples before or after formatting the Sample
Table?
It does not matter whether you enter the number of samples before or after formatting the
Sample Table for replicates and measurements; the table will be updated accordingly. If more
than one replicate is specified, the correct number of replicates are added to or removed from
the table when the number of samples is changed. For example, if you specify three replicates
per sample and you increase the number of samples by 2, then 6 entries are added to the table.
However, if your sample table contains columns such as Initial Volume for a dilution, entering the
number of samples before or after formatting the sample table will make a difference. For
example, you have 3 samples in the table and set the Initial Volume to 10 ml. If you then format
the table and change the Volume to 15 ml, the samples currently in the table will not be updated
with the new volume. However, any new samples added to the table will have a Volume of 15
ml. It is possible though to edit the previous Volumes in the sample table by clicking in the
required cell and editing the value.
NOTE: Adding samples using Insert adds samples to the top of the list. Increasing the number
of samples by amending the number of samples in the field to the left of the Format
Sample Table button adds samples to the bottom of the list.
NOTE: The number of samples is determined by the Analyst after a Method has been opened,
rather than when the Developer is creating the Method.
After you have defined the number of samples, it is possible to add samples if you have
forgotten to do so.
1. Click in the Sample row where you want to add the sample.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 467
2. Click Insert.
4. Click in any cell of the row of the sample that you wish to delete.
A dotted line appears around the cell to show that it is selected:
5. Click Delete.
The sample is deleted from the Sample Table. When a replicate is deleted, the remaining
replicates are renamed and ordered accordingly.
NOTE: If replicates are defined, Replicate 1 must be selected to delete the entire sample.
Otherwise, only the selected replicate is deleted.
If data has not been collected, the sample ID of a deleted sample can be re-used.
If you are using the Standard Security version of UV WinLab, you are prompted to confirm the
deletion. The sample is then deleted.
If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, you are prompted to confirm the
deletion and provide a reason to be recorded with the sample. This information together with the
User name and the Date/Time is recorded with the sample data. The row is grayed. The behavior
is the same for replicates.
The sample types: Sample, Blank, Control and Standard are available.
If Replicates are used, Sample is replaced by Replicate 1 to Replicate n (where n is the number
of replicates).
1. Click in the Type cell of the sample whose Type you wish to specify.
A drop down arrow appears.
NOTE: The Open menu item is only available if the Sample Info page is selected.
3. Using the Folders and Name sections, navigate to the spectrum you want to import into
UV WinLab.
When you select a spectrum it is displayed in the lower panel.
4. Click Open.
The spectrum is imported into the method and can be manipulated in the same way as
collected spectra.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 469
It is possible to import sample tables created in *.csv, *.prn and *.txt files. The imported table
does not need to contain all the columns that are in the Sample Table, but if it contains more
columns than the UV WinLab Sample Table these will not be imported. Also the order of the
columns in the imported file must match that in the UV WinLab. Sample Table
NOTE: The Import Table menu item is only available if the Sample Info page is selected.
NOTE: When creating your file for import you will need to ensure that the appropriate list
separator is used. The list separator allowed will depend on what is specified in the
Regional and Language Options set up via the Control Panel in Windows.
4. Click Open.
The samples are imported into the Sample Table.
If the file includes information on the sample type, this will be automatically recognized in
the UV WinLab Sample Table.
NOTE: When you have imported a Sample Table you can edit it the columns as describedon this
page.
NOTE: The Export Table menu item is only available if the Sample Info page is selected.
2. Select the file type you would like to export the sample table as.
The options are *csv, *.txt and *.prn.
NOTE: The list separator used when creating the text files will be that specified in the Regional
and Language Options set up via the Control Panel in Windows.
3. Click Save.
NOTE: A comment can only be added to a sample via the Add Comment menu item that is
displayed when you right-click on a sample.
The comment can be viewed in the Sample Event Log – right-click on the sample and select
View Sample Event Log. The Sample Event Log records the Event, Date and Time, User, and
Reason/Comment.
It can also be viewed via the results of a Query. Select the result from the table and then select
Signatures and Comments from the Folder List. Any comments added to the sample are listed.
If you want several cells to contain the same entry, for example, if the Description is the same,
Fill Down allows you to enter the text once and then copy it into the other cells.
1. Enter the text in the top cell of the range of cells that will contain the same information:
2. Select all the cells to contain the information – including the cell you have just entered the
information in:
Clicking on the column header will select all the cells in the column.
NOTE: Fill Down is not applicable to the Sample ID and Standard ID columns.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 471
By default the first column will be Sample ID. The other columns depend on the formatting of
the table and what accessories are installed. See the questions on this page relating to each
accessory and how the sample table is affected.
What menu items are available when I right mouse-click on a row in the
Sample Table?
Show Corrections Displays the corrected spectra collected for the sample.
These are specified on the Corrections dialog.
The Sample Event Log records all events connected with the sample. For example, if a
description is added after the sample has been run, this event is recorded in the Event Log. The
original value and new value are recorded.
The Sample Event Log records the event, time, user, and reason/comment.
NOTE: If a field has been changed from being empty to containing a value, empty quotes "" are
used to show that the field was initially empty. For example, if the description field was
empty and then changed to read Batch 1, the Event Log would record: Description
changed from "" to "Batch 1".
The Sample Event Log only records any comments associated with the sample.
472 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Formatting the Sample Table allows you to define the Columns and layout of the Sample Table
for a particular Method. In the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, Analysts will not be able
to change which columns are displayed or which columns are mandatory to complete.
Preparation
Select the type of sample preparation to be used. Columns will be added to the table depending
on the type of sample preparation selected:
Substrate Adds columns called Starting Volume (ml) and Added Volume (ml) to
concentration the Sample Table.
The options on the Preparation tab are different when Substrate
Concentration is selected.
NOTE: Substrate concentration is only available for Timedrive methods.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 473
Set preparation This is only available when Dissolved solid or Dissolved solid and
volume (ml) dilution is selected. Enter the volume used (ml). This value will appear
in the Volume (ml) column of the table.
Set volume taken This is only available when Dilution or Dissolved solid and dilution is
for dilution (ml) selected. Enter the volume used (ml). This value will appear in the Initial
Volume (ml) column of the table.
Set final volume This is only available when Dilution or Dissolved solid and dilution is
(ml) selected. Enter the volume used (ml). This value will appear in the Final
Volume (ml) column of the table.
NOTE: When a value is entered for Set preparation volume (ml), Set volume taken for
dilution (ml), or Set final volume (ml), it applies to all samples in the table. However,
you can edit these values. Alternatively, you can de-select these options and manually
enter any values in the Sample Table for each sample. Values set by the Developer
cannot be edited by the Analyst within the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab.
Set starting volume This is only available when Substrate concentration is selected. Enter
(ml) the starting volume used (ml). This value will appear in the Starting
Volume (ml) column of the table.
Set added volume This is only available when Substrate concentration is selected. Enter
(ml) the added volume. This value will appear in the Added Volume (ml)
column of the table.
The volume information does not have to be entered in the Sample Table. However, if Table
must be completed before run is selected, this information must be entered by the Analyst
before running the task.
474 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Design
Select whether you wish to include replicates and control samples. Rows will be added to the
table depending on the options selected.
Replicates per sample Enter the number of replicates per sample. The default is one. If
more than one replicate is entered, each sample will have the
appropriate number of replicates added. The cell in the Type column
then contains a drop-down list of Blank, Control and Replicate 1.
Sequence by sample Select Sequence by sample to run the samples in sample order
rather than replicate order. For example, if you had 2 samples (S1 and
S2) and each sample had 2 replicates (R1 and R2) (that is, S1R1,
S1R2, S2R1, S2R2), the samples would be run in the order: S1R1,
S1R2, S2R1, S2R2.
Sequence by replicate Select Sequence by replicate to run the samples in replicate order
rather than sample order. For example, if you had 2 samples (S1 and
S2) and each sample had 2 replicates (R1 and R2) (that is, S1R1,
S1R2, S2R1, S2R2), the samples would be run in the order: S1R1,
S2R1, S1R2, S2R2.
Control sample at start Inserts a control sample at the start of the run (that is, the first entry
of run in the Sample Table)
Control sample every Inserts a control sample after every Xth sample. Enter a value for X.
X samples The default is 1.
Control sample at end Inserts a control sample at the end of the run (that is, the last entry in
of run the Sample Table).
NOTE: The order of the samples in the table (which is determined by the options on the Design
tab) is the order in which the samples will be run.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 475
NOTE: It is possible to select Control sample at start of run, Control sample every X
samples, and Control sample at end of run within one Sample Table. This will allow
the analyst to always run a Control at the beginning, Xth position, and at the end of a
run.
Columns
Select the columns to appear in the Sample Table and the order of these columns.
Add Displays the Column type dialog which enables you to add a custom column
to the table. See Custom Columns.
Move Up Moves the selected column one space up. This means the column is moved
one space to the left in the Sample Table.
Move Down Moves the selected column one space down. This means the column is moved
one space to the right in the Sample Table.
Format Displays a Format Column dialog depending upon the type of column
selected. See Formatting Columns.
ID
User When User must enter is selected, the user must fill in the Sample ID column of
must the Sample Table for each sample.
enter
NOTE: If replicates are included, when you enter the name for the first replicate
the name of the other replicates for the sample are automatically filled in.
Use When Use this format is selected, the Sample ID column of the Sample Table is
this automatically filled in by incrementing the prefix which you should enter in the field
format below. For example, if you enter the prefix Trial, the samples will be numbered
Trial1 to Trialn (where n is the number of samples). The numbering is
remembered across all tasks created by this method.
3. When you have selected all the required settings, click OK.
The Table Builder dialog closes. Any new samples added to the Sample Table are populated
using the chosen settings.
NOTE: When reprocessing a task, only the Columns tab of the Table Builder dialog is available.
476 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The Sample Table can only be formatted using the Format Sample Table button.
The Format Sample Table button is not available in the Enhanced Security version of UV
WinLab if the Method has been locked, if the samples have been run, or if you do not have the
correct permission. However, information such as the sample description can still be edited.
NOTE: Permissions are defined by the UV WinLab Administrator. Please contact them for further
information about your permissions.
2. Select the check box next to the name of a column that you want to appear in the table.
A tick indicates that the column will appear in the Sample Table.
NOTE: The column to the right of the sample table will automatically expand to fill the pane.
The order of the columns listed on the Columns tab is the order in which the columns will appear
in the Sample Table.
2. Click Move Up or Move Down to move the selected column up or down the list.
The columns in the Sample Table are updated accordingly.
Move Up moves the column to the left in the table.
Move Down moves the column to the right in the table.
7. Click OK.
The replicates are added to the sample table.
If I have replicate samples, can I choose the order in which the samples are
run?
The Design tab of the Table Builderdialog allows you to specify the order in which the samples
should be run when you have replicates. You can either sequence by sample or sequence by
replicate.
Select Sequence by sample to run the samples in sample order rather than replicate order. For
example, if you had 2 samples (S1 and S2) and each sample had 2 replicates (R1 and R2) (that
is, S1R1, S1R2, S2R1, S2R2), the samples would be run in the order: S1R1, S1R2, S2R1, S2R2.
Select Sequence by replicate to run the samples in replicate order rather than sample order.
For example, if you had 2 samples (S1 and S2) and each sample had 2 replicates (R1 and R2)
(that is, S1R1, S1R2, S2R1, S2R2), the samples would be run in the order: S1R1, S2R1, S1R2,
S2R2.
Samples are run in the order they appear in the Sample Table.
7. Click OK.
The measurements are added to the sample table.
If I have measurement samples, can I choose the order in which the samples
are run?
The Design tab of the Table Builderdialog allows you to specify the order in which the samples
should be run when you have replicates. You can either sequence by sample or sequence by
measurement.
Select Sequence by sample to run the samples in sample order rather than measurement
order. For example, if you had 2 samples (S1 and S2) and each sample had 2 measurements (M1
and M2) (that is, S1M1, S1M2, S2M1, S2M2), the samples would be run in the order: S1M1,
S1M2, S2M1, S2M2.
Select Sequence by measurement to run the samples in measurement order rather than
sample order. For example, if you had 2 samples (S1 and S2) and each sample had 2
measurements (M1 and M2) (that is, S1M1, S1M2, S2M1, S2M2), the samples would be run in
the order: S1M1, S2M1, S1M2, S2M2.
Samples are run in the order they appear in the Sample Table.
Replicates should be used when you have identical samples. For example if you have 3 solutions
of a sample and they are all the same concentration, you would enter 1 sample in the number of
samples and 3 in the number of replicates. You cannot use varying concentrations with replicates
of a sample. If concentration is specified in the sample table, all replicates of a sample must have
the same concentration.
Measurements should be used when you have similar samples. For example, if you have 3
solutions that are of varying concentrations having been made up by diluting 1 original solution.
In this case you would enter 1 in the number of samples and 3 in the number of measurements.
If concentration is specified in the sample table you can define the concentration of each
measurement.
Yes.
2. Click on the arrow and then select Blank or Control from the drop-down list.
Replicate 1 is changed and all other replicates for the sample are deleted.
NOTE: Only Replicate 1 can be changed. The Type field is not selectable for the other replicates.
Control samples
When would I use Control samples?
The simplest use is simply to flag the sample as a control so you can manually check that
the results are correct.
Or, you can set up a conditional response using Equation builder so that calculations on
Control samples are flagged if they fall outside set limits. For example, create an equation
of Area[Control, 260,300], then on the Conditional tab select that equation and set the
criteria for a failure and decide what happens in the case of that failure. See Equations and
Conditional Formatting for more information.
Or, in Quant when you select Control as the sample type you can then enter the expected
concentration in the Sample Table in Sample Info and then on the Beer's Law Quant page you
set the Control samples tolerance and any samples that give a calculated results more than the
tolerance limit away from the expected concentration are flagged up.
Control samples can be included at the start of the run, after every X samples, and/or at the end
of the run.
3. Select where you want your control samples within your run – Control sample at start of
run, Control sample every X samples, and/or Control sample at end of run.
4. If you select Control sample every X samples, enter the number of samples between
each control in the field below:
5. Click OK.
The Control samples are added to the table as specified. The Sample ID is Control and the
Type is also Control.
NOTE: You can also set the Sample type for any sample in the table to Control using the drop-
down list.
480 . UV WinLab Software Guide
If Sample Table is specified for the Wavelength in the Method Settings section on the Data
Collection page, then a Wavelength column is added to the Sample Table.
By default, the wavelength specified on the Data Collection page is listed for each sample.
Click in the wavelength field you wish to amend and enter the new wavelength.
NOTE: If the wavelength is changed on the Data Collection page and then more samples are
added to the sample table, the default wavelength for the added samples is the new
wavelength that was specified. Only samples added to the Sample Table after this
change will display the new value.
How do I specify the values for the Common Beam Mask (CBM) if 'Sample
Table' is specified on the Data Collection page?
If Sample Table is specified for the Common Beam Mask (CBM) on the Data Collection page,
then a CBM% column is added to the Sample Table.
By default the value is set to the value specified on the Data Collection page.
If the field is left empty, the default value on the instrument's page will be used.
NOTE: If Fixed is re-selected on the Data Collection page, the CBM value altered, and then
Sample Table re-selected, only samples added to the Sample Table after this change will
display the new CBM value.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 481
How do I specify the values for the UV/Vis slits if 'Sample Table' is specified
on the Data Collection page?
If Sample Table is specified for the UV/Vis Slit on the Data Collection page, UV/Vis Mode and
UV/Vis Slit columns are added to the Sample Table.
Fixed – Enter the required slit width in the UV/Vis field. Different slit widths can be specified for
each sample that has a Fixed UV/Vis Mode. The default value is the value on the Instruments
page.
If the UV/Vis Slit is left blank, the default value on the Data Collection page will be used.
NOTE: These values will override the value displayed on the Data Collection page.
Program – If Program is selected, the software will use the pre-defined program from the
Program page, and the UV/Vis slit column is set to <None>.
How do I specify the values for the NIR slits if 'Sample Table' is specified on
the Data Collection page?
NOTE: This is only available for the Lambda 750, 950 and 1050.
If Sample Table is specified for the NIR Slit on the Data Collection page, NIR Mode and NIR
Slit columns are added to the Sample Table.
482 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: If you have a Three Detector Module installed, and selected on the Accessory page, then
there will be two NIR slit options, one for the InGaAs detector (NIR InGaAs Slit) and one
for the PbS detector (NIR Slit). If Sample Table is specified for the NIR InGaAs slit on the
Data Collection page, NIR InGaAs Mode and NIR InGaAs Slit columns are added to the
table.
Fixed – Enter the required slit width in the UV/Vis field. Different slit widths can be specified for
each sample that has a Fixed UV/Vis Mode. The default value is the value on the Instruments
page.
If the NIR Slit is left blank, the default value on the Data Collection page will be used.
NOTE: These values will override the value displayed on the Data Collection page.
Program – If Program is selected, the software will use the pre-defined program from the
Program page, and the UV/Vis slit column is set to <None>.
Servo – If Servo is selected, the system will monitor the reference beam energy and adjust the
slits oversaturation of the detectors. The NIR Slit column is set to <None>.
NOTE: These values will override the value displayed on the Data Collection page.
If no mode is selected the system will use the default from the Data Collection page.
How do I specify the setting for the Common Beam Depolarizer (CBD) in the
Sample Table?
If the Common Beam Depolarizer is installed, a column called CBDep is added to the sample
table. This means that, for each sample, you can specify whether to have the polarization
settings on or off.
How do I specify the values for the front and/or rear beam attenuators if
'Sample Table' is specified on the Data Collection page?
If Sample Table is specified on the Data Collection page for the front beam attenuator, a
column called SBAtt (sample beam attenuator) is added to the sample table.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 483
If Sample Table is specified on the Data Collection page for the rear beam attenuator, a column
called RBAtt (rear beam attenuator) is added to the sample table.
2. Click to display a drop-down list, and select 0%, 0.1% (L1050 only), 1%, 10%, 100% or
Automatic.
0%, 0.1%, 1%, 10%, 100% correspond to the amount of energy passing through the attenuator.
100% means that the beam is free.
When a polarizer/depolarizer is installed, a Pol. Angle column is added to the sample table. The
polarization angle can be defined for each sample.
Pol. Angle – Enter the polarization angle to be used for the sample.
When a Universal Reflectance Accessory (URA) is also installed, a Polarizer Type column is also
added to the sample table.
The Polarizer Type is used to alter the effective pathlength to allow for the polarizer / depolarizer
installed.
Select the type from the drop-down list – Thick, Thin, None, 1 mm, 2 mm, 5 mm, 10 mm,
20 mm, or 30 mm.
484 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Accessory settings
What is displayed in the Sample Table when a cell changer is installed in a
Medium performance instrument?
Two columns are added to the sample table – Cell and Carousel. Carousel indicates the
carousel being used (this will always read Front for a Cell Changer installed in a Medium-
performance spectrometer), and Cell indicates the position within the carousel.
NOTE: If the available cell positions are updated on the Accessory page after the sample table
has been setup, the updated available/not available positions will only apply to samples
subsequently added to the sample table.
Two columns are added to the sample table – Cell and Carousel. Carousel indicates the
carousel being used (front or rear), and Cell indicates the position within the carousel. How
these columns are filled in depends on the type of reference(s) specified on the Cell Changer
Accessory page.
NOTE: If the available cell positions are updated on the Accessory page after the sample table
has been setup, the updated available / not available positions will only apply to samples
subsequently added to the sample table.
If Single reference in position is specified, and the reference beam is specified as the rear
beam, the Carousel column is defined as Front for all samples and cannot be edited.
If Single reference in front beam and single reference in rear beam is specified, the Carousel can
be Front or Rear.
If Matched pairing of samples to reference is selected, and the reference beam is specified as
the rear beam, the Carousel column is defined as Front for all samples and cannot be edited.
What is displayed in the Sample Table if Auto is selected as the Cell Changer
Type?
Two columns are added to the table – Cell and Carousel (this applies to Medium- and High-
performance instruments). Both are populated as Auto for every sample and this cannot be
edited. At run time, the software will detect the type of cell changer and populate the sample
table. The Cell positions can then be changed.
486 . UV WinLab Software Guide
What columns are added to the Sample Table when a sipper is installed?
Three columns are added to the sample table – Fill Time (secs) [Sipper], Flush/Return Time
(secs) [Sipper], and Delay Time (secs) [Sipper]. The values in each of these columns are
specified on a per sample basis. This means that you can use different settings for every sample
if you require.
Flush/Return column means the sipper will flush OR return depending on the option selected on
the Sipper Accessory page.
2. You can type directly into the field without first selecting an item from the drop-down list.
You can enter any numeric value or the word Default.
Default will use the value specified on the Sipper Accessory page.
OR
3. If you wish to use the Default value specified on the Sipper Accessory page, select Default.
OR
If you wish to enter your own value in the field, select the only value currently listed in the
drop-down list (this will subsequently be edited).
When the value is entered in the field, it is highlighted to show that it can be edited.
What columns are added to the Sample Table when a Peltier and/or
temperature probe are installed?
One column – Target Peltier Temp is added to the Sample Table when a Peltier is
installed. The Target Peltier Temp column is the requested temperature, and this can be set on
a per sample basis.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 487
NOTE: Even if you want to specify another temperature, you MUST select one of these options
from the drop-down list first.
3. If you wish to enter another value, click in the field and edit the value.
The minimum is 15 °C and the maximum is 45 °C.
Actual Peltier Temp – displays the Peltier temperature for the measurement.
Average Peltier Cycles Temp – displays the average Peltier temperature for the sample over
the sample measurement cycles. This column is present only when using more than one
measurement cycle.
External Probe Temp – displays the external probe temperature for the measurement.
Average Ext. Probe Cycles Temp – displays the average external probe temperature over the
sample measurement cycles. This column is present only when using more than one
measurement cycle.
Six columns are added to the sample table – Position [Autosampler],Probe Depth (mm)
[Autosampler], Return Position [Autosampler], Fill Time (s) [Autosampler], Flush / Return
Time(s) [Autosampler], and Delay Time(s) [Autosampler]. The values in each of these columns
are specified on a per sample basis. This means that you can use different settings for every
sample if you require.
Flush / Return column means the autosampler will flush OR return depending on the option
selected on the Autosampler Accessory page.
Position numbering starts at 1 as this is the first sample position. Position 0 is the rinse port and
cannot be used in the sample table.
488 . UV WinLab Software Guide
When the number of samples is specified, the Position column is automatically populated
sequentially. The software will prompt for new trays if required when the samples are run.
NOTE: The sample tray selected on the Autosampler Accessory page cannot be altered once the
sample table has been completed.
1. Click in a field (Position, Probe Depth, Return Position, Fill Time, Flush/Return Time, or
Delay Time).
An arrow appears.
2. You can type directly into the field without first selecting an item from the drop-down list.
You can enter any numeric value or the word Default.
Default will use the value specified on the Autosampler Accessory page.
NOTE: If Flush has been specified, all entries in the Return Position column are set to Rinse
Port. The Return Position column can only be edited if Sample return is selected on
the Autosampler Accessory page. The Return Position column does not have a 'Default'
option. Instead, if you wish the sample to return to the vial from which it came, select
Original, otherwise select or enter the number of the vial into which it should go after it
has been run.
OR
3. If you wish to use the Default value specified on the Autosampler Accessory page, select
Default.
OR
If you wish to enter your own value in the field, select the only value currently listed in the
drop-down list (this will subsequently be edited).
When the value is entered in the field, it is highlighted to show that it can be edited.
NOTE: All sample information that has not been completed at runtime will have the default
values used.
What columns are added to the Sample Table when a Universal Reflectance
Accessory (URA) is installed?
When in %R, three columns are added to the sample table – Width, Length, and Angle. These
columns are removed when in A or %T ordinate mode.
By default, the values on the accessory page are used on the sample info page.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 489
All these values can be altered by sample (or by measurement, if there are many measurements
for one sample).
When measuring several angles with the URA, do the angles have to be
specified incrementally in the Sample Table?
No, the angles can be specified in any order. The accessory will move to the required angle for
each measurement.
How should I set up the Sample Table if I want to measure many angles of
one sample using the URA?
We recommend that you use measurements to measure many angles of one sample.
7. Click OK.
The measurements are added to the sample table.
NOTE: A maximum of 200 measurements can be added for each sample. You can edit the width,
length and angle fields for each measurement.
490 . UV WinLab Software Guide
What columns are added to the Sample Table if a URA is installed but the
instrument is used in %T or A Ordinate mode?
The instrument can be used in %T or A ordinate mode with the URA installed. When %T or A
ordinate mode is selected, two columns are added to the sample table – Sample Pathlength
and Baseline Pathlength.
These columns are used to adjust the pathlengths. This may be particularly useful if you have
thick samples and wish to improve the Signal:Noise ratio. You can independently adjust the
sample and/or baseline pathlength for each sample (or each measurement or replicate if either
of these are being used).
Custom columns
What is a custom column?
A custom column is a user-defined column that can be added to the Sample Table.
3. Click Add.
The Column Type dialog is displayed.
4. Select Data entry, Text selection or Sample tag and click OK.
The appropriate Format dialog is displayed.
1. On the columns tab of the Table Builder dialog, select the column you wish to delete by
clicking on it.
A dotted line appears around the name to show that it is selected.
NOTE: Sample ID, Description and Type are mandatory columns and cannot be deleted.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 491
Formatting columns
What types of column are present in the Sample Table?
System System Columns are the first three columns that appear by default in a table –
Column Sample ID, Description, and Type. It is not possible to define any other System
Columns.
Data Entry A Data Entry Column is a custom column added by the user. Numeric values
Column that can then be used as variables in equations are expected in a Data Entry
Column.
Text A Text Selection Column is a custom column added by the user. Each cell in a
Selection Text Selection column contains a drop-down list of options. These options are
Column defined within the Format Text Selection dialog.
Sample Tag A special text selection column that is used as an identifier in special equations
that use variations on a sample. The Sample Tag becomes part of the spectrum
name.
The type of formatting that can be performed on a column depends on the type of column.
A sample tag is a special custom column that can be added to assign an alias to a sample. For
instance, if you have a group of samples that each have their own particular identifier that you
need to use as the sample name, but you also want to pick out samples as belonging to special
groups, you can use a sample tag.
Sample tags are like other text selection columns in that the method developer assigns the
entries available and then when samples are entered in the table there is a drop-down list of
options for the user to select from. Where this differs from standard text is that these options
then become available in the Variables list in the Equation Builder so you can specifically select
an equation to operate only on samples with that tag, or perform an operation that differentiates
between samples with different tags.
NOTE: You should not use the words Sample, Blank or Control as sample tags as this will
cause confusion with the sample types.
492 . UV WinLab Software Guide
An example use of sample tags is where you have several matched pairs of samples and you
want to subtract one from the other:
1. Add the Sample Tag column and format it with the list reading A and B.
2. In your Sample Info table use the drop-down list in the new Sample Tag column to select
which samples are A and which are B.
In this example, they must run in sequence one after the other, and there must be an even
number of each.
3. In Processing, set up an equation using these new variables, for example Height[A, 265]-
Height[B, 265].
When samples are run a Custom table will appear in the Results page that gives the result of this
equation for each pair of samples.
3. From the list of columns highlight the column you want to format and click Format.
The appropriate formatting dialog is displayed:
System Column
2. Select the Font, Font style, Size, Effect, Color and Script, and then click OK.
An example of the selected font is shown on the Format System Column dialog.
1. If you wish to format a Data Entry Column that already exists, select the Name of the Data
Entry Column that you wish to format from the drop-down list of all available Data Entry
Columns.
OR
NOTE: It is not possible to edit the Name of a previously saved column. If you try to edit the
Name of a previously saved column, a new column is created.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 493
2. If you wish to add units to a column header, enter the Units in the field:
The units are automatically placed in brackets after the column name.
3. If you want the analyst to enter information in the selected column before they can run a
sample, select Mandatory.
4. If you want the analyst to only be allowed to enter numbers in the selected column, select
Numbers only.
NOTE: Significant figures and Decimal places are only available when Numbers only is selected.
5. Click Change Font to change the Font type, Font style, Size, Effect, Color and Script.
6. If Numbers only has been selected, select the number of Significant figures (0 to 9) or
the number of Decimal places (1 to 9) from the drop-down list.
1. If you wish to format a Text Selection Column that already exists, select the Name of the
Text Selection Column that you wish to format from the drop-down list of all available Text
Selection Columns.
OR
2. If you want the analyst to enter information in the selected column before they can run a
sample, select Mandatory.
3. Enter the words to be selectable (from a drop-down list) for each cell in the column in the
Selection listfield:
In the Supplier column you want the analyst to be able to choose from Supplier A, Supplier
B and Supplier C.
Enter Supplier A, Supplier B and Supplier C in the Selection list.
494 . UV WinLab Software Guide
When the user clicks on a cell in the Supplier column of the table a drop-down list is
displayed containing Supplier A, Supplier B and Supplier C.
Click Change Font to change the Font type, Font style, Size, Effect, Color and Script.
When creating the custom column, select Mandatory within the Format column dialog.
The user then must fill in the column prior to data collection.
How do I force the user to enter a sample ID before they run a sample?
5. Position the cursor in the cell into which the information is to be pasted and then select
Paste from the Edit menu.
The information is pasted into the selected cell.
NOTE: It is also possible to paste information from the Windows clipboard into the Sample
Table.
Copy and Paste are also available from the context menu shown by right-clicking in a cell.
Yes.
You can select adjacent cells by clicking on the first cell and then dragging the mouse over
all the required cells.
OR
You can click in the first cell and then hold down the Shift key and use the arrow keys on
the keyboard to select the block of cells.
What do I see in the Sample Table when a sample has been run?
When a sample has been run, a green tick mark appears in the first column:
496 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The row is highlighted blue (apart from the first cell in the field) to show that it is selected.
1. Click in the first cell of the first row you wish to select (the row number):
The row is highlighted blue (apart from the first cell) to show that it is selected.
2. Hold down the SHIFT key and then click in the first cell of the final row you wish to select.
All rows in between (and including the selected rows) are highlighted blue.
1. Click on the header (column title) of the column you wish to select.
The column is highlighted blue (apart from the first cell below the title) to show that it is
selected.
1. Click on the header (column title) of the column you wish to select.
The column is highlighted blue (apart from the first cell below the header) to show that it is
selected.
2. Hold down the SHIFT key and then click in the header of the final column you wish to
select.
All columns in between (and including the selected columns) are highlighted blue (except
the first cell below the header in the first column).
Yes, if a column is added to a table but is then hidden, it will be available for export as the
software will populate all specified columns even if they are not displayed. The Data Export
dialog (obtained via the Output page in the Workspace) will automatically list all table columns
(displayed and hidden).
In the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, the analyst cannot add or remove the replicate
sample rows.
In the Standard version of UV WinLab, the analyst can alter the position of any control samples.
In the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, the analyst is not able to alter the position of
any control samples.
NOTE: The settings on the Data Collection page MUST NOT be altered while the Sample Table is
being run.
How does the analyst use the Sample Table at run time?
3. Click .
The samples are run in the order listed in the Sample Table. The Graphs tab displays
automatically at the start of the run and the spectrum appears in the graph display. A green
tick appears next to the sample name in the Sample Table when it has been run.
Does the analyst have to complete the Sample Table before a run?
The analyst will be required to enter the number of samples to be run, and any information that
has previously been specified as mandatory by the Developer. The sample table will be checked
for this information before the samples are run.
NOTE: Samples may be added to the Sample Table during data acquisition. DO NOT ADD
REPLICATES TO SAMPLES WHEN THE SAMPLE TABLE IS RUNNING.
Yes, the analyst will be prompted to perform an autozero before the samples in the Sample Table
are run.
NOTE: There is no graphical display for the autozero but the Instrument Status Bar is updated
appropriately.
Can samples be added to the table whilst the Sample Table is being run?
No. While the Sample Table is running it is not possible to edit the Sample Table in any way.
Can samples be added to the table when the sample list has been run?
Yes, you can add samples and then run these additional samples.
Can information in the Sample Table be edited whilst the Sample Table is
being run?
Can information in the Sample Table be changed if data has been collected?
In the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, you will be asked to confirm the edit request
and provide a comment to be recorded with the sample in the Sample Event Log.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 499
How do I exclude a sample once the Sample Table has been run?
2. Click Delete.
OR
3. Click OK.
If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, the green tick is replaced by
a red cross and the row is grayed.
If you are using the Standard version, the sample is removed from the Sample Table.
2. Right-click anywhere in the row and from the menu select Include.
The row is no longer grayed.
Can I view reference spectra while samples in the Sample Table are being
run?
Yes. Reference spectra can be added to the Graphs tab for comparison using the Add Reference
button. These are not saved as part of the task.
The correction spectra can be viewed within the Sample Table, Standards Table or Results Table.
Right-click on the sample whose correction spectrum you wish to view and select View
Corrections.
A graph window is displayed showing the sample and correction spectra:
500 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: The Simulator must have been setup correctly before simulating running the Sample
Table. Ensure that the Simulated instrument is selected under Instruments in the UV
WinLab Explorer. The Simulator is only available for Medium-performance instruments.
NOTE: If the name is not entered correctly the simulator will report an error when it tries to run.
2. Click .
The samples are 'run' and the graphs displayed.
See also
Accessories
Quant Calibration
UV WinLab Software Guide . 501
Processing
Pre-processing and Post-processing can be defined for Quant Methods and Timedrive Methods.
Pre-processing applies to all samples and standards before a Quant or Rate calculation is
performed. Post-processing allows processing to be applied to the Quant or Rate results.
NOTE: Pre-processing and Post-processing are defined for scanning Quant methods. For
Wavelength Quant, there is only Post-processing which is simply called Processing.
The table defining the processing parameters and the order they will be performed in is
displayed.
Equation Difference
Arithmetic Normalize
Convert Y Smooth
Derivative
NOTE: The processing options that are available depend on the type of Method selected. For
example, smooth is not applicable to a Wavelength Program method.
502 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Up Moves the selected row up the table and therefore changes the order in which the
processes occur.
Down Moves the selected row down the table and therefore changes the order in which
the processes occur.
Settings Displays a dialog enabling you to change the settings of the selected process. The
dialog displayed depends on the Process represented by the selected row.
1. Click Add.
A row is added to the Table. By default, Process is set to Select and Settings is set to None.
2. In the Process column, click and select the type of Process from the drop-down list.
The Process field is updated and the Properties field displays the default settings for the
selected Process.
5. Repeat steps 1 to 4 for all the processes you wish to apply to the collected data.
A process is selected from a drop-down list of all available processes. By default, Select is
displayed in the field.
2. Click Settings.
The appropriate settings dialog is displayed.
NOTE: It is not possible to edit the Settings field within the table. You must click Settings and
select the settings from the dialog.
Double-clicking in the Settings field also displays the appropriate settings dialog.
Does it matter in which order the processes are listed in the table?
The order in which the processes are listed is the order in which they will be performed. It is
therefore important that you place them in the sequence that you want the processing to be
applied.
2. Click Clear.
The row is removed from the table.
Click Add.
A row is added at the bottom of the table.
504 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Equation
Equation is used to perform calculations on raw data or on numerical data obtained from other
processing. Equations are constructed from Functions and Operators applied to all samples or
specific samples as set by Variables. The results of one equation can be used as Variables in
another, so that complex calculations can be carried out as a sequence of simpler operations.
1. From the Processing page, select Equation as the type of process and click Settings.
The Settings dialog for Equation is displayed.
OR
4. The Result Column name is the name of that will be used as the column header in the
Results Table. This field is read only. The default Result Column name is the same as the
default equation name. If you wish to change the default name, click Edit.
The Format Data column dialog is displayed. See 'How do I format the result column name
?' below for information on how to change the name.
5. Select Add to favorites if you want to be able to re-use this equation in other Methods.
The equation will then appear in the Equation name drop-down list next time you open the
Equation Settings dialog.
NOTE: When you select Add to favorites, the information on the Equation page is locked and
cannot be edited. To edit the Equation you must first enter a new Equation name. It is
not possible to de-select Add to favorites once it has been selected.
6. Enter the details of the Equation, either by typing directly or clicking on items in the
Operators, Functions and Variables lists.
Further information on each of the Functions is given below, but basically each function has
a number of settings that are required or optional (as shown in the tooltip that is displayed
when a function is added to the equation). The first of these settings is usually a <spectrum
variable> which by default will be set to All. This means that the function will be applied to
each sample, however, if you want to create an equation that performs a function on a
specific type of sample or even a specific spectrum, change the All to one of the other
Variables or click Browse to read in a specific spectrum.
7. Click Check to ensure that the syntax used in the equation is correct.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 505
8. Click OK.
The new column is created with the equation providing the data for that column. The
column will now be shown in the Organize columns dialog on the Results page where you
can choose whether it is displayed or hidden, and where in the table it appears.
1. Click Edit.
The Format Data Column dialog is displayed.
NOTE: It is not possible to create two columns with the same name.
4. Click Change Font to change the font type, style, size and color.
6. Click OK.
These column settings will be applied to the Results Table.
This calculates the area under the curve between two set points. The formatting of the command
is "Area[<spectrum variable>, Left Limit, Right Limit, Left Base Point(optional), Right Base
Point(optional)]"
For example: Area(All,800,900,700,1000) calculates the area between abscissa positions 800
and 900 above a baseline with base points at 700 and 1000.
The area reported is that between the Left Limit and Right Limit, either relative to a zero
baseline or relative to a linear baseline intersecting the spectrum at the specified baseline points.
If no baseline points are specified, the area reported is that above zero. If only one baseline
point is specified, a horizontal baseline is constructed from that point.
506 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Yval is used to obtain the ordinate value at a specified abscissa position. The formatting of the
command is "Yval[<spectrum variable>, Abscissa position]", for example, Yval[All, 360]
would give the ordinate value for each spectrum at 360 nm.
It is likely to be used to obtain a net absorbance from the difference in the values at two
positions. A typical use (instead of Ymax or Ymin) would be to determine the amplitude of a
band on a varying sloping background, where apparent shifts in the position of the band
maximum should be ignored.
PeakX is used to find the position of a peak or valley within a specified range. The formatting of
the command is "PeakX[<spectrum variable>, Start Range, End Range, Peak Threshold,
1=Peak/-1=Base, 1=Interpolated(default)/0=sampled position (optional)]".
A peak is identified by having a valley that exceeds the selected threshold on either side. PeakX
gives the abscissa position of a peak or valley over the specified range. If there is more than one
peak that exceeds the threshold the routine returns the value of the first peak or valley it finds.
For example: PeakX[All, 450, 350, 0.1, 1, 0] will return the first peak between 350 and 450 over
the 0.1 threshold, and return the abscissa value of the sampled data point (as opposed to the
peak position when a smooth curve is fitted to the sampled data points).
Ymax finds the maximum ordinate value within a specified range instead of measuring the
height at a fixed position. This has the advantage in the processing of multiple spectra where
there are shifts in the locations of the maximum. The formatting of the command is
"Ymax[<spectrum variable>, Start Range, End Range]", where Ymax[All, 450, 350] will give
the maximum ordinate value found between 450 and 350.
Ymin finds the minimum ordinate value within a specified range. This has the advantage in the
processing of multiple spectra where there are shifts in the locations of the minimum. The
formatting of the command is "Ymin[<spectrum variable>, Start Range, End Range]", where
Ymin[All, 450, 350] will give the minimum ordinate value found between 450 and 350.
XYmax is used to return the abscissa position of the maximum ordinate value found by
interpolation over a specified range. The formatting of the command is "XYmax[<spectrum
variable>, Start Range, End Range]", where XYmax[All, 450, 350] will give the abscissa
position for the maximum ordinate value found between 450 and 350.
XYmin is used to return the abscissa position of the minimum ordinate value found by
interpolation over the specified range. The formatting of the command is "XYmin[<spectrum
variable>, Start Range, End Range]", where XYmin[All, 450, 350] will give the abscissa
position for the minimum ordinate value found between 450 and 350.
Height is used to obtain the ordinate value at a specified abscissa position relative to an optional
baseline. The formatting of the command is "Height[<spectrum variable>, Abscissa position,
UV WinLab Software Guide . 507
Left Base Point(optional), Right Base Point(optional)]" where Height[All, 400, 450, 350]
would give the height at 400 corrected for a baseline drawn between 450 and 350. If one base
point is specified, a horizontal baseline is calculated from that point. If no base points are
specified then the height is not corrected for baseline.
Calculates the data interval of the spectrum. The formatting is "Interval[<spectrum variable>]",
where Interval[All] simply gives the data interval of each spectrum.
Calculates the number of data points in the spectrum. The formatting is "Npts[<spectrum
variable>]", where Npts[All] simply gives the number of data points in each spectrum.
Calculates the last abscissa point of the spectrum. The formatting is "End[<spectrum
variable>]", where End[All] simply gives the last abscissa point of each spectrum.
End can also be used nested within a command in place of the actual start value for a command,
for example XYmax[All, Start[All], End [All]] will give the abscissa value for the maximum
ordinate anywhere in the spectrum without having to set start and end limits.
If End is used with Wavelength Programmed data it will return the last wavelength in the list, so
combined with Height, Height[All, End[All]] will give the height at the last wavelength in the list
without pre-setting that value.
Calculates the first abscissa point of the spectrum. The formatting is "Start[<spectrum
variable>]", where Start[All] simply gives the first abscissa point of each spectrum.
Start can also be used nested within a command in place of the actual start value for a
command, for example XYmax[All, Start[All], End [All]] will give the abscissa value for the
maximum ordinate anywhere in the spectrum without having to set start and end limits.
If Start is used with Wavelength Programmed data it will return the first wavelength in the list, so
combined with Height, Height[All, Start[All]] will give the height at the first wavelength in the
list without pre-setting that value.
MaxHt determines the height of the biggest peak in a range, relative to a baseline if required.
The most common use is to obtain absorbance values for quantitative applications. The most
common use of %T data is for measurements of optical filters.
The formatting of the command is "MaxHt[<spectrum variable>, Start Range, End Range,
Left Base Point, Right Base Point]" where MaxHt[All, 400, 350, 450, 300] gives the height of
the biggest peak between 450 and 350 corrected for the baseline constructed between 450 and
300, using cubic interpolation between data points.
When Left Base Point and Right Base Point are given the same value, a horizontal baseline is
used, as shown below.
508 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Mean,SD (Standard deviation) and RMS (Root mean square deviation) are standard statistical
operators. When applied to a spectrum or wavelength programmed data they produce the
average, standard deviation or RMS deviation ordinate value over all wavelengths.
Mean and SD are mostly used to evaluate results from repeat measurements in order to improve
precision and estimate uncertainty. RMS is used in a similar way to determine variability, for
example as a measure of noise in a region of a spectrum or timedrive measurement.
Trend is used to measure variation that is slow relative to the frequency of measurement, that
would be regarded as drift rather than noise. It operates on a timedrive measurement or a
spectrum. It is used in noise measurements to separate out any longer term drift.
Trend calculates the slope of a linear fit to the data on which it operates. It can be applied to the
complete spectrum or timedrive measurement or to a limited region defined by Start Range and
End Range. Unlike other statistical functions it cannot be applied to the results of calculations on
a group of spectra.
The formatting of the command is "Trend[<spectrum variable>, Start Range (optional), End
Range (optional)]" where Trend[All, 450, 350] calculates the slope of a linear fit to all data
between 450 nm and 350 nm.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 509
These are standard mathematical operations that can be applied to spectra or numerical data.
For example they can be used to further manipulate the results of a different equation.
NOTE: A value of zero is returned if you try to take the log, natural log (Ln), or square root
(Sqrt) of a negative number.
Log returns the base <n> logarithm of a number or a spectrum. The formatting of the Log
command is "Log[<spectrum variable> or number, base]", for example, Log[All, 10] would
give the logarithm (base 10) of all spectra. Base 10 can be replaced by any base if required.
XVal is used to determine the abscissa value at a specified Y value. If interpolation is used (this
is the default), the equation will report the actual abscissa value at the specified Y value. If
interpolation is not used (by entering 0 in the syntax), the equation will report the abscissa value
of the nearest data point.
XVal will report the first abscissa value at the specified Y value. The Search from Start / End
options in the equation syntax are useful if the spectrum has more than one abscissa value at
the specified Y value (for example, if there is more than one peak in the spectrum). You can start
the search from the end of the spectrum that ensures the required value is reported.
The formatting of the command is "XVal[<spectrum variable>,Ordinate value, Start Range, End
Range, 1=Search from Start(default)/–1=Search from End(optional),
1=Interpolated(default)/0=sample position (optional)]"
NOTE: If you include the Interpolated command in the equation, you must include the Search
from command to ensure the syntax is correct. XVal[All, 1.2, 900, 300, 1] means that the
Interpolated value has not been defined. XVal[All, 1.2, 900, 300, ,1] where no value has
been entered for the Search from value (only a space between 2 commas) would return
an incorrect syntax message.
Examples:
The above equation will calculate the abscissa value for all spectra at the Y value of 1.2, between
900 and 300 nm. It will start the search from 900 nm, and it will be interpolated (give the actual
value rather than the nearest data point).
The above equation will calculate the abscissa value for all spectra at the Y value of 1.1, between
800 and 700 nm. It will start the search from 700 nm (Search from End), and it will not be
interpolated (give the nearest data point).
510 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The above equation will calculate the abscissa value for all spectra at the Y value of 1.2, between
900 and 300 nm. It will start the search from 900 nm (the default if nothing is specified), and it
will be interpolated (the default if nothing is specified).
Example:
In this example, we are looking at the peak between 1835 and 1845 nm. The width at half
height will be reported for all spectra. The functions Ymax and XYMax are used to calculate XVal.
Ymax calculates the maximum ordinate value within the range. XYMax calculates the abscissa
position of the ordinate maximum.
In the first part of the equation – XVal[All, Ymax[All, 1835, 1845] / 2, XYMax[All, 1835, 1845],
1845] -
1845 means the first XVal is looked for starting from 1845.
In the second part of the equation – XVal[All, Ymax[All, 1835, 1845] / 2, XYMax[All, 1835,
1845], 1835] – 1835 means the first XVal is looked for starting from 1835.
To calculate the width at half height for any data, use the equation above and simply replace the
values (1835, 1845).
UV WinLab Software Guide . 511
If the Start Range and End Range are not included, the whole range scanned for the spectrum is
used.
The graph below is an example of the type of data that may be produced from a Timedrive task.
RCoeff can be used to find the goodness of fit of the slope to the actual curve.
The formatting of the command is "Ri[<spectrum variable>, Start Range, End Range, Thickness,
Num Fringes (-1=Auto), Angle of Incidence, Thickness Units: 1=Å /2=m, Peak
Threshold(optional)]"
The formatting of the command is "Tcalc[<spectrum variable>, Start Range, End Range,
Refractive Index, Num Fringes(-1=Auto), Angle of Incidence, Result Units: 1=Å /2=m, Peak
Threshold(optional)]"
512 . UV WinLab Software Guide
There are three distinct types of variables that will appear in the Variables list:
Sample variables – All (which is used to apply a function to every sample), Sample, Blank
and Control (which can be used to pick a certain sample type only), Replicates, if
replicates are being used this will group results by the replicates of each sample, and an
individual entry for each sample in the task at this time (so you can use an individual
sample in an equation).
Sample tags – If you set up a Sample Tag column, the entries for that column will appear
as variables so that you can apply functions only to samples with a certain tag. There will
also be a Sample Tags entry that enables you to group by sample tag, as per Replicates
above.
Other columns – If you have other columns, either equations you've already set up or Data
Entry columns that are set to Numbers only added to the sample table. If this is a post-
processing page, the Rate and Quant results columns will also be available for equations.
The Replicates variable is used to process all samples that are of the type Replicate but keeps
the results grouped by Sample ID. This allows the results of the equation to be used in the
Mean, SD and RMS functions so that these calculations are performed on all replicates of the
same sample and the result is then put in the Replicates table
For example, if it was required that the maximum ordinate value of each replicate is calculated
and then the mean and standard deviation of the results for each Sample ID is produced, this
can be achieved with the following equations:
Ymax[Replicates,Start[Replicates],End[Replicates]]
This will calculate the maximum ordinate value for each sample marked replicate and put the
result in the Replicate Means table in a column called YMax.
Mean[YMaxResult]
This will calculate the mean result for the replicates of each sample and put the result in the
Replicate Means table in a column called YMaxMean.
SD[YMaxResult]
This will calculate the standard deviation result for the replicates of each sample and put the
result in the Replicate Means table in a column calledYMaxStdDev.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 513
For example, perform the absorptance calculation manually and then setup the method to have 2
measurements per sample. The first measurement is the %T measurement made by inserting
the sample in front of the reflectance sphere. The second is the %R measurement made by
putting the sample on the reflectance sphere.
The result is a spectrum and this will appear as the spectrum for that sample in the
measurements table replacing the 'mean' spectrum that normally appears. The description of the
spectrum is the equation description.
NOTE: If you perform several equations that output a spectrum for the measurements table,
only the last equation's results are displayed.
514 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Conditional Formatting
Conditional formatting is part of the Equation settings and enables you to apply special
formatting to the result when it meets certain criteria.
In this way you can highlight, for example, results that are below a certain limit.
The format for this is an "if...then...else " type of construction. For example "If the result of
Equation 1 ('If' condition) is less than (Operator) 15 (Criterion) then turn the result red ('Then'
conditional formatting) else leave it as it is ('Else' conditional formatting)".
1. From the Processing page, select Equation as the type of process and click Settings.
The Settings dialog for Equations is displayed.
3. Select the result you are going to apply the conditions to as the 'If' condition.
The drop down list contains equations that have been constructed previously.
6. Select the 'Then' conditional formatting to be applied if the criterion is met and select the
font and color, if required.
Formatting options are discussed below.
7. Select the 'Else' conditional formatting to be applied to results that do not meet the
criterion, and select the font and color, if required.
The default is No formatting.
Replace result with text – the result will not be displayed, the text entered in the field will
be displayed instead.
Add text to result – the result will be displayed followed by the text entered in the field.
Only change font – the result is displayed as calculated but in a different font as specified
here.
2. If the type was Replace result with text or Add text to result, enter the text in the field
below.
3. To change the font, click Change Font, and then use the dialog displayed to set the font
required.
The current font settings are displayed under Current format.
5. Select Apply to row if you want the font formatting and fill color to be applied to the whole
row in the table rather than just the cell with the result in it.
516 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Arithmetic
Arithmetic is a processing command.
NOTE: The input field and Import button are not available when log, ln, sqr, or sqrt is selected
as this operation is performed on the spectrum itself.
– subtraction
x multiplication
/ division
ln log base e
sqr square
NOTE: For logarithmic and square root functions, negative values are set to zero.
When adding subtracting or dividing two spectra, the resulting spectrum is the sum, difference or
ratio (as appropriate) of the two original spectra and the ordinate axis is designated the units of
the first spectrum.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 517
A %T A
%T A %T
%T Egy %T
Egy %T Egy
A Egy A
Egy A Egy
The following table shows the special cases that may arise and the units of the resulting
spectrum:
%T %T multiply /100 %T
%R %R multiply /100 %R
NOTE: Multiplying two spectra in %T produces a result where the value is divided by 100. For
example, 50 %T x 50 %T = 25 %T
Adding Spectra
What happens when I add two spectra with the same units and the same
range but different data intervals?
The resulting spectrum is the sum constructed from the smaller data interval.
What happens when I add two spectra with the same units and data intervals
but different ranges?
Subtracting Spectra
What happens when I subtract two spectra with the same units and data
intervals but different ranges?
What happens when I subtract two spectra with the same units and range
but different data intervals?
The resulting spectrum is the difference constructed from the smaller data interval.
520 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Multiplying Spectra
What happens when I multiply two spectra with the same units, data interval
and range?
The resulting spectrum is the product of the two spectra, except when multiplying two spectra in
%T.
NOTE: Multiplying two spectra in %T produces a result where the value is divided by 100. For
example, 50 %T x 50 %T = 25 %T
What happens when I multiply two spectra with the same units and data
intervals but different ranges?
NOTE: Multiplying two spectra in %T produces a result where the value is divided by 100. For
example, 50 %T x 50 %T = 25 %T
What happens when I multiply two spectra with the same units and ranges
but different data intervals?
The resulting spectrum is the product constructed from the smaller data interval.
NOTE: Multiplying two spectra in %T produces a result where the value is divided by 100. For
example, 50 %T x 50 %T = 25 %T
UV WinLab Software Guide . 521
Dividing Spectra
What happens when I divide two spectra with the same units, data interval
and range?
The resulting spectrum is the ratio of the two spectra, except when dividing two spectra in Egy.
NOTE: Dividing any spectrumby a spectrum in %T, produces a result where the value is
multiplied by 100.
What happens when I divide two spectra with the units and data intervals
but different ranges?
NOTE: Dividing any spectrumby a spectrum in %T, produces a result where the value is
multiplied by 100.
What happens when I divide two spectra with the same units and ranges but
different data intervals?
The resulting spectrum is the ratio constructed from the smaller data interval.
NOTE: Dividing any spectrumby a spectrum in %T, produces a result where the value is
multiplied by 100.
522 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Convert X
When would I use Convert X?
Spectra are commonly displayed with abscissa scales that may be linear either in wavelength or
in frequency. Linear wavelength is preferred for the UV/Vis region, while a linear frequency scale
is employed for most applications in the mid-IR region. In the near IR region, both kinds of scale
are in common use. Convert X is used to change between linear wavelength and linear
frequency.
Select Wavenumbers (cm–1), Microns (m), Angstrom (Å ), Nanometers (nm), Hours (h),
Minutes (min) or Seconds (s).
The data interval, or digital resolution, refers to the abscissa spacing of data points in a
spectrum.
To change the default value, enter a new value in the Data Interval field.
What are the relationships between data linear in wavenumber (cm–1) and
data linear in wavelength – micrometers (mm) or nanometers (nm)?
nm = 103 x m
Convert Y
When would I use Convert Y?
Spectra are typically generated in transmittance or reflectance. However, for work involving
quantitative determinations, it is appropriate to work in units that can be directly related to
concentrations. This involves a logarithmic conversion to units of absorbance or log(1/R). For
diffuse reflectance measurements, an equivalent conversion is to Kubelka-Munk units.
Select Transmittance (%T), Absorbance (A), Kubelka-Munk (K-M), Reflectance (%R), or Log 1/R.
Spectra can be converted between A and %T, %R and K-M, %R and Log 1/R.
NOTE: The software treats data in %T and %R identically except for the purposes of labeling
the ordinate axis.
A = 2 – log 10 (%T)
NOTE: The conversion is truncated for transmission vales below 1 x 10 –6 %T, which are
converted to 8 absorbance.
NOTE: The conversion is truncated for transmission vales below 1 x 10 –6 %R, which are
converted to 8 absorbance.
The K-M command converts a reflectance spectrum, R, to K-M units, using the relationship:
K-M = (1-R)2 / 2R
where R is the ratio of the reflectance of the sample to that of a suitable reference material.
Typically, reflectance spectra may be initially represented on a %R scale from 0 to 100. The
ordinate value used in the Kubelka-Munk calculation is equal to 0.01 x %R. As R approaches
zero, the results are truncated at approximately 0.7 %R to avoid division by zero.
In theory, after K-M (Kubelka-Munk) transformation, the band intensities vary linearly with
concentration (obey Beer's Law). So, you would use K-M for diffuse reflectance spectra just as
UV WinLab Software Guide . 525
you would use absorbance for spectra measured in transmittance. The K-M theory is strictly
applicable only to very weak absorption.
NOTE: Performing the Kubelka-Munk transform on a spectrum that is already in K-M units will
convert it to Reflectance units.
Derivative
Derivative is a processing command.
the identification of band centers where bands are not well separated;
to reduce the influence of broad features, typically those associated with the wings of
neighbouring bands, in quantitative analysis.
Derivative applies a 1st–4th order derivative function to the spectrum. A fixed width can be
applied, where the width is the number of data points (of the original spectrum) over which the
derivative calculation is applied. The amplitude of a feature in a derivative spectrum should be
proportional to the amplitude of the original band.
What is Derivative?
Derivative uses the Savitzky-Golay procedure to estimate the derivative of a smooth curve,
constructed through the original data points of your original spectrum. It uses a number of
neighboring data points to estimate the curve. As the number of data points used in the
calculation is increased, the contributions of broader features increase relative to narrow
features.
Derivative spectra have both negative and positive features, which make them difficult to
interpret.
Derivative spectra emphasize narrow features, including noise, relative to broad ones. You can
control this to some extent by varying the width of the derivative function. This is equivalent to
applying some smoothing to the derivative spectrum.
First derivative – the first derivative is zero at the band center and has single sidelobes of equal
amplitude, one positive and one negative on either side.
Second derivative – the second derivative has a minimum at the center of the band and single
maxima of equal amplitude on either side.
Third derivative – the third derivative is zero at the band center and has two sidelobes, one
positive and one negative, on either side. The corresponding sidelobes on the two sides are of
opposite sign.
Fourth derivative – the fourth derivative has a maximum at the band center and has two
sidelobes on either side. The first sidelobes are negative and the second are positive.
Original spectrum
UV WinLab Software Guide . 527
First Derivative
Second Derivative
Third Derivative
528 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Fourth Derivative
Derivative spectra usually have sharper features than the original spectra. In quantitative
analysis, they are sometimes used to reduce the effects of overlapping bands. You can use the
amplitudes of features in derivative spectra in the same way as peak absorbances. The
elimination of some baseline effects in derivative spectra can be useful in quantitative methods.
You can use the Derivative command to take the first, second, third or fourth order derivative of
a spectrum.
The first derivative removes any baseline offset and the second derivative removes a linear
slope.
Second-derivative spectra have sharp minima where there are maxima in the original spectrum
and so can be used to identify band positions in complex regions.
The Width sets the number of data points used to calculate the derivative. As you increase the
width used in the calculation, the contributions of broader features increase relative to narrow
features. The use of derivative can increase noise, so using a broader width can help to minimize
this.
What are the default parameters for Derivative and how do I change them?
By default, when Derivative is selected the defaults are First order and Width 9 point.
1. Click Settings.
The Derivative tab of the Settings dialog is displayed.
Difference
Difference is a processing command.
Difference subtracts one spectrum from another with an applied scaling factor. The factor can
be selected manually or applied automatically.
Examples:
Two samples of the same material have two different dilutions. When a difference is
performed using an automatic scaling factor, the ideal result is a flat baseline. The scaling
factor needed to achieve this is representative of the difference in dilution of the
Absorbance.
A sample spectrum containing a known and unknown can have a standard spectrum of a
different dilution subtracted from it. Difference using Automatic attempts to remove the
standard spectrum completely with the use of a scaling factor to leave just the unknown
spectrum.
1. Click Import to display the Import Data dialog, and select the spectrum to be subtracted.
NOTE: A scaling factor of 1 performs a straight forward subtraction of one spectrum from
another.
If Automatic Factor is selected, the software automatically calculates the best scaling factor to
apply to correct for the difference in baseline between the two spectra. If Manual Factor is
selected, you must enter a value to apply. By default, Automatic is selected.
530 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Interpolate
Interpolate is a processing command.
Interpolate is used to change the number of data points that are used to represent a spectrum.
Interpolate can result in a spectrum with more or less data points than the raw spectrum.
What is Interpolation?
Interpolation adds points to a spectrum by adding new points between the points that already
exist. Interpolation removes points from a spectrum by selecting every nth point of a spectrum
and ignoring it.
The number of data points needed in a spectrum depends on the width of the features in the
spectrum. If the separation of the data points is smaller than that needed to define the features
in the spectrum, the number of points can be reduced without reducing the amount of
information in the spectrum.
Increasing the number of data points in a spectrum cannot increase the amount of information in
the spectrum.However, it can increase the definition of the spectrum.
Interpolate copies a spectrum, and changes the number of points used to plot the spectrum.
reduce the number of data points in a file to save storage space, or to reduce the time
needed to process or print it.
1. Click Settings.
The Interpolate dialog is displayed.
2. Enter the Start and End values for the interpolation range.
Normalize
Normalize is a processing command.
Normalize allows spectra to be scaled so that the absorbance of a chosen band or at a chosen
position has a specified value, thus compensating for differences in concentration or pathlength.
The band is selected by choosing a frequency range within which it represents the maximum
absorbance. A baseline offset can be applied so that either absorbance at a chosen frequency, or
the minimum absorbance in the spectrum, is set to zero.
Its main use is for setting a common peak in several spectra to the same ordinate limit. Other
peaks in these spectra can then be compared. All calculations are performed in absorbance.
the ordinate value to which you want the spectrum or spectra to be scaled
the abscissa point (or range) at which this ordinate value is to be set
1. Click Settings.
The Normalize dialog is displayed.
4. If you select Maximum Ordinate value, enter the Start and End value for the range.
OR
If you select Selected Abscissa point, enter the abscissa point at which the spectrum will
be normalized.
532 . UV WinLab Software Guide
6. If you select Manual zero at, enter the value to zero the baseline at.
Zero point defines the point to zero the baseline at. There are three options:
Manual zero at Manual zero at enables you to choose a point to zero at.
If you select Manual zero at, enter the ordinate position value that will be set to zero.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 533
Peak Table
The positions and intensities of peaks above a specified threshold, and bases can be obtained
using a Peak Table. For spectra in ordinate units of A or log (1/R), a peak is defined as a point of
maximum intensity, with a corresponding definition for bases. For spectra in %T, %R or Energy
units, peaks are defined as intensity minima. A threshold is applied to distinguish genuine peaks
from local maxima associated with noise.
Positions are reported either as values obtained by interpolation or as the coordinates of the data
points. By default, the values obtained by interpolation are reported.
Threshold Enter a value for the threshold. Peaks above this threshold are included in
the peak table. The allowed threshold is 0.0001–100 %T , 0.00001–10 A.
Start, End (nm) Enter a Start and End value for the range over which the peaks are
identified. The range must be within the scan range.
All peaks / Only the Select whether to find all peaks or only a certain number of peaks. If only
top X peaks the top X peaks is selected, you must enter the number of peaks to be
found. The maximum is 199 and the minimum is 1. The default is 10.
Return actual data The closest data point to the maxima (or minima) is reported.
point Interpolation is not used.
Formatting tab
Change Font Click Change Font to display a standard Windows font selector dialog.
Abscissa Select Significant figures or Decimal places, and then select the
number from the appropriate drop-down list.
Ordinate Select Significant figures or Decimal places, and then select the
number from the appropriate drop-down list.
Enter a Start and End value for the range over which the peaks are calculated.
Units are in nm for collected data. If only imported data is available, the units of the imported
data are used.
534 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The buttons shown below are used to navigate through all the samples that were run. Hover the
mouse over the buttons to find out what they do.
The threshold defines which peaks are included in the peak table. It is measured in units on the
ordinate scale. If the peak height is less than the threshold, it is not included in the peak table.
The peak height is the smallest difference in ordinate units between the peak and the bases on
either side of it. In the following diagrams, P is listed as a peak, because both A and B are
greater than the threshold.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 535
536 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Smooth
Smooth is a processing command.
Smooth applies one of three algorithms to the spectrum to make spectral features more visible
by reducing noise. There are three types of Smooth available: Block Average, Triangular, and
Savitsky-Golay (cubic).
What is smoothing?
The ordinate value of each data point is replaced by a weighted average of the ordinate values of
the data points in a smoothing window around that point. Increasing the width of this smoothing
window leads to greater noise reduction but broadens the bands in the spectrum.
The weighting coefficients are generally chosen to minimize this broadening. The width of the
smoothing window is usually selected by visual inspection of the smoothed data. Smoothing
should not change band areas or the positions of symmetrical bands.
Block Average Smoothing – all points are weighted equally, giving the maximum noise
reduction for a chosen window.
Savitsky-Golay Smoothing – aims for minimum distortion by least squares fitting a cubic
polynomial.
Triangular Smoothing – the weighting coefficients decrease linearly from the center of the
smoothing window, causing less broadening than Block Averaging but achieving less noise
reduction.
NOTE: Data less than half the window width from the ends of the spectra are treated differently.
The data are extended by a double reflection about the end of the spectrum and the
smoothing function is applied to the real and reflected data. This allows the smoothed
data to extend to the limits of the original range with no discontinuity.
NOTE: For reasons of compatibility with earlier software, the number of points used in the
Triangular smoothing differs from that quoted. The relationship between these numbers
is shown below. For widths of 13 and above the number used is approximately 2/3 of the
number specified.
Number used 3 7 9 13 17 25 33 99
UV WinLab Software Guide . 537
What are the default smoothing parameters and how do I change them?
1. Click Settings.
The Smooth dialog is displayed.
Smooth reduces the noise level of your spectrum, but it also degrades the resolution of your
spectrum and features in the spectrum become broader.
The amount of noise in your spectrum is related to the number of scans collected. If you collect
more scans, the less the noise compared with the signal.
538 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Quant
Data from standards or standard replicates of known concentration is collected and a calibration
curve (Absorbance against Concentration) is generated. The quality of a calibration curve is
normally checked by assessing the fit of the concentrations of the calibration standards or by
analyzing control samples of known composition. This calibration curve is then used to determine
the concentration in unknown samples.
Beer's Law Quant – this page determines the type of calibration and the
limits to be applied to the calibration, as detailed below.
Parameters – this page is used to set up the actual calculation. It differs depending on whether
the Method is a Wavelength quant or a Scanning quant.
Calibration – this page displays the Standards Table and the calibration details if the calibration
type selected was Calibration curve or Single standard.
See also
Results
UV WinLab Software Guide . 539
Component Enter a name for the column. This column will appear in the Results
Table.
Units Enter the Units that will also be displayed in the column header. The
units will be displayed as Name (units).
NOTE: The other details on the page update depending on the type
of Calibration selected.
Type of curve Select the type of fit for the calibration curve. Select Linear, Cubic
or Quadratic from the drop-down list.
Force through zero Select Force through zero to include the origin as a point when
creating the calibration curve.
Correlation (r2) Calculates the correlation factor for the calibration and compares it
to the limit set.
Standard tolerance (%) The software checks each standard against the tolerance set.
Control samples The software checks each control sample against the tolerance
tolerance (%) defined.
Allow 10% extrapolation Enables you to exceed the range covered by your standards by 10%.
Proceed on error Select Proceed on error to display a warning when one of the
tolerances is exceeded. When Proceed on error is selected, you are
allowed to proceed with running the sample even if the tolerance
(tolerances) is exceeded.
In Enhanced Security:
Users with Create and edit methods and IPV set-ups permission can setup Quant.
Users with Run calibration permission and Run methods permission can run and save a
calibration. Users with Edit calibration permission can modify and save calibrations.
Calibration
What types of calibration are available?
Calibration curve
Selecting Calibration curve means that the curve is calculated from the standards entered in
the Standards table.
Single standard
Selecting Single standard means that the curve is calculated from a single standard and a fit
through zero. Therefore, the Standards table only has one row.
User factor
Selecting User factor means that the user enters a factor instead of creating a curve. The
Factor is the slope of the curve and it assumes an intercept through zero. There is no Standards
table.
When User factor is selected, only Control samples tolerance and Proceed on error are
available in the Limits section of the page.
Selecting User defined curve means that the user enters a slope and intercept instead of
creating a curve from standards. There is no Standards table.
NOTE: The Slope and Intercept fields only appear when User defined is selected.
When User defined curve is selected, only Control samples tolerance and Proceed on error
are available in the Limits section of the page.
The options for the curve are linear, quadratic and cubic.
Linear A = k1 + k2C
where A is the absorbance, C the concentration, and k 1, k2 and k3 are constants. K1 can be set to
zero by selecting Force through zero.
The constants are determined by least squares fitting between the specified concentrations and
measured absorbance values for a set of standards.
Selecting Force recalibration enables you to define the next time the calibration needs to be
run:
On Start-up – this means that recalibration is needed as soon as the method starts.
After X days – sets the number of days after which re-calibration must be performed again.
NOTE: Force recalibration is only available when calibration curve or single standard is
selected.
542 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Limits
What are the different limits for?
Correlation, Standard tolerance and Control samples tolerance allow you to define the
acceptance criteria for the calibration. Allow 10% extrapolation allows the calculation of the
unknown beyond the highest or lowest standard in the calibration by up to 10%. One or more of
these options can be selected.
When a calibration is performed the correlation factor for the calibration will be calculated and
compared to the limit set here. If the calculated correlation is less than the value set here, a
warning message will be displayed, and the calibration is said to have failed.
Enter a value between 0 and 1 for the Correlation limit to be compared against.
NOTE: This is not available when Single standard calibration, User factor or User defined curve is
selected.
The software calculates the difference between the specified value and the calculated value for
each standard and then compares that result to the Standard tolerance set here. If the
calculated value is not within the set tolerance from the specified value then a warning is
displayed.
Enter a value between 0.1 and 10 for the Standard tolerance (%).
The software calculates the difference between the specified value and the calculated value for
each control sample and then compares that result to the Control samples tolerance set here.
If the calculated value is not within the set tolerance from the specified value then a warning is
displayed.
Enter a value between 0.1 and 10 for the Control samples tolerance (%).
NOTE: If Proceed on error is switched off then this warning will stop any further samples being
analyzed.
When Allow 10% extrapolation is switched on, the concentration of a sample can be outside the
range the calibration standards by up to 10% and still be reported. When switched off, if a
sample concentration is calculated that falls below the concentration of the weakest standard, or
above the concentration of the strongest standard, a warning message will be displayed.
NOTE: If Proceed on error is switched off then this warning will stop any further samples being
analyzed.
Normally, if a control limit is exceeded a warning message will be displayed and the analysis will
be stopped. Selecting Proceed on error will enable following samples to still be run.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 543
Proceed on error also controls the use of invalid calibrations. If the calibration is unsuccessful
and Proceed on error is not selected, data collection of the samples will not be allowed. If the
calibration is successful or the calibration is unsuccessful and Proceed on error is selected, data
collection of the samples will proceed and the outcome of the calibration is not reported until all
the samples have been run.
See also
Quant
Quant Calibration
Results
544 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The parameters for a Scanning Quant method are used to set up whether the calculation is to be
based on Height, Maximum Height (looks for the maximum height within a range), or Area. It
also enables you to decide whether to include baseline correction.
Height
Maximum Height
Enter the Start and End values for the range within which the Maximum Height is
calculated.
Area
Enter the Start and End values for the range over which the Area is calculated.
None
Single point
The absorbance at the specified wavelength is subtracted from the original values.
Enter the wavelength in the Base 1 field to be used for the Baseline correction.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 545
Two points
Linear interpolation between the absorbance values at two specified wavelengths is used to
determine a value to be subtracted from the original absorbance value at each wavelength.
Enter the first wavelength to be used for the Baseline correction in the Base 1 field, and the
second wavelength in the Base 2 field.
NOTE: If you have browsed a spectrum into the graph display you can use the markers
displayed to set Base 1 (and Base 2). When you move the marker(s), the value(s) in the
Base field(s) update(s) accordingly.
Can I display a spectrum to help me set the points for the calculation?
Yes.
3. Click Open.
The spectrum is displayed on the graph.
4. Click to switch on the cursor and use it to find the points required.
546 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The parameters for a Wavelength Quant method are used to set up the wavelength for the
calculation and it also enables you to decide whether to include baseline correction.
The wavelength for the calculation is selected from the drop down list of wavelengths set up on
the Data Collection page.
Baseline correction is used here by selecting one or two points where the absorbance is read and
taken as a baseline, and the graph updated accordingly.
The points used can only be wavelengths set up on the Data Collection page.
How do I export the information displayed in the table at the bottom of the
page when I am working with a Wavelength Task?
Click the right mouse button anywhere in the table and select Copy To Clipboard.
All the data in the table is copied to the clipboard. It can then be directly pasted into
another application such as Excel.
NOTE: If you select certain cells in the table before selecting Copy To Clipboard, only the
selected cells are copied to the clipboard.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 547
Quant Calibration
This page is only available if the calibration type is Calibration curve or Single standard, as set
up on the Beer's Law Quant page, and it enables you to set up the standards to be used and
review the calibration details after the standards have been run.
The calibration curve is updated after the last standard has been run. You can choose to exclude
standards (from the calibration graph) that are in error and see the results updated. Standards
can be excluded in the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab; they can be deleted in the
Standard version of UV WinLab.
You can not add a new standard directly to the Standard Table.
All measurements, including standards, are entered in the Sample Table. Once added to the
Sample Table and the type selected as Standard, a sample will be visible in the Standards Table.
A standard can be edited in the Standards Table.
Should I add new standards before or after formatting the Standards Table?
It does not matter whether you add standards to the Sample Table (which will automatically
update the Standard Table) before or after formatting the Standard Table; the table will be
updated accordingly. If more than one replicate is specified, the correct number of replicates are
added to or removed from the table when the number of standards is changed. For example, if
you specify three replicates per standard and increase the number of standards by 2, then 6
entries are added to the table.
NOTE: If you are a Developer setting up a method for use by an Analyst, you can format the
table but not define the number of standards, as this can be done by the Analyst at run
time (and may vary each time the method is used). However, if you wish, you can save a
method with a defined number of samples and standards so that the Analyst simply has
to run the method without having to enter this information.
548 . UV WinLab Software Guide
After you have defined the number of standards, it is possible to add standards if you have
forgotten to do so.
1. Click in the Sample Table row where you want to add the standard.
2. Click Insert.
The new sample is added above the selected row.
Standards can be imported into a method from another task or from another file. You need to
import the standards into the Sample Table. They will then automatically appear in the Standards
Table.
NOTE: When importing data, data are always opened as standards. Replicates are not
applicable.
1. Click .
The Browse dialog is displayed.
3. Click Open.
The standard is imported into the Sample Table. A green tick appears in the left column of
the table to show that the imported standard has previously been run.
You cannot delete a standard from the Standards Table directly. You need to delete the standard
from the Sample Table.
1. Click in any cell of the row of the Sample Table that contains the standard that you wish to
delete.
A dotted line appears around the cell to show that it is selected:
2. Click Delete.
The standard is deleted from the Standard Table. When a replicate is deleted, the remaining
replicates are renamed and ordered accordingly.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 549
NOTE: If replicates are defined, Replicate 1 must be selected to delete the entire standard.
Otherwise, only the selected replicate is deleted.
NOTE: If you are using the Enhanced Security version, replicates cannot be deleted.
If data has not been collected, the standard ID of a deleted standard can be re-used.
If you are using the Standard Security version of UV WinLab, you are informed that the
calibration will be invalidated.
If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, you are prompted to confirm the
deletion and provide a reason to be recorded with the standard. This information together with
the User name and the Date/Time is recorded with the standard data. The standard is marked as
Excluded (a cross is displayed in the first column of the Standard table and the row is grayed).
The behaviour is the same for replicates.
NOTE: A comment can only be added to a sample via the Add Comment menu item that is
displayed when you right-click on a sample.
The comment can be viewed in the Sample Event Log – right-click on the sample and select
View Sample Event Log.
In the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, the Sample Event Log records the Event, Date
and Time, User, and Reason/Comment.
It can also be viewed via the results of a Query. Select the result from the table and then select
Signatures and Comments from the Tree. Any comments added to the sample are listed.
550 . UV WinLab Software Guide
What menu items are available when I right-click on a row in the Standards
Table?
The Sample Event Log records all events connected with the standard. For example, if a
description is added after the standard has been run, this event is recorded in the Event Log. The
original value and new value are recorded.
The Sample Event Log records the event, time, user, and reason/comment.
NOTE: If a field has been changed from being empty to containing a value, empty quotes "" are
used to show that the field was initially empty.
Formatting the Standard Table allows you to define the exact content and layout of the
Standards Table for a particular task. You cannot format the table if the Method has been locked,
if you do not have the necessary permission (within the Enhanced Security version of UV
WinLab), or if the standards have been run. See Security Settings for further information.
Preparation
Select the type of standard preparation to be used. Columns will be added to the table
depending on the type of standard preparation selected:
Dissolved solid Adds columns called Weight and Volume to the Table along with
Concentration.
Dissolved solid and Adds columns called Weight, Volume, Initial Volume and Final Volume
dilution to the Table along with Concentration.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 551
NOTE: For Dissolved solid and Dissolved solid and dilution, the concentration fields are
automatically completed when values are entered in the other columns. The
Concentration fields are non-editable in these cases.
Set preparation This is only available when Dissolved solid or Dissolved solid and
volume dilution is selected. Enter the volume used (ml). This value will appear
in the Volume column of the table when the number of Standards has
been specified.
Set volume taken for This is only available when Dissolved solid and dilution is selected.
dilution Enter the volume used (ml). This value will appear in the Initial
Volume column of the table when the number of Standards has been
specified.
Set final volume This is only available when Dissolved solid and dilution is selected.
Enter the volume used (ml). This value will appear in the Final Volume
column of the table when the number of Standards has been
specified.
NOTE: When a value is entered for Set preparation volume, Set volume taken for dilution, or
Set final volume, it applies to all standards in the table. However, you can edit these
values. Alternatively, you can de-select these options and manually enter any values
required.
This information does not have to be entered in the table unless Table must be completed
before run is selected, in which case this information must be entered by the Analyst before
running a standard.
Design
Select whether you wish to include replicates or measurements. If you do, a column will be
added to the table.
Replicates or Select Replicates or Measurements from the drop-down list. Enter the
Measurements per number of replicates per standard or measurements per standard. The
standard default is one. If value >1 then each cell in the Type column has a drop
down list which includes Replicate 1 to Replicate n where n is the number
of replicates selected.
NOTE: The order of the standards in the table is the order in which they will be run.
Columns
Select the columns to appear in the Standard Table and the order of these columns.
Add Displays the Column type dialog which enables you to add a custom column to the
table. See Custom Columns
Move Up Moves the selected column one space up. This means the column is moved one
space to the left in the Table.
Move Moves the selected column one space down. This means the column is moved one
Down space to the right in the Table.
NOTE: Move Down is only available if a column is selected (a dotted line appears
around the column name when it is selected).
Format Displays a Format Column dialog depending upon the type of column selected. See
Formatting Columns
ID
User When User must enter is selected, the user must fill in the Standard ID column of
must the Standard Table for each standard.
enter
NOTE: If replicates are included, when you enter the name for the first replicate the
name of the other replicates for the standard are automatically filled in.
Use this When Use this format is selected, the Sample ID column of the Sample Table is
format automatically filled in by incrementing the prefix which you should enter in the field
below. For example, if you enter the prefix Trial, the standards will be numbered
Trial1 to Trialn (where n is the number of standards). The numbering is
remembered across all tasks created by this method.
When you have selected all the required settings, click OK.
The Table Builder dialog closes and the Standard Table is populated using the chosen
settings.
NOTE: The Sample Table can only be formatted using the Format Standards Table button. The
button is not available if the Method has been locked, if the standards have been run, or
UV WinLab Software Guide . 553
if you do not have the correct permission (within the Enhanced Security version of UV
WinLab).
NOTE: Permissions are defined by the UV WinLab Administrator. Please contact them for further
information about your permissions.
NOTE: Setting up the Standards Table is very similar to setting up the Sample Table used on the
Sample Info page. For further details, for example on adding new columns, formatting
columns, and how the table can be used once it is created, see the Sample Info help.
7. Click OK.
The replicates are added to the standard table.
had 2 measurements (M1 and M2) (that is, S1M1, S1M2, S2M1, S2M2), the standards would
be run in the order: S1M1, S1M2, S2M1, S2M2.
Select Sequence by measurement to run the standards in measurement order rather than
standard order. For example, if you had 2 standards (S1 and S2) and each standard had 2
measurements (M1 and M2) (that is, S1M1, S1M2, S2M1, S2M2), the standards would be
run in the order: S1R1, S2R1, S1R2, S2R2.
7. Click OK.
The measurements are added to the standard table.
For example, within Quantitative methods you have replicate samples. UV WinLab calculates the
individual analyte concentration in the Results Table. However, you may wish to calculate the
analyte concentration per replicate and the ordinate mean per replicate.
To calculate the analyte concentration per replicate, set up the following equation in Post-
processing:
mean[Quant.concentration.Sampleid.Replicates]
To calculate the ordinate mean per replicate, set up the following equation in Post-processing:
mean[Quant.Ordinate.Sampleid.Replicates]
Create columns (with appropriate names) and add these to the Results Table.
Replicates should be used when you have identical samples. For example if you have 3 solutions
of a sample and they are all the same concentration, you would enter 1 sample in the number of
samples and number of replicates = 3. You cannot use varying concentrations with replicates of
a sample. If concentration is specified in the sample table, all replicates of a sample must have
the same concentration.
Measurements should be used when you have similar samples. For example you have three
solutions that are of varying concentrations having been made up by diluting one original
solution. In this case you would enter 1 in the number of samples, and the number of
measurements = 3. If concentration is specified in the sample table you can define the
concentration of each measurement.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 555
Spectral graph – shows the data for each standard for Scanning Quant.
Data – shows the data for each standard for Quant (Wavelength Program).
Calibration graph – can be used to display the Absorbance vs concentration graph, a graph of
Calculated vs specified values, or the Residuals.
Calibration details – displays a report listing correlation coefficient and coefficients of the
calibration equation, and the calculated concentrations and residuals for all the standards.
Calibration event – displays an event log for the calibration. This is only available in the
Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab.
As well as choosing at what stage of a task to save the calibration, you can choose to save the
method and on the dialog displayed, choose to Save Calibration.
A Quant method may be developed with or without a calibration being performed. In the case of
the latter, the analyst would have to run the Method and perform the calibration first, before
analyzing the standards. In the case of the former and as referenced in step 16, the Method is
saved with the calibration having been performed. The analyst would then only run the Method
to analyze the standards.
When the calibration graph has been displayed, you can review and if necessary, modify the
calibration curve by excluding one or more standards.
NOTE: Within the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, you can only modify a calibration if
you have the correct permissions. Permissions are defined by the Administrator. Please
contact your UV WinLab Administrator if you do not have the permission you need.
To exclude a standard, right-click on the standard point on the graph, or right-click on the
relevant row of the standard table.
In the ES software, the point excluded is grayed out on the graph and in the standard table.
In the Standard version of UV WinLab, the standard is deleted from the table.
NOTE: IT IS NOT POSSIBLE TO INCLUDE A STANDARD AGAIN ONCE IT HAS BEEN EXCLUDED.
NOTE: When you modify the calibration you are warned that this will invalidate calibration. Once
you elect to continue, the calibration will then be re-calculated.
556 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Right-click on the standard whose correction spectrum you wish to view, and select View
Corrections.
A second window is displayed showing the standard and correction spectra:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 557
Rate
Rate allows you to extract basic kinetic information from timedrive data (that is, measurements
of absorbance as a function of time). A typical measurement involves measuring absorbance over
a period of time during which a reagent, such as an enzyme, is added to the sample. Rate can be
used simply to measure the absorbance or to perform additional calculations. These calculations
may be based on the rate of change of absorbance or on the total change in absorbance. The
rate of change is used to determine enzyme activity (Slope analysis) while the total change in
absorbance provides a measure of substrate concentration (End point analysis).
The rate input data is a plot of Absorbance versus Time. The following data can be determined
from the plot:
The total change in absorbance due to the reaction. Additionally, the change in absorbance
is used to determine the substrate concentration.
The slope of the Timedrive. This is determined by calculating the slope between two
specified time points. This slope is used to calculate the enzyme activity.
Creeping baselines. This is used to evaluate the total change in absorbance and slope of the
curve. If the user decides the curve has a sloping baseline, they calculate the slope based
on the different slope areas of the curves and the difference between the slopes in the
resultant slope of the curve. The resultant slope is used to determine the enzyme activity.
Select the type of calculation to be performed – None, End point analysis or Slope
analysis.
End point analysis – use to determine the substrate concentration in the sample.
The following default Timedrive methods are provided. Further information about a method, see
Simple Timedrive
558 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Enzyme Activity
Substrate concentration.
NOTE: It is not possible to make the time less than was originally specified.
Yes. Data imported into the Sample Table are processed as samples – See Sample info for more
information on Importing. Data imported into the graph display are for reference purposes only.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 559
The change in absorbance is determined between the start of the measurement period and an
end point that is either determined automatically or taken at a specified time.
Automatic end point The end point is automatically calculated at the end of the time set for
the Timedrive.
Manual end point Enables you to enter a value for the end point.
Baseline corrected Enables you to calculate the true end point on the basis of the slope of
end point the baseline over a section defined by two points.
Component Enter the name for the column that will be added to the Results Table to
display the substrate concentration results.
Units Enter the units for the column that will be added to the Results Table to
display the substrate concentration results. These units are displayed as
Name (units).
NOTE: The time units are set from the time units control on the Timedrive Data Collection page.
You can select Automatic end point, Manual end point or Baseline corrected end point.
An Automatic end point is taken at the point where there is the maximum change in
absorbance from the initial value. If the absorbance change is positive, the end point
corresponds to the maximum absorbance. For a negative absorbance change, the end point
corresponds to the minimum absorbance.
560 . UV WinLab Software Guide
1. Select Automatic end point, Manual end point or Baseline corrected end point.
If you select Automatic, the end point is calculated automatically at the end of the time set
for the Timedrive.
OR
If you select Baseline corrected end point, enter the Base 1 and Base 2 values.
If you have imported a spectrum to locate the base points you can use the base point
markers on the graph to locate the desired points. If you use the mouse to move the base
point markers on the graph the Base 1 and Base 2 fields update appropriately.
NOTE: A Manual end point cannot be calculated if the run was stopped.
Baseline correction involves measuring the Slope over a period after the reaction is deemed to be
complete. This is extrapolated back to the start time to give a corrected absorbance value A corr.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 561
Baseline Slope = EF / DE
Enter the Base 1 and Base 2 points to be used when calculating the slope.
OR
If you have imported a spectrum to locate the base points you can use the base point markers
on the graph to locate the desired points. If you use the mouse to move the base point markers
on the graph the Base 1 and Base 2 fields update appropriately.
Selecting Calculate substrate concentration allows you to calculate the concentration of the
substrate and include the results in the Results Table.
If you specify a dilution for a sample, the result is multiplied by the dilution factor to give the
concentration of the material before dilution.
2. Click Settings.
The Substrate concentration settings dialog is displayed.
3. Enter values for the Molecular weight (g/mol), Pathlength of cuvette(cm), and the Molar
extinction coefficient (mmol-1 cm-1).
4. Click OK.
562 . UV WinLab Software Guide
8. On the Preparation tab select Substrate Concentration from the drop-down list.
9. Select Starting Volume and/or Added Volume if you wish to enter the values at this
stage. Otherwise, the columns are added to the table and the analyst can enter the values
at run-time.
All the settings for calculating substrate concentration are now defined. When the samples are
run, the Substrate concentration is reported on the Results page.
NOTE: If you re-process a Rate task which did not previously have substrate concentration
selected, it is not possible to select it as by definition the sample table would need to be
edited and this is not permitted when re-processing a task.
You may wish to display a previously collected graph if you select Baseline corrected end point,
to help you determine the Start and End points.
3. Click Open.
The graph is displayed in the graph pane.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 563
Slope Analysis
What is slope analysis?
The slope is calculated from the change is absorbance (A) between two times – Slope Start and
Slope End.
The result can be displayed in units of Enzyme Activity by specifying an Enzyme activity factor.
The measured slope is multiplied by this factor to give the Enzyme Activity. You may specify a
dilution for the sample, in which case the result is multiplied by the dilution factor to give the
enzyme activity of the material before dilution.
NOTE: The slope is calculated between two data points (start and end). Fitting is not applied
over the points in the selected range.
Calculate enzyme activity Select Calculate enzyme activity to calculate the enzyme
activity. An Enzyme activity factor must be specified.
Component This is the name of the column added to the Results Table to
display the enzyme activity.
Units Enter the units that will also appear in the column header.
NOTE: The time units are defined on the Data Collection page .
564 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Optional baseline correction involves subtraction of a baseline slope calculated over a period for
which separate Start and End times are specified.
Baseline Slope = EF / DE
3. In the Component field, enter the name of the component that will be displayed in the
Results Table.
This column displays the enzyme activity results.
4. In the Activity units field, enter the units that will also be displayed in the enzyme activity
results column header.
You may wish to display a previously collected graph if you select Baseline corrected end point,
to help you determine Base 1 and Base 2.
3. Click Open.
The graph is displayed in the graph pane.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 565
OR
You may wish to display a previously collected graph to help you determine the Slope Start and
End points.
1. Click Browse.
The Browse dialog is displayed.
3. Click Open.
The graph is displayed in the graph pane.
OR
See also
Rate
566 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Results
The Results page allows you to define the columns of results that are displayed when the
samples have been run. It also shows spectra (where applicable) and peak tables (if previously
defined). If measurements have been defined, a measurements sub-branch is added underneath
Results:
2. Click in the box next to the name of a column that you want to appear in the table.
A tick indicates that the column will appear in the Results Table.
The order of the columns listed on the Columns tab is the order in which the columns will appear
in the Results Table.
2. Click Move Up or Move Down to move the selected column up or down the list.
The columns in the Results Table are updated accordingly.
What menu items are available when I right-click on a row in the Results
Table?
Show Corrections Shows the correction spectra collected for the sample.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 567
NOTE: If you select certain cells in the table before selecting Copy To Clipboard, only the
selected cells are copied to the clipboard.
The Sample Event Log records all events connected with the sample. For example, if a
description is added after the sample has been run, this event is recorded in the Event Log. The
original value and new value are recorded.
The Sample Event Log records the event, time, user, and reason/comment.
NOTE: If a field has been changed from being empty to containing a value, empty quotes "" are
used to show that the field was initially empty. For example, if the description field was
empty and then changed to read Batch 1, the Event Log would record: Description
changed from "" to "Batch 1".
The Sample Event Log only records any comments associated with the sample.
NOTE: A comment can be added to a sample via the Add Comment menu item that is displayed
when you right-click on a sample.
The comment can be viewed in the Sample Event Log – right-click on the sample and select
View Sample Event Log. The Sample Event Log records the Event, Date and Time, User, and
Reason/Comment.
A comment can also be added and viewed via the results of a Query.
Select the sample whose spectrum you wish to view by clicking in the field in the Results
Table.
The spectrum on the Graph tab below updates for the selected sample.
568 . UV WinLab Software Guide
If a peak table has previously been defined as part of the processing, a peaks tab is added on
the results page.
The correction spectra can be viewed within the Sample Table, Standards Table or Results Table.
Right-click on the sample / standard whose correction spectrum you wish to view, and
select View Corrections.
A second window is displayed showing the sample and correction spectra:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 569
Replicates only appears if you have replicate samples and gives the average result for the set of
replicates.
For example, if you have Sample10.Replicate1 and Sample10.Replicate2, on the Replicates page
there is Sample10.Mean
Custom appears if you have set up an equation that needs to put the results in a new table
because they don’t apply to each sample. For example the equation discussed in Sample Tag
creates a result from two samples so it used a new Custom table to display those results.
A table listing the measurement samples that have been run and a graph tab (if applicable)
shows the spectra. The table can be formatted in the same way as the Results Table. See 'How
do I select which columns will appear in the Results Table ?' above. All the information above on
this page of the Help such as adding comments also applies to the measurements page.
A custom table is generated when equations are used in processing and when the result of an
equation cannot be associated with a particular sample.
For example if you have 2 samples and you define an equation as Sample 1 / Sample 2, the
result is not associated with either of these samples and so a custom table is created to report
the result.
570 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The Mass fraction in solid column is added to the Results Table (by default)when a Quant
method is run and the preparation type (specified on the Preparation tab of the Table Builder
dialog) is set to Dissolved solid or Dissolved Solid and dilution. The column is also available
on the Sample Info page but it is not enabled by default.
NOTE: There are no units associated with this column as the quantity is dimensionless.
For Dissolved solid, the values in this column are calculated using the equation
Mass Fraction = Concentration in solution (mg/ml) * solution volume (ml) / Mass of substrate
(mg)
that is, Quant Predicted concentration (Analyte) column * Volume column / Weight column
For Dissolved solid and dilution, the values in the Mass fraction in solid column are calculated
using the equation
Mass Fraction = [Concentration in solution (mg/ml) * solution volume (ml) / Mass of substrate
(mg)] * final volume / initial volume
that is, [Quant Predicted concentration (Analyte) column * Volume column / Weight column] *
final volume column / initial volume column
Custom Columns
What is a custom column?
A custom column is a user defined column that can be added to the Results Table.
3. Click Add.
The Column Type dialog is displayed.
4. Select Data entry, Text selection or sample tag and click OK.
The appropriate Format dialog is displayed.
1. On the columns tab of the Table Builder dialog, select the column you wish to delete by
clicking on it.
A dotted line appears around the name to show that it is selected.
Formatting Columns
What types of column can be present in the Results Table?
System Sample ID is the only column to appear by default in a table. Sample ID,
Column Description, and Type are System Columns. It is not possible to define any
other System Columns.
Data Entry A Data Entry Column is a custom column added by the user. Numeric values
Column that can then be used as variables in equations are expected in a Data Entry
Column.
Text A Text Selection Column is a custom column added by the user. Each cell in a
Selection Text Selection column contains a drop-down list of options. These options are
Column defined within the Format Text Selection dialog.
Sample Tag A special text selection column that is used as an identifier in special equations
that use variations on a sample. The sample tag becomes part of the spectrum
name.
NOTE: A sample tag column cannot be deleted once it has been created.
The type of formatting that can be performed on a column depends on the type of column.
A sample tag is a special custom column that can be added to assign an ‘alias’ to a sample. For
instance if you have a group of samples that each have their own particular identifier that you
need to use as the sample name, but you also want to pick out samples as belonging to special
groups, you can use a sample tag.
Sample tags are like other text selection columns in that the method developer assigns the
entries available and then when samples are entered in the table there is a drop down list of
options for the user to select from. Where this differs from a standard text table is that these
options then become available in the Variables list in the Equation Builder so you can specifically
select an equation to operate only on samples with that tag, or perform an operation that
differentiates between samples with different tags.
NOTE: You should not use the words Sample, Blank or Control as sample tags as this will
cause confusion with the sample types.
572 . UV WinLab Software Guide
An Example use of sample tags is where you have a matched pairs of samples where you want
to subtract one from the other:
1. Add the Sample Tag column and format it with the list reading A and B.
2. In your Sample Info table use the drop-down list in the new Sample Tag column to select
which samples are A and which are B (in this example they must run in sequence one after the
other and there must be an even number of each).
3. In Processing, set up an equation using these new variables, for example Height[A, 265]–
Height[B, 265].
When samples are run a Custom table will appear in the Results that gives the result of this
equation for each pair of samples.
2. From the list of columns highlight the column you want to format and click Format.
The appropriate formatting dialog is displayed:
System Column
4. Select the Font, Font Style, Size and Color, and then click OK.
An example of the selected font is shown on the Format System Column dialog.
5. If you wish to format a Data Entry Column that already exists, select the Name of the Data
Entry Column that you wish to format from the drop-down list of all available Data Entry
Columns.
OR
NOTE: If you edit the Name of a previously saved column, a new column is created.
NOTE: It is not possible to create two columns with the same name.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 573
6. If you wish to add units to a column header, enter the Units in the field:
The units are automatically placed in brackets after the column name.
NOTE: If you edit the details of a previously saved column, a message will be displayed
informing you that if you save the changed details, all methods containing the column
will also be updated. You can choose to Save or Rename. Click Save to save the column
details, overwriting the previous settings for that name. Click Rename to enter a new
name for the column settings.
7. If you want the analyst to enter information in the selected column before they can run a
sample, select Mandatory.
8. If you want the analyst to only be allowed to enter numbers in the selected column, select
Numbers only.
NOTE: Significant figures or Decimal places are only available when Numbers only is selected.
9. Click Change Font to change the font type, style, size and color.
10. If Numbers only has been selected, select the number of Significant figures (1 to 9) or
the number of Decimal places (0 to 9)from the drop-down list.
11. If you wish to format a Data Entry Column that already exists, select the Name of the Data
Entry Column that you wish to format from the drop-down list of all available Data Entry
Columns.
OR
NOTE: If you edit the Name of a previously saved column, a new column is created.
NOTE: It is not possible to create two columns with the same name.
12. If you want the analyst to enter information in the selected column before they can run a
sample, select Mandatory.
574 . UV WinLab Software Guide
13. Enter the words to be selectable (from a drop-down list) for each cell in the column in the
Selection listfield:
In the Supplier column you want the analyst to be able to choose from Supplier A, Supplier
B and Supplier C.
Enter Supplier A, Supplier B and Supplier C in the Selection list
.
When the user clicks on a cell in the Supplier column of the table a drop-down list is
displayed containing Supplier A, Supplier B and Supplier C.
Click Change Font to change the font type, style, size and color.
3. Position the cursor in the cell into which the information is to be pasted and then select
Paste from the Edit menu.
The information is pasted into the selected cell.
NOTE: It is also possible to paste information from the Windows clipboard into the Sample
Table.
576 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Output
The Output page allows you to select the template to use when creating reports, how frequently
the report should be created, and how the report should be output. A template is available with
each of the methods supplied as part of UV WinLab. A preview of the selected report template is
shown on the Output page. A new report template can be created via the Output page. It is also
possible to export data to a specified directory at the same time as the reports are generated.
NOTE: If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, the template assigned to a
locked Method cannot be altered by the end user. If the Method is not locked, you must
have permission to create and edit report templates in order to alter the assigned
template. Please see your UV WinLab Administrator for further information about your
permissions.
Templates
How do I select the report template to use?
Select the required template from the drop-down list of available templates.
When you highlight a Report Template, the Display Pane lists Name, Description, Type, Created
by, Created on, Revision, and Status.
A list of all Report Templates is also available from the Output page within the Workspace, by
selecting the Template drop-down list.
NOTE: A report template must be approved before a report can be saved to the database using
the template. See the Communiqué Report Creator section of the Help for further
information on approving report templates.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 577
Yes, select the template from the drop-down list and then click Edit.
Communiqué Report Creator opens enabling you to edit the selected template.
NOTE: If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, you must have permission
to create and edit report templates. For further information about your permissions,
please contact your UV WinLab Administrator.
To see a preview the report, select the template from the drop-down list and click Preview.
The report is shown in the Communiqué Print Preview window.
Click New.
Communiqué Report Creator opens enabling you to create and save a new template. When
the template has been saved, the name appears in the Template drop-down list on the
Output page.
Report frequency
How often can I obtain a report?
It is possible to obtain a report On Demand, After each sample, or When task is completed.
NOTE: A task is only completed once it has been saved. On Demand is the default.
Select the required frequency from the Report frequency drop-down list.
Reports are obtained On Demand via the Explorer, which lists all reports saved to the database.
NOTE: Reports can only be saved to the database if an approved report template is used. See
the Communiqué Report Creator book in this Help file for
further information on approving report templates.
Report output
What type of outputs are available?
The report can be output in the following ways: Print hardcopy, Print to file or Print to
database. It is possible to select more than one type of output.
NOTE: If a Method is locked but the report template associated with the Method has not been
approved, Print to database will not be available.
578 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Hardcopy tab
The Hardcopy tab enables you to select the printer and the number of copies to be printed.
File tab
The File tab enables you to specify where the file should be saved to and the type of file to be
created.
5. Select where you want the path to go; select the path from the drop-down list of previous
destinations, type in a new path, or click Browse to select a directory for the file path.
6. Select the File type you want to create from the drop-down list of available file types.
Select ASCII (.txt), HTML (.htm), Microsoft Excel (.csv) or Microsoft Word (.rtf).
Sections tab
This tab allows you to switch sections created in the report template, on and off. All the sections
created in the report are listed.
Highlight the required section in the Sections Off list and click On.
The section moves from the Sections Off to the Sections On list.
Highlight the required section on the Sections On list and click Off.
The section moves from the Sections On to the Sections Off list.
Data Export
Why would I use Data Export?
Data Export exports data generated when the task is created. The data can then be used by
software such as Color Application Software, Protection Glass Application Software, Architectural
Glass Application Software and Filter Application Software.
Tables, including the Sample Table and Replicates Table, Spectra (raw or processed), and
Wavelength Program data can be exported. You can choose to export an entire table, or just
selected columns from the table.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 579
NOTE: The data is exported when the Task is saved. To export data manually, at any time the
Task is open, select Export on the File menu to access the Export Data dialog. The
settings can be different to those set in the Export Data dialog accessed via the Output
page.
NOTE: If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, you must have the correct
permission to be able to export data. If you cannot see this option, please consult your
UV WinLab Administrator regarding your permissions within the software.
2. Click Setup.
The Export Data dialog is displayed. The folder to which the data will be exported is shown
at the top of the options.
NOTE: The Output page is where you define what data you would like to export when saving a
Task. You can also access the Export Data dialog via Export on the File menu to export
your data manually, at any time a Task is open. The settings can be different to those set
in the Export Data dialog accessed via the Output page.
4. Click , and select the required folder or click Make New Folder to create a new folder.
The new path is displayed.
NOTE: If a branch (for example, Columns) is selected, all items underneath are automatically
selected. However, if another item is later added below this branch (for example, adding
another column to a table will add the column name to the list of columns) this is not
automatically selected. You must deselect the branch and then reselect it so that all items
are selected.
Where an item at the end of an option is underlined:, this means that a drop-down list is
available and the type can be changed.
6. Click on the underlined text to display a drop-down list:, and select the required option.
To restore the default settings for data export, click Restore Defaults.
You will be asked to confirm that you wish to restore the defaults.
The Export Data dialog displays all the data that can be exported:
Sample Table:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 581
Results Table:
This is an EXAMPLE of the columns available for export within the Results Table:
Standards Table:
This is an example of the options available when exporting a standards table:
582 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Custom Table:
This is an example of the options for a custom table:
Replicates Table:
This is an EXAMPLE of the columns that can be exported in the Replicates table:
Peak Table:
This is an example of the items available when exporting a peak table:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 583
NOTE: The list of columns available for each table will be the columns selected to be displayed
(see Sample Info). If a column is displayed, but does not contain any information, it is
not selected for export by default.
Raw and/or processed spectra can be exported as *.sp, *.asc or *.dx format.
The spectral data can also be exported as XY data (raw and/or processed data). This will create
a CSV file when exported.
Click on the underlined text to display a drop-down list:, and select the required option.
584 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: You can also export your raw spectra as *.sp format using the Save Spectra option on
the File menu. See Can I save my spectra as *.sp files?.
Click on the underlined text to display a drop-down list:, and select the required option.
Samples by columns
Columns by samples
How do I reset the defaults if I do not wish to keep the settings I have
chosen?
To restore the defaults of just a particular node on the Folder List, right-click on the
required node and select Reset to Defaults.
You will be asked to confirm that you wish to restore the default settings for the node and
all settings below it:
586 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Yes, If you are using the Standard version of UV WinLab, the previous data will be overwritten.
If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, it is not possible to save tasks with
the same name. Therefore, the data cannot be overwritten.
Yes, if a column is added to a table but is then hidden (see Sample info), it will be available for
export as the software will populate all specified columns even if they are not displayed. The
Export Data dialog will automatically list all table columns (displayed and hidden).
Call Application
Why would I use Call Application?
Call Application enables you to export your spectra or data directly to another software
application after each sample is run or at the end of a task. For example, you can send the XY
data of your processed sample to Microsoft Excel as a .csv file, after each sample is run.
NOTE: If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, you must have the correct
permission to be able to use Call Application. If you cannot see this option, please consult
your UV WinLab Administrator regarding your permissions within the software.
Call Application exports the data in the formats defined in the Data Export dialog.
1. In the Data Export section, make sure Output to file is selected and click Setup.
2. Define the Data Export settings for the output as described in "How do I export data?" on
this page.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 587
OR
click to display the Open dialog and browse to the executable file.
The new path is displayed in the field. The path can be viewed in full in a tooltip by
hovering the mouse over the field.
If the application you wish to call is one of the PerkinElmer Advanced Spectroscopy software
packages, such as Color, Filter, Architectural Glass and Protection Glass, the syntax for the
command line is C:\UVWINLAB\AppName where AppName is:
Application AppName
Color UVAPPLC.EXE
Filter UVAPPLF.EXE
Architectural UVAPPLG.EXE
Glass
6. In the Commands field, type the command line parameters for the external application.
Use <*>to designate the output files to be passed to the application. This is a placeholder
that will be replaced with the filename of each sample.
If the application you wish to call is one of the PerkinElmer Advanced Spectroscopy software
packages, such as Color, Filter, Architectural Glass and Protection Glass,the application
parameter typically appears as "MethodName" <*>,where MethodName is the path to an
application method file (generated using the application) and <*> is a placeholder for the
output filenames.
NOTE: The path to the method file must be enclosed in quotes. For example,
"C:\UVWINLAB\MyColorMethod.mcx".
NOTE: Different software applications may require different command lines. Please see the
relevant software Help for details of the command line options.
8. Select when the application will start from the drop-down list.
The options are At end of run and After each sample.
If At end of run is selected, the current sample is the last sample run.
11. Spectroscopy Software Package applications used with UV WinLab versions 2.x/3.x.
This will ensure the validity of the command line passed to these applications.
12. Select Suppress sample prompts if you selected After Each Sample in Step 8 and you do
not want to display sample prompts. This is relevant for some custom accessories that use
Call Application to move or change samples, and therefore do not require sample prompts.
The only prompts displayed if this option is selected are for Autozero and for the first
sample.
Click the mouse button in the row you wish to delete and click Remove.
Select the row you wish to move and click Move Up or Move Down to move the row up or
down respectively.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 589
Graphs
Graphs are displayed on the Graphs tab in the Sample Info page and in the lower panes of the
Processing and Results pages in the Workspace.
If the Sample Table has been run and data collected, all spectra currently in memory are
displayed either on one graph (Overlay Display mode) or on separate graphs (Split Display
mode).
To switch between Split Display mode and Overlay Display mode and vice versa:
Within the Workspace go to the View menu and select or deselect the Overlay Samples
check box.
NOTE: Overlay Samples is not available for Wavelength Program or Wavelength Quant method
types.
NOTE: The Raw, Processed and Both controls are only available when the graph is shown as
part of the Processing level of the Folder List.
Select Raw to display the raw data as generated from the settings on the Data Collection page.
Select Processed to display the data after all the processes defined within the Processing page
have been performed in order.
Select Both to display both the raw and processed data for comparison.
Select the Raw, Processed or Both check box at the bottom of the viewing area.
Hover the mouse over the buttons to find out what they do.
Hover the mouse over the buttons to find out what they do.
590 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Add Text Displays the Label Properties dialog which enables you
to add text onto the graph.
What menu items are available when I right-click on a spectrum name below
the graph?
Save as Displays a Save As dialog, allowing the spectrum to be saved as a .sp file to the
Binary selected directory.
Save as ASC Displays a Save As dialog, allowing the spectrum to be saved as a .asc file to
the selected directory.
What menu items are available when I right-click on the background of the
graph?
Previous Range Undoes a command that changes the X or Y range displayed by the graph.
NOTE: To undo a Full Scale command, use the Previous Range command
twice: once to undo the X component and once again to undo the Y
component.
Full Scale Sets the X range to the Start and End data points, and the Y range to the
maximum and minimum, of the selected spectra.
Vertical Cursor Places a vertical line on the graph that you can drag along the X axis. By
double-clicking, you can label the position of the cursor at any point of
interest.
Split Display Switches the display between the Overlay Display and the Split Display
modes.
Set Anchor Places an anchor point in the graph of the selected spectrum, enabling you to
Point drag your spectrum horizontally or vertically.
Add Text Displays the General tab of the Label Properties dialog, which enabling you to
add text to a graph.
Add Bitmap Displays the Bitmap tab of the Label Properties dialog, enabling you to add an
Image image to a graph.
Properties Displays the Graph properties dialog, enabling the graph properties to be
defined.
Copy to Clipboard:
When you select Copy to Clipboard, 2 copies of the graph are placed on the clipboard a bitmap
and an enhanced metafile.
A bitmap of the graph is the same dimension as the current graph window. This is an EXACT
copy of what is shown on the screen. It will include the information page. The graph will have
the same resolution as the screen. This means, the bigger the graph is shown in UV WinLab, the
bigger the bitmap and the better the resolution. This format should be used for screen reports.
592 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The enhanced metafile (EMF) is the same physical dimension as the screen but it is produced for
the default printer rather than the screen and is therefore of much higher resolution. This is the
format that should be used if you wish to print the report as the curve will appear much
smoother than if the bitmap is used. There is a disadvantage with the metafile. If you stretch the
image, you must keep the same aspect ratio as the original image otherwise you will get
overlapping characters if the image is stretched in the vertical direction but not the horizontal
direction. If you perform a non-proportional stretch with a bitmap, the characters just become
stretched on one direction (rather than overlapping) but the curve starts to become 'blocky'.
You need to use the Paste Special command within Microsoft Word to see the different formats.
Microsoft Word gives the options: Picture (Windows Metafile), Bitmap, Device Independent
Bitmap, and Picture (Enhanced Metafile). If you use Paste rather than Paste Special,
Microsoft Word will use the Picture format by default.
What menu items are available when I right-click on the spectral line on the
graph?
Set Anchor Places an anchor mark allowing free hand scrolling of the graph
Point
Label Peaks Displays a Label Peaks dialog to determine the settings and formatting of the
peak labels.
Save as Displays a Save As dialog, allowing the spectrum to be saved as a .sp file to the
Binary selected directory.
Save as ASC Displays a Save As dialog, allowing the spectrum to be saved as a .asc file to
the selected directory.
Click the right mouse button on the spectral line or the name of the curve and from the
menu select Status.
The Status dialog is displayed. Each of the tabs is described below.
Sample tab
The Sample tab allows you to select which sample (of those currently displayed) you wish to
view the status of and enter a description and/or comments.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 593
1. If you wish to view the status of a sample other than that listed by default, select the
sample from the drop-down Properties of list.
The dialog displays the Date the spectrum was collected and the Analyst who collected it.
Both these fields are for information only and cannot be edited. This information is not
provided if the spectrum was imported.
2. You can enter a Description of the sample and any Comments that you wish to associate
with the sample in the appropriate fields.
The comments can be viewed via a Samples Query.
NOTE: If you add a description or any comments, you must click OK (the dialog closes). If you
do not click OK, and then you choose another spectrum, the information previously
entered is lost.
Scan tab
The Scan tab details the Ordinate used for the method, the Interval and Scan Range
depending on the type of method used to generate the data. All these fields are for information
only and cannot be edited.
If you wish to view the status of a sample other than that listed by default, select the
sample from the drop-down Properties of list.
Instrument tab
The Instrument tab lists all the available parameters used for collecting the spectra. The
parameters are for information only and cannot be edited.
History tab
The History tab displays a table of operations conducted with the spectra.
Highlight the Operation whose details you wish to view from the Summary list.
The History record displays the current history record number out of the total number of history
records available.
Click Next >> or <<Prev to select the next or previous record from the summary.
For each Operation conducted on the spectrum, the Analyst who performed the operation, and
any Parameters used to perform the operation are listed. These are all for information only and
cannot be edited.
NOTE: Spectra added via the Add Reference button are for visual comparison only. They do not
become part of the task. If the task is opened again via a Query, the spectra added via
Add Reference are not present. Also, the spectra (added via Add Reference) are not
processed through the processing chain.
1. Click the right mouse button (right-click) on the graph background, and from the menu
select Properties.
OR
Right-click on the spectral line on the graph, and from the menu select Appearance.
The Graph Properties dialog is displayed.
General tab
The General tab allows you to enter the Title and Description of the graph:
Axes tab
The Axes tab allows you to define the axes for a selected curve or all curves.
5. Select the graph (or select All Curves) from the Properties of drop-down list.
6. Enter the Top and Bottom values for the Y Axis, and select the Units for the Y Axis from
the drop-down list.
7. Select Autorange on new data if you wish the software to automatically set the range to fit
the graph to window, setting the top and bottom values to the required values.
8. Enter the Left and Right values for the X Axis and select the Units for the X Axis from the
drop-down list.
9. Select Autorange on new data if you wish the software to automatically set the range to fit
the graph to window, setting the left and right values to the required values.
NOTE: The 2000 cm-1 scale change checkbox is intended for infra-red spectra only.
Appearance tab
If you wish to display gridlines in the graph window, select Enable Gridlines.
Element displays a drop-down list of the text objects that are in the graph window. To change
the settings for a particular element:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 595
13. To change the color of the text, click Color and select the color from the dialog displayed.
14. Select the curve from the drop-down list of Curves currently displayed.
15. Click Color and select the color or create a custom color from the dialog displayed.
Advanced tab
16. Select whether to Hide X Axis Units, Hide Y Axis Units, Hide X Axis Numbers, Hide Y Axis
Numbers and/or Hide Information Pane.
NOTE: If you hide a feature of a graph, such as the axis units, the information will not be
included if you use the Copy to Clipboard function.
17. Select which items to include in the Tool Tip when the cursor is positioned on the spectral
line.
One or more of the options Show Curve/Group Name, Show Co-ordinates, Show Data Point
Name can be selected.
19. Select the name of the spectrum from the Properties of: drop-down list.
This is the spectrum whose properties you will define in the lower part of the Advanced tab.
20. For the individual data points, select Display Never, Display Always, or Scale
Dependent.
21. Select the Shape of the points. Select Dot, Square, Triangle, Cross or Diamond from the
drop-down list.
22. To change the color of the shape click Color and select the required color from the dialog.
23. Select the method by which the spectral line is plotted point to point. Select None,Linear or
Cubic from the drop-down list.
24. Select the Size (1–10) and Style (Solid, Dot, Dash) of the line using the drop-down lists.
The Label Properties dialog is displayed when Add Text or Label This Point is selected from the
menus obtained by clicking the right mouse button (see menu items above).
The Advanced tab is only available when adding a label to a spectrum point.
596 . UV WinLab Software Guide
General Tab
3. If you wish to include the time or date in the label select Time or Date from the Insert
drop-down list. (These options are available when the General Tab is accessed via Add
Text).
<Current Time> or <Current Date> is displayed as appropriate in the Text field, but he
actual time and/or date is displayed on the graph.
If you access the General Tab via Label This Point, you have the options: Curve Name,
Description, X Value, X Units, Y value, Y Units.
Advanced Tab
7. Select Show Tie Line to display a line linking the position of the label to the associated
data point on the spectrum.
NOTE: The Label Properties Dialog is also displayed if you right-click on the background of the
graph and select Add Bitmap. The Bitmap Tab only is displayed.
You can place an image, such as your company logo, into the graph using the Add Bitmap Image
command.
1. Right-click on the background of the graph and from the menu select Add Bitmap Image.
The Label Properties dialog is displayed.
2. Click Browse, and from the Open dialog select the bitmap to add to the graph.
The name of the image is displayed in the Filename field.
3. Select Transparent Background if you wish to set the background color of the bitmap to
be transparent.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 597
1. Right-click on the spectral line, and from the menu select Label Peaks.
OR
Settings tab
Threshold Enter the Threshold value (in Absorbance) for determining a peak.
Start, End Enter the Start and End values for the range over which the peaks are
detected.
Display All peaks, Select whether to display All peaks, or Only the top X peaks. If Only the
Only the top X top X peaks is selected, enter the number of peak labels to be displayed.
peaks
Abscissa, Ordinate Select whether to display the Abscissa and/or Ordinate values.
Formatting tab
Abscissa For the Abscissa value, select Significant figures or Decimal places and
Significant figures, then select the number from the appropriate drop-down list.
Decimal places
Ordinate For the Ordinate value, select Significant figures or Decimal places and
Significant figures, then select the number from the appropriate drop-down list.
Decimal places
3. Click OK.
The dialog closes and the peak labels are displayed.
NOTE: The position of a peak label on the graph can be moved. Position the mouse over the
peak label. The mouse pointer changes to a 4-headed arrow. Drag the peak label to the
new position.
598 . UV WinLab Software Guide
If I delete a graph of a sample from the Sample Table is the data removed
from the table?
No. The graph is removed from the display but the data is not removed from the table.
The graph can be re-displayed by double-clicking on the appropriate row in the Sample Table.
NOTE: If spectra have been added via the Add Reference button and subsequently removed
from the graph, they must be added again via the Add Reference button.
The event marker is only applicable for Timedrive methods. It allows you to add a label to a
graph to show when you perform an action such as adding a reagent.
Options dialog
The settings are Ordinate precision for Instrument Status Bar and Wavelength Program table and
Interpolation.
NOTE: If Linear interpolation between points is selected, this setting will applyto all new
methods created by a particular Windows user (not UV WinLab user – the option will
apply to all UV WinLab users logged on to that Windows user account). Existing methods
will not be changed. If Linear interpolation between points is not selected, linear
interpolation will not be applied to all new methods created by a particular Windows user.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 599
Audit Trail
NOTE: The method Audit Trail is only available when a method has been locked.
The report contains details on the Method Revision, Data Collection Settings, and Reporting
Settings.
600 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Event Logs
Event Logs are available for Methods, Tasks and Samples.
The Event Log for a Method or Task records each event for the method or task. For example, if
the Method is created by the Method Wizard this is the first event recorded in the Event Log.
For each event, the Method Event Log records the Event, Revision Number, Date, User, Full
Name, Reason and Comments.
For each event, the Task Event Log records the Event, Date, User, Full Name, Reason and
Comments.
For each event in the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab, the Sample Event Log records
the Event, Date and Time, User, Reason and Comments. The Event Log starts recording after
data has been collected and the Task has been saved. The first entry is the Save.
In the Standard version of UV WinLab, the Sample Event Log only records any comments
associated with the sample.
2. From the Tools menu in the Workspace select Event Log and then select Method from the
submenu.
The Method Event Log is displayed.
The Method Event Log records the Created by New Method, Saved, Locked, Unlocked, Reviewed
and Approved Events.
2. From the Tools menu in the Workspace select Event Log and then select Task from the
submenu.
The Task Event Log is displayed.
The Task Event Log records the Saved, Reviewed and Approved Events.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 601
The Sample Event Log can be viewed via the Sample Table, the Results Table or the Standards
Table.
2. Click the right mouse button and select View Sample Event Log.
The Sample Event Log is displayed.
The Sample Event Log records all events connected with the sample. For example, if a
description is added after the sample has been run, this event is recorded in the Event Log. The
original value and new value are recorded.
The Sample Event Log records the Event, Date and time, User, and Reason/Comment.
NOTE: If a field has been changed from being empty to containing a value, empty quotes "" are
used to show that the field was initially empty. For example, if the description field was
empty and then changed to read Batch 1, the Event Log would record: Description
changed from "" to "Batch 1".
The Sample Event Log only records any comments associated with the sample.
602 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Welcome to Communiqué
UV WinLab Software Guide . 603
Welcome to Communiqué
Communiqué is the report designer tool supplied with your PerkinElmer application software
and it enables you to create and edit your own report templates.
Once in Communiqué, you use the layout tools and the data objects to create report
templates for use with the parent application.
Communiqué is a very powerful report creator and the rest of this help file will help you get
the most from it.
The Menu Bar below that contains the menu commands that enable you to work with
Communiqué, as described in the Understanding the Menu Commands topic.
The Toolbar, below the menus, contains icons for standard interactions that will be
performed frequently, enabling quick access to these commands. All these commands are
also available from the menus. Hover the mouse over the tools below for details:
The grey Banner below the toolbar informs you which template is being edited and which
element of the template is currently active. For instance:
The Tree View on the left hand side enables quick access to items on the template. Selecting
an item on the Tree displays the relevant view in the Main Pane. Sub-branches can be
expanded and collapsed as required. Pages and items on the tree can be selected and re-
named, and the page order can be changed by dragging them with the mouse. The Tree
changes dynamically depending on selections made on the Template level and as objects are
added to the template. Further information is in Working with the Tree View.
The Main Pane, in the center of the window, displays views of the template enabling you to
position items as required. This includes rulers and a grid that can help you place objects
appropriately.
604 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The Objects Toolbox on the right is split into three groups: Layout Tools, Data Objects and
Custom Objects.
Layout Toolsare either tools used for laying out objects, or are visual items to be
displayed on the page .
Data Objectsrepresent the items from your application software to be displayed in the
report.
Custom Objectsare special objects you have created yourself, either where you want to
keep re-using particular groups of objects or where you have created special equations.
The Status Bar at the bottom of the window is used to provide feedback, for instance when
an object is being sized or placed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 605
The Description will be saved with the template, enabling you to give extra information
about what the template was designed for, as information for others who may want to use
the template.
The Paper size and the Portrait or Landscape orientation determine the size and shape of
the template.
Set Margins enables you to set up the margins on the template, as described in Working
with Margins.
You can select whether to have a Header and/or Footer,areas that will be repeated at the
top or bottom of every page, and whether to have them Different on page one, as
described in Working with Headers and Footers.
The Grid units and choices of whether to Display grid and Snap to grid are discussed in
Using Rulers and the Grid.
To open a template, select Open on the File menu. Select your template from the Open
dialog.
The details of the template are added to the tree view.
NOTE: Only templates associated with the currently defined data model by name (the
version does not matter) are shown.
To close a template, select the required template and then select Close Template from
the File menu.
If no changes have been made since the template was last saved, the template closes.
NOTE: If there are unsaved changes, you are asked whether you wish to save the changes
before the template closes. Select Yes to save the changes before closing the
template, or select No to close the template without saving any changes.
606 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Importing
You can import a template or custom object that was exported from another copy of
Communiqué.
1. Select Import and then Template or CustomObject from the File menu.
NOTE: If you import a template that uses fonts not available on your PC the template will
use a different font as set by the Windows operating system. a template, select the
required template and then select Close Template from the File menu.
If no changes have been made since the template was last saved, the template
closes.
Exporting
You can export a template or custom object to disk so that it can be used on another PC.
NOTE: Before you can export a template, you must save it.
3. Select Export and then Template or Custom Object from the File menu.
4. On the file selector, choose where to save the item and give it a name.
Templates can be locked with a password using the icon in the Print Preview. A locked
template cannot be changed.
2. Enter your Password in the Password field and enter it again in the Repeat
Password field.
3. Click OK.
The template is locked.
When the template is opened in future it will be read-only until it is unlocked.
3. Click OK.
Assuming the password was correct, the template is unlocked.
NOTE: In the Enhanced Security mode templates are locked (made read-only) when the
template is "approved". An approved template cannot be unapproved (unlocked).
To save a template with a new name, select Save as from the File menu.
The Save dialog is displayed, enabling you to give the template a new name.
Depending on the security settings of the parent application, you may need to
electronically sign the save.
608 . UV WinLab Software Guide
You can not place items within the margins, and objects will not spill over into the margins
when reports are created.
The margins appear on the page as red lines, as shown in the picture here. The blue shading
shows the header and footer, which can only be set within the top and bottom margin, so
you must create these margins before you can work with a header or footer.
The margins can be set both by using a dialog and by using the mouse.
NOTE: For best results, you should set your margins before laying out a template. If
margins are moved and cross over an object, the objects may not print properly.
NOTE: These are only available if the Rulers are switched on.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 609
However, if an item is placed at the Page Type level and overlaps the header or footer it is
not ‘on’ the header/footer and does not get replicated on each page.
2. Select Header and/or Footer to include headers and/or footers in the template.
When Header is checked a "Header" item appears in the Tree. When Footer is checked
a "Footer item appears in the Tree.
NOTE: The header and footer settings may be changed for each page type and the contents
of the header and or footer may be different for each page type. See Working with
Page Types for more information.
1. In the Tree View, right mouse click on the required Page Type and select
PageTypeProperties from the pop up menu that appears..
The Page Type Properties dialog appears.
2. Select Specific to this page type to customize the header and footer for this page type
only.
3. Check Header and/or Footer to include headers and/or footers in the page type.
4. Check Different on page one to enable you to have the Header/Footer on page one
different than all the other pages in the page type.
The Page Type Header and/or Footer nodes in Tree are expanded to include a Page
Type First Header and/or Footer sub node.
5. Click on the Page Type First Header and/or Footer sub nodes to customize the header
and/or footer settings.
NOTE: If you create and populate a header/footer and then switch on Different on page
one the original header/footer you set up will now only be available on page two
onwards and you will need to set up the header/footer for page one as required.
610 . UV WinLab Software Guide
1. To add items to the Header or Footer, select the appropriate Header or Footer from
the Tree view.
The selected section (Header or Footer) is then displayed in white and items can be
added.
2. To return to the main section of the template select the page or an item on the page
from the Tree view.
Elements and objects added to the Header or Footer must be placed inside the margins.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 611
Page types should not be confused with actual pages of the finished report, as when a report
is generated a particular page type may create more than one page of actual report, either
because the objects on the page take up more room than expected and spill onto another
page, or because you have set up a repeating section that gets used for reporting details of
multiple samples one at a time, or a table has expanding rows.
Selecting a Page Type on the tree shows the overall design for the whole ‘page’, with red
lines showing the position of the margins.
NOTE: Each Page Type has its own Properties dialog for setting up features such as
individual header, footer, print orientation and margins.
These can be renamed by right mouse clicking on the required page and selecting
Rename page, then, on the dialog, enter the New name.
Note that the working design area displayed (the region between the header and the footer
onto which you can drop objects) will be equal to twice the normal height of the template
page. That is, the space occupied by the footer for the first design page and the header for
the second design page will not be included. This is so that the design area accurately
reflects the space that is available on the two pages.
612 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The intervening header and footer will not be shown in design mode, to permit the
manipulation of section contents across the page break, but of course these would be
present in a preview or printed report. The headers and footer for multiple design pages will
always be identical.
The break between the pages will be indicated with a distinctive line style. In this example a
section is shown covering most of the two pages. The primary need for this new feature is
no allow the generation of reports where the required contents of a section are too large to
be accommodated on a single design page.
1. Drag the lower edge of a section (existing or newly dropped on the page) off the
bottom of the page layout (even though the section outline does not extend below the
top of the footer, the drag cursor indicates the section boundary can be dropped below
the page). This means below the page footer (if one exists) and hence implies that the
current zoom factor allows the bottom of the page to be seen (see example below).
2. When you release the mouse button, a confirmation dialog is displayed, asking Do you
want to create an additional design page for this section?.
3. If the you respond No then the section will be sized to the bottom of the existing page
and no additional design page will be created.
If the you respond Yes then an additional design continuation page is created and the
display changes to the following format.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 613
1. Select Center and Zoom Options from the Actions menu and set your desired
parameters.
The zoom factor defined in the Center and Zoom Options is completely separate from the
‘global’ zoom factor defined in the Zoom dialog displayed from the Zoom in the View menu
command or using the toolbar control.
NOTE: The zoom behavior is an optional feature of Center and Zoom, which can be disabled
separately from the basic Center and Zoom menu option or toolbar button.
Centering the object will not be possible, or necessary, at some zoom levels. For example if
the whole page is displayed then the object may not be ‘centered’ depending on its location
on the page but it will be visible. The page display will never introduce space above the
header in order to center an object. True centering behavior will only be required at higher
zoom factors, where only a part of the page is visible.
When the Center and Zoom option is turned off the page display will revert to the ‘global’
zoom factor.
614 . UV WinLab Software Guide
When the tree has sub-branches they can be opened and collapsed by clicking on the + or -
sign.
Selecting Header/Footer on the Template level adds Header/Footer to the tree under
the Template level.
Selecting Different on page one on the Template level adds Page One to tree under
Header and/or Footer level.
Selecting additional page types on the Template level adds extra Page items to tree
(Page Type 1, Page Type 2, etc.) under Template level.
Adding items to a page adds the objects to the tree under the relevant Page level, at
multiple levels such that Sections, Tools and Objects are at different levels.
Opening a second template will add the details for that template to the bottom of the
tree.
You can also right-click on a page and select Rename page on the context menu, or right-
click on an item and select Rename item on the context menu.
Insert New First Page inserts a new page type at the top of the tree.
Insert New Page Before inserts a new page before the currently selected page.
Insert New Page After inserts a new page after the currently selected page.
Insert New Last Page inserts a new page type at the end of the tree.
Move Page Up moves the selected page up one position on the tree.
Move Page Down moves the selected page down one position on the tree.
PageTypeProperties opens the Page Type Properties dialog from where you can
customize margins, page orientation, headers, and footers.
RenamePage opens the Rename dialog from where you can rename the Page Type.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 615
Text Block
NOTE: When typing text into a Test Block, the text may not display properly at zoom levels
less than 100%. Set the zoom to 100% to see the proper text.
Text blocks can be used to create:
The mouse pointer changes to to show that the Text Block is selected.
2. Click on the page where you want the top left hand corner then, holding down the
mouse button, drag the mouse to the bottom right corner and release the mouse
button.
The text block is added to the page and the name is added to the Tree View.
Right-click on a blank area of the template page and chooses the Add Text command
from the context menu.
A text block will be automatically created at the point of the right-click (on the left, top
of the text block). The width of the text block will be such that it fills the space between
the point where you double-clicked and the next object to the right (or the margin). It
will initially contain no default text but the insertion point will appear at the left hand
side of the block, ready for text entry. When you enter some text and move focus to
another object the text block will resize to fit the text actually entered. If you move
focus from the text block without entering any text then the object will be automatically
deleted.
Click the mouse inside the inner box of the Text Block and then type in the text.
Position the cursor within the text in the Text Block where the object is required and
then insert the data object as above.
For example: The following results were created by [analyst name] using the task [task
name].
Using the Properties command to move and resize the Text Block:
OR
A Text Block can be formatted by selecting Properties from the Format menu
OR
Use the In from left and Down from top controls to position the block on the
page.
NOTE: If snap to grid is on, the top left corner will still snap to the grid.
Use Oversize text to determine what happens when a text object placed in the
block is too large for the block:
Select Truncate if you wish any text that does not fit within the Text Block to be
truncated.
Select Re-size block to fit if you wish the Text Box to resize to accommodate all the
text, and then select Vertically or Horizontally to decide which way the box will re-
size.
Use the Fill control to change the color inside the block.
Use the Horizontal and Vertical controls to determine how the object is aligned
inside the block.
Use the Spacing controls to determine the spacings used in the frame:
NOTE: If your template view if less than 100%, the text may display differently in the print
preview window. This is a function of the computer font display.
Use the Font, Size, Style, Color, and Underline controls to determine how the
text will look.
2. Click , or press DELETE, or right-click and from the menu select Delete.
The Text Block is deleted.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 619
1. Highlight the text within the Text Block using the mouse.
2. Press DELETE.
The text is deleted. 0.
1. Highlight the Data Object within the Text Block using the mouse.
2. Press DELETE.
The object is deleted. 0.
NOTE: The tool and Delete on the Edit menu or context menu will delete the whole
block.
NOTE: If you do make a mistake, use the Undo command on the Edit menu or click .
By default the Text Blocks are named TEXTX , where X is numerically incremented (TEXT1,
etc) for each new Text Block added to the template. You can rename the Text Block if you
wish.
1. Right-click on the Text Block in the Tree View and select Rename Item.
The Rename dialog is displayed.
2. Enter a new name in the New Name field and click OK.
The name in the Tree view and within the Text Block is updated.
620 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Table
Tables can be created where all the properties can be defined within Communiqué but the
data comes from the Parent Application when a report is generated.
2. Click on the page where you want the top left hand corner.
A default table with two rows and four columns will be placed on the template and
added to the Tree View.
OR
Right mouse click on the table and select Properties from the pop up menu that
appears.
The Table Properties dialog appears.
2. On the Table tab enter a new value for the Numberofcolumns and Numberofrows.
NOTE: Increasing the value will add a row to the bottom of the table or a column to the
right-hand side of the table. Decreasing the value will delete the bottom row of a
table or the column on the extreme right.
3. Click OK.
To add rows and/or columns in other positions or to delete specific rows and/or
columns:
2. Select Insert > Columns, to have as many columns as are selected are inserted to the
left of the selected columns. The new columns are blank.
OR
Select Insert > Rows, to have as many rows as are selected are inserted above the
selected rows. The new rows are blank.
1. Right mouse click on an empty cell and select Insert > Text from the pop up menu that
appears.
An empty text block is inserted into the cell.
OR
The mouse pointer changes to to show that the Text Block is selected.
NOTE: If a table is grouped with other objects you won't be able to change the table without
ungrouping it.
622 . UV WinLab Software Guide
2. Position the mouse cursor on the box at the lower left corner of the table and drag the
mouse as required to resize the table.
2. Position the mouse cursor on the box at the top left corner of the table and drag the
mouse to move the table.
OR
OR
Use the Preferred width control to set the width of the table.
Use the Number of columns and Number of rows controls to set the shape of
the table.
NOTE: The actual number of rows will depend on whether the table is set to expand
depending on data being loaded. You can define up to 50 rows here and have up to
9999 rows in the generated report.
Use the In from left and Down from top controls to position the table on the
page.
NOTE: If snap to grid is on, the top left corner will still snap to the grid.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 623
Use the Borders controls to determine how the table edges and lines between
cells will look.
Use the Next and Previous controls to select the required row.
Use the Setup controls to determine the settings for the selected row:
You can choose to have a Set height for the row by switching on the check box and
then entering a value.
For the first row, you can elect to Repeat first row as a header.
That row is then repeated at the top of each new page when the table splits over
pages.
Then select the way the rows will be populated from Available expansions by
building the required order in the Expand by list.
Set the Expansion Count of the item in the Expand by list to set the source of
the row count.
Use the Next and Previous controls to select the required column and then use
the Setup controls to set the Width and the Name as required.
Set the Expansion Count of the item in the Expand by list to set the source of
the row count.
Check Repeat column on each new page to sets the specified column to be
repeated if the table rolls over onto another page at run time.
NOTE: This tab displays the settings for the current selection of cells. Where all selected
cells share the same setting for a parameter that value will be shown; where the cells
have different settings then no value will be shown.
Use the Horizontal and Vertical controlsto set how the contents will be
positioned.
Use the General formatting controls to determine the font and fill color used in
the cell.
Use the Number formatting controls to determine how numerical data will be
displayed.
624 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Use the Formatting for a null result to determine what happens if the required
data for a cell is not available.
Use the Object fit controls to determine what happens if the incoming data object
is larger than the cell.
You can access the Filter, Sort, Group dialog from the Rows tab and the Columns tab of the
Table Properties dialog when an item in the "Expand by list" is selected and the Filter, Sort,
Group button is clicked.
4. Click a DataItem cell and select a data item from the drop down list.
7. Check or uncheck the Enable sort checkbox to determine whether or not sort
conditions will be applied to the specified collection.
8. Select a data item by which to sort the collection first from the Sort by drop down
menu.
9. From the Type drop down menu corresponding to the sort by field, select the mode of
sorting.
10. If you wish to sort the collection further, use the Then by fields and the corresponding
Type fields to select a data item and mode of sorting.
12. From the Group By drop down menu, select the data item by which to sort the
collection first.
Note: See How do I use Statistics Rows? for more information on defining statistics rows for
a group.
You can access the Filter and Sort dialog from the Columns tab of the Tables Properties
dialog when an item in the "Expand by list" is selected and the Filter and Sort button is
clicked.
The behavior of the Filter and Sort tab pages is the same as that described in How do I
Filter, Sort, and Group Rows?
Use the Horizontal and Vertical controls to set the positioning of the object within
its frame.
Use the Currency symbol, Decimal separator, Digit grouping character, and
Negative indicator to control how your currency is displayed.
Use Number of digits after the decimal to set the number of digits to appear
after the decimal symbol.
Use the Horizontal control to set the position of the contents across the statistics
row. Use the Vertical control to set the position of the contents vertically in the
statistics row.
Select the number format using Significant figures, Decimal places, Absolute
number, Scientific (If On enables exponents), and Force rounding.
Select the Calculation option to use raw data or data as formatted in the table for
the statistics calculations.
Use raw data calculates statistics on the full original data in the data source. Use
formatted data calculates statistics on the data as it is shown in the relevant
column of the report.
Include a 0 before the decimal separator if the value is between -1 and +1.
Add zeros as required to make up decimal digits to the number defined by Number of
digits after decimal on the Object tab.
Use the Font, Size, Style, Color, and Underline controls to determine how the
text will look.
1. Select the table and then select Properties from the Format menu
OR
3. In the Based on column, select the grouping you want to do statistics on.
The available groups depend on your application.
4. In the Perform on column, select the column you want to perform statistics on.
Only columns set to display numerical data will be available.
6. In the Display as column, enter any text you want to appear before the calculated
number.
NOTE: To remove a statistics row, click in the far left column to select the row and then click
Delete row.
1. If you wish to format a statistics row, select the row and click FormatStatistics.
The Format Statistics dialog appears.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 627
2. If you selected a Numeric data type option on the Statistics Rows dialog, then define
the Alignment, Format, and Calculation settings from the Format Statistics dialog.
OR
If you selected a Currency data type option on the Statistics Rows dialog, then define
the Alignment, Symbols, and Digits settings from the Format Statistics dialog.
OR
Select the Index (Current, First, or Last) for each parent collection to define the
number of expanded rows.
2. Click , or press DELETE, or right-click and from the menu select Delete.
The Table is deleted. 0.
1. From the tree view, select the data object within the Table.
2. Click , or press DELETE, or right-click and from the menu select Delete.
The Data Object is deleted.
628 . UV WinLab Software Guide
2. Press DELETE.
The text is deleted. 0.
NOTE: The tool and Delete on the Edit menu or context menu will delete the whole
block.
NOTE: If you do make a mistake, use the Undo command on the Edit menu, or click .
1. Right-click on the Table in the Tree View and select Rename Item.
The Rename dialog is displayed.
2. Enter a new name in the New Name field and click OK.
The name in the Tree view and within the Table is updated.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 629
Graphic
Graphics, for example a company logo, can be imported into the Template. They can be
placed in the Header, Footer or main part of the page.
The Graphic can be moved and resized using the mouse or by accessing the Properties
dialog for the selected graphic.
NOTE: You can access the Properties dialog for a selected object by selecting Properties
from Format menu, or by right clicking on the object and selecting Properties from
the pop up menu that appears.
OR
Select the graphic and from the Format menu select Properties.
OR
Use the Size controls to set the exact size you require.
OR
Use the Scale controls to set the size of the graphic as a percentage of its original
size.
Select Keep aspect ratio if you want to ensure that the graphic retains its aspect
ratio.
When the Height is changed, the Width resets to keep the original aspect ratio, and
vice-versa.
Use the In from left and Down from top controls to position the graphic on the
page.
NOTE: If snap to grid is on, the top left corner will still snap to the grid.
2. Click , or press DELETE, or right-click and select Delete from the pop up menu that
appears.
The Graphic is deleted.
3. Enter a new name in the New Name field and click OK.
The name is updated. 0.
632 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Equation
Equations can be used to place a result on the page, or populate a cell or column, when a
Report is generated.
By using conditional formatting, you can also set up special formatting or actions to occur if
the result of the equation fits certain criteria. This action requires a numeric data type.
While previewing if an equation is encountered, Communiqué will check for the immediate
container where the equation is placed and depending on this container the data-item source
index mentioned in the Equation Text will be evaluated. All together there are 5-different
index styles, which you can specify. They are:
1. First: Communiqué will get the 1st index value from the data object when this index
text is specified on the data-item source. This can be used in Absolute and Relative
situations.
2. Previous: Communiqué will get the one back index value as compared to the current
index from the data object when this index text is specified on the data-item source.
Mainly used on Relative situations where ‘Current’ is dynamically referred based on the
repeating iteration.
3. Next: Communiqué will get the one next index value as compared to the current index
from the data object when this index text is specified on the data-item source. This is
mainly used on Relative situations where ‘Current’ is dynamically referred based on the
repeating iteration.
4. Last: Communiqué will get the index value based on the total count of a particular
source collection from the data object. This can be used in Absolute and Relative
situations.
5. Current: Communiqué will get the ongoing running index based on the iterating object
(iterating object can be either a Section or a Table or Object Frame). This is specifically
used in Relative situations.
Communiqué evaluates all the Equations in Phases based on whether the equation is placed
on a Section or a Table and so while looping through all the inside-items of Section/Table if
the item is of type ‘Equation’ the equation text will be evaluated based on the iterating index
but if the equation has any Conditional formatting criteria specified then this will be
evaluated in next phase i.e. after evaluating the Equation-text for all the Equations on a
template (this is done in-order to gather all the dependent equation results for the evaluating
condition.)
UV WinLab Software Guide . 633
2. Click on the page where you want the result of the equation to be displayed.
This can be either directly on the page, or within a table.
When you release the mouse button, the equation is placed on the page and the
Equation Builder dialog is displayed.
2. Create the Equation by typing in the field and/or selecting elements from the three lists
below.
To select an item from one of the lists, position the cursor where required in the
equation, then simply double-click on the required Operator, Data or Other equation
and it appears in the Equation.
OR select an item from one of the lists, position the cursor where required in the
equation, then press the space bar on the required Operator, Data or Other equation
and it appears in the Equation.
3. When a data object is inserted in the equation, the display will show how that object
is set up, including indexes within square brackets, [].
By default, the indexing will be set to Current for all, for example an equation to create
the square of a concentration value would look like:
Sqr({Samples[Current].Replicates[Current].Conc})
NOTE: The data object must be a numeric and/or currency object in order for equations to
work. Some applications may not have numeric and/or currency objects as part of
their data model.
4. Clicking on one of the indexes will display the current list of possible indexes,
enabling you to select the one required.
The default list for indexing is Current, First, Last, Next,Previous, All, and New
Keyword,but you can enter your own terms using the Organize keywords command
on the Tools menu. For example if you have a software application that identifies peaks
by a name, then you can use that name for indexing. Indexing can be used for the
eight functions of: Sum, Mean, Count, %RSD, RMS, SD, Min, and Max.
NOTE: In most cases the index of Current will suffice, other indices are used to construct
complex equations or instances where you need to take for example the result of one
sample from the sample before it (previous), or need to work with a named peak.
6. When you have completed the equation, click Check to check the general construction
of the equation is correct.
If the equation has been set up correctly, the message Syntax is correct will be
displayed.
If there is a problem with the equation, the message Syntax is incorrect will be
displayed.
7. To format the value that will result from this equation, click Format Result.
The Numeric Data Object Properties dialog or the Currency Data Object Properties
dialog appears depending upon the Result Type you selected.
8. If you selected a Numeric Result Type, then select the Alignment and Format
required and then click OK.
The formatting will be applied to the calculated result.
If you selected a Currency Result type, then select the Alignment, Symbols, and
Digits required and then click OK.
9. Click OK.
The equation is created and appears on the page, in the Custom Objects section of the
Object Toolbox, and in the Other equations list in the Equation Builder next time you
use it.
Conditional formatting is used to highlight particular results from the equation. This is set up
using an 'if, then, else' type logic.
Replace with text – uses the text entered in the field below instead of the number
generated by the equation or data field. You can also Change Font.
Add text – adds the text entered in the field below after the number calculated.
You can also Change Font.
Change font – displays the calculated number but changes the font as set by
Change Font.
Remove row – is used when the equation is in a table and takes the relevant row
out of the table.
Don’t display section – stops the section selected in the field below from being
displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 635
5. Set the 'Else' conditional formatting to happen if the criteria is not met.
The options are the same as above.
To re-use an equation elsewhere on the template, simply select it from the Custom
Objects section of the Objects toolbox and click on the page where you want it.
OR
Select the equation on the page and then select Properties, either from the
Format menu or the right-click menu.
The Equation Builder is displayed with the details of the equation loaded ready to be
edited.
NOTE: Because once you create an equation it can be used elsewhere, when you edit an
equation you must give the edited version a new name. If you had used this
equation in more than one place and need to change it in all places simply go round
deleting the old equation and replacing it with the new one from the Custom Objects
section of the Objects Toolbox.
2. Click , or press DELETE, or right-click and from the menu select Delete.
The Equation is deleted from the template, but still exists in the Custom Objects section
of the Objects Toolbox for re-use later.
You can delete the old equation from the Custom Objects by right clicking on it in the
Custom Objects section of the Objects Toolbox and selecting Delete.
636 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: All calculations done with equations are performed using the full precision of the
number. The formatting (decimal places, significant figures, scientific notation, etc) is
applied after the calculation is complete.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 637
Page Break
A Page Break can be added to a page to force a break after a particular object.
The mouse pointer changes to to show that the Page Break is selected.
2. Click the mouse on the page at the position you require the Page Break.
A Page Breakis added to the Template and the name is added to the Tree View.
1. Click on the Page Break or click on the name of the Page Break in the Tree view to
select it.
The border of the Page Break turns blue to show that it is selected.
2. Click , or press DELETE, or right-click and from the menu select Delete.
The Page Break is deleted.
By default the Page Breaks are named PAGEBREAKX , where X is numerically incremented
(PAGEBREAK1 etc) for each new Page Break added to the template. You can rename the
Page Break if you wish.
1. Right-click on the Page Break in the Tree View and select Rename Item.
The Rename dialog is displayed.
2. Enter a new name in the New Name field and click OK.
The name in the Tree view is updated.
638 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Edit Border
You can create a border around a previously placed text block, graphic, equation, data
object, group or section. The styling of the line can then be set.
NOTE: You cannot add a border to a Table, table borders are set in the formatting of the
table itself. See How do I format a table?
OR
Use the Padding tools to set the distance between the border line and the object
that you wish to place a border.
Using Keep symmetrical makes all the padding the same.
Use the Style, Weight and Color controls to define the actual line used for the
border.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 639
1. Select the item with the border and then select Format > Edit Border again.
OR
Right mouse click on the item with the border, select Properties from the pop up
menu, and then select the Border tab.
Edit Caption
You can create a caption to a previously placed tool, object, group or section. This will create
a single line of text (no word-wrap) so the number of characters that can be used is basically
dependent on the font. The caption is placed outside of the object.
A caption can be added using the layout tool or by using the Edit Caption
command on the Format menu.
Edit Caption is also available from the menu displayed when you right-click on an
object.
NOTE: Adding a caption creates a single line of text. There is no word-wrap. The caption is
placed outside of the object.
3. Select the required options as explained in the table below and click OK.
The caption is added to the object.
2. From the Format menu, or the right mouse click menu, select Edit caption.
The Edit caption dialog is displayed.
OR
Line Color Select the color of the border around the caption from the
drop-down list of available colors.
Line Weight Select the thickness of the line around the caption from the
drop-down list of available line weights.
Fill Color Select the fill color for the caption from the drop-down list of
available colors.
Position Select the position of the caption. Select either Above, Below,
Left or Right.
Alignment Select the alignment of the caption. Select either Left, Right or
Center.
Orientation Select the orientation of the caption.
Keep symmetrical Select Keep symmetrical to keep all the padding the same. The
Bottom, Left and Right selectors are not available if Keep
symmetrical is selected.
Top, Left, Bottom, Padding selectors. Select the padding - that is, the distance
Right between the border line and the object being bordered. Select a
value between 0 and 20.
1. Select the item with the caption and then select Edit Caption again.
Section
Sections can be used both to create a set of objects that gets repeated based on some
grouping you define (for example, for each sample) or to enable you to have a part of the
template that you can switch on and off when you print a report.
NOTE: You can still add items to the section once it has been created.
2. Click on the page where you want the top left hand corner then, holding down the
mouse button, drag the mouse to the bottom right corner and release the mouse
button.
The idea is to surround the objects that you wish to include in the section.
A dashed line appears around the section.
When the mouse is released the Format Section dialog is displayed.
The section is added to the tree view and the items in the section become sub-branches
of the section.
Simply select the layout tool or data object as normal and place it within the
section.
NOTE: You can easily tell what is and isn't part of a section by looking at the tree view.
The section can be moved and resized using the mouse or the Format command.
2. Position the mouse inside the section, but not on any of the items in it.
The mouse changes to a four-headed arrow.
Using the Format command to move and resize the Text Block:
OR
NOTE: Moving or re-sizing the section may make it look like items placed on the page earlier
are now part of the section. This is not true, and the best way to tell what is actually
part of the section is to look at the tree view as items within a section appear as sub-
branches of the section.
OR
On the dialog:
Use the In from left and Down from top controls to position the section on the
page.
NOTE: If snap to grid is on, the top left corner will still snap to the grid.
Use Repeat section based on to set whether this is a repeating section, and if
so what makes the section repeat.
NOTE: You can use nested sections for example to have a set of items repeat for each
replicate, and then have an enveloping set of items that repeats for each sample.
Click Filter and Sort to display the dialog to filter and sort the data associated
with this section.
Use Allow section to be switched off to set whether the section can be turned
off before a report is printed.
When this option is selected, the name of the selected section is added to the print
dialog.
OR
Select the Index (Current, First, or Last) for each parent collection to define the
number of expanded rows.
2. Click , or press DELETE, or right-click and from the menu select Delete.
The section, and all the items in it, is deleted.
2. Click , or press DELETE, or right-click and from the menu select Delete.
The item is deleted. 0.
2. Select Cut from the Edit menu or the right mouse click menu.
The item is removed from the section, onto the clipboard.
3. Place the cursor where you want the item moved to, and select Paste from the Edit
menu or the right mouse click menu.
The item is placed on the page and is no longer part of the section, as can be seen from
the tree view.
1. Right-click on the section in the Tree View and select Rename Item.
The Rename dialog is displayed.
2. Enter a new name in the New Name field and click OK.
The name in the Tree view and within the section is updated.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 645
Create Group
Grouping items can enable you to move them easily, draw a border around a set of items, or
create a custom object made up of a set of items. Once a group is created it has a Properties
dialog.
NOTE: You can also group items using the menu commands, as described in Grouping
items.
2. Click on the page where you want the top left hand corner then, holding down the
mouse button, drag the mouse to the bottom right corner and release the mouse
button.
The idea is to surround the objects that you wish to include in the group.
A yellow background shows what is in the group.
The group is added to the tree view and the items in the group become sub-branches of
the group.
2. Position the mouse inside the group, but not on any of the items in it.
The mouse changes to a four-headed arrow.
2. Click , or press DELETE, or right-click and from the menu select Delete.
All the items in the group are deleted.
To make any changes, select the group and then select Ungroup from the
Format menu or the right mouse click menu.
646 . UV WinLab Software Guide
1. Right-click on the group in the Tree View and select Rename Item.
The Rename dialog is displayed.
2. Enter a new name in the New Name field and click OK.
The name in the Tree view and within the group is updated.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 647
Insert H Line
Horizontal lines can be added to divide up different areas of the report.
The mouse pointer changes to to show that the horizontal line is selected.
2. Drag the mouse onto the page and draw a line in the position you require and of the
approximate size you require.
The horizontal line is added to the page and the name is added to the Tree View.
The horizontal line can be moved and resized using the mouse or the Properties command.
NOTE: This only applies if the line has not been set to Fit across page.
On the dialog:
Fit across page sets the line to the width of the page.
Including or excluding the margin as selected by Inside margins.
Use the In from left and Down from top controls to position the line on the page.
NOTE: If snap to grid is on, the top left corner will still snap to the grid.
Use Style, Weight and Color to set the style of the line.
2. Click , or press DELETE, or right-click and from the menu select Delete.
The line is deleted. 0.
1. Right-click on the line in the Tree View and select Rename Item.
The Rename dialog is displayed.
2. Enter a new name in the New Name field and click OK.
The name in the tree view is updated.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 649
Insert V Line
Vertical lines can be added to divide up different areas of the report.
The mouse pointer changes to to show that the vertical line is selected.
2. Drag the mouse onto the page and draw a line in the position you require and of the
approximate size you require.
The vertical line is added to the page and the name is added to the Tree View.
The horizontal line can be moved and resized using the mouse or the Properties command.
NOTE: This only applies if the line has not been set to Fit Length of Page.
On the dialog:
Fit length of page sets the line to the height of the page.
Including or excluding the margin as selected by Inside margins.
Use the In from left and Down from top controls to position the line on the page.
NOTE: If snap to grid is on, the top left corner will still snap to the grid.
Use Style, Weight and Color to set the style of the line.
2. Click , or press DELETE, or right-click and from the menu select Delete.
The line is deleted. 0.
1. Right-click on the line in the Tree View and select Rename Item.
2. Enter a new name in the New Name field and click OK.
The name in the tree view is updated.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 651
Text objects – both individual text items and full blocks of text.
Numeric objects – both numbers set by a user in the parent application and numbers
generated when samples are run.
Special objects – there are special objects generated by the parent application that are
shown as in the Data Objects list.
NOTE: Not all data object types may be present in each data source.
1. Select the required Data Object from the list of available Data Objects.
The mouse pointer changes to to show that a data object has been selected.
NOTE: Data objects marked create a frame that other objects of the same type can also
be added to. Creating one container with multiple objects, for example a spectral
graph with two spectra on it.
The properties of a data object can be set by selecting the object and then
selecting Properties from the Format menu.
OR
Use the Horizontal and Vertical controls to set the positioning of the object within
its frame.
Use the Between lines and Between paragraphs controls to set the paragraph
spacings for large blocks of text.
652 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Use the Height (inches) and Width (inches) to set the size of the data object
Use In from left (inches) and Down from top (inches) to set the position relative
to the top edge of the page.
Use the Truncate andResize block to fit controls to deal with oversized blocks of
text.
Use the Font, Size, Style, Color, and Underline controls to determine how the
text will look.
The properties of a data object can be set by selecting the object and then
selecting Properties from the Format menu.
OR
Use the Horizontal and Vertical controls to set the positioning of the object within
its frame.
Use the Format controls to set the way the number itself will be formatted.
This enables you to set exactly how this particular number object will be displayed.
NOTE: If you want to change the default setting for numbers to be displayed, use the
Default number format command on the Properties dialog. This will change the
formatting for all new numeric data objects added to the template.
Use the Height (inches) and Width (inches) to set the size of the data object
Use In from left (inches) and Down from top (inches) to set the position relative
to the top edge of the page.
Use the Font, Size, Style, Color, and Underline controls to determine how the
text will look.
The properties of a data object can be set by selecting the object and then
selecting Properties from the Format menu
OR
Use the Horizontal and Vertical controls to set the positioning of the object within
its frame.
Use the DateFormat controls to determine whether the date is displayed for this
particular object and set the date format.
Use the Time format controls to determine whether the time is displayed for this
particular object and set the time format, including:
Original time – The time zone the data was collected in.
NOTE: If you want to change the default setting for all times and dates to be displayed in,
use the Default date/time format command on the Properties dialog. This will
change the formatting for all new objects added to the template.
Use the Layout controls to determine how the object should be laid out when
both the time and date are included.
Use the Preview section to see how the settings you have selected here will look.
Use the Height (inches) and Width (inches) to set the size of the data object
Use In from left (inches) and Down from top (inches) to set the position relative
to the top edge of the page.
Use the Font, Size, Style, Color, and Underline controls to determine how the
text will look.
The properties of a data object can be set by selecting the object and then
selecting Properties from the Format menu.
OR
NOTE: If the parent application uses currency settings they will over-ride these settings.
Use the Horizontal and Vertical controls to set the positioning of the object within
its frame.
Use the Currency symbol, Decimal separator, Digit grouping character, and
Negative indicator to control how your currency is displayed.
Use Number of digits after the decimal to set the number of digits to appear
after the decimal symbol.
Include a 0 before the decimal separator if the value is between –1 and +1.
Add zeros as required to make up decimal digits to the number defined by Number of
digits after decimal on the Object tab.
Use the Height (inches) and Width (inches) to set the size of the data object
Use In from left (inches) and Down from top (inches) to set the position relative
to the top edge of the page.
Use the Truncate andResize block to fit controls to deal with oversized blocks of
text.
Use the Font, Size, Style, Color, and Underline controls to determine how the
text will look.
Select multiple objects by holding the Shift key and clicking on each object you want to
select
Multiple objects may be selected within a single section but objects may not be selected
within several sections at once. Nor may objects within a section be selected at the
same time as objects outside the section.
Multiple data objects may be selected within a table but not within several tables at
once. Nor may objects within a table be selected at the same time as objects outside
the table. Nor may data objects and table cells be selected at the same time.
A group may be selected together with other objects but objects within a group cannot
be selected.
The general principle for editing properties of multiple objects is that the tabs common to all
the selected objects will be included in the Properties dialog, but the following tabs will never
be displayed in the case of multiple objects:
Caption – Since displaying the ‘common’ property values would not indicate which of
the objects currently had captions and which did not it would be too easy to overwrite
an existing caption accidentally if this tab were shown.
Location – The size and position of several objects can be set more efficiently with the
‘Align’ commands.
NOTE: V Line, H Line and Table objects share none of the relevant tabs with other objects,
so whenever one of these is included in a multiple selection the Properties
command is disabled.
Graphic, Equation, Section, Group and ActiveX Object Frame objects only share the
Border property with other objects, so whenever these objects are included with a
multiple selection only the Border tab is displayed in the Properties dialog. When
the objects are within a table then the Properties command is disabled.
Text Block, Text data, Numeric data, Date/Time and Currency objects share both
Font and Border tabs. Therefore when the multiple selection consists only of objects
from this group then both these tabs are displayed. When the selections are within a
table then only the Font tab is displayed.
656 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Exceptions to this rule are the Table, Equation and Section objects. Because of their
complex nature it is inappropriate to attempt to set common properties and so these are
treated as special cases. When multiple tables are selected the properties command is
disabled. When multiple equations or sections are selected the Properties dialog contains
only the Border tab.
Selecting the object and then selecting Properties from the Format menu.
OR
The properties of an object can be set by selecting the object and then
selecting Properties from the Format menu.
OR
Use the Height and Width controls to set the size of the frame.
Use the In from left and Down from top controls to set the position of the frame
on the page.
NOTE: If snap to grid is on, the top left corner will still snap to the grid.
Use the Fill control to set the background color of the frame.
Use the Horizontal and Vertical controls to set the position of the object within the
frame.
Use the Fit controls to determine what happens if the object is a different size to
the frame:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 657
Selecting Fit to frame will resize the incoming object to the size of the frame. Multiple
objects will be tiled.
NOTE: The Fit to frame will occur when the report is rendered (using Preview or Print.
When the Object Frame and its associated ActiveX control are displayed in the
design environment there is always a small gap between the ActiveX and its Object
Frame container. This gap is there to allow selection of the Object Frame and also so
that additional copies of the ActiveX control can be dropped in the same frame (for
example, when creating overlaid plots). But this is purely for display purposes.
When the report is displayed or printed and the Fit to frame option is set then the
size of the ActiveX will be the size set in the Object Frame Properties and no less.
Selecting Keep original size will keep the size of the incoming object, resizing the
frame to accommodate the object, and using the top left corner as the anchor point.
Selecting Scale on height will rescale the incoming object so the height is the same as
the frame, but it will increase the width if necessary to ensure the aspect ratio is
maintained.
Selecting Scale on width will rescale the incoming object so the width is the same as
the frame, but it will increase the height if necessary to ensure the aspect ratio is
maintained. In from left and Down from top settings are maintained.
Use the Repeat based on control to set up the control to repeat for each instance
of the set parameter.
For example, if the control was a graph and samples was selected for the repeat then
you would get each sample on its own graph, whereas if samples was not set here, all
the samples would appear on one graph.
When the Object Frame and its associated ActiveX control are displayed in the design
environment, there is always a small gap between the ActiveX and its Object Frame
container. This gap is there to allow selection of the Object Frame and also so that
additional copies of the ActiveX control can be dropped in the same frame (for example,
when creating overlaid plots).
1. After dropping the ActiveX controls into the small gap area, move the mouse pointer
2. Use the Font, Size, Style, Color, and Underline controls to determine how the text
will look.
Use the Preview to see how the text will look.
3. Click OK.
From now on, all data objects and text added to the template will use this new font.
Having selected the object, select Indexing from the Format menu.
On the Indexing dialog you can set the particular index for each possible choice as listed
in the first column.
If there is more than one item on the object then you will get more than one Index tab.
The default list for indexing is Current, First, Last, NextPrevious, and All but you can
enter your own terms, for example if you have a software application that identifies
peaks by a name, then you can use that name for indexing.
When a new term, or keyword, is entered it then becomes available from the drop down
list the next time you start the Indexing dialog and these keywords can be organized by
selecting Organize keywords on the Tools menu.
2. Click , or press DELETE, or right-click and from the menu select Delete.
The object is deleted. 0.
1. Highlight the Data Object within the Text Block using the mouse.
2. Press DELETE.
The object is deleted. 0.
NOTE: The tool and Delete on the context menu will delete the whole text block.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 659
3. Enter a new name in the New Name field and click OK.
The name in the Tree view and within the Data Object is updated.
660 . UV WinLab Software Guide
1. Select an item or multiple items and then select Create custom object from the
Actions menu or click .
OR
Create a Group of items and then select Create custom object from the Actions menu
or click .
OR
Create a Section and then select Create custom object from the Actions menu or click
.
The Name custom object dialog is displayed.
1. From the Custom Objects section of the Objects Toolbox, select the required object or
equation.
The mouse pointer changes to to show that the Custom Object is selected, or to
2. From the list, highlight the object that you wish to move, rename or delete.
2. Select the custom object from the list and click Rename.
The Rename Custom Object dialog is displayed.
3. Enter a New Name for the Custom Object and click OK.
4. The Organize Custom Objects dialog and the Custom Objects list in the Objects Toolbox
is updated with the new name.
2. Select the custom object from the list and click Delete.
You are asked to confirm the deletion.
1. Select the item to be selected in the Custom Objects section of the Objects Toolbox.
3. On the dialog, choose where to save the custom object and give it a name.
Indexing
Where an object can potentially be one of a collection of items, you can set the specific
instance using indexing.
Indexing is used for all data objects and equation terms that could potentially be one of a
collection. Each indexing term is called a keyword and the default list of keywords for
indexing is Current, First, Last, Next, Previous, and All but you can enter new words as
long as they will be understood by the Parent Application.
Having selected the object, select Indexing from the Format menu or the right
mouse click menu.
On the Indexing dialog you can set the particular index for each possible Collection as
listed in the first column.
If there is more than one item on the object then you will get more than one Index tab.
The default list for indexing is Current, First, Last, Next, Previous, and All, but you
can enter your own terms, for example if you have a software application that identifies
peaks by a name, then you can use that name for indexing.
When a new term, or keyword, is entered it then becomes available from the drop down
list the next time you start the Indexing dialog and these keywords can be organized by
selecting Organize keywords on the Tools menu.
NOTE: In most cases the index of Current will suffice, other indices are used to construct
complex equations or instances where you need to take for example the result of one
sample from the sample before it (previous), or need to work with a named peak.
NOTE: When using objects, you can place multiple objects of the same type into one
frame. When you then select indexing for this frame the Indexing dialog will have
multiple tabs, one for each object.
1. When a data object is inserted in the equation, the display will show how that object is
set up, including indexes within square brackets, [].
By default, the indexing will be set to Current for all, for example an equation to create
the square of a concentration value would look like:
Sqr({Tasks[Current].Samples[Current].Replicates[Current].Conc})
2. Clicking on one of the indexes will display the current list of possible indexes,
enabling you to select the one required.
The default list for indexing is Current, First, Last, Next and Previous, but you can
enter your own terms using the Organize keywords command on the Tools menu. For
example if you have a software application that identifies peaks by a name, then you
can use that name for indexing.
NOTE: In most cases the index of Current will suffice, other indices are used to construct
complex equations or instances where you need to take for example the result of one
sample from the sample before it (previous), or need to work with a named peak.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 663
How do I use Indexing to get the iteration count for parent collections of a
sub-collection?
The Expansion Count button appears on both the Rows and Columns tabs. The Expansion
Count button is enabled when ‘Enables column to expand’ is checked and a selection
appears in the ‘Expand by’ drop–down list. Here you can set the index of any parent
collection that contains the sub-collection you are about to iterate.
OR
Select the Index (Current, First, or Last) for each parent collection to define the
number of expanded rows.
4. Use the Move up and Move down controls to determine the order you want the drop
down list of keywords to appear.
The All index can be useful for calculations that involve more than one piece of data (i.e. an
Average of data points). For example, if you wish to know the average concentration for a
set of samples the following equation would calculate that for them:
Mean{Tasks[Current].Samples[ALL].Conc}]
664 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Order items so that one item is overlaid on another in the correct order.
Use the Create Group Layout Tool, , and draw around the objects you want
to group.
OR
Select the required items by holding down SHIFT and clicking on them, and then
select Group objects on the Actions menu or click .
OR
Select the required items by holding down SHIFT and clicking on them, and then
right-click on one of the items and select Group from the menu displayed.
When items are grouped a border is drawn around them and a yellow background color
is displayed. A group level is also inserted on the Tree View and the items in the group
are moved to sub-branches.
NOTE: Once items are placed in a group, there is nothing you can do with them until you
ungroup them again.
Right-click on the yellow background and select Ungroup from the menu
displayed.
OR
Select the group on the Tree View and then select Ungroup objects from the
Actions menu or click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 665
Select the item you want to change the order of and the select the required
option from the Order objects sub menu off the Actions menu.
OR
Right-click on the item required and select an option from the Order objects sub
menu of the menu displayed.
OR
Select the item you want to change the order of and click the correct toolbar
icon.
Menu Icon Action
Command
Bring to front Brings current object to the front of
all others.
Send to back Sends current object to the back of
all the others.
Bring forward Brings current object forward one
level.
Send backward Sends current object back one level.
Select the required items by holding down SHIFT and clicking on the items, then
select the required alignment from the Align sub menu on the Format menu.
Switch on the Snap to grid control on the Template level of the Tree View.
All objects placed on the page will move to the nearest grid lines.
A four-headed arrow cursor will move the item, a horizontal or vertical two-headed
cursor will resize the selected edge, and a diagonal two-headed cursor will resize from
the selected corner.
Select the required item and use the arrow keys on the keyboard to move the
item.
Select the required item and hold down SHIFT and use the arrow keys to expand
an edge of the item.
666 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To turn the grid on, select Grid from the View menu.
OR
OR
How do I change the gradations on the ruler from inches to metric and
vice-versa?
2. Select mm, cm or inches from the drop-down list and click OK.
The dialog closes and the rulers are updated.
The Status field (located on the bottom of the Communiqué window) provides feedback. This
is particularly useful during multiple operations such as importing or exporting multiple
templates.
Import… – Imports one (or more) report template(s) from a file (or files) into the
Communiqué database.
Export… – Exports one or more report templates from the Communiqué database to a file
(or files).
Archive… – Moves one or more selected templates or stored reports to an archive file. Any
audit trail and event log records associated with the selected datasets are always included in
the archive.
Open Archive… – Enables you to select an archived data file and view the contents.
Restore… – Restores selected items in the archive file to the main Communiqué database.
Print Preview – Displays the selected reports in the Communiqué preview window.
Folder New Folder… – Creates a new folder as a child of the selected folder and allows
the user to enter a name for the folder.
Event Log tab - The Event Log list view shows ONLY those events that are not
associated with either a report or a template (‘general’ events). The Communiqué
Utilities is not intended as an environment to examine event logs because this can be
done quite adequately in the Communiqué Designer. The Utilities window is primarily
for management of the database. With reference to the event log this means archiving
and/or deleting sections of it.
668 . UV WinLab Software Guide
2. Choose the Define Template Filter command from the Options menu.
1. Select the desired report template in the list displayed on the Templates tab.
3. Select the desired path and enter a name for the exported file, in the Save As dialog.
1. Select the desired report in the list displayed on the Reports tab.
1. Select the desired report(s) or template(s) in the list on the appropriate tab.
3. On the Reports Archive or Templates Archive tab select the desired reports or
templates.
5. Select whether to restore the data to the original location (folder path) in the database
or to select a new root folder.
1. Select the desired report(s) or template(s) in the list on the appropriate tab.
1. Select the folder in the tree which is to be the parent of the new folder (to create a
folder at the highest level, select the ‘Folders’ node).
2. Choose the New Folder command from the File/Folder submenu or the Tree View
context menu.
Reports Filter
This defines the filter for displaying stored reports. The filter applies to both the normal
Reports tab view and also the Reports Archive tab view. The items listed in the dialog are all
properties of stored reports in the Communiqué database. The initial settings after
installation of the software is no items selected. Thereafter the last used set of conditions will
be remembered.
3. Select the appropriate operator (the available operators depend on the item type)
4. Enter or select the value(s) associated with the filter item (if any)
5. Click OK to save the filter definition and close the dialog (it will be applied if Apply
Report Filter is currently checked but not otherwise)
or
Click Apply to have the list updated immediately (Apply Report Filter is always set On
if the Apply button is clicked).
UV WinLab Software Guide . 671
Templates Filter
The filter applies to both the normal Templates tab view and also to the Templates Archive
tab view. The items listed in the dialog are all properties of stored templates in the
Communiqué database. One significant difference between this and the Reports Filter dialog
is that the initial default settings for the templates filter will not be to have all items
unchecked. The initial default is for only the latest versions of templates to be displayed.
3. Select the appropriate operator (the available operators depend on the item type).
4. Enter or select the value(s) associated with the filter item (if any)
5. Click OK to save the filter definition and close the dialog (it will be applied if Apply
Template Filter is currently checked but not otherwise)
OR
Click Apply to have the list updated immediately (Apply Template Filter is always set
On if the Apply button is clicked).
672 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Archiving Data
The archive process is fundamentally the same for all data types, although there may be
minor differences in how data are selected for archiving and in what related data are
archived.
You may select an existing archive file in the Archive dialog. The selected items will then be
added to the existing archive.
NOTE: An archive may then consist of different data types (templates, reports and event
logs).
To initiate the archive process:
Previewing a Template
The Print Preview window has two purposes. It enables the designer of a template to see
what it looks like with data and it enables the template to be reviewed, approved or locked
depending on the security settings of the Parent Application.
NOTE: To minimize font size distortion when approving documents, always display the
documents at 100%.
You can review or approve a template from the Print Preview dialog:
Reason – Only available if using electronic signatures. Shows the reason for the signature
as selected on the e-signature dialog.
Printing a Template
In the Communiqué main window, click or select Print from the File menu.
OR
Template with details - Prints the template and a full list of the properties of all
the components on it.
Template with signatures - Prints the template together with a page showing
the approval signatures for the template. This option is not available if electronic
signatures are not used by the parent application.
Template with details and signatures - Prints the template, a full list of
properties of all the components on it, and the approval signatures for the template.
Print hardcopy - Prints to the printer selected from the drop-down list of available
printers. Click Properties to display the printer properties.
NOTE: You can print as PDF files. This feature is possible only if you purchased and
installed Adobe Acrobat Writer on the target PC.
Print to database - Stores the report in the database in a Folder of your choice.
Select the number of Copies to print and if you want to Collate them.
676 . UV WinLab Software Guide
An Event Log is related to an Audit Trail (see above), and is used to record major events,
such as login, logout, password changes and system functions, in a 21 CFR Part 11 compliant
system.
2. Choose whether to View the Audit Trail, Event Log, or Audit Trail andEvent Log.
Within these views you can filter what data is displayed.
4. To order the items in the table, click on the required column heading.
To use the reverse order, click on the same column heading again.
1. To get the full details of an item in the Audit trail (but not the Event Log), double click
the item in the table.
A Details window is opened showing further information about that item.
Report IDs are unique for each instance of report generation. Thus, if all four forms of
‘persistent‘ report (a preview is transitory) are generated at the same time, each one will
have a different Report ID associated with it in the event log (and in the report itself if the
report includes the Report ID object).
NOTE: A new Report ID is not generated when a report saved to the database in reprinted.
Such a reprinted report will always show the original Report ID.
678 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Save Saves the current template, with the current name. If it hasn't been
saved before then this acts like Save As below.
Save As Displays a file selector to enable the template to be named and saved.
Once named this name replaces New Template in the Banner.
Print preview Enables the user to see how the template looks, as discussed in
Previewing a template.
Close Closes the currently selected template, asking whether to save any
Template changes first, as discussed in How do I open another template.
Redo Redoes up to the last 10 actions. This is only available if Undo has been
used.
Delete Deletes the selected tool or object. This is only available when one or
more objects are selected.
Rename... Enables you to change the name of a page or item on the tree view.
Rulers Turns the rulers on and off, enabling you to position things properly, as
discussed in How do I use the rulers?
Object Enables you to switch the view in the Object Toolbox between Layout
Toolbox Tools, Data Objects and Custom Objects.
Zoom Enables you to switch the view in the Main Pane as discussed in How do I
zoom in on the Main Pane?
Default font Displays a standard font selector, which becomes the default for all
objects on the template that have not been manually set to something
other than the original default. See How do I set Font properties?
Default Sets the default format for all numeric data objects on the template that
number have not been manually set to something other than the original default.
format See How do I set the properties of a numeric object?
Default Sets the default for all date/time data objects on the template that have
date/time not been manually set to something other than the original default. See
format How do I set the properties of a Date/Time object?
Edit Border Puts a border around a tool, object, section or group, just as the Edit
Border layout tool.
Edit Caption Puts a caption to a tool, object, section or group, just as the Edit Caption
layout tool.
Properties Displays the properties dialog for the currently selected object or objects.
Ungroup Enables you to break a grouping created previously. Only available when a
objects group is selected.
Center and A toggle switch that determines whether the page display is centered (and
Zoom optionally zoomed) when an object is selected in the tree view.
Center and Displays the Center and Zooms Options dialog from where you can set an
Zoom optional zoom factor associated with the object center feature.
Options
Create Displays a file selector to enable the user to save a special object,
custom populated table or group of items as a known object that will from then on
object appear under the Custom object selector. Only available if an object or
group of objects is selected. See Using Custom Data Objects.
Organize Displays a dialog that enables the user to add and delete words on the
keywords keyword list, as discussed in How do I organize my keywords?
Audit trail Displays the dialog used to view audit trails and event logs as discussed in
Displaying the Audit Trail and Event Log.
About Displays a dialog that shows what version of Communiqué this is.
Communiqué
UV WinLab Software Guide . 681
Cut Standard Windows clipboard behavior. Only available when one or more
objects are selected.
Copy Standard Windows clipboard behavior. Only available when one or more
objects are selected.
Group Groups selected objects. Only available when one or more objects are
selected.
Delete Deletes the selected tool or object. Only available when one or more
objects are selected.
Font... Displays the font dialog enabling the font to be set for the selected section
of text.
Format Displays the correct format dialog for the currently selected tool or object.
Object Will display the correct properties dialog for the selected object.
properties
Order Is a cascading menu that then has the commands Bring to front, Send to
objects back, Bring forward, and Send Backward. Only available when one or
more objects are selected.
682 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Other Interactions
There are other standard interactions with the software detailed below:
Exporting
You can export a template or custom object to disk so that it can be used on another PC.
NOTE: Before you can export a template, you must save it.
1. Select Export and then Template or Custom Object from the File menu.
2. On the file selector, choose where to save the item and give it a name.
Importing
You can import a template or custom object that was exported from another copy of
Communiqué.
3. Select Import and then Template or CustomObject from the File menu.
NOTE: If you import a template that uses fonts not available on your PC the template will
use a different font as set by the Windows operating system.
Change version - Will import the file with the same name but incremented version
number.
Change name - Will import the file with the new name you type in.
Zooming in is particularly useful when the text on a page is too small to read:
Select Zoom from the View menu and on the dialog displayed, select the required view:
You can set a Percentage either from the drop down list of 400, 200, 150, 100, 75, 50,
25, and 10, or by typing in any required number.
You can size the page to the Page width of the page.
You can size the page so that the Whole page can be seen.
For information about each of the data objects within the list, see
Global
Task List
Method List
Sample List
User List
Instrument List
System Data.
NOTE: The IPV data objects are listed but they are only ever populated in templates that are
associated with IPV tests. It is not possible to change the default templates that are
associated with the IPV tests. It is possible to edit the default templates but WE
STRONGLY RECOMMEND THAT YOU DO NOT DO THIS. Therefore, these data objects
will not be discussed in the Help.
NOTE: There are a number of report templates that are installed when you Add your
instrument. There is a default template for each base method that will produce a
simple report of your results. There is also a default template for each type of
method that will provide a summary of all the details of the task.
NOTE: Some UV WinLab Custom Data Objects are also provided. These include tables and
graphs, such as an expanding results table, that are designed to help you create your
own templates more easily. See the Communique Help for more details on using
Custom Objects.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 687
Global
This major branch has general information about the software, current user, and database.
The Current User Name data object will place the name of the user currently logged in into
the report.
1. Click on Current User Name in the Data Object list to select it.
3. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to the required size.
The following object is added to the template.
The Current User Name object is added to the tree on the left hand side of the
template.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
4. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is
how the report will appear when printed.
NOTE: It may not be particularly useful to have just the object on the page as it is not clear
what it relates to. You can create a table where you can enter text in one field and
the data object in other field. This is described below.
5. Select the Table Layout tool from the Layout Tools list.
6. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
7. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
8. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
In the example below there are two columns and one row.
11. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Current User' has been entered.
12. Click on Current User Name in the Data Object list to select it.
13. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table and drag to the required size.
The table now looks like:
and the Current User Name data object is added to the tree
UV WinLab Software Guide . 689
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
14. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed.
The Current User ID data object will place the ID of the user currently logged in into the
report.
3. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to the required size.
The following object is added to the template.
The Current User ID object is added to the tree on the left hand side of the template.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
4. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is
how the report will appear when printed.
690 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: It may not be particularly useful to have just the object on the page as it is not clear
what it relates to. In this example, the Current User ID is the same as the Current
user Name (see above) so you would not know which data object you had placed on
the page once the report was printed. You can create a table where you can enter
text in one field and the data object in other field. This is described below.
6. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
7. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
8. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
In the example below there are two columns and one row.
11. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Current User ID' has been entered.
12. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table and drag to the required size.
The table now looks like:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
13. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed.
The Software Version data object will place the name and version of the software into the
report.
3. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to the required size.
The following object is added to the template
and the Software Version object is added to the tree on the left hand side of the
template.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
4. Click .
692 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is
how the report will appear when printed.
NOTE: It may not be particularly useful to have just the object on the page as it is not clear
what it relates to. You can create a table where you can enter text in one field and
the data object in other field. This is described below.
6. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
7. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
8. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
In the example below there are two columns and one row.
11. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 693
12. Click on Software Version in the Data Object list to select it.
13. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table and drag to the required size.
The table now looks like:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
14. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed.
The Database Version data object will place the version number of the database into the
report.
3. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to the required size.
694 . UV WinLab Software Guide
and the Database Version object is added to the tree on the left hand side of the
template.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview
the report.
4. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is
how the report will appear when printed.
NOTE: It may not be particularly useful to have just the object on the page as it is not clear
what it relates to. You can create a table where you can enter text in one field and
the data object in other field. This is described below.
6. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree.
7. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
8. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
In the example below there are two columns and one row.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 695
11. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Database Version' has been entered.
12. Click on Database Version in the Data Object list to select it.
13. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table and drag to the required size.
The table now looks like:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview
the report.
14. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed.
696 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The Database Name data object will place the name of the database into the report.
3. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to the required size.
The following object is added to the template
and the Database Name object is added to the tree on the left hand side of the
template.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview
the report.
4. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is
how the report will appear when printed.
NOTE: It may not be particularly useful to have just the object on the page as it is not clear
what it relates to. You can create a table where you can enter text in one field and
the data object in other field. This is described below.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 697
6. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree.
7. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
8. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
In the example below there are two columns and one row.
11. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Database Name' has been entered.
12. Click on Database Name in the Data Object list to select it.
13. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table and drag to the required size.
698 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview
the report.
14. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed.
The Database Path data object will place the location of the database into the report.
3. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to the required size.
The following object is added to the template
and the Database Path object is added to the tree on the left hand side of the template.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview
the report.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 699
4. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is
how the report will appear when printed.
NOTE: It may not be particularly useful to have just the object on the page as it is not clear
what it relates to. You can create a table where you can enter text in one field and
the data object in other field. This is described below.
6. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree.
7. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
8. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
In the example below there are two columns and one row.
11. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Database Path' has been entered.
12. Click on Database Path in the Data Object list to select it.
13. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table and drag to the required size.
The table now looks like:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview
the report.
14. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 701
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
A table is added to the tree.
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Current User' has been entered first as this is the first data
object listed under Global.
702 . UV WinLab Software Guide
8. Repeat steps 6 and 7 to enter text that will indicate what the data objects are.
9. Click on Current User Name in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field adjacent to Current User Name in the
table and drag to the required size.
The table now looks like:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 703
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other Global data objects.
The table will look like this:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview
the report.
NOTE: The order of the objects in the tree depends on the order in which the items were
added.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed.
704 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Task List
How do I add the Name, Description, Creation Date, Modified Date and
Status of the task to my report template?
This example puts this information in a table with text to explain what each of the objects
are.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
6. Click the mouse inside a field in the first row of the table.
A text object is placed in the field.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Name' has been entered.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 705
8. Repeat steps 5–7 for 'Description', 'Date Created', 'Date Modified' and 'Status'
headings.
10. Position the mouse pointer on the template in the cell below 'Name' and drag to display.
The following object is added to the template
706 . UV WinLab Software Guide
and the Name object is added to the tree on the left hand side of the template.
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the Description and Status data objects.
The template will look like this:
The date data objects have not been added in the same way because these are affected by
the size of the fields. If the field is too small, the date will display as ####. To avoid this,
date data objects should be placed inside text blocks.
13. Click the mouse inside the empty field for the Date Created field.
15. Select the Date Created data object and then click the mouse inside the text block you
have just created:
16. Repeat steps 12–15 for the Date Modified data object:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview
the report.
17. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is
how the report will appear when printed:
708 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Task Samples
Table Objects
Method
Created By/Modified By
Instrument
Quant Calibration
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'ID' has been entered.
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other output settings:
710 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: The text headings should be at the top of each column (rather than all rows in the
first column) as the table will be repeated on the second row to obtain the
information for all samples in the task.
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table
To obtain the ID, description, status and comments for all the samples in the task, you need
to repeat the second row of the table.
12. Right-click on the table and select Properties from the context menu.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
16. From the list of Available expansions, select Task Samples, and then click Add.
Samples moves from the Available expansions list to the Expand by list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
18. Click .
712 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: In this example there are no comments associated with any of the samples and so
the Comments fields are empty.
The ID object will report the Sample ID as seen in the Sample Table. This is sufficient if you
have a fairly simple Sample Table of, for example, just 5 samples.
However, this does not report the full sample name, which includes the extension (as seen in
the Results Table). The Full ID is particularly useful if you are using Replicates or
Measurements. If, for example, you have 1 sample with 2 replicates, and you create a table
in the report template using ID, you will see the Sample ID twice but it will not show that
these are replicates.
If you use the Full ID data object, the full name including the extension will be shown.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 713
The Type data object displays the information from the Type field in the Sample Table that
is, what type of sample is to be run. For example, it could be a Sample, Blank, Control,
Replicate or Measurement. If you are using the ID data object, you may wish to use the
Type data object as well so that you can tell what type each sample is. However, if you use
the Full ID data object, the extension (for example Sample1.Replicate) explains what type of
sample it is and so the Type field is not necessary.
How do I create a table of all the sample names and types in my report
template?
This example explains how to use the ID and Type data objects together. This information
can be also be displayed using the Full ID data object (see "What is the difference between
ID and Full ID ?" above).
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'ID' has been entered.
714 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: The text headings should be at the top of each column (rather than all rows in the
first column) as the table will be repeated on the second row to obtain the
information for all samples in the task.
9. Click on the ID data object beneath Task Samples in the Task List.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the Type data object to complete your table.
To obtain the ID and Type for all the samples in the task, you need to repeat the second row
of the table.
12. Right-click on the table and select Properties from the context menu.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
16. From the list of Available expansions, select Task Samples, and then click Add.
Task Samples moves from the Available expansions list to the Expand by list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
18. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 715
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
How do I create a table that contains all the information displayed in the
Results Table?
The simplest way to do this is to use the Results Table data object (See "How do I add the
Results Table to my report template ?"). However, you can also create your own table
(known as an expanding table). The example below shows how to create an expanding table
for all the information in a Results Table.The table will be created with 2 columns. The first
is for the sample ID. The second will expand so that all columns in the Results Table are
reported.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'SampleID' has been entered.
8. Select the Title data object beneath the Results Table Columns (within Task Samples in
the Task List).
The data object to be used in the final cell of the table depends on the data in the Results
Table. If there is text as well as numbers, you should use the Text data object. If there is
only numerical data, use the Number data object.
12. Select the Number data object beneath the Result Table Columns.
14. Right-click on the table and select Properties from the menu.
17. Select Enables row to expand, and then select Task Samples from the drop-down
list.
19. Click Next Column so that Column 2 is specified at the top of the setup.
20. Select Enables column to expand, and then select Result Table Column.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
22. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed.
NOTE: You must repeat on the same type that is specified in the table. In the example
above, the text data object from the Result Table Column is used in the table, and
then the column is expanded by Result Table Column. If you were to repeat by
Sample Table Column in this example, the table would not expand and populate
correctly.
If you wish to create an expanding table for the sample table, use the procedure described
above, but change the following:
In step 8, use the Title data object within the Sample Table Columns.
In step 12 use the Text or Number data object within Sample Table Columns.
How do I include the analyst name and ID and the date the samples were
analyzed in my report template?
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 719
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Analyst Name' has been entered.
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for Analyst ID and Date Analyzed.
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
When using a date data object, we recommend that the data object in placed inside a
text block. This ensures that all the date is displayed. If a text block is not used, and the
field is not large enough to display the date, you will see ##### in the field.
13. Drag the mouse on the report template to create a Text Block:
14. Click inside the Text Block and remove the default text.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
17. Click .
722 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To display the raw spectrum for each sample on a separate graph, a section must be
created.
4. Drag the mouse around the object frame to create a section containing the spectrum:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 723
5. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and then select Task Samples from the
drop-down list.
6. Click OK.
The section is added to the tree:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
7. Click .
724 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To display the processed spectrum for each sample, a section must be created.
4. Drag the mouse around the object frame to create a section containing the spectrum:
5. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and then select Task Samples from the
drop-down list.
726 . UV WinLab Software Guide
6. Click OK.
The section is added to the tree:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
7. Click .
Example:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 727
How do I overlay the raw spectra of each sample on the same graph or
How do I overlay the processed spectra of each sample on the same
graph?
The example below uses the Raw Spectrum data object. To overlay all processed spectra on
one graph, follow the instructions below but use the Processed Spectrum data object.
5. Select Repeat based on, and then select Task Samples from the drop-down list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
6. Click .
728 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To display the overlaid spectra for each sample (each sample on a separate graph), a section
must be created.
6. Drag the mouse around the object frame to create a section containing the spectrum:
7. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and then select Task Samples from the
drop-down list.
730 . UV WinLab Software Guide
8. Click OK.
The section is added to the tree:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 731
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
9. Click .
An example is shown below:
732 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Wavelength Data
How do I add a Wavelength Table to my report template?
This data object creates a table that lists the absorbances for each of the wavelengths
specified in the task. By default only the data relating to the first samples is displayed. You
must use a section to display the information for all samples.
The size of the Frame determines the size of the table in the printed report.
5. Select Repeat section based on, and then select Wavelength Data from the drop-
down list.
6. Click OK.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
7. Click .
The report is displayed. This is how the report will appear when printed.
734 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Peak Table
How do I include a peak table in my report template?
A peak table must have been setup as part of the processing for it to be available within the
report template.
1. Select the Peak Table data object within the Task List.
2. Click the mouse on the report template and drag to create the object:
The size of the frame will determine the size of the peak table in the report. If the
frame is too small, not all of the results will be displayed.
To display a peak table for each sample you need to create a section.
4. Click and drag the mouse over the Peak table frame:
5. Select Repeat section based on, and then select Task Samples from the drop-down
list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
6. Click .
NOTE: Peak Tables cannot wrap over pages. If you have created the object the size of a
page and not all the information is displayed, we recommend that you adjust the
settings of the Peak Table within the Processing page of the Task (for example,
increasing the Threshold).
UV WinLab Software Guide . 737
Table Columns
How do I create a table that contains all the information displayed in the
Sample Table and Results Table (excluding mandatory columns)?
You can also create a table (known as an expanding table) using the Table columns data
objects. This will display all columns from the sample table and results table excluding
mandatory columns (such as Type).
The example below shows how to create an expanding table. The table will be created with 2
columns. The first is for the sample ID. The second will expand so that all columns in the
both the Sample and Results Table are reported.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'SampleID' has been entered.
738 . UV WinLab Software Guide
8. Select the Title data object beneath the Table Columns (within Task Samples in the
Task List).
The data object to be used in the final cell of the table depends on the data in the Sample
and Results Table. If there is text as well as numbers, you should use the Text data object. If
there is only numerical data, use the Number data object.
12. Select the Number data object beneath the Table Columns
14. Right-click on the table and select Properties from the menu.
17. Select Enables row to expand, and then select Task Samples from the drop-down
list.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 739
19. Click Next Column so that Column 2 is specified at the top of the setup.
20. Select Enables column to expand, and then select Table Columns.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
22. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Sample' has been entered.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 741
9. Select the Full ID data object (from below Task Samples in the Task List).
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the Sample Event Log Event data object:
To obtain all sample event log information for all samples, you need to repeat on the rows
(to get all samples), and on the second column (to get all events for each sample).
12. Right-click on the table and select Properties from the context menu.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
16. From the list of Available expansions, select Task Samples, and then click Add.
Task Samples moves from the Available expansions list to the Expand by list.
20. From the list of Available expansions, select Sample Event Log, and then click Add.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
22. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed.
NOTE: Where cycles are used, any comment added to a sample in the Sample Table only
appears against the first cycle in the report table (as shown above).
This example shows how to create a table of sample event log information. Each sample has
a separate table.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 743
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The columns will be set
to expand for all the events recorded for a particular sample.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Sample' has been entered.
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other sample event log settings:
744 . UV WinLab Software Guide
9. Click on the Full ID data object (Task Samples) in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other Sample Event Log data objects except Time.
14. Select the Time data object and then click inside the text block.
This enables the time to text wrap within the text block. Otherwise the cell would need to be
very long to display all of the date.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 745
To include all sample event log information for the sample, the second column must be set to
repeat on the Sample Event Log.
To display a table for every sample, a section must be created around the table.
24. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and then select Task Samples from the
drop-down list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
26. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
In this example, there is an event log for sample 5 and an event log for sample 6. Sample 5
has 2 entries in the sample event log so the table has expanded to show both of these. For
sample 6 there was only one entry.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 747
Corrections
How do I include correction information for each sample in my report
template?
In this example a table of sample name, correction name and corrections samples ID will be
created for a sample. In addition a graph containing all the correction spectra for the sample
will be created. All this information will be put within a section which will then be repeated on
to get all the information for all samples in the task.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include.
The correction samples ID columns will be set to expand for all correction IDs for a particular
name. For example, the 100% and 0% baseline corrections (Corrections Name) has 2
Corrections IDs (spectra) associated with it – 100% or 0 Absorbance Baseline and 0% or
Blocked Beam Baseline.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Correction Name' has been entered.
748 . UV WinLab Software Guide
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the Correction ID and Full Sample ID:
9. Click on the Corrections Name in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the Correction Samples ID and the Full ID.
The Full ID data object is further up the Task List beneath Task Samples.
To show all the Correction IDs for a particular correction you need to expand column 2.
12. Select the Correction ID data object in the table (Data 2 in this example) and right-click.
To display all the correction spectra for a particular correction on one graph, you must repeat
on the object frame based on correction samples.
23. Ensure Repeat based on is selected, and then select Correction Samples from the
drop-down list.
750 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To display a table and graph for every sample, a section must be created around the table
and graph.
27. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and then select Task Samples from the
drop-down list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
29. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
The table could also include a column for the Date Analyzed data object if required. Follow
the steps above but create a table with an additional column. Ensure that the Correction ID
column is still set to expand.
752 . UV WinLab Software Guide
How do I include a wavelength table for all corrections for each sample in
my report template?
In this example the report template will include the name of the sample, the name of the
correction and the wavelength table for the correction (for all samples).
1. Select the Wavelength Table data object (beneath Corrections) within the Task List.
2. Click the mouse on the report template and drag to create the object:
To display a table for all correction samples for a particular correction (for example 100% or
0 Absorbance Baseline and 0% or Blocked beam baseline for 100% and 0% baseline
corrections), you need to create a section around the Wavelength Table.
5. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and select Correction Samples from the
drop-down list.
6. Click OK.
10. Place the object above the Corrections Name data object
To obtain the information for all samples, a section is needed around all this information.
12. Click and draw a section around all the objects placed on the template in the above
steps
754 . UV WinLab Software Guide
13. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and select Task Samples from the drop-
down list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
15. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 755
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
756 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The data objects allow you to display abscissa and ordinate value for raw and processed
data. You can display all points, every 2 points, every 5 points, every 10 points, and/or every
100 points for raw and processed data.
These data objects can be used for all data collection types – scan, timedrive, polarization
scan, and wavelength programming.
The example below shows how to create a table of every 5th raw data point and the
associated ordinate value. For all other raw point / processed points, follow the steps below
and substitute the required data objects.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Abscissa (every 5 points)' has been entered.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field below Abscissa (every 5 points), and
click.
The table now looks something like:
NOTE: The option selected from the drop-down list must correspond to the raw/processed
abscissa/ordinate objects in the table. In this example Raw points every 5 Abscissa
and Ordinate data objects have been used so Raw Points every 5 must be selected
for the expansion.
To display a table for every sample, a section must be created around the table.
NOTE: You may wish to include another column in your table for Sample ID so that you can
identify which sample the data points relate to. (This is not shown here)
21. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and then select Task Samples from the
drop-down list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
23. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 759
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: You can specify the number of significant figures or decimal places by setting the
properties of the data object. Close the print preview window if this is still open.
Right-click on the data object and select Properties. The Numeric Data Object
Properties dialog is displayed. You can select Significant figures or Decimal
places and specify the number of Significant figures or Decimal places from the
appropriate drop-down list.
760 . UV WinLab Software Guide
How do I obtain the ordinate value at a specific abscissa value for all
samples and include this in my report?
Rather than obtain all raw or processed points or every 2, 5, 10 or 100 points (see "How do I
include a table of data points and the associated ordinate values in my report template ?"
above), you can display the ordinate at a single specified value. This example shows how to
create a table to report the ordinate value at 445 nm for all samples.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The example below has 2 columns and 2 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Sample' has been entered.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 761
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for Ordinate value at 445 nm:
9. Select the Full ID data object and click in the second row of the first column of the
table.
11. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field and click.
The table now looks something like:
To display the Ordinate value at 445 nm you need to use Indexing on the Ordinate data
object.
12. Right-click on the Ordinate data object in the table and select Indexing.
The Data Object Indexing dialog is displayed.
14. Enter the Abscissa value whose Ordinate value you wish to display (445 in this
example). The value MUST be in quote marks:
To display the ordinate value at the specified abscissa value for each sample, you need to
repeat the second row based on task samples.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
21. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: To display the ordinate value of a processed data point, follow the procedure
described above, but use the Processed Points Ordinate data object instead.
NOTE: You can specify the number of significant figures or decimal places by setting the
properties of the data object. Close the print preview window if this is still open.
Right-click on the data object and select Properties. The Numeric Data Object
Properties dialog is displayed. You can select Significant figures or Decimal
places and specify the number of Significant figures or Decimal places from the
appropriate drop-down list.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 763
1. Select the Samples Table data object within the Task List.
2. Click the mouse on the report template and drag to create the object:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
3. Click .
The report is displayed and the sample table are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
You can only have Replicates or Measurements in a method (not both at the same time). The
table applicable to your data will be displayed when this data object is selected.
1. Select the Replicates/Measurements Table data object within the Task List.
2. Click the mouse on the report template and drag to create the object:
764 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
3. Click .
The report is displayed and the sample table are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when
printed:
1. Select the Results Table data object within the Task List.
2. Click the mouse on the report template and drag to create the object:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
3. Click .
The report is displayed and the sample table are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
This is the information displayed on the data tab within Processing and Results.
1. Select the Data Table data object within the Task List.
2. Click the mouse on the report template and drag to create the object:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
3. Click .
The report is displayed and the sample table are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
766 . UV WinLab Software Guide
A custom table is created when one equation (defined in processing) is used to create
another equation.
1. Select the Custom Table data object within the Task List.
2. Click the mouse on the report template and drag to create the object:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
3. Click .
The report is displayed and the sample table are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when
printed:
NOTE: The Custom Table data object is an ActiveX object. This means that the size of the
frame drawn on the report template determines the size of the table (and hence the
amount of information) seen in the report.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 767
The instructions below describe how to put this information in a table as the individual values
such as 1 for Method Revision Number would be meaningless on the page.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Method Name' has been entered.
768 . UV WinLab Software Guide
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other output settings.
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
770 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
How do I include the name and ID of the person who created the method
that was used to create the task?
The Created by sub-branch of Method (within the Task list) contains the data objects for the
Name and ID of the person who created the method that was then used to create the task.
The instructions below describe how to put this information in a table as the individual values
could be meaningless on the page.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 771
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Method created by (Name)' has been entered.
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it:
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 8 and 9 for the number of copies data object:
772 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
How do I include the name and ID of the person who modified the method
that was used to create the task?
The Modified by sub-branch of Method (within the Task list) contains the data objects for the
Name and ID of the last person who modified the method that was then used to create the
task.
The instructions below describe how to put this information in a table as the individual values
could be meaningless on the page.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Method modified by (Name)' has been entered.
9. Click on the Modified by Name data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the number of copies data object:
774 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 775
The Created by sub-branch within the Task list contains the data objects for the Name and
ID of the person who created the task.
The instructions below describe how to put this information in a table as the individual values
could be meaningless on the page.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Task created by (Name)' has been entered.
776 . UV WinLab Software Guide
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the number of copies data object.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 777
How do I include the name and ID of the person who modified the task?
The Modified by sub-branch within the Task list contains the data objects for the Name and
ID of the last person who modified the task.
The instructions below describe how to put this information in a table as the individual values
could be meaningless on the page.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Task modified by (Name)' has been entered.
9. Click on the Modified by Name data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the number of copies data object.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 779
The instructions below describe how to put this information in a table as the individual values
may be meaningless on the page.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Format.
The format table dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example has 2
columns and 5 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Instrument Name' has been entered.
780 . UV WinLab Software Guide
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
If you have more than one instrument installed you will need to create a section that will
then repeat for all instruments.
14. Select Repeat section based on, and then select Instrument List from the drop-down
list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
15. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: If you have more than one instrument attached, you could create a section around
the table and repeat by Instrument List to obtain the information for all instruments.
782 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: The IPV data objects are listed but they are only ever populated in templates that are
associated with IPV tests. It is not possible to change the default templates that are
associated with the IPV tests. It is possible to edit the default templates but WE
STRONGLY RECOMMEND THAT YOU DO NOT DO THIS. Therefore, these data objects
will not be discussed in the Help.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 783
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
3. Click .
784 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
3. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 785
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
3. Click .
786 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Calibration Details
How do I include a table of the Calibration coefficients and Correlation
coefficient in my report template?
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
5 columns and 2 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Coefficient x0' has been entered.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 787
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
788 . UV WinLab Software Guide
How do I include the analyst name and ID from the person who performed
the calibration and the date the calibration was performed in my report
template?
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 3 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Calibrated by (Name)' has been entered.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 789
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for Analyst ID and Calibrated on:
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
When using a date data object, we recommend that the data object in placed inside a text
block. This ensures that all the date is displayed. If a text block is not used, and the field is
not large enough to display the date, you will see ##### in the field.
13. Drag the mouse on the report template to create a Text Block:
14. Click inside the Text Block and remove the default text.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
17. Click .
Standards Table
How do I add the Standards table from my Quant task to my report
template?
If the frame is too small, when you select Print Preview an error message will be
displayed and the Standards Table will not be displayed correctly.
The frame object is added to the tree:
792 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
4. Click .
Standards
How do I include the ID, description, status and comments for each of the
standards in my task in the report template?
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
4 columns and 2 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'ID' has been entered.
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other output settings:
NOTE: The text headings should be at the top of each column (rather than all rows in the
first column) as the table will be repeated on the second row to obtain the
information for all samples in the task.
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
To obtain the ID, description, status and comments for all the samples in the task, you need
to repeat the second row of the table.
12. Right-click on the table and select Properties from the context menu.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
794 . UV WinLab Software Guide
16. From the list of Available expansions, select Standards, and then click Add.
Samples moves from the Available expansions list to the Expand by list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
18. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 795
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: In this example there are no comments associated with any of the standards and so
the Comments fields are empty.
For information about the Full ID and Type data objects, see:
How do I include the analyst name and ID and the date the standards
were analyzed in my report template?
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 3 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Analyst Name' has been entered.
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for Analyst ID and Date Analyzed:
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
When using a date data object, we recommend that the data object in placed inside a
text block. This ensures that all the date is displayed. If a text block is not used, and the
field is not large enough to display the date, you will see ##### in the field.
13. Drag the mouse on the report template to create a Text Block.
14. Click inside the Text Block and remove the default text.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
17. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 799
To display the raw spectrum for each sample on a separate graph, a section must be
created.
4. Drag the mouse around the object frame to create a section containing the spectrum:
5. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and then select Standards from the
drop-down list.
6. Click OK.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
7. Click .
How do I overlay the raw spectra of each standard on the same graph?
5. Select Repeat based on, and then select Standards from the drop-down list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
6. Click .
802 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Events such saving and reviewing are recorded in the Task Event Log. If these data objects
were just placed on the page, only the most recent event would be displayed in the report.
To display all events, a section must be created that repeats on the Task Event Log.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 6 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Event' has been entered.
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other output settings:
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects except Time.
14. Select the Time data object and then click inside the text block.
This enables the time to text wrap within the text block. Otherwise the cell would need to be
very long to display all of the date.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 805
To display all the event log entries a section must be created around the table.
17. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and then select Task Event Log from the
drop-down list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
19. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 807
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
808 . UV WinLab Software Guide
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
3 columns and 2 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'FullID' has been entered.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 809
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other output settings:
9. Click on the Full data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
To obtain the Full ID, description and status for all the measurements in the task, you need
to repeat the second row of the table.
12. Right-click on the table and select Properties from the context menu.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
16. From the list of Available expansions, select Measurements or Replicates Table
Samples, and then click Add.
Samples moves from the Available expansions list to the Expand by list.
810 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
18. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: The Description is not the description entered for each measurement in the sample
table. Instead, the software enters the description to reflect that it is a mean of the
measurements.
How do I include a table of data points and the associated ordinate values
for measurements or replicates in my report template?
The data objects allow you to display abscissa and ordinate value for raw data associated
with replicates or measurements. You can display all points, every 2 points, every 5 points,
every 10 points and/or every 100 points for raw data. Each of the objects has associated
abscissa and ordinate objects.
These data objects can be used for all data collection types – Scan, Timedrive, Polarization
scan, and Wavelength Program.
The example below shows how to create a table of every 10th raw data point and the
associated ordinate value. For all other raw points, follow the steps below and substitute the
required data objects.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 811
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The example below has 2 columns and 2 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Abscissa (every 10 points)' has been entered.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field below Abscissa (every 10 points), and
click.
The table now looks something like:
17. Select Raw Points every 10 (beneath Measurement or Replicates) from the drop-down
list.
NOTE: The option selected from the drop-down list must correspond to the raw/processed
abscissa/ordinate objects in the table. In this example Raw points every 10 Abscissa
and Ordinate data objects have been used so Raw Points every 10 must be
selected for the expansion, and it must be below the Measurements or Replicates
option. If the incorrect option is chosen, the table will not expand.
To determine which sample the data belongs to it is useful to include a text header.
19. Select the Full ID data object from the task list and position this above the table.
To display a table for every sample, a section must be created around the table and Full ID
data object.
22. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and then select Task Samples from the
drop-down list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
24. Click .
814 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
The Full ID is SampleX.Mean as this is the mean of all the replicates for the sample.
NOTE: You can specify the number of significant figures or decimal places by setting the
properties of the data object. Close the print preview window if this is still open.
Right-click on the data object and select Properties. The Numeric Data Object
Properties dialog is displayed. You can select Significant figures or Decimal
places and specify the number of Significant figures or Decimal places from the
appropriate drop-down list.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 815
The size of the Frame determines the size of the table in the printed report.
5. Select Repeat section based on, and then select Wavelength Data from the drop-
down list.
6. Click OK.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
7. Click .
The report is displayed. This is how the report will appear when printed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 817
Method List
How do I add the following information to my report template – Method
Name, Revision, Type, Description, Status, Method ID, Created by (Name
and ID), Modified by (Name and ID), Date Created, Date Modified and SOP
Document attached?
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 13 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Name' has been entered.
818 . UV WinLab Software Guide
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
820 . UV WinLab Software Guide
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 821
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
822 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: The Description field is empty as a Description of the Method was not entered
when the Method was created.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 823
NOTE: The terms used below are the Index keywords that must be used to return the value
for the setting. Some of the terms are specific to the type of method that you are
running (for example, Total Time is applicable to Timedrive but not Scan methods).
Rear Cell 1
Rear Cell 2
Rear Cell 3
Rear Cell 4
Rear Cell 5
Rear Cell 6
Rear Cell 7
Rear Cell 8
Rear Cell 9
Rear Cell 10
Rear Cell 11
Rear Cell 12
Rear Cell 13
Peltier Control
Peltier Description
826 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Peltier Type
Peltier Temperature
Sipper Description
Sipper Mode
By creating a custom table that only contains specific data collection settings, you avoid
having all entries in the table.
Before you create the table, you need to decide which data collection settings you wish to
include so you know how big to create the table. This list is not in the software, but is listed
within "What data collection settings are available to display on my template?"on this page of
the Help.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter 3 columns and the required number of rows.
The number of rows should include one extra row for the table headings.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 827
6. Click the mouse inside a field in the first row of the table.
A text object is placed in the field:
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Name' has been entered.
9. Click on the Name data object within Data Collection Settings in the Data Object list to
select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the Value and Units data objects.
The table should now look like this:
The instrument setting (DATA1) that has been placed in the table will by default be the
first setting in the instrument setting list shown above. This needs to be amended for
the setting you wish to report.
828 . UV WinLab Software Guide
12. Using the right mouse button, click on the Name data object and select Indexing.
13. Click the right mouse button on the Index field for the Data Collection Settings.
The text is highlighted and a drop-down arrow appears .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 829
14. Using the instrument settings list given inWhat data collection settings are available to
display on my template ? below,enter the instrument settings you wish to include.
NOTE: You must use the exact terms used in the list above for the software to understand
and return the required value. If an incorrect Index term is used, the Value field will
be empty when the report is printed.
15. Repeat steps 9 to 14 for all the other instrument settings you wish to add to your table.
You can verify that you have the correct Index terms by using print preview. The value field
for each instrument setting will be populated.
830 . UV WinLab Software Guide
16. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information.
This is how the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: The terms used below are the Index keywords that must be used to return the value
for the setting. Some of the terms are specific to the type of method that you are
running (for example, Total Time is applicable to Timedrive but not Scan methods).
Rear Cell 1
Rear Cell 2
Rear Cell 3
Rear Cell 4
Rear Cell 5
Rear Cell 6
Rear Cell 7
Rear Cell 8
UV WinLab Software Guide . 833
Rear Cell 9
Rear Cell 10
Rear Cell 11
Rear Cell 12
Rear Cell 13
Peltier Control
Peltier Description
Peltier Type
Peltier Temperature
Sipper Description
Sipper Mode
All the data collection settings can be displayed by creating a table that repeats on data
collection settings. However, this will display ALL settings and these may not be applicable to
you particular task.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
6. Click the mouse inside a field in the first row of the table.
A text object is placed in the field:
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Name' has been entered.
9. Click on the Name data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the Value and Units data objects.
The table should now look like this:
16. From the list of Available expansions, select Data Collection Settings, and then click
Add.
Data Collection Settings moves from the Available expansions list to the Expand by list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
18. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 837
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed (only part of the report is shown below for illustration):
838 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Timedrive
How do I add the Timedrive time interval and total time to my report
template?
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
The Table is added to the tree:
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 2 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Total Time' has been entered.
9. Click on the Total Time data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
840 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Corrections Settings
How do I include information about the Correction Settings in my report
template?
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree:
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 6 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Collection Type' has been entered.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 841
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other output settings:
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it:
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 843
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
844 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Quant Settings
How do I add the Quant Settings information to my report template?
Any of these data objects can be placed individually on the report template. However, the
example below shows all this information (excluding wavelengths, which is explained
separately below) in one table, as the individual values may otherwise be meaningless on the
page.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 18 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Component Name' has been entered.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 845
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other output settings:
846 . UV WinLab Software Guide
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it:
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
848 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 849
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 7 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Single Point Wavelength' has been entered.
850 . UV WinLab Software Guide
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other output settings:
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it:
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
852 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: In this example, Single Point Wavelength, Area Start Wavelength and Area End
Wavelength are not applicable to the task and so N/A (not applicable) is reported on
the report).
UV WinLab Software Guide . 853
Rate Settings
How do I add the Calculation Type to my report template?
and the Calculation Type object is added to the tree on the left hand side of the
template.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
4. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is
how the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: It may not be particularly useful to have just the object on the page as it is not clear
what it relates to. You can create a table where you can enter text in one field and
the data object in other field. See "How do I place the data object in a table with text
to explain what the object is?"
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
854 . UV WinLab Software Guide
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 9 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Start Slope' has been entered.
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other output setting:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 855
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it:
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
856 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 857
The individual data objects can be placed on the report template. The example below shows
how to enter them into a table with identifying text.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 10 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'End point analysis type' has been entered.
858 . UV WinLab Software Guide
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other output settings:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 859
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
860 . UV WinLab Software Guide
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 861
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
862 . UV WinLab Software Guide
UV WinLab Software Guide . 863
The Pre-processing data objects can be placed individually on a page, but this example
shows how to place them in a table and repeat on a row so that all the Pre-processing
settings are listed when the report is printed.
NOTE: The Post-processing options within a task are a subset of the Pre-processing options.
The Pre-processing are discussed below. The same procedure should be followed for
placing Post-processing information within a report template, but substituting the
Post-processing data objects.
In this example, the task processing page contains two processing commands:
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
6. Click the mouse inside a field in the first row of the table.
A text object is placed in the field
864 . UV WinLab Software Guide
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Pre-processing ProcessName' has been entered.
8. Repeat steps 5–7 for 'Pre-processing settings name' and 'Pre-processing settings value'
headings.
9. Click on the ProcessName data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the Pre-processing settingsName and Value data objects.
The table should now look like this:
16. From the list of Available expansions, select Pre-processing, and then click Add.
Pre-processing moves from the Available expansions list to the Expand by list.
NOTE: If you create a table that only contains the Pre-processing settings (Name and Value)
and not the Process name, you should repeat on Pre-processing settings.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
18. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 867
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
868 . UV WinLab Software Guide
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 9 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Preparation Type' has been entered.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 869
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other sample table settings:
This example uses Replicates per sample and Replicates sequence type. If you have
used Measurements rather than Replicates, you should replace these examples.
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
870 . UV WinLab Software Guide
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 871
Any of these data objects can be placed individually on the report template. However, the
example below shows all this information in one table, as the individual values may otherwise
be meaningless on the page.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 6 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Column Title' has been entered.
872 . UV WinLab Software Guide
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other standards table settings:
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 873
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed.
874 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Any of these data objects can be placed individually on the report template. However, the
example below shows all this information in one table, as the individual values may otherwise
be meaningless on the page.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree:
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 8 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Preparation Type' has been entered.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 875
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other standards table settings:
Replicates have been used in this example, but if you have used Measurements, replace
the text as required. The data object will automatically report Replicates or
Measurements correctly.
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
876 . UV WinLab Software Guide
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 877
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 6 rows.
878 . UV WinLab Software Guide
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Column Title' has been entered.
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other standards table settings:
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
880 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Any of these data objects can be placed individually on the report template. However, the
example below shows all this information in one table, as the individual values may otherwise
be meaningless on the page.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 8 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Visible Columns' has been entered.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 881
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other standards table settings:
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
882 . UV WinLab Software Guide
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 883
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
884 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Reporting Options
How do I add the report template name and revision to my template?
The report template name and revision can be included in the report template. The
instructions below describe how to put this information in a small table.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Report Template' has been entered.
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
The report output settings (fore example, print hardcopy) defined on the Output page of the
Workspace can be included in the report template. The instructions below describe how to
put this information in a table as the individual values such as Yes for Print hardcopy would
be meaningless on the page.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
886 . UV WinLab Software Guide
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many reporting options you wish to include. The example
below has 2 columns and 4 rows as all the information is reported.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Report frequency' has been entered.
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other output settings:
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
These data objects describe the printer which prints the hardcopy of the report, and the
number of copies of the report.
The instructions below describe how to put this information in a table as the individual values
such as 1 for Number of copies would be meaningless on the page.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Format.
The format table dialog is displayed.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Printer' has been entered.
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the number of copies data object:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 889
These data objects describe the location to which the report is saved and the file format of
the report.
The instructions below describe how to put this information in a table as the individual values
could be meaningless on the page.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Format.
The format table dialog is displayed.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Output folder path' has been entered.
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the number of copies data object:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 891
How do I add information about which sections of the report are selected
on or off?
If you have created a report template that contains sections, within the reporting setup you
can specify which of these sections are on or off when the report is output. This information
can be included within the report.
In the example below, a report is created that contains 3 sections. It also contains a table to
report which of these sections are on and off.
1. Create a report that contains at least 1 sections. The example below contains 3 sections.
3. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
4. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The format table dialog is displayed.
892 . UV WinLab Software Guide
8. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Sections on' has been entered.
11. Select the Sections Off data object, and then click in the field next to the Sections Off
text:
The Sections that are specified on and off are set on the Output page in the Workspace.
In this example 2 of the 3 sections are switched off (this means that the information within
these sections would not be included when the report is generated).
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The table in the report shows which sections are switched on and off:
894 . UV WinLab Software Guide
These data objects describe the executable path of the application started, the files that were
sent to the application and when during the task they were sent.
The instructions below describe how to put this information in a table as the individual values
could be meaningless on the page.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
To obtain the information for more than one executable path, you need to repeat the second
row of the table.
12. Right-click on the table and select Properties from the context menu.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
16. From the list of Available expansions, select Call Application, and then click Add.
Call Application moves from the Available expansions list to the Expand by list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
18. Click . 0.
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information.
NOTE: A number of templates supplied with UV WinLab provide a Task Summary that
includes an expanding table containing the details of Call Application.
These data objects describe the data that was exported from the task at and the files
formats used.
The instructions below describe how to put this information in a table as the individual values
could be meaningless on the page.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 897
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other Data Export options.
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
11. Repeat steps 8–9 for the other Data Export data objects.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
12. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information.
NOTE: Some example templates are available that cover the reporting options. These are
the Task Summary Report templates, which allow you to print all the details of
your task, including the Output settings. They are available for each type of method.
898 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Every event such saving is recorded in the Method Event Log. If these data objects were just
placed on the page, only the most recent event would be displayed in the report. To display
all events, a section must be created that repeats on the Method Event Log.
14. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
15. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
16. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 7 rows.
19. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Method Event' has been entered.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 899
20. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other output settings:
21. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it
22. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
900 . UV WinLab Software Guide
23. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects except Time.
26. Select the Time data object and then click inside the text block.
.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 901
This enables the time to text wrap within the text block. Otherwise the cell would need
to be very long to display all of the date.
To display all the event log entries a section must be created around the table.
29. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and then select Method Event Log from
the drop-down list.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 903
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
31. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
904 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Sample List
How do I include the ID, description, status and comments for each of the
samples in my task in the report template?
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
4 columns and 2 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'ID' has been entered.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 905
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other output settings:
NOTE: The text headings should be at the top of each column (rather than all rows in the
first column) as the table will be repeated on the second row to obtain the
information for all samples in the task.
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
To obtain the ID, description, status and comments for all the samples in the task, you need
to repeat the second row of the table.
12. Right-click on the table and select Properties from the context menu.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
16. From the list of Available expansions, select Samples, and then click Add.
Samples moves from the Available expansions list to the Expand by list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
18. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 907
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: In this example there are no comments associated with any of the samples and so
the Comments fields are empty.
The ID data object will report the Sample ID as seen in the Sample Table. This is sufficient if
you have a fairly simple Sample Table, for example just 5 samples.
However, this does not report the full sample name which includes the extension (as seen in
the Results Table). The Full ID is particularly useful if you are using Replicates or
Measurements. If, for example, you have 1 sample with 2 replicates, and you create a table
in the report template using ID, you will see the Sample ID twice but it will not show that
these are replicates.
If you use the Full ID data object, the full name including the extension will be shown.
908 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To ensure that all your results are printed, you must use a custom table.
In this example we will recreate a Results Table from a task which has three columns –
sample ID, Abs541 (where an equation was used to calculate the absorbance at 451 nm for
each sample), and Conc.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
3 columns and 2 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'SampleID' has been entered.
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other output settings:
NOTE: The text headings should be at the top of each column (rather than all rows in the
first column) as the table will be repeated on the second row to obtain the
information for all samples in the task.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Select the Number data object in Table Columns (within the Sample List).
12. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table below the Abs451 header and
drag to the required size.
910 . UV WinLab Software Guide
13. Repeat steps 11 and 12 and position the data object in the field beneath the Conc
header.
The table should now look like:
14. To display the correct values in the Abs451 an Conc columns you must use Indexing.
15. Right-click inside the data object beneath the Abs451 header and select Indexing.
The Data Object Indexing dialog is displayed.
17. Within quotes (" "), enter the name of the column as it appears in the results table.
If the name is not exactly correct, the table will not populate with data.
18. Repeat the indexing (steps 13 to 15) for the Conc data object.
To obtain the ID, Abs451 and Conc values for all the samples in the task, you need to repeat
the second row of the table.
19. Right-click on the table and select Properties from the context menu.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
23. From the list of Available expansions, select Samples, and then click Add.
Samples moves from the Available expansions list to the Expand by list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
25. Click .
912 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
How do I create a table that contains all the information displayed in the
Results Table?
The simplest way to do this is to use the Results Table data object (See How do I add the
Results Table to my report template ? above). However, you can also create your own table
(known as an expanding table). The example below shows how to create an expanding table
for all the information in a Results Table. The table will be created with 2 columns. The
first is for the sample ID. The second will expand so that all columns in the Results Table are
reported.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
UV WinLab Software Guide . 913
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 2 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'SampleID' has been entered.
8. Select the Title data object beneath the Results Table Columns (within Task Samples in
the Task List).
The data object to be used in the final cell of the table depends on the data in the
Results Table. If there is text as well as numbers, you should use the Text data object.
If there is only numerical data, use the Number data object.
12. Select the Number data object beneath the Result Table Columns.
14. Right-click on the table and select Properties from the menu.
17. Select Enables row to expand, and then select Task Samples from the drop-down
list.
19. Click Next Column so that Column 2 is specified at the top of the setup.
20. Select Enables column to expand, and then select Result Table Column.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
22. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 915
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information.
NOTE: You must repeat on the same type that is specified in the table. In the example
above, the text data object from the Result Table Column is used in the table, and
then the column is expanded by Result Table Column. If you were to repeat by
Sample Table Column in this example, the table would not expand and populate
correctly.
If you wish to create an expanding table for the sample table, use the procedure described
above, but change the following:
In step 8, use the Title data object within the Sample Table Columns.
In step 12 use the Text data object within Sample Table Columns.
The Type data object displays the information from the Type field in the Sample Table – that
is, what type of sample is to be run. For example, it could be a Sample, Blank, Control,
Replicate or Measurement. If you are using the ID data object, you may wish to use the
Type data object as well so that you can tell what type each sample is. However, if you use
the Full ID data object, the extension (for example Sample1.Replicate) explains what type of
sample it is and so the Type field is not necessary.
How do I create a table of all the sample names and types in my report
template?
This example explains how to use the ID and Type data objects together. This information
can be also be displayed using the Full ID data object (see 'What is the difference between
ID and Full ID ?' above).
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 2 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'ID' has been entered.
NOTE: The text headings should be at the top of each column (rather than all rows in the
first column) as the table will be repeated on the second row to obtain the
information for all samples in the task.
9. Click on the ID data object beneath Task Samples in the Task List.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the Type data object to complete your table:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 917
To obtain the ID and Type for all the samples in the task, you need to repeat the second row
of the table.
12. Right-click on the table and select Properties from the context menu.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
16. From the list of Available expansions, select Task Samples, and then click Add.
Task Samples moves from the Available expansions list to the Expand by list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
18. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
918 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Analyst
How do I include the analyst name and ID and the date the samples were
analyzed in my report template?
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 3 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Analyst Name' has been entered.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 919
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for Analyst ID and Date Analyzed:
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
When using a date data object, we recommend that the data object in placed inside a
text block. This ensures that all the date is displayed. If a text block is not used, and the
field is not large enough to display the date, you will see ##### in the field.
920 . UV WinLab Software Guide
13. Drag the mouse on the report template to create a Text Block
14. Click inside the Text Block and remove the default text.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
17. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 921
Spectra
How do I display the raw spectrum of each sample on a separate graph?
To display the raw spectrum for each sample on a separate graph, a section must be
created.
4. Drag the mouse around the object frame to create a section containing the spectrum:
5. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and then select Task Samples from the
drop-down list.
6. Click OK.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
7. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 923
The example below uses the Raw Spectrum data object. To overlay all processed spectra on
one graph, follow the instructions below but use the Processed Spectrum data object.
5. Select Repeat based on, and then select Task Samples from the drop-down list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
6. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 925
To display the processed spectrum for each sample, a section must be created.
4. Drag the mouse around the object frame to create a section containing the spectrum:
5. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and then select Task Samples from the
drop-down list.
6. Click OK.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
7. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 927
To display the overlaid spectra for each sample (each sample on a separate graph), a section
must be created.
6. Drag the mouse around the object frame to create a section containing the spectrum:
7. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and then select Task Samples from the
drop-down list.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 929
8. Click OK.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
9. Click .
An example is shown below:
930 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Wavelength Data
How do I add a Wavelength Table to my report template?
This data object creates a table that lists the absorbances for each of the wavelengths
specified in the task. By default only the data relating to the first samples is displayed. You
must use a section to display the information for all samples.
The size of the Frame determines the size of the table in the printed report.
5. Select Repeat section based on, and then select Wavelength Data from the drop-
down list.
6. Click OK.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
7. Click .
The report is displayed. This is how the report will appear when printed:
932 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Peak Table
How do I include a peak table in my report template?
A peak table must have been setup as part of the processing for it to be available within the
report template.
1. Select the Peak Table data object within the Sample List.
2. Click the mouse on the report template and drag to create the object:
The size of the frame will determine the size of the peak table in the report. If the
frame is too small, not all of the results will be displayed.
To display a peak table for each sample you need to create a section.
4. Click and drag the mouse over the Peak table frame:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 933
5. Select Repeat section based on, and then select Task Samples from the drop-down
list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
6. Click .
NOTE: Peak Tables cannot wrap over pages. If you have created the object the size of a
page and not all the information is displayed, we recommend that you adjust the
settings of the Peak Table within the Processing page of the Task (for example,
increasing the Threshold).
UV WinLab Software Guide . 935
Table Columns
How do I create a table that contains all the information displayed in the
Sample Table and Results Table (excluding mandatory columns)?
You can create a table (known as an expanding table) using the Table columns data objects.
This will display all columns from the sample table and results table excluding mandatory
columns (such as Type).
The example below shows how to create an expanding table . The table will be created with
2 columns. The first is for the sample ID. The second will expand so that all columns in the
both the Sample and Results Table are reported.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 2 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'SampleID' has been entered.
936 . UV WinLab Software Guide
8. Select the Title data object beneath the Table Columns (within the Sample List).
10. Select the ID or Full ID data object from the Sample List.
The data object to be used in the final cell of the table depends on the data in the
Sample and Results Table. If there is text as well as numbers, you should use the Text
data object. If there is only numerical data, use the Number data object.
12. Select the Number data object beneath the Table Columns.
14. Right-click on the table and select Properties from the menu.
17. Select Enables row to expand, and then select Task Samples from the drop-down
list.
19. Click Next Column so that Column 2 is specified at the top of the setup.
20. Select Enables column to expand, and then select Table Columns (beneath Sample
List).
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
22. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The example below has 2 columns and 2 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Sample' has been entered.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 939
9. Select the Full ID data object (from below Task Samples in the Task List).
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the Sample Event Log Event data object:
To obtain all sample event log information for all samples, you need to repeat on the rows
(to get all samples), and on the second column (to get all events for each sample).
12. Right-click on the table and select Properties from the context menu.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
16. From the list of Available expansions, select Task Samples, and then click Add.
Task Samples moves from the Available expansions list to the Expand by list.
20. From the list of Available expansions, select Sample Event Log, and then click Add.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
22. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed.
NOTE: Where cycles are used, any comment added to a sample in the Sample Table only
appears against the first cycle in the report table (as shown above).
This example shows how to create a table of sample event log information. Each sample has
a separate table.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 5 rows. The columns will be set to expand for all the events recorded for
a particular sample.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Sample' has been entered.
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other sample event log settings:
942 . UV WinLab Software Guide
9. Click on the Full ID data object (Task Samples) in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other Sample Event Log data objects except Time.
14. Select the Time data object and then click inside the text block.
The Time data object is placed inside the text block.
This enables the time to text wrap within the text block. Otherwise the cell would need
to be very long to display all of the date.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 943
To include all sample event log information for the sample, the second column must be set to
repeat on the Sample Event Log.
To display a table for every sample, a section must be created around the table.
24. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and then select Task Samples from the
drop-down list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
26. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 945
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
In this example, there is an event log for sample 5 and an event log for sample 6. Sample 5
has 2 entries in the sample event log so the table has expanded to show both of these. For
sample 6 there was only one entry.
946 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Corrections
How do I include correction information for each sample in my report
template?
In this example a table of sample name, correction name and corrections samples ID will be
created for a sample. In addition a graph containing all the correction spectra for the sample
will be created. All this information will be put within a section which will then be repeated on
to get all the information for all samples in the task.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
3 columns and 2 rows.
The correction samples ID columns will be set to expand for all correction IDs for a particular
name. For example, the 100% and 0% baseline corrections (Corrections Name) has 2
Corrections IDs (spectra) associated with it – 100% or 0 Absorbance Baseline and 0% or
Blocked Beam Baseline.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Correction Name' has been entered.
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the Correction ID and Full Sample ID.
9. Click on the Corrections Name in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the Correction Samples ID and the Full ID.
The Full ID data object is further up the Task List, beneath Task Samples.
To show all the Correction IDs for a particular correction you need to expand column 2.
12. Select the Correction ID data object in the table (Data 2 in this example) and right-
click.
To display all the correction spectra for a particular correction on one graph, you must repeat
on the object frame based on correction samples.
23. Ensure Repeat based on is selected, and then select Correction Samples from the
drop-down list.
To display a table and graph for every sample, a section must be created around the table
and graph.
27. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and then select Task Samples from the
drop-down list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
29. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 951
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
The table could also include a column for the Date Analyzed data object if required. Follow
the steps above but create a table with an additional column. Ensure that the Correction ID
column is still set to expand.
How do I include a wavelength table for all corrections for each sample in
my report template?
In this example the report template will include the name of the sample, the name of the
correction and the wavelength table for the correction (for all samples).
1. Select the Wavelength Table data object (beneath Corrections) within the Task List.
2. Click the mouse on the report template and drag to create the object:
952 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To display a table for all correction samples for a particular correction (for example 100% or
0 Absorbance Baseline and 0% or Blocked beam baseline for 100% and 0% baseline
corrections), you need to create a section around the Wavelength Table.
5. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and select Correction Samples from the
drop-down list.
6. Click OK.
10. Place the object above the Corrections Name data object.
To obtain the information for all samples, a section is needed around all this information.
12. Click and draw a section around all the objects placed on the template in the above
steps.
954 . UV WinLab Software Guide
13. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and select Task Samples from the drop-
down list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
15. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 955
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed.
956 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Data Points
How do I include a table of data points and the associated ordinate values
in my report template?
The Raw Points and Processed Points data objects allow you to display abscissa and ordinate
value for raw and processed data. You can display all points, every 2 points, every 5 points
and/or every 10 points for raw and processed data. Each of the objects has associated
abscissa and ordinate objects.
These data objects can be used for all data collection types – scan, timedrive, polarization
scan, and wavelength programming.
The example below shows how to create a table of every 5th raw data point and the
associated ordinate value. For all other raw point / processed points, follow the steps below
and substitute the required data objects.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The example below has 2 columns and 2 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Abscissa (every 5 points)' has been entered.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field below Abscissa (every 5 points), and
click.
The table now looks something like:
NOTE: The option selected from the drop-down list must correspond to the raw/processed
abscissa/ordinate objects in the table. In this example Raw points every 5 Abscissa
and Ordinate data objects have been used so Raw Points every 5 must be selected
for the expansion.
To display a table for every sample, a section must be created around the table.
NOTE: You may wish to include another column in your table for Sample ID so that you can
identify which sample the data points relate to. (This is not shown here)
21. Ensure Repeat section based on is selected, and then select Sample List from the
drop-down list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
23. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 959
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
How do I obtain the ordinate value at a specific abscissa value for all
samples and include this in my report?
Rather than obtain all raw or processed points or every 2, 5 or 10 points (see How do I
include a table of data points and the associated ordinate values in my report template ?),
you can display the ordinate at a single specified value. This example shows how to create a
table to report the ordinate value at 445 nm for all samples.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The example below has 2 columns and 2 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Sample' has been entered.
9. Select the Sample List Full ID data object , and click in the second row of the first
column of the table.
10. Click on the Sample List Raw Points Ordinate data object.
11. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field and click.
The table now looks something like:
To display the Ordinate value at 445 nm you need to use Indexing on the Ordinate data
object.
12. Right-click on the Ordinate data object in the table and select Indexing.
The Data Object Indexing dialog is displayed.
You need the Raw Points row in the dialog
.
The Index is Current by default.
14. Enter the Abscissa value whose Ordinate value you wish to display (445 in this
example). The value MUST be in quote marks:
To display the ordinate value at the specified abscissa value for each sample, you need to
repeat the second row based on task samples.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
21. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed.
NOTE: To display the ordinate value of a processed data point, follow the procedure
described above, but use the Processed Points Ordinate data object instead.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 963
User List
How do I add a list of all user names and IDs to my report template?
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
6. Click the mouse inside a field in the first row of the table.
A text object is placed in the field
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'UserName' has been entered.
NOTE: The text must be column headings and not row headings as the repeat (described
below) is repeated on rows. If you only want to list Names or IDs, create a table that
has 1 column and 2 rows and proceed in the same way.
9. Click on the Name data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
16. From the list of Available expansions, select User List, and then click Add.
Instrument Settings moves from the Available expansions list to the Expand by list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
18. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
966 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Instrument List
The instrument list is used to provide information about all the available instruments. If you
wish to include instrument settings used for a particular task, you should use the Data
Collection data objects, which are available within the Task List.
How do I add the name, type, serial number, IPV status and the date the
instrument information was last modified to my template?
The instructions below describe how to put this information in a table as the individual values
may be meaningless on the page.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree.
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The format table dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example has 2
columns and 5 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Instrument Name' has been entered.
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects to complete your table:
968 . UV WinLab Software Guide
If you have more than one instrument installed you will need to create a section that will
then repeat for all instruments. If you do not do this, the report will give details of the last
instrument that was added to the database. This may not be your default instrument if you
have more than one instrument installed.
14. Select Repeat section based on, and then select Instrument List from the drop-down
list.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
15. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 969
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: The IPV data objects are listed but they are only ever populated in templates that are
associated with IPV tests. It is not possible to change the default templates that are
associated with the IPV tests. It is possible to edit the default templates but WE
STRONGLY RECOMMEND THAT YOU DO NOT DO THIS. Therefore, these data objects
will not be discussed in the Help.
970 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: Do not use the Calibration Results data object from this list.
The Query Results Table data object displays a table of all the settings specified when
generating a query.
1. Select the Query Results Table from the Query Results data objects .
5. Create a Query.
6. Highlight the results you wish to include in the table in the report.
If only one result is selected, default templates are used. You must select at least two
results in order to be able to specify the template to be used for printing.
NOTE: You must select Single report using template. If not, the table will not populate
and the report will appear blank.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 971
9. Select the template containing the Query Results Table data object from the drop-down
list of available templates.
NOTE: When the Query Results Chart data object is used, the chart displayed on the report
will be the chart that is currently displayed in the Display Pane of the Query window.
The Query Summary data object displays a table of all the settings specified when generating
a query.
1. Select the Query Results Chart from the Query Results data objects .
5. Create a Query.
NOTE: You must select Single report using template. If not, the Chart will not populate
and the report will appear blank.
9. Select the template containing the Query Results Table data object from the drop-down
list of available templates.
The Query Summary data object displays a table of all the settings specified when generating
a query.
1. Select the Query Summary from the Query Results data objects .
5. Create a Query.
NOTE: You must select Single report using template. If not, the Query Summary will not
populate and the report will appear blank.
9. Select the template containing the Query Summary data object from the drop-down list
of available templates.
This data object must only be used on report templates that will be used for printing the
results of calibration Queries. It is used to generate a printed calibration report for all
selected results in the query. (The calibration report is the report that is seen when a
calibration result is selected in the Results Table, and Report is selected on the Results
Tree.)
NOTE: A section must be used with this data object so that the calibration report will print
for all selected results. If a section is not used, the report template will not be
populated.
974 . UV WinLab Software Guide
4. Drag the mouse around the object frame to create a section containing the Calibration
Result X object:
12. Select the template containing the Calibration Result X data object from the drop-down
list of available templates.
System Data
How do I place the data object in a table with text to explain what the
object is?
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
In the example below there are two columns and one row.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Current User Name' has been entered.
8. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it. For example:
9. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
10. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
11. If you wish to remove the table borders, right click on the table in the template editor
(not print preview), and select Properties.
12. In the Table Properties dialog, remove all the table lines:
The table will then appear without any lines in the Print Preview.
978 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Miscellaneous
How do I add page X of Y to my template?
NOTE: Page X of Y can only be added to the footer section of the report template.
1. Select Default Footer from the Tree on the left hand side of the screen.
4. Position the mouse pointer within the footer and drag to display.
The following object is added to the template
and the Page X of Y object is added to the tree on the left hand side of the template:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
5. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is
how the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: The Page Number can only added to the footer of the report template.
1. Select Default Footer from the Tree on the left hand side of the screen.
and the Page No object is added to the tree on the left hand side of the template:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 979
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
5. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is
how the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: It may not be particularly useful to have just the object on the page as it is not clear
what it relates to. You can create a table where you can enter text in one field and
the data object in other field. See How do I place the data object in a table
with text to explain what the object is ?
NOTE: The number of pages(Num Pages)can only added to the footer of the report
template.
1. Select Default Footer from the Tree on the left hand side of the screen.
and the Num Pages object is added to the tree on the left hand side of the template:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
5. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is
how the report will appear when printed:
980 . UV WinLab Software Guide
NOTE: Num Pages will not automatically appear on all pages of the report. It must be
added to each page of the template.
NOTE: It may not be particularly useful to have just the object on the page as it is not clear
what it relates to. In the example above the number could be the page number or
the number of pages. You can create a table where you can enter text in one field
and the data object in other field. See How do I place the data object in a table with
text to explain what the object is?
1. Click on Communiqué Software Version in the Data Object list to select it.
and the Communiqué Software Version object is added to the tree on the left hand side
of the template:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
4. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is
how the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: It may not be particularly useful to have just the object on the page as it is not clear
what it relates to. You can create a table where you can enter text in one field and
the data object in other field. See How do I place the data object in a table with text
to explain what the object is?
UV WinLab Software Guide . 981
How do I add the name of the user who is logged into the computer to my
template?
1. Click on Operating System User Name in the Data Object list to select it.
and the Operating System User Name object is added to the tree on the left hand side
of the template:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
4. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is
how the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: It may not be particularly useful to have just the object on the page as it is not clear
what it relates to. You can create a table where you can enter text in one field and
the data object in other field. See How do I place the data object in a table with text
to explain what the object is?
How do I add the name of operating system and the software version to
my template?
1. Click on Operating System And Version in the Data Object list to select it.
and the OperatingSystemAndVersion object is added to the tree on the left hand side of
the template:
982 . UV WinLab Software Guide
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
4. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is
how the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: It may not be particularly useful to have just the object on the page as it is not clear
what it relates to. You can create a table where you can enter text in one field and
the data object in other field. See How do I place the data object in a table with text
to explain what the object is?
and the Computer Name object is added to the tree on the left hand side of the
template:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
4. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is
how the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: It may not be particularly useful to have just the object on the page as it is not clear
what it relates to. You can create a table where you can enter text in one field and
the data object in other field. See How do I place the data object in a table with text
to explain what the object is?
UV WinLab Software Guide . 983
How do I add the date and time the report was generated to my template?
1. Click on Date Time Report in the Data Object list to select it.
and the Date Time Report object is added to the tree on the left hand side of the
template:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
4. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is
how the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: It may not be particularly useful to have just the object on the page as it is not clear
what it relates to. You can create a table where you can enter text in one field and
the data object in other field. See How do I place the data object in a table with text
to explain what the object is?
984 . UV WinLab Software Guide
This is the time on the computer's clock when the report is printed.
1. Click on Date Time Local PC in the Data Object list to select it.
and the Date Time Local PC object is added to the tree on the left hand side of the
template:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
4. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is
how the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: It may not be particularly useful to have just the object on the page as it is not clear
what it relates to. You can create a table where you can enter text in one field and
the data object in other field. See +
UV WinLab Software Guide . 985
Templates
How do I add the name of the template, the template creation date, the
template author, the date the template was last edited, the name of the
person who last edited the template, the template description, current
revision, previous revision, previous name, and data model version to my
report template?
The instructions below describe how to put this information in a table as the individual values
such as 1 for Template Previous Revision would be meaningless on the page.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 10 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Template Name' has been entered:
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other template objects. For example:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 987
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it.
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects EXCEPT THE
CREATION DATE AND EDITED DATE:
988 . UV WinLab Software Guide
If a date object is placed in a field which is too small, when you print preview you will see
##### instead of the date. Rather than enlarging the field (which may not always be
possible if you have a large table), you can create a text block and then place the date object
inside this block. The text block will handle any wrapping or expanding that is required.
13. Drag the mouse on the report template to create a Text Block inside the date field:
14. Click inside the Text Block and remove the default text.
15. Select the Template Creation Date data object and click inside the text field:
UV WinLab Software Guide . 989
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
17. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
990 . UV WinLab Software Guide
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
In the example below there are two columns and one row.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 991
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Template Status' has been entered.
9. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
10. Click .
992 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The Templates Signatures data object will create a table of all the signatures that have been
applied to the report template – when the report template has been saved, reviewed and
approved.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree .
A table header and table column headers are automatically created:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
3. Click .
UV WinLab Software Guide . 993
Reports
How do I add the report name, ID, template name and revision, data
model version, and report created date to my report template?
The instructions below describe how to put this information in a table as the individual values
such as 1 for Report Template Revision would be meaningless on the page.
2. Position the mouse pointer on the template and drag to create a table.
Table is added to the tree
3. To format the size of the table, right click on the table and select Properties.
The Table Properties dialog is displayed.
4. Select the Table tab and enter the number of columns and rows.
The size will depend on how many options you wish to include. The example below has
2 columns and 6 rows.
7. Click inside the blue box in the table and edit the text as required.
In the example below 'Report Name' has been entered.
994 . UV WinLab Software Guide
8. Repeat steps 5–7 to enter text for the other template objects:
9. Click on the required data object in the Data Object list to select it:
10. Position the mouse pointer in the empty field in the table next to the corresponding text
and drag to the required size.
The table now looks something like:
11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the other output settings data objects EXCEPT THE REPORT
CREATED DATE:
If a date object is placed in a field which is too small, when you print preview you will see
##### instead of the date. Rather than enlarging the field (which may not always be
possible if you have a large table), you can create a text block and then place the date object
inside this block. The text block will handle any wrapping or expanding that is required.
13. Drag the mouse on the report template to create a Text Block inside the date field.
996 . UV WinLab Software Guide
14. Click inside the Text Block and remove the default text.
15. Select the Report Created Date data object and click inside the text field:
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
16. Click .
The report is displayed and the data objects are populated with the information. This is how
the report will appear when printed:
NOTE: In print preview the Report ID and Created date are not populated as the report has
not been generated.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 997
Communiqué FAQ
Why is the date object displayed as #### when I print preview the
report?
This means that the object is too big for the field. The field will not expand to fit the
information. You can enlarge the field although this is not always possible depending on the
space available on your report template. Or, you can create a text block and then place the
date object inside this block. The text block will handle any wrapping or expanding that is
required.
3. Click inside the Text Block and remove the default text.
To view what will actually appear when the report is printed you need to print preview the
report.
6. Click .
NOTE: This also applies to a text block that is within a table, which prevents the date
column from being very long.
998 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Older Deskjet printers (for example, Deskjet 660) seem to have internal margins. You will
have to modify the template to place the footer information into the main page. If you create
a section with a page break, this will allow you to repeat the footer information on each
page.
No, once the template is approved no further modifications are possible as it becomes 'read-
only'. However, you can save it with a new name and this version will be fully editable.
How can I set the number of significant figures or decimal places for the
values displayed in my report?
If the 'numeric' data objects (for example, an ordinate value) are within a table, you can
right-click on the table and select Properties. Select the Cells tab and define the numeric
formatting for the table.
If the object is not in a table, right-click on the object and select Properties. The Numeric
Data Object Properties dialog is displayed. You can select Significant figures or Decimal
places and specify the number of Significant figures or Decimal places from the appropriate
drop-down list.
Does a graph retain the colors set in the Workspace when it is placed in a
report template?
Colors are generally retained between the Workspace and Communiqué. However, if you
wish, you can change the colors of the graphs within Communiqué.
How can I get my text blocks and data fields to line up vertically?
If a data object is placed directly on the report template is can sometimes be difficult to line
this up with an associated Text Block. To solve this, you can put the data object in its own
text block:
3. Click inside the Text Block and remove the default text.
You will now be able to align this with another Text Block easily.
Click on the object already on the template to select it (The outline turns blue to show that it
is selected and the mouse pointer changes to a four-headed arrow to show that it can be
moved). Drag the object to the new position.
Does the object frame determine the size of the spectrum that will be
displayed in my report?
Yes. You must drag the object frame to the required size. This allows you to specify how
large the spectrum will appear on your report.
The ID data object will report the Sample ID as seen in the Sample Table. This is sufficient if
you have a fairly simple Sample Table, for example just 5 samples:
However, this does not report the full sample name which includes the extension (as seen in
the Results Table). The Full ID is particularly useful if you are using Replicates or
Measurements. If, for example, you have 1 sample with 2 replicates, and you create a table
in the report template using ID, you will see the Sample ID twice but it will not show that
these are replicates:
1000 . UV WinLab Software Guide
If you use the Full ID data object, the full name including the extension will be shown:
Why do some of the data objects have a red cross through them?
Why do the examples of the data objects in the Help have '1' after them in
the Tree View but I always have a different number?
The Data Object is named (Object Name) DataX where X is numerically incremented (Object
Name)Data1, etc. for each new Data Object added to the template. You can rename the
Data Object if you wish. As long as you have followed the example, you should see the same
information in your report. The incremental number is not important.
Why is there a browse for folder option within the Communiqué print
dialog but my reports are not stored within folders?
Communiqué reporting is available to other PerkinElmer applications, and so the Print dialog
has to cater for all these applications. Folders are not available for storing reports within UV
WinLab.
Why is my column in a table not populating when I have used Indexing for
the column header?
If you have created a custom column in a table within UV WinLab, you may wish to include
this column in a table within your report template. (see 'How do I create a table that contains
all the information in my results table and will continue over several pages when printed ?'
on the Sample List page of the Help).
When you use Indexing to populate the column, you must put the name of the column within
quotes but you must not include any units that are present in the column header.
You have a Results Table column that you have created called Ordinate (that has the units A)
3. Select the Number data object in Table Columns (within the Sample List).
UV WinLab Software Guide . 1001
4. Right-click inside the data object beneath the Ordinate header and select Indexing.
The Data Object Indexing dialog is displayed:
6. Within quotes (" "), enter the name of the column as it appears in the results table -
If the name is not exactly correct (including upper and lower case letters), the table will not
populate with data.
NOTE: Do not enter the units that were in the original column header. In the above
example, (A) is included in the header in the Results Table, but if this is included in
the Index, the column will not populate.
When you print preview, the column will now populate with all the data from the Ordinate
column in the Results Table.
1002 . UV WinLab Software Guide
The tray layout is reported as part of the Data Collection settings. However, a value of 0, 1,
or 2 – corresponding to E, F, or G respectively is reported rather than the letter of the tray.
Why does the standards table in the Default Scanning Quant report not
show all the information from the Calibration page of the task?
The size of the table on the report is limited. The report will fit as many columns as possible
in the table in the order in which they are displayed within the task. You can use to Table
Builder dialog to choose which columns to hide and show, and the order of these columns
within the table and this will be reflected in the table printed in the report. See How do I
format the Standard Table (Columns tab).
This can be achieved in Communiqué by setting up a table. It is best to keep the report as
concise as possible (that is, as little other information as possible including headers and
footers). It is important to ensure that the table is fully populated. If you are using fields
from the Sample Table such as description, make sure that these are set to mandatory in the
method otherwise mis-assignment of the data fields will result.
Within the Output page of the task, select Print to file. Excel (*.csv) is one of the options
within the settings. The resulting file (which is stored under the task name unless it is
renamed) will be placed in:
The 'print to database' option is grayed. How can I send my reports to the
database?
Only reports that use approved templates can be sent to the database. You need to approve
your template. This is done from the print preview window in Communiqué.
Further Information
1004 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Further Information
See the following for further information on topics related to UV Spectroscopy.
Recommended Practices
Choice of Solvent
IPV References
UV Spectroscopy
FAQs
UV WinLab Software Guide . 1005
Recommended Practices
Following these guidelines will help ensure good instrument performance:
Plug the instrument into a proper power line free from interference.
Do not drop the instrument and do not place instrument on an uneven benchtop.
Do not block air flow to the instrument or partially cover the instrument during operation.
Handle the sources by the base and always wipe off the envelope before installation.
Do not get fingerprints on cells or allow reagent to run down the sides of the cells. Wipe the
cell clean before placing it into the instrument.
Change source lamp(s) when performance begins to degrade instead of waiting until the
lamp(s) burn out. Tungsten halide lamps provide a continuous energy output throughout lamp
life, and no degradation of instrument performance with lamp age.
Increase the lamp life by turning off the lamp when not in use and keeping the instrument
power on.
Always refer to the operating directions for details on each individual instrument, as well as for
manufacturer's practices for optimum performance.
1006 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Take special care not to touch or scratch the optical surfaces when inserting a calibration
standard into the cell holder in the spectrometer.
After use, do not place calibration standards on the laboratory bench, but return them
immediately to their storage container.
Always keep the storage container closed in a safe place where dust cannot accumulate on it.
Do not clean the optical surfaces of calibration standards unless absolutely essential. If you
need to clean the optical surfaces, for example to remove a fingerprint, very carefully press
the glass filter out of the spring mount with a soft wooden probe. Take care to hold the filter
only by the edges. Clean the optical surfaces by very carefully wiping them with a soft, lint-
free cloth moistened with ethanol. Return the filter to the spring mount with the same
orientation and press it into place with a soft wooden probe.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 1007
Choice of Solvent
The table below gives a list of some common solvents and the minimum wavelength from which
they may be used in a 1 cm cell.
acetonitrile 190
water 191
cyclohexane 195
hexane 195
methanol 201
ethanol 204
ether 215
chloroform 237
IPV References
National Bureau of Standards, (1983) Accuracy in Analytical Spectrophotometry, NBS Special
Publication, 260-82, National Bureau of Standards, Washington, D.C.
Alman, D.H., Billmeyer, F.W., (1975) "A Review of Wavelength Calibration Methods for Visible-
Range Photoelectric Spectrophotometers", J. Chem Ed. 52(5), A28, 53(6), A325.
Bohme, W., Steinwand, M., (1983) "UV/VIS Spectrometers as Detectors in Modern Liquid
Chromatography", Applied UV Spectroscopy, 9E, Bodenseewerk PerkinElmer GmbH,
Uberlingen Germany.
Burgess, C., Knowles, A., (1986) Standards in Absorption Spectrometry, Chapman and Hall
Ltd., London/New York.
Demey, R.C., Sinclair R, (1987) Visible and Ultraviolet Spectroscopy, John Wiley and Sons,
New York.
Denny R.C., (1973) A dictionary of spectroscopy, MacMillan Press Ltd,, London, pp. 1-161.
Coleman Instruments Division, (1972) Directions for Didymium Calibration Standard. Oak
Brook, IL: Coleman Instruments Division, No 6-400, D241R.
Eckerle, K.L., Sutter, E., et al., (1990) "International Comparison of Regular Transmittance
Scales", Metrologia.
Lange, B., Vejdelek, Z.K., (1980) "Photometrische Analyse", Verlag Chemie, Weinheim.
Macdonald, R.P., (1964) "Uses for a holmium oxide filter in spectrophotometry", Clin. Chem.,
10, pp. 1117-1120.
Rand, R.N., (1972) "The Role of Spectrophotometric Standards in the Clinical Chemistry
Laboratory", NBS Special Publication 378, National Bureau of Standards, Washington, D.C.
Slavin, W., (1963) "Stray light in ultraviolet, visible and near-infra-red spectrophotometry",
Anal. Chem., 35, pp. 561-566.
American Society of Testing Materials Committee E13 (1969) "Standard definitions of terms
and symbols relating to molecular spectroscopy (E131-71)", Manual on Recommended
Practices in Spectroscopy, American Society of Testing Materials Committee E13, Philadelphia,
PA, pp. 10-34.
American Society of Testing Materials Committee E13 (1974) "Standard method of estimating
stray radiant energy (E387-72), Analytical Methods of Spectroscopy, American Society of
Testing Materials Committee E13, Philadelphia, PA, Annual Book of ASTM Standards, pp. 291-
302.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 1009
American Society of Testing Materials Committee E13 (1974) "Standard recommended practice
for describing and measuring performance of spectrophotometers", Analytical Methods of
Spectroscopy, American Society of Testing Materials Committee E13, Philadelphia, PA, Annual
Book of ASTM Standards, pp. 193-212.
UV Spectroscopy
Ultraviolet and visible (UV/Vis) absorption spectroscopy is the measurement of the attenuation of a
beam of light after it passes through a sample. Absorption measurements can be made over a
wavelength range or at single wavelengths.
UV/Vis spectra have broad features that are of limited use for sample identification, but the spectra
are very useful for quantitative measurements. The concentration of an analyte in solution can be
determined by measuring the absorbance at a particular wavelength and applying the Beer–
Lambert Law (Beer's Law).
The UV/Vis spectral range is defined as approximately 190 to 1100 nm. The short-wavelength limit
is determined by the absorption of spectral gases. If a spectrometer is purged with nitrogen, this
lower limit can be extended to 175 nm. Beyond 175 nm, a vacuum spectrometer and suitable
source are required. Some high-end UV/Vis spectrometers are able to extend their working range
into the NIR region as far as 3300 nm.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 1011
Electronic Transitions
Ultraviolet and visible light are energetic enough to promote outer electrons to higher energy levels,
and UV/Vis spectroscopy is usually applied to molecules or complexes in solution. There are three
types of electronic transition to consider:
When an atom or molecule absorbs energy, electrons are promoted from their ground state to an
excited state.
The solvent in which the absorbing species is dissolved also has an effect on the spectrum of the
species. Peaks resulting from to * transitions are shifted to shorter wavelengths (blue shift)
with increasing solvent polarity. This arises from increased solvation of the lone pair, which lowers
the energy of the orbital. Often, the reverse (red shift) is seen for to * transitions. This is
caused by attractive polarization forces between the solvent and the absorber, which lowers the
energy levels of the excited and unexcited states.
to(oxygen, nitrogen, sulfur, and halogen compounds) - This transition is possible for
compounds with lone pairs of electrons. The transition needs less energy than to.
Many inorganic species show charge-transfer absorption and are therefore called charge-transfer
complexes. These species must have one component that has electron donating properties and one
component that is able to accept electrons. Absorption of radiation then involves the transfer of an
electron from the donor to an orbital associated with the acceptor.
Molar absorptivities from charge-transfer absorption are greater than 10000 L mol –1 cm–1.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 1013
High humidity and temperature may cause water condensation on the optical surfaces, which
results in performance degradation. In extreme cases it may also affect some electronic
components as well, resulting in early failure of parts.
Aging Lamp
An aging lamp causes a reduction in energy, which lowers performance and increases noise and
stray radiation.
Alignment
Improper lamp alignment after lamp installation causes loss of energy and results in noise and
degradation of performance. Improper alignment of the cell holder in the radiation beam also
causes loss of energy and poor performance. When micro-cells or micro flowcells are used, proper
alignment is critical.
Warm-up Time
If the instrument has not reached its specified warm-up time, it may not perform according to
specification.
Sample Handling
Poor chemistry, improper procedure or method, and scratched or unclean cells can cause
degradation of performance.
1014 . UV WinLab Software Guide
Aging of Instrument
Optical degradation with time, unclean environment and humidity all cause loss of energy and
result in degradation of performance.
Electrical component aging may cause a calibration change and results in degradation of
performance.
Photodetector aging or exposure of the detector to room light may cause failure or poor
performance. High humidity may cause drift and photometric error. Photodiodes are less sensitive
to these influences.
The Administrator has been likened to the King in a game of chess – the most important person,
but with limited rights. As an Administrator, you can make yourself a member of another group that
will then give you access to all areas of the software. If you make yourself a member of the default
groups provided, you will have access to everything. The software is designed like this as Software
Administrators may not possess an analytical chemistry background and therefore may not be
qualified to run an analysis.
This is very serious as there is not a 'back door' into the software. This is to ensure 21 CFR part 11
compliance.
We strongly recommend that at least one more Administrator is created. A very good idea is to
create a dummy administrator whose log-in is stored in a secure location (such as a safe).
I am concerned that it looks like I am able to clear the security audit trail. Is
this possible?
The Security Audit Trail can be deleted only once it has been exported. You will not be allowed to
proceed unless the information has been first saved as a file. Once the data has been exported, it
becomes your responsibility.
The security (Users.mdb) is the smallest and contains all users and log-in information. This
database MUST remain resident on the PC and cannot be run on a network.
The second database, UVWinLab.mdb, stores all the methods and tasks (data) associated with
those methods as well as the IPV (Instrument Performance Verification) information.
The third database, Communiqué.mdb, is concerned with all aspects of the Communiqué
reporting tool.
Please refer to the Administrator's Guide (provided with UV WinLab ES) for further information.
The UV WinLab and Communiqué databases can be placed on a network although it is the
responsibility of the customer to ensure that their network it reliable and secure. UV WinLab has
not been designed as a multi-access 'client/server' system but it will allow the data to be stored
remotely from the PC. The security database (users.mdb) MUST remain local to the PC.
1016 . UV WinLab Software Guide
No. Two of the databases are too large for this to happen after every writing to the database
event. The system does make a backup of the security database for its own internal purposes but,
as this is still resident on the hard drive, it cannot be regarded as a backup for archive purposes, as
data will be lost in the event of a catastrophic hard disk failure.
...\PerkinElmer\Security System\Users.mdb
...\PerkinElmer\UVWinLab\Communique.mdb
...\PerkinElmer\UVWinLab\UVWinLab.mdb
We do not make specific recommendations on how to do this, but it is the client's responsibility to
ensure that this is done.
There are three levels of security within the main UV WinLab database:
Data is written to the database as a Binary Large Object (BLOB) which makes it impossible to
view the raw data in, for example, a text editor.
The data is then encrypted using a proprietary encryption (RSA encryption). This is about as
secure as encryption is allowed to be for civilian applications.
Finally, the records of the database are checksummed to make them tamper-evident.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 1017
Some aspects of my system have started to run more slowly, why is this?
Assuming that you PC is of the correct specification, it could be that your Communiqué or UV
WinLab databases have become very large. You should try compacting the database (using
Database Tools). If this doesn't improve the situation, consider archiving your old database and
starting a new one (you will need to export methods and templates from the old database(s) to the
new one(s).
The system insists of the file system being configured as NTFS (NT File System) during installation.
This means that only Windows Administrators can delete databases. Normal users will not be able
to accidentally delete protected files.
Yes. In Database Tools there is a Check Database option that allows you to do this.
Yes. Similarly, if your data was on the hard disk and you had a catastrophic failure of the hard
drive, you would also have lost your data. UV WinLab ES is technically compliant with 21 CFR part
11, but, the system administrator also has obligations to make sure that the software is being used
in a compliant manner. Regular backup of the databases is part of your obligation to the FDA.
Yes, there is. It is provided as a .pdf file. On the toolbar of this Help file is a button called User's
Guide. Click this and it will access a .pdf version of this Help file.
Assuming you have the correct permissions to review and approve methods, you need to lock the
method first.
When the method is first locked. If you wish to revise a method, it can be unlocked, edited and
locked again (this will be reflected in the audit trail).
You need to set up replicates in the sample table (design). If you want to average an absorbance
at 450 nm (for example), you should set up an equation:
Yval(SampleID.Replicates,450)
Mean(Equation1)
This will then create a separate table (replicates table) that will display the mean values.
Why does the software not appear to respond when I make changes?
If you have made any changes that affect the instrument settings, the software relays these
changes to the instrument. This may take several seconds, during which time any other changes to
the software may not be seen. The software will update correctly when the communication with the
instrument is complete.
This indicates a detector overload. In addition, an exclamation mark is displayed next to the
ordinate value in the Instrument Status Bar and an 'Invalid data: overflow reference' tooltip is also
displayed. Alter the slit and/or gain settings on the Data Collection page of the Workspace.
Why can't I access the instrument properties page from manual control?
If you cannot access the Instrument Properties page from Manual Control it is likely that the lamp
usage is beyond the specified limit. You will see the progress bar on the screen and a lamp warning
prompt beneath the progress bar. If the lamp warning is confirmed, the Instrument Properties page
is displayed but the progress bar remains.
This can be resolved by resetting the lamp usage. See Instruments for further information about
changing and resetting lamps.
Why can't I edit a locked method when I have 'create and edit methods and
IPV set-ups' permission?
Once a method has been locked it cannot be edited. If you wish to edit the method, you must open
it by clicking the right mouse button on the Method name in the Explorer and selecting View, and
then use the Save As - Method command from the File menu to save the method with a new
name.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 1019
Why is sample position one used for sampling when I have added a sample to
the Sample Table after my previous samples have been run, even when I have
specified a different sample position?
When all the samples in the Sample Table have been run, and then a further sample is added, the
default sample position is 1. You can select another position from the drop-down list. However, you
must then click outside of this cell (containing the new sample position) for the software to
recognize the change. If you click Run without moving out of the cell, the software will
automatically use position 1.
Why can't I select substrate concentration within End Point Analysis (Rate)
when I reprocess the task?
By definition, the substrate concentration calculation needs a column to be present in the Sample
Table. However, it is not possible to edit the Sample Table when reprocessing a task.
What correction spectra are collected when I set the sample beam attenuator
to automatic (High performance instruments only, excluding the Lambda 650
and 750 spectrometers) and then press Autozero ?
Attenuator spectrum – Sample beam set to the value defined for the reference beam
attenuator on the Data Collection page (for example, 1% or 10%) and reference beam set to
100%.
How do I save the attenuator correction spectra as part of a method but collect
other correction spectra (baselines) when I run a task?
1. Create a method.
2. On the Data Collection page select automatic attenuator for the sample beam and select the
value for the reference beam.
4. Select the Frequency as As required at task start or As required before next measurement.
6. Click .
The attenuator data (correction spectra) are collected.
7. When the spectra have been collected, select the required baseline options and set the
required expiry time for the attenuator corrections.
NOTE: You may also wish to stop the software from invalidating the attenuator corrections when
instrument settings (for example, slit width) are changed, by selecting Do not invalidate
attenuator corrections.
1020 . UV WinLab Software Guide
In future when the method is run, only the baselines selected will be collected and not the
attenuator correction spectra.
Why is the residual column on the results page not populated when I run a
Quant method?
The residual column can only be calculated for samples in the Sample Table in the 'expected'
concentration has been entered. To do this, you must add the Concentration column to the Sample
Table and enter the value for all samples. The residual is this 'expected' concentration minus the
analyte concentration.
If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab you may not have the necessary
permission to reprocess tasks. You should contact your UV WinLab Administrator for further
information about your permissions
If the method used to create the task is locked, reviewed or approved, you will not be able to
reprocess the task.
No, it means that if you have selected more than one test as part of your IPV, it will abort further
tests. This just saves you unnecessary effort.
This depends on how you set up the permissions. If an IPV is due, it will prompt you when you run
a method. If you do not have permission to perform an IPV or are logged on as an analyst, it will
not let you proceed. If you are a method developer, you will be able to postpone the IPV to a more
convenient time.
Why are there two identical sample and two identical block prompts in the
summary for the IPV Stray light with sodium nitrite test?
In the test setup there is one sample prompt row and one block row only where the message text
can be edited. However, the test is performed at two wavelengths, so the same sample and block
messages are used for each wavelength. In the summary, Pre-Sample-Prompt-2 and Pre-Sample-
Prompt-4 are the sample message text. Pre-Sample-Prompt-1 and Pre-Sample-Prompt-3 are the
block message text.
Why do I get a full report and summary report for my IPV test(s)?
If Report summary only is selected, only the report summary is printed. However, if Report
summary only is not selected, both the full report and summary report are printed by default.
UV WinLab Software Guide . 1021
IPV results can be reviewed and approved from the Results Browser. Create an IPV query to search
for the results you wish to review/approve. From the list of results displayed, select the required
result(s) and from the Tools menu select Review or Approve.
For tests involving standards, the IPV report has 4 boxes for standard details regardless of the
number of samples used. However, if the particular test (for example, Photometric accuracy with
K2Cr2O7 solution) has only one standard, 3 of the fields will be empty.
Printing
Why does my graph print badly when I have copied it from the clipboard into a
report?
When you select Copy to Clipboard, 2 copies of the graph are placed on the clipboard - a bitmap
and an enhanced metafile.
A bitmap of the graph is the same dimension as the current graph window. This is an EXACT copy
of what is shown on the screen. It will include the information page. The graph will have the same
resolution as the screen. This means, the bigger the graph is shown in UV WinLab, the bigger the
bitmap and the better the resolution. This format should be used for screen reports.
The enhanced metafile (EMF) is the same physical dimension as the screen but it is produced for
the default printer rather than the screen and is therefore of much higher resolution. This is the
format that should be used if you wish to print the report as the curve will appear much smoother
than if the bitmap is used. There is a disadvantage with the metafile. If you stretch the image, you
must keep the same aspect ratio as the original image otherwise you will get overlapping
characters if the image is stretched in the vertical direction but not the horizontal direction. If you
perform a non-proportional stretch with a bitmap, the characters just become stretched on one
direction (rather than overlapping) but the curve starts to become 'blocky'.
You need to use the Paste Special command within Word to see the different formats. Word gives
the options: Picture, Bitmap, Device Independent Bitmap, and EMF. If you use Paste rather
than Paste Special, Word will use the Picture format by default.
Why can I not print a report despite selecting the settings on the Output page
of the Workspace?
If you are using the Enhanced Security version of UV WinLab is it likely that you do not have
permission to print reports. Contact your UV WinLab Administrator for information about your
permissions.
1022 . UV WinLab Software Guide